Demangler crash handler
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 @cindex quotes in commands
1604 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1605 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1606 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1607 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1608 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1609 @value{GDBN} commands.
1610
1611 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1612 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1613 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1614 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1615 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1616 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1617 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1618 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1619 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1620 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1621 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1625 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1626 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1627 @end smallexample
1628
1629 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1630 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1631 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1632 place:
1633
1634 @smallexample
1635 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1636 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1637 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1638 @end smallexample
1639
1640 @noindent
1641 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1642 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1643 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1644
1645 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1646 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1647 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1648 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1649
1650 @cindex completion of structure field names
1651 @cindex structure field name completion
1652 @cindex completion of union field names
1653 @cindex union field name completion
1654 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1655 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1656 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1657 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1658 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1659 left-hand-side:
1660
1661 @smallexample
1662 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1663 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1664 to_data to_isatty to_write
1665 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1666 to_flush to_read
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @noindent
1670 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1671 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1672 follows:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 struct ui_file
1676 @{
1677 int *magic;
1678 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1679 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1680 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1681 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1682 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1683 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1684 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1685 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1686 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1687 void *to_data;
1688 @}
1689 @end smallexample
1690
1691
1692 @node Help
1693 @section Getting Help
1694 @cindex online documentation
1695 @kindex help
1696
1697 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1698 using the command @code{help}.
1699
1700 @table @code
1701 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1702 @item help
1703 @itemx h
1704 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1705 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 (@value{GDBP}) help
1709 List of classes of commands:
1710
1711 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1712 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1713 data -- Examining data
1714 files -- Specifying and examining files
1715 internals -- Maintenance commands
1716 obscure -- Obscure features
1717 running -- Running the program
1718 stack -- Examining the stack
1719 status -- Status inquiries
1720 support -- Support facilities
1721 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1722 stopping the program
1723 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1724
1725 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1726 commands in that class.
1727 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1728 documentation.
1729 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1730 (@value{GDBP})
1731 @end smallexample
1732 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1733
1734 @item help @var{class}
1735 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1736 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1737 help display for the class @code{status}:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1741 Status inquiries.
1742
1743 List of commands:
1744
1745 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1746 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1747 info -- Generic command for showing things
1748 about the program being debugged
1749 show -- Generic command for showing things
1750 about the debugger
1751
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757
1758 @item help @var{command}
1759 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1760 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1761
1762 @kindex apropos
1763 @item apropos @var{args}
1764 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1765 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1766 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1767
1768 @smallexample
1769 apropos alias
1770 @end smallexample
1771
1772 @noindent
1773 results in:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 @c @group
1777 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1778 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1779 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1780 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1781 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1782 @c @end group
1783 @end smallexample
1784
1785 @kindex complete
1786 @item complete @var{args}
1787 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1788 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1789 command you want completed. For example:
1790
1791 @smallexample
1792 complete i
1793 @end smallexample
1794
1795 @noindent results in:
1796
1797 @smallexample
1798 @group
1799 if
1800 ignore
1801 info
1802 inspect
1803 @end group
1804 @end smallexample
1805
1806 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1807 @end table
1808
1809 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1810 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1811 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1812 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1813 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1814 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1815 Index}.
1816
1817 @c @group
1818 @table @code
1819 @kindex info
1820 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1821 @item info
1822 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1823 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1824 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1825 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1826 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1827 @w{@code{help info}}.
1828
1829 @kindex set
1830 @item set
1831 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1832 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1833 @code{set prompt $}.
1834
1835 @kindex show
1836 @item show
1837 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1838 @value{GDBN} itself.
1839 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1840 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1841 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1842 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1843
1844 @kindex info set
1845 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1846 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1847 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1848 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1849 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1850 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1851 @end table
1852 @c @end group
1853
1854 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1855 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex show version
1859 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1860 @item show version
1861 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1862 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1863 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1864 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1865 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1866 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1867 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1868 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1869 @value{GDBN}.
1870
1871 @kindex show copying
1872 @kindex info copying
1873 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1874 @item show copying
1875 @itemx info copying
1876 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1877
1878 @kindex show warranty
1879 @kindex info warranty
1880 @item show warranty
1881 @itemx info warranty
1882 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1883 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1884
1885 @kindex show configuration
1886 @item show configuration
1887 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1888 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1889 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1890 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1891 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1892 your report.
1893
1894 @end table
1895
1896 @node Running
1897 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1898
1899 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1900 debugging information when you compile it.
1901
1902 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1903 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1904 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1905 kill a child process.
1906
1907 @menu
1908 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1909 * Starting:: Starting your program
1910 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1911 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1912
1913 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1914 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1915 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1916 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1917
1918 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1919 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1920 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1921 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1922 @end menu
1923
1924 @node Compilation
1925 @section Compiling for Debugging
1926
1927 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1928 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1929 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1930 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1931 and addresses in the executable code.
1932
1933 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1934 the compiler.
1935
1936 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1937 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1938 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1939 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1940 executables containing debugging information.
1941
1942 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1943 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1944 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1945 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1946 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1947
1948 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1949 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1950 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1951
1952 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1953 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1954 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1955 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1956 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1957 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1958
1959 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1960 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1961 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1962
1963 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1964 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1965 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1966 format in @value{GDBN}.
1967
1968 @need 2000
1969 @node Starting
1970 @section Starting your Program
1971 @cindex starting
1972 @cindex running
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex run
1976 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1977 @item run
1978 @itemx r
1979 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1980 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1981 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1982 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1983 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1984
1985 @end table
1986
1987 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1988 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1989 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1990 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1991 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1992 message like this one:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1996 Try "help target" or "continue".
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 @noindent
2000 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2001 first (@pxref{load}).
2002
2003 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2004 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2005 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2006 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2007 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2008 divided into four categories:
2009
2010 @table @asis
2011 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2012 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2013 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2014 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2015 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2016 the arguments.
2017 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2018 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2019 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2020 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2021 below for details).
2022
2023 @item The @emph{environment.}
2024 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2025 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2026 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2027 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2028
2029 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2030 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2031 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2032 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2033
2034 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2035 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2036 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2037 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2038 set a different device for your program.
2039 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2040
2041 @cindex pipes
2042 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2043 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2044 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2045 wrong program.
2046 @end table
2047
2048 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2049 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2050 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2051 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2052 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2053
2054 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2055 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2056 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2057 your current breakpoints.
2058
2059 @table @code
2060 @kindex start
2061 @item start
2062 @cindex run to main procedure
2063 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2064 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2065 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2066 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2067 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2068 procedure, depending on the language used.
2069
2070 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2071 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2072 the @samp{run} command.
2073
2074 @cindex elaboration phase
2075 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2076 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2077 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2078 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2079 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2080 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2081 will remain to halt execution.
2082
2083 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2084 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2085 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2086 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2087 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2088
2089 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2090 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2091 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2092 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2093 elaboration code before running your program.
2094
2095 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2096 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2097 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2098 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2099 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2100 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2101 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2102 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2103 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2104 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2105 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2106 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2107
2108 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2109 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2110 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2111 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2112
2113 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2114 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2115 environment:
2116
2117 @smallexample
2118 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2119 (@value{GDBP}) run
2120 @end smallexample
2121
2122 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2123 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2124
2125 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2126 @item set startup-with-shell
2127 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2128 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2129 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2130 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2131 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2132 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2133 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2134 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2135 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2136 startup failures such as:
2137
2138 @smallexample
2139 (@value{GDBP}) run
2140 Starting program: ./a.out
2141 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2142 @end smallexample
2143
2144 @noindent
2145 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2146 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2147 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2148 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2149 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2150 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2151
2152 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2153 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2154 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2155 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2156 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2157 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2158
2159 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2160 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2161 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2162 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2163 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2164 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2165
2166 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2167 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2168 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2169
2170 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2171 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2172
2173 @smallexample
2174 (@value{GDBP}) run
2175 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2176 @end smallexample
2177
2178 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2179 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2180
2181 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2182 @code{target native} command. For example,
2183
2184 @smallexample
2185 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2186 (@value{GDBP}) run
2187 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2188 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2189 (@value{GDBP}) run
2190 Starting program: ./a.out
2191 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2192 @end smallexample
2193
2194 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2195 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2196 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2197 disconnect.
2198
2199 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2200 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2201 proc}, @code{info os}.
2202
2203 @kindex set disable-randomization
2204 @item set disable-randomization
2205 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2206 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2207 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2208 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2209 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2210
2211 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2212 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2216 @end smallexample
2217
2218 @item set disable-randomization off
2219 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2220 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2221 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2222 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2223 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2224 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2225
2226 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2227 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2228 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2229 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2230 a code at its expected addresses.
2231
2232 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2233 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2234 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2235 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2236 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2237 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2238 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2239 a randomly chosen address.
2240
2241 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2242 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2243 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2244 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2245 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2246
2247 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2248 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2249
2250 @item show disable-randomization
2251 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2252 the virtual address space of the started program.
2253
2254 @end table
2255
2256 @node Arguments
2257 @section Your Program's Arguments
2258
2259 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2260 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2261 @code{run} command.
2262 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2263 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2264 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2265 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2266 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2267
2268 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2269 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2270 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2271 the program, not by the shell.
2272
2273 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2274 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @kindex set args
2278 @item set args
2279 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2280 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2281 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2282 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2283 it again without arguments.
2284
2285 @kindex show args
2286 @item show args
2287 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2288 @end table
2289
2290 @node Environment
2291 @section Your Program's Environment
2292
2293 @cindex environment (of your program)
2294 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2295 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2296 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2297 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2298 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2299 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2300 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex path
2304 @item path @var{directory}
2305 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2306 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2307 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2308 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2309 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2310 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2311 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2312
2313 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2314 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2315 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2316 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2317 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2318 @var{directory} to the search path.
2319 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2320 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2321
2322 @kindex show paths
2323 @item show paths
2324 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2325 environment variable).
2326
2327 @kindex show environment
2328 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2329 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2330 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2331 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2332 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2333
2334 @kindex set environment
2335 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2336 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2337 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2338 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2339 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2340 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2341 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2342 null value.
2343 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2344 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2345
2346 For example, this command:
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 set env USER = foo
2350 @end smallexample
2351
2352 @noindent
2353 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2354 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2355 are not actually required.)
2356
2357 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2358 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2359 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2360 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2361 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2362
2363 @kindex unset environment
2364 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2365 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2366 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2367 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2368 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2369 @end table
2370
2371 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2372 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2373 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2374 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2375 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2376 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2377 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2378 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2379 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2380 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2381
2382 @node Working Directory
2383 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2384
2385 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2386 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2387 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2388 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2389 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2390 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2391
2392 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2393 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2394 Specify Files}.
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @kindex cd
2398 @cindex change working directory
2399 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2400 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2401 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2402
2403 @kindex pwd
2404 @item pwd
2405 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2409 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2410 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2411 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2412 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2413 current working directory of the debuggee.
2414
2415 @node Input/Output
2416 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2417
2418 @cindex redirection
2419 @cindex i/o
2420 @cindex terminal
2421 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2422 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2423 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2424 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2425 running your program.
2426
2427 @table @code
2428 @kindex info terminal
2429 @item info terminal
2430 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2431 program is using.
2432 @end table
2433
2434 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2435 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2436
2437 @smallexample
2438 run > outfile
2439 @end smallexample
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2443
2444 @kindex tty
2445 @cindex controlling terminal
2446 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2447 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2448 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2449 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2450 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2451
2452 @smallexample
2453 tty /dev/ttyb
2454 @end smallexample
2455
2456 @noindent
2457 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2458 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2459 that as their controlling terminal.
2460
2461 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2462 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2463 terminal.
2464
2465 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2466 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2467 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2468 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2469
2470 @cindex inferior tty
2471 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2472 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2473 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2474 program.
2475
2476 @table @code
2477 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2478 @kindex set inferior-tty
2479 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2480
2481 @item show inferior-tty
2482 @kindex show inferior-tty
2483 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2484 @end table
2485
2486 @node Attach
2487 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2488 @kindex attach
2489 @cindex attach
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @item attach @var{process-id}
2493 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2494 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2495 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2496 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2497 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2498
2499 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2500 executing the command.
2501 @end table
2502
2503 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2504 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2505 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2506 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2507
2508 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2509 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2510 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2511 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2512 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2513 Specify Files}.
2514
2515 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2516 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2517 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2518 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2519 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2520 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2521 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @kindex detach
2525 @item detach
2526 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2527 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2528 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2529 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2530 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2531 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2536 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2537 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2538 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2539 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2540 Messages}).
2541
2542 @node Kill Process
2543 @section Killing the Child Process
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex kill
2547 @item kill
2548 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2549 @end table
2550
2551 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2552 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2553 is running.
2554
2555 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2556 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2557 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2558 outside the debugger.
2559
2560 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2561 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2562 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2563 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2564 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2565 breakpoint settings).
2566
2567 @node Inferiors and Programs
2568 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2569
2570 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2571 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2572 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2573 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2574 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2575 from multiple executables.
2576
2577 @cindex inferior
2578 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2579 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2580 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2581 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2582 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2583 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2584 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2585 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2586 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2587 threads running in it.
2588
2589 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2590 inferiors}}:
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex info inferiors
2594 @item info inferiors
2595 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2598
2599 @enumerate
2600 @item
2601 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2602
2603 @item
2604 the target system's inferior identifier
2605
2606 @item
2607 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2608
2609 @end enumerate
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2613 indicates the current inferior.
2614
2615 For example,
2616 @end table
2617 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2618
2619 @smallexample
2620 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2621 Num Description Executable
2622 2 process 2307 hello
2623 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2624 @end smallexample
2625
2626 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2630 @item inferior @var{infno}
2631 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2632 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2633 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2634 @end table
2635
2636
2637 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2638 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2639 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2640 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2641 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2642 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @kindex add-inferior
2646 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2647 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2648 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2649 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2650 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2651 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2652
2653 @kindex clone-inferior
2654 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2655 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2656 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2657 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2658 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2662 Num Description Executable
2663 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2664 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2665 Added inferior 2.
2666 1 inferiors added.
2667 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2668 Num Description Executable
2669 2 <null> helloworld
2670 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2671 @end smallexample
2672
2673 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2674
2675 @kindex remove-inferiors
2676 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2677 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2678 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2679 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2680
2681 @end table
2682
2683 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2684 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2685 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2686 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2687
2688 @table @code
2689 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2690 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2691 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2692 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2693 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2694 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2695
2696 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2697 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2698 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2699 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2700 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2701 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2702 @end table
2703
2704 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2705 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2706 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2707 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2708
2709
2710 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2711 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set print inferior-events
2715 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2716 @item set print inferior-events
2717 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2718 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2719 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2720 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2721 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2722 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2723
2724 @kindex show print inferior-events
2725 @item show print inferior-events
2726 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2727 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2728 @end table
2729
2730 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2731 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2732 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2733
2734
2735 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2736 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2737 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2738 info program-spaces}} command.
2739
2740 @table @code
2741 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2742 @item maint info program-spaces
2743 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2744 @value{GDBN}.
2745
2746 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2747
2748 @enumerate
2749 @item
2750 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2751
2752 @item
2753 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2754 the @code{file} command.
2755
2756 @end enumerate
2757
2758 @noindent
2759 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2760 indicates the current program space.
2761
2762 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2763 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2764 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2765
2766 @smallexample
2767 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2768 Id Executable
2769 2 goodbye
2770 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2771 * 1 hello
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2775 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2776 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2777 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2778 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2782 Id Executable
2783 * 1 vfork-test
2784 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2785 @end smallexample
2786
2787 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2788 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2789 @end table
2790
2791 @node Threads
2792 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2793
2794 @cindex threads of execution
2795 @cindex multiple threads
2796 @cindex switching threads
2797 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2798 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2799 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2800 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2801 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2802 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2803 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2804
2805 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2806 programs:
2807
2808 @itemize @bullet
2809 @item automatic notification of new threads
2810 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2811 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2812 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2813 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2814 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2815 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2816 messages on thread start and exit.
2817 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2818 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2819 isn't compatible with the program.
2820 @end itemize
2821
2822 @quotation
2823 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2824 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2825 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2826 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2827 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2828 like this:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2832 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2833 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2834 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2835 @end smallexample
2836 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2837 @c doesn't support threads"?
2838 @end quotation
2839
2840 @cindex focus of debugging
2841 @cindex current thread
2842 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2843 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2844 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2845 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2846 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2847
2848 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2849 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2850 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2851 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2852 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2853 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2854 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2855 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2856 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2857 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2861 @end smallexample
2862
2863 @noindent
2864 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2865 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2866 further qualifier.
2867
2868 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2869 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2870 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2871 @c program?
2872 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2873 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2874 @c threads ab initio?
2875
2876 @cindex thread number
2877 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2878 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2879 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @kindex info threads
2883 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2884 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2885 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2886 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2887 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2888
2889 @enumerate
2890 @item
2891 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2892
2893 @item
2894 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2895
2896 @item
2897 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2898 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2899 program itself.
2900
2901 @item
2902 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2903 @end enumerate
2904
2905 @noindent
2906 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2907 indicates the current thread.
2908
2909 For example,
2910 @end table
2911 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2915 Id Target Id Frame
2916 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2917 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2918 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2919 at threadtest.c:68
2920 @end smallexample
2921
2922 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2923 Solaris-specific command:
2924
2925 @table @code
2926 @item maint info sol-threads
2927 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2928 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2929 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2930 @end table
2931
2932 @table @code
2933 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2934 @item thread @var{threadno}
2935 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2936 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2937 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2938 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2939 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2943 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2944 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2945 8 printf ("hello\n");
2946 @end smallexample
2947
2948 @noindent
2949 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2950 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2951 threads.
2952
2953 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2954 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2955 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2956 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2957 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2958 information on convenience variables.
2959
2960 @kindex thread apply
2961 @cindex apply command to several threads
2962 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2963 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2964 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2965 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2966 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2967 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2968 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2969 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2970
2971 @kindex thread name
2972 @cindex name a thread
2973 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2974 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2975 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2976 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2977
2978 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2979 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2980 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2981 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2982 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2983
2984 @kindex thread find
2985 @cindex search for a thread
2986 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2987 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2988 matches the supplied regular expression.
2989
2990 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2991 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2992 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2993 is the LWP id.
2994
2995 @smallexample
2996 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2997 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2998 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2999 Id Target Id Frame
3000 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3001 @end smallexample
3002
3003 @kindex set print thread-events
3004 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3005 @item set print thread-events
3006 @itemx set print thread-events on
3007 @itemx set print thread-events off
3008 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3009 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3010 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3011 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3012 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3013
3014 @kindex show print thread-events
3015 @item show print thread-events
3016 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3017 have started and exited.
3018 @end table
3019
3020 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3021 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3022 programs with multiple threads.
3023
3024 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3025 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3026
3027 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3028 @table @code
3029 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3030 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3031 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3032 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3033 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3034 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3035 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3036 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3037 macro.
3038
3039 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3040 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3041 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3042 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3043 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3044 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3045
3046 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3047 refers to the default system directories that are
3048 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3049 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3050 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3051
3052 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3053 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3054 was loaded in the inferior process.
3055
3056 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3057 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3058 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3059 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3060 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3061 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3062 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3063
3064 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3065 only on some platforms.
3066
3067 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3068 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3069 Display current libthread_db search path.
3070
3071 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3072 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3073 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3074 @item set debug libthread-db
3075 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3076 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3077 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @node Forks
3081 @section Debugging Forks
3082
3083 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3084 @cindex multiple processes
3085 @cindex processes, multiple
3086 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3087 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3088 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3089 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3090 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3091 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3092 will cause it to terminate.
3093
3094 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3095 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3096 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3097 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3098 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3099 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3100 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3101 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3102 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3103 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3104
3105 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3106 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3107 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3108 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3109
3110 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3111 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3112
3113 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3114 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3115
3116 @table @code
3117 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3118 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3119 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3120 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3121 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3122
3123 @table @code
3124 @item parent
3125 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3126 unimpeded. This is the default.
3127
3128 @item child
3129 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3130 unimpeded.
3131
3132 @end table
3133
3134 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3135 @item show follow-fork-mode
3136 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3140 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3141 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3142
3143 @table @code
3144 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3145 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3146 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3147 retain debugger control over them both.
3148
3149 @table @code
3150 @item on
3151 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3152 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3153 independently. This is the default.
3154
3155 @item off
3156 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3157 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3158 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3159 is held suspended.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3164 @item show detach-on-fork
3165 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3166 @end table
3167
3168 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3169 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3170 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3171 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3172 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3173 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3174
3175 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3176 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3177 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3178 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3179 and Programs}.
3180
3181 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3182 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3183 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3184 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3185 the child process's @code{main}.
3186
3187 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3188 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3189
3190 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3191 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3192 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3193 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3194 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3195 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3196 command.
3197
3198 @table @code
3199 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3200 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3201
3202 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3203 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3204
3205 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3206
3207 @table @code
3208 @item new
3209 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3210 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3211 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3212 original inferior.
3213
3214 For example:
3215
3216 @smallexample
3217 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3218 (gdb) info inferior
3219 Id Description Executable
3220 * 1 <null> prog1
3221 (@value{GDBP}) run
3222 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3223 Program exited normally.
3224 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3225 Id Description Executable
3226 * 2 <null> prog2
3227 1 <null> prog1
3228 @end smallexample
3229
3230 @item same
3231 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3232 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3233 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3234 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3235 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3236
3237 For example:
3238
3239 @smallexample
3240 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3241 Id Description Executable
3242 * 1 <null> prog1
3243 (@value{GDBP}) run
3244 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3245 Program exited normally.
3246 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog2
3249 @end smallexample
3250
3251 @end table
3252 @end table
3253
3254 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3255 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3256 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3257
3258 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3259 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3260
3261 @cindex checkpoint
3262 @cindex restart
3263 @cindex bookmark
3264 @cindex snapshot of a process
3265 @cindex rewind program state
3266
3267 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3268 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3269 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3270 later.
3271
3272 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3273 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3274 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3275 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3276 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3277
3278 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3279 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3280 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3281 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3282 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3283 start again from there.
3284
3285 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3286 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3287
3288 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex checkpoint
3292 @item checkpoint
3293 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3294 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3295 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3296
3297 @kindex info checkpoints
3298 @item info checkpoints
3299 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3300 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3301 listed:
3302
3303 @table @code
3304 @item Checkpoint ID
3305 @item Process ID
3306 @item Code Address
3307 @item Source line, or label
3308 @end table
3309
3310 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3311 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3312 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3313 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3314 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3315 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3316 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3317
3318 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3319 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3320 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3321 the debugger.
3322
3323 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3324 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3325 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3326
3327 @end table
3328
3329 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3330 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3331 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3332 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3333 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3334 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3335 previously read data can be read again.
3336
3337 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3338 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3339 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3340 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3341 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3342 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3343
3344 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3345 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3346 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3347 different execution path this time.
3348
3349 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3350 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3351 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3352 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3353 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3354 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3355 potentially pose a problem.
3356
3357 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3358
3359 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3360 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3361 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3362 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3363 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3364 next.
3365
3366 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3367 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3368 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3369 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3370 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3371
3372 @node Stopping
3373 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3374
3375 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3376 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3377 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3378
3379 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3380 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3381 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3382 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3383 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3384 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3385 explicitly request this information at any time.
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @kindex info program
3389 @item info program
3390 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3391 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @menu
3395 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3396 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3397 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3398 Skipping over functions and files
3399 * Signals:: Signals
3400 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3401 @end menu
3402
3403 @node Breakpoints
3404 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3405
3406 @cindex breakpoints
3407 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3408 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3409 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3410 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3411 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3412 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3413 program.
3414
3415 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3416 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3417 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3418 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3419 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3420 call).
3421
3422 @cindex watchpoints
3423 @cindex data breakpoints
3424 @cindex memory tracing
3425 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3426 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3427 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3428 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3429 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3430 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3431 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3432 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3433 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3434 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3435 same commands.
3436
3437 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3438 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3439 Automatic Display}.
3440
3441 @cindex catchpoints
3442 @cindex breakpoint on events
3443 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3444 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3445 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3446 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3447 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3448 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3449 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3450
3451 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3452 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3453 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3454 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3455 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3456 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3457 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3458 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3459 enable it again.
3460
3461 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3462 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3463 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3464 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3465 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3466 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3467 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3468
3469 @menu
3470 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3471 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3472 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3473 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3474 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3475 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3476 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3477 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3478 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3479 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3480 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3481 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3482 @end menu
3483
3484 @node Set Breaks
3485 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3486
3487 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3488 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3489 @c
3490 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3491
3492 @kindex break
3493 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3494 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3495 @cindex latest breakpoint
3496 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3497 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3498 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3499 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3500 convenience variables.
3501
3502 @table @code
3503 @item break @var{location}
3504 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3505 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3506 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3507 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3508 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3509
3510 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3511 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3512 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3513 that situation.
3514
3515 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3516 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3517 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3518
3519 @item break
3520 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3521 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3522 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3523 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3524 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3525 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3526 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3527 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3528 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3529 inside loops.
3530
3531 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3532 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3533 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3534 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3535 existed when your program stopped.
3536
3537 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3538 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3539 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3540 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3541 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3542 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3543 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3544
3545 @kindex tbreak
3546 @item tbreak @var{args}
3547 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3548 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3549 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3550 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3551
3552 @kindex hbreak
3553 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3554 @item hbreak @var{args}
3555 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3556 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3557 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3558 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3559 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3560 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3561 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3562 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3563 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3564 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3565 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3566 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3567 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3568 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3569 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3570 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3571 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3572 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3573
3574 @kindex thbreak
3575 @item thbreak @var{args}
3576 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3577 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3578 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3579 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3580 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3581 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3582 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3583 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3584
3585 @kindex rbreak
3586 @cindex regular expression
3587 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3588 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3589 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3590 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3591 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3592 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3593 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3594 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3595 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3596
3597 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3598 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3599 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3600 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3601 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3602 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3603
3604 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3605 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3606 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3607 classes.
3608
3609 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3610 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3611 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3612
3613 @smallexample
3614 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3618 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3619 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3620 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3621 every function in a given file:
3622
3623 @smallexample
3624 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3625 @end smallexample
3626
3627 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3628 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3629
3630 @kindex info breakpoints
3631 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3632 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3633 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3634 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3635 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3636 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3637 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3638
3639 @table @emph
3640 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3641 @item Type
3642 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3643 @item Disposition
3644 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3645 @item Enabled or Disabled
3646 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3647 that are not enabled.
3648 @item Address
3649 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3650 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3651 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3652 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3653 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3654 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3655 @item What
3656 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3657 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3658 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3659 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @noindent
3663 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3664 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3665 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3666 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3667 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3668 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3669
3670 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3671 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3672 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3673 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3674
3675 @noindent
3676 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3677 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3678 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3679 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3680 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3681
3682 @noindent
3683 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3684 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3685 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3686 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3687 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3688 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3692 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3693
3694 @end table
3695
3696 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3697 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3698 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3699 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3700
3701 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3702 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3703 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3704 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3705
3706 @itemize @bullet
3707 @item
3708 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3709
3710 @item
3711 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3712 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3713
3714 @item
3715 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3716 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3717
3718 @item
3719 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3720 several places where that function is inlined.
3721 @end itemize
3722
3723 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3724 the relevant locations.
3725
3726 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3727 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3728 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3729 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3730 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3731 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3732 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3733
3734 For example:
3735
3736 @smallexample
3737 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3738 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3739 stop only if i==1
3740 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3741 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3742 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3743 @end smallexample
3744
3745 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3746 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3747 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3748 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3749 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3750 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3751 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3752 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3753 that belong to that breakpoint.
3754
3755 @cindex pending breakpoints
3756 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3757 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3758 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3759 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3760 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3761 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3762 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3763 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3764 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3765 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3766 is not yet resolved.
3767
3768 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3769 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3770 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3771 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3772 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3773 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3774
3775 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3776 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3777 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3778 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3779
3780 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3781 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3782 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3783
3784 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3785 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3786 address specification to an address:
3787
3788 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3789 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3790 @table @code
3791 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3792 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3793 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3794
3795 @item set breakpoint pending on
3796 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3797 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3798
3799 @item set breakpoint pending off
3800 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3801 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3802 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3803
3804 @item show breakpoint pending
3805 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3806 @end table
3807
3808 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3809 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3810 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3811
3812 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3813 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3814 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3815 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3816 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3817 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3818 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3819 breakpoints.
3820
3821 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3824 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3828 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3829 breakpoint must be used.
3830
3831 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3832 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3833 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3834 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3838 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3839 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3840 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3841 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3842 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3843 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3844 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3845 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3846
3847 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3848 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3849 @table @code
3850 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3851 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3852 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3853 removed from the target when it stops.
3854
3855 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3856 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3857 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3858 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3859 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3860
3861 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3862 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3863 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3864 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3865 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3866 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3867 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3868 @end table
3869
3870 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3871 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3872 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3873
3874 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3875 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3876
3877 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3878
3879 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3880 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3881 @table @code
3882 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3883 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3884 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3885 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3886 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3887
3888 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3889 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3890 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3891 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3892 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3893 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3894 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3895 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3896 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3897 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3898 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3899 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3900 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3901
3902 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3903 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3904 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3905 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3906 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3907 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3908 @end table
3909
3910
3911 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3912 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3913 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3914 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3915 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3916 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3917 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3918 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3919
3920
3921 @node Set Watchpoints
3922 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3923
3924 @cindex setting watchpoints
3925 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3926 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3927 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3928 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3929 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3930
3931 @itemize @bullet
3932 @item
3933 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3934
3935 @item
3936 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3937 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3938 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3939
3940 @item
3941 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3942 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3943 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3944 @end itemize
3945
3946 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3947 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3948 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3949 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3950 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3951 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3952 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3953 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3954 the expression changes.
3955
3956 @cindex software watchpoints
3957 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3958 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3959 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3960 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3961 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3962 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3963 culprit.)
3964
3965 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3966 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3967 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3968
3969 @table @code
3970 @kindex watch
3971 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3972 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3973 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3974 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3975 to watch the value of a single variable:
3976
3977 @smallexample
3978 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3979 @end smallexample
3980
3981 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3982 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3983 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3984 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3985 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3986 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3987
3988 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3989 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3990 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3991 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3992 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3993 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3994 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3995 error.
3996
3997 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3998 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3999 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4000 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4001 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4002 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4003 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4004 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4005 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4006 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4007 Examples:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4011 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4012 @end smallexample
4013
4014 @kindex rwatch
4015 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4016 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4017 by the program.
4018
4019 @kindex awatch
4020 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4021 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4022 or written into by the program.
4023
4024 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4025 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4026 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4027 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4028 @end table
4029
4030 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4031 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4032 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4033 a never-changing value:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4037 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4038 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4039 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4043 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4044 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4045 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4046 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4047 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4048
4049 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4050 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4051 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4052 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4053 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4054 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4055 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4056 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4057
4058 @table @code
4059 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4060 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4061 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4062
4063 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4064 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4065 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4066 @end table
4067
4068 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4069 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4070 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4071
4072 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4073
4074 @smallexample
4075 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4076 @end smallexample
4077
4078 @noindent
4079 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4080
4081 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4082 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4083 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4084 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4085 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4086 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4087 will print a message like this:
4088
4089 @smallexample
4090 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4091 @end smallexample
4092
4093 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4094 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4095 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4096 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4097 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4098 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4099 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4100 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4101
4102 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4103 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4104 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4105 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4106 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4107 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113 @noindent
4114 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4115
4116 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4117 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4118 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4119 expression with separately allocated resources.
4120
4121 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4122 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4123 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4126 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4127 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4128 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4129 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4130 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4131 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4132 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4133 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4134
4135 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4136 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4137 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4138 watched expression from every thread.
4139
4140 @quotation
4141 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4142 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4143 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4144 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4145 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4146 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4147 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4148 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4149 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4150 @end quotation
4151
4152 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4153
4154 @node Set Catchpoints
4155 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4156 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4157 @cindex exception handlers
4158 @cindex event handling
4159
4160 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4161 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4162 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4163
4164 @table @code
4165 @kindex catch
4166 @item catch @var{event}
4167 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4168
4169 @table @code
4170 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4171 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4172 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4173 @kindex catch throw
4174 @kindex catch rethrow
4175 @kindex catch catch
4176 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4177 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4178
4179 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4180 regular expression will be caught.
4181
4182 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4183 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4184 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4185 exception being thrown.
4186
4187 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4188 @value{GDBN}:
4189
4190 @itemize @bullet
4191 @item
4192 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4193 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4194 supported.
4195
4196 @item
4197 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4198 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4199 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4200 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4201 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4202 built.
4203
4204 @item
4205 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4206 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4207
4208 @item
4209 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4210 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4211 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4212 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4213
4214 @item
4215 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4216 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4217 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4218 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4219 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4220 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4221 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4222 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4223 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4224
4225 @item
4226 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4227
4228 @item
4229 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4230 @end itemize
4231
4232 @item exception
4233 @kindex catch exception
4234 @cindex Ada exception catching
4235 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4236 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4237 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4238 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4239 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4240
4241 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4242 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4243 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4244 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4245 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4246 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4247 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4248 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4249
4250 @item exception unhandled
4251 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4252 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4253
4254 @item assert
4255 @kindex catch assert
4256 A failed Ada assertion.
4257
4258 @item exec
4259 @kindex catch exec
4260 @cindex break on fork/exec
4261 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4262 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4263
4264 @item syscall
4265 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4266 @kindex catch syscall
4267 @cindex break on a system call.
4268 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4269 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4270 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4271 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4272 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4273 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4274 will be caught.
4275
4276 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4277 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4278 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4279 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4280
4281 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4282 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4283 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4284 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4285
4286 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4287 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4288 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4289 available choices.
4290
4291 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4292 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4293 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4294 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4295 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4296 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4297 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4298 behind the OS upgrades).
4299
4300 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4301 arguments to it:
4302
4303 @smallexample
4304 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4305 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4306 (@value{GDBP}) r
4307 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4308
4309 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4310 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4311 (@value{GDBP}) c
4312 Continuing.
4313
4314 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4315 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4316 (@value{GDBP})
4317 @end smallexample
4318
4319 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4320
4321 @smallexample
4322 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4323 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4324 (@value{GDBP}) r
4325 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4326
4327 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4328 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4329 (@value{GDBP}) c
4330 Continuing.
4331
4332 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4333 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4334 (@value{GDBP})
4335 @end smallexample
4336
4337 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4338 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4339 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4343 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4344 (@value{GDBP}) r
4345 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4346
4347 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4348 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4349 (@value{GDBP}) c
4350 Continuing.
4351
4352 Program exited normally.
4353 (@value{GDBP})
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4357 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4358 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4359 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4360
4361 @smallexample
4362 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4363 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4364 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4365 (@value{GDBP})
4366 @end smallexample
4367
4368 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4369 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4370 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4371 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4372 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4373 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4374
4375 @smallexample
4376 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4377 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4378 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4379 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4380 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4381 (@value{GDBP})
4382 @end smallexample
4383
4384 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4385
4386 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4387 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4391 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4392 @end smallexample
4393
4394 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4395
4396 @item fork
4397 @kindex catch fork
4398 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4399 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4400
4401 @item vfork
4402 @kindex catch vfork
4403 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4404 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4405
4406 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4407 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4408 @kindex catch load
4409 @kindex catch unload
4410 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4411 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4412 matches one of the affected libraries.
4413
4414 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4415 @kindex catch signal
4416 The delivery of a signal.
4417
4418 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4419 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4420 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4421
4422 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4423 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4424 signal names.
4425
4426 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4427 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4428 will be caught.
4429
4430 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4431 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4432 catchpoint.
4433
4434 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4435 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4436 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4437 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4438 commands.
4439
4440 @end table
4441
4442 @item tcatch @var{event}
4443 @kindex tcatch
4444 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4445 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4446
4447 @end table
4448
4449 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4450
4451
4452 @node Delete Breaks
4453 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4454
4455 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4456 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4457 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4458 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4459 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4460 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4461
4462 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4463 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4464 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4465 their breakpoint numbers.
4466
4467 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4468 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4469 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4470
4471 @table @code
4472 @kindex clear
4473 @item clear
4474 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4475 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4476 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4477 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4478
4479 @item clear @var{location}
4480 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4481 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4482 most useful ones are listed below:
4483
4484 @table @code
4485 @item clear @var{function}
4486 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4487 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4488
4489 @item clear @var{linenum}
4490 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4491 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4492 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4493 @end table
4494
4495 @cindex delete breakpoints
4496 @kindex delete
4497 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4498 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4499 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4500 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4501 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4502 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4503 @end table
4504
4505 @node Disabling
4506 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4507
4508 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4509 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4510 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4511 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4512 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4513
4514 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4515 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4516 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4517 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4518 do not know which numbers to use.
4519
4520 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4521 affects all of its locations.
4522
4523 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4524 different states of enablement:
4525
4526 @itemize @bullet
4527 @item
4528 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4529 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4530 @item
4531 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4532 @item
4533 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4534 disabled.
4535 @item
4536 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4537 N times, then becomes disabled.
4538 @item
4539 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4540 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4541 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4542 @end itemize
4543
4544 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4545 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4546
4547 @table @code
4548 @kindex disable
4549 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4550 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4551 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4552 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4553 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4554 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4555 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4556
4557 @kindex enable
4558 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4559 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4560 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4561
4562 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4563 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4564 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4565
4566 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4567 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4568 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4569 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4570 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4571 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4572 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4573
4574 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4575 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4576 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4577 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4578 @end table
4579
4580 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4581 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4582 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4583 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4584 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4585 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4586 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4587 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4588 Stepping}.)
4589
4590 @node Conditions
4591 @subsection Break Conditions
4592 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4593 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4594
4595 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4596 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4597 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4598 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4599 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4600 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4601 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4602 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4603
4604 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4605 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4606 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4607 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4608 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4609
4610 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4611 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4612 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4613 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4614 one.
4615
4616 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4617 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4618 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4619 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4620 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4621 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4622 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4623 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4624 conditions for the
4625 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4626 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4627
4628 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4629 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4630 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4631 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4632 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4633 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4634
4635 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4636 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4637 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4638 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4639 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4640
4641 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4642 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4643 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4644 with the @code{condition} command.
4645
4646 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4647 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4648 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4649 catchpoint.
4650
4651 @table @code
4652 @kindex condition
4653 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4654 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4655 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4656 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4657 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4658 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4659 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4660 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4661 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4662 prints an error message:
4663
4664 @smallexample
4665 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 @noindent
4669 @value{GDBN} does
4670 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4671 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4672 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4673
4674 @item condition @var{bnum}
4675 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4676 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4677 @end table
4678
4679 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4680 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4681 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4682 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4683 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4684 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4685 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4686 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4687 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4688 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4689 your program reaches it.
4690
4691 @table @code
4692 @kindex ignore
4693 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4694 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4695 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4696 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4697 takes no action.
4698
4699 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4700 a count of zero.
4701
4702 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4703 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4704 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4705 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4706
4707 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4708 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4709 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4710
4711 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4712 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4713 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4714 Variables}.
4715 @end table
4716
4717 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4718
4719
4720 @node Break Commands
4721 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4722
4723 @cindex breakpoint commands
4724 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4725 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4726 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4727 enable other breakpoints.
4728
4729 @table @code
4730 @kindex commands
4731 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4732 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4733 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4734 @itemx end
4735 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4736 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4737 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4738
4739 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4740 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4741
4742 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4743 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4744 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4745 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4746 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4747 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4748 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4749 Expressions}).
4750 @end table
4751
4752 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4753 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4754
4755 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4756 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4757 that resumes execution.
4758
4759 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4760 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4761 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4762 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4763 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4764
4765 @kindex silent
4766 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4767 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4768 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4769 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4770 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4771 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4772
4773 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4774 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4775 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4776
4777 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4778 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4779
4780 @smallexample
4781 break foo if x>0
4782 commands
4783 silent
4784 printf "x is %d\n",x
4785 cont
4786 end
4787 @end smallexample
4788
4789 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4790 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4791 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4792 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4793 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4794 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4795 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4796
4797 @smallexample
4798 break 403
4799 commands
4800 silent
4801 set x = y + 4
4802 cont
4803 end
4804 @end smallexample
4805
4806 @node Dynamic Printf
4807 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4808
4809 @cindex dynamic printf
4810 @cindex dprintf
4811 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4812 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4813 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4814 having to recompile it.
4815
4816 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4817 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4818 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4819 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4820 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4821 redirects to files and so forth.
4822
4823 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4824 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4825 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4826 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4827 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4828 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4829 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4830
4831 @table @code
4832 @kindex dprintf
4833 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4834 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4835 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4836 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4837
4838 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4839 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4840 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4841 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4842 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4843 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4844
4845 @item gdb
4846 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4847 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4848
4849 @item call
4850 @kindex dprintf-style call
4851 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4852 @code{printf}).
4853
4854 @item agent
4855 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4856 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4857 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4858 support running commands on the target.
4859
4860 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4861 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4862 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4863 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4864 command.
4865
4866 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4867 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4868 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4869 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4870 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4871 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4872
4873 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4874 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4875 you could do the following:
4876
4877 @example
4878 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4879 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4880 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4881 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4882 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4883 (gdb) info break
4884 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4885 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4886 continue
4887 (gdb)
4888 @end example
4889
4890 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4891 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4892 the variable settings.
4893
4894 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4895 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4896 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4897 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4898 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4899 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4900
4901 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4902 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4903 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4904
4905 @end table
4906
4907 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4908 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4909 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4910 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4911 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4912 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4913
4914 @node Save Breakpoints
4915 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4916
4917 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4918 breakpoints}} command.
4919
4920 @table @code
4921 @kindex save breakpoints
4922 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4923 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4924 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4925 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4926 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4927 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4928 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4929 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4930 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4931 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4932 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4933 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4934 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4935 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4936 that can no longer be recreated.
4937 @end table
4938
4939 @node Static Probe Points
4940 @subsection Static Probe Points
4941
4942 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4943 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4944 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4945 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4946 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4947 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4948 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4949
4950 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4951 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4952 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4953 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4954 in your applications.
4955
4956 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4957 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4958 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4959 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4960 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4961 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4962 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4963 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4964
4965 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4966 probes}, with optional arguments:
4967
4968 @table @code
4969 @kindex info probes
4970 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4971 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4972 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4973 probes from all providers are listed.
4974
4975 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4976 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4977 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4978
4979 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4980 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4981 given, all object files are considered.
4982
4983 @item info probes all
4984 List the available static probes, from all types.
4985 @end table
4986
4987 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4988 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4989 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4990 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4991 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4992 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4993 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4994 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4995 at the current probe point.
4996
4997 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4998 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4999 an error message.
5000
5001
5002 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5003 @node Error in Breakpoints
5004 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5005
5006 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5007 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5008
5009 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5010 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5011 @smallexample
5012 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5013 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5014 @end smallexample
5015
5016 @noindent
5017 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5018 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5019 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5020
5021 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5022 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5023
5024 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5025 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5026 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5027
5028 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5029 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5030 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5031 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5032
5033 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5034 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5035 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5036 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5037 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5038 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5039 first in the bundle.
5040
5041 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5042 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5043 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5044 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5045 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5046 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5047 is hit.
5048
5049 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5050 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5051
5052 @smallexample
5053 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5054 @end smallexample
5055
5056 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5057 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5058 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5059 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5060 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5061 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5062 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5063 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5064
5065 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5066 adjusted breakpoints:
5067
5068 @smallexample
5069 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5070 to 0x00010410.
5071 @end smallexample
5072
5073 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5074 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5075 frequently than expected.
5076
5077 @node Continuing and Stepping
5078 @section Continuing and Stepping
5079
5080 @cindex stepping
5081 @cindex continuing
5082 @cindex resuming execution
5083 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5084 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5085 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5086 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5087 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5088 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5089 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5090 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
5091
5092 @table @code
5093 @kindex continue
5094 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5095 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5096 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5097 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5098 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5099 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5100 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5101 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5102 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5103 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5104
5105 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5106 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5107 @code{continue} is ignored.
5108
5109 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5110 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5111 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5112 @code{continue}.
5113 @end table
5114
5115 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5116 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5117 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5118 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5119
5120 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5121 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5122 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5123 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5124 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5125 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5126
5127 @table @code
5128 @kindex step
5129 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5130 @item step
5131 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5132 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5133 abbreviated @code{s}.
5134
5135 @quotation
5136 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5137 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5138 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5139 @c distinction here.
5140 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5141 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5142 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5143 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5144 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5145 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5146 below.
5147 @end quotation
5148
5149 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5150 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5151 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5152 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5153 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5154 called within the line.
5155
5156 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5157 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5158 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5159 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5160 was any debugging information about the routine.
5161
5162 @item step @var{count}
5163 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5164 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5165 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5166
5167 @kindex next
5168 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5169 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5170 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5171 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5172 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5173 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5174 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5175 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5176
5177 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5178
5179
5180 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5181 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5182 @c
5183 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5184 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5185 @c function are executed without stopping.
5186
5187 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5188 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5189 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5190
5191 @kindex set step-mode
5192 @item set step-mode
5193 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5194 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5195 @itemx set step-mode on
5196 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5197 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5198 information rather than stepping over it.
5199
5200 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5201 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5202 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5203
5204 @item set step-mode off
5205 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5206 debug information. This is the default.
5207
5208 @item show step-mode
5209 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5210 source line debug information.
5211
5212 @kindex finish
5213 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5214 @item finish
5215 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5216 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5217 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5218
5219 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5220 ,Returning from a Function}).
5221
5222 @kindex until
5223 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5224 @cindex run until specified location
5225 @item until
5226 @itemx u
5227 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5228 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5229 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5230 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5231 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5232 than the address of the jump.
5233
5234 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5235 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5236 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5237 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5238 through the next iteration.
5239
5240 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5241 stack frame.
5242
5243 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5244 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5245 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5246 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5247 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 (@value{GDBP}) f
5251 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5252 206 expand_input();
5253 (@value{GDBP}) until
5254 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5255 @end smallexample
5256
5257 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5258 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5259 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5260 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5261 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5262 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5263 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5264
5265 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5266 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5267 argument.
5268
5269 @item until @var{location}
5270 @itemx u @var{location}
5271 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5272 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5273 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5274 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5275 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5276 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5277 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5278 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5279 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5280 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5281 invocations have returned.
5282
5283 @smallexample
5284 94 int factorial (int value)
5285 95 @{
5286 96 if (value > 1) @{
5287 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5288 98 @}
5289 99 return (value);
5290 100 @}
5291 @end smallexample
5292
5293
5294 @kindex advance @var{location}
5295 @item advance @var{location}
5296 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5297 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5298 @ref{Specify Location}.
5299 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5300 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5301 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5302 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5303
5304
5305 @kindex stepi
5306 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5307 @item stepi
5308 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5309 @itemx si
5310 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5311
5312 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5313 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5314 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5315 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5316
5317 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5318
5319 @need 750
5320 @kindex nexti
5321 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5322 @item nexti
5323 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5324 @itemx ni
5325 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5326 proceed until the function returns.
5327
5328 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5329
5330 @end table
5331
5332 @anchor{range stepping}
5333 @cindex range stepping
5334 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5335 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5336 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5337 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5338 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5339 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5340 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5341 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5342 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5343 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5344 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5345 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5346 if necessary:
5347
5348 @table @code
5349 @kindex set range-stepping
5350 @kindex show range-stepping
5351 @item set range-stepping
5352 @itemx show range-stepping
5353 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5354
5355 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5356 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5357 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5358 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5359 default is @code{on}.
5360
5361 @end table
5362
5363 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5364 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5365 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5366
5367 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5368 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5369 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5370
5371 For example, consider the following C function:
5372
5373 @smallexample
5374 101 int func()
5375 102 @{
5376 103 foo(boring());
5377 104 bar(boring());
5378 105 @}
5379 @end smallexample
5380
5381 @noindent
5382 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5383 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5384 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5385 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5386
5387 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5388 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5389 is called from many places.
5390
5391 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5392 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5393 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5394 @code{foo}.
5395
5396 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5397 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5398
5399 @table @code
5400 @kindex skip function
5401 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5402 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5403 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5404 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5405 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5406
5407 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5408 will be skipped.
5409
5410 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5411 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5412
5413 @kindex skip file
5414 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5415 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5416 will be skipped over when stepping.
5417
5418 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5419 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5420 @end table
5421
5422 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5423 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5424
5425 @table @code
5426 @kindex info skip
5427 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5428 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5429 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5430 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5431
5432 @table @emph
5433 @item Identifier
5434 A number identifying this skip.
5435 @item Type
5436 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5437 @item Enabled or Disabled
5438 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5439 @item Address
5440 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5441 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5442 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5443 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5444 address here.
5445 @item What
5446 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5447 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5448 where it is defined.
5449 @end table
5450
5451 @kindex skip delete
5452 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5453 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5454 skips.
5455
5456 @kindex skip enable
5457 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5458 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5459 skips.
5460
5461 @kindex skip disable
5462 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5463 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5464 skips.
5465
5466 @end table
5467
5468 @node Signals
5469 @section Signals
5470 @cindex signals
5471
5472 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5473 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5474 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5475 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5476 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5477 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5478 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5479 requested an alarm).
5480
5481 @cindex fatal signals
5482 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5483 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5484 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5485 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5486 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5487 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5488
5489 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5490 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5491 signal.
5492
5493 @cindex handling signals
5494 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5495 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5496 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5497 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5498 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5499
5500 @table @code
5501 @kindex info signals
5502 @kindex info handle
5503 @item info signals
5504 @itemx info handle
5505 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5506 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5507 the defined types of signals.
5508
5509 @item info signals @var{sig}
5510 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5511
5512 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5513
5514 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5515 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5516 for details about this command.
5517
5518 @kindex handle
5519 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5520 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5521 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5522 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5523 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5524 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5525 say what change to make.
5526 @end table
5527
5528 @c @group
5529 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5530 Their full names are:
5531
5532 @table @code
5533 @item nostop
5534 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5535 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5536
5537 @item stop
5538 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5539 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5540
5541 @item print
5542 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5543
5544 @item noprint
5545 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5546 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5547
5548 @item pass
5549 @itemx noignore
5550 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5551 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5552 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5553
5554 @item nopass
5555 @itemx ignore
5556 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5557 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5558 @end table
5559 @c @end group
5560
5561 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5562 program until you
5563 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5564 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5565 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5566 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5567 program sees that signal when you continue.
5568
5569 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5570 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5571 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5572 erroneous signals.
5573
5574 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5575 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5576 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5577 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5578 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5579 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5580 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5581 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5582 Program a Signal}.
5583
5584 @cindex extra signal information
5585 @anchor{extra signal information}
5586
5587 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5588 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5589 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5590 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5591 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5592 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5593 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5594 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5595 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5596 system header.
5597
5598 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5599 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5600
5601 @smallexample
5602 @group
5603 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5604 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5605 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5606 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5607 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5608 type = struct @{
5609 int si_signo;
5610 int si_errno;
5611 int si_code;
5612 union @{
5613 int _pad[28];
5614 struct @{...@} _kill;
5615 struct @{...@} _timer;
5616 struct @{...@} _rt;
5617 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5618 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5619 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5620 @} _sifields;
5621 @}
5622 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5623 type = struct @{
5624 void *si_addr;
5625 @}
5626 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5627 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5628 @end group
5629 @end smallexample
5630
5631 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5632
5633 @node Thread Stops
5634 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5635
5636 @cindex stopped threads
5637 @cindex threads, stopped
5638
5639 @cindex continuing threads
5640 @cindex threads, continuing
5641
5642 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5643 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5644 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5645 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5646 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5647 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5648 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5649 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5650 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5651
5652 @menu
5653 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5654 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5655 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5656 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5657 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5658 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5659 @end menu
5660
5661 @node All-Stop Mode
5662 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5663
5664 @cindex all-stop mode
5665
5666 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5667 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5668 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5669 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5670 underfoot.
5671
5672 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5673 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5674 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5675
5676 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5677 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5678 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5679 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5680 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5681 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5682 stops.
5683
5684 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5685 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5686 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5687 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5688
5689 @cindex automatic thread selection
5690 @cindex switching threads automatically
5691 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5692 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5693 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5694 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5695 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5696 thread.
5697
5698 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5699 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5700
5701 @table @code
5702 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5703 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5704 @cindex lock scheduler
5705 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5706 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5707 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5708 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5709 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5710 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5711 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5712 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5713 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5714 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5715 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5716 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5717
5718 @item show scheduler-locking
5719 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5720 @end table
5721
5722 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5723 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5724 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5725 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5726 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5727 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5728 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5729 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5730 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5731 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5732 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5733 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5734 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5735 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5736
5737 @table @code
5738 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5739 @item set schedule-multiple
5740 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5741 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5742 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5743 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5744 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5745 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5746
5747 @item show schedule-multiple
5748 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5749 multiple processes.
5750 @end table
5751
5752 @node Non-Stop Mode
5753 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5754
5755 @cindex non-stop mode
5756
5757 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5758 @c with more details.
5759
5760 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5761 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5762 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5763 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5764 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5765 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5766
5767 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5768 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5769 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5770 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5771 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5772 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5773 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5774 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5775 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5776 independently and simultaneously.
5777
5778 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5779 or attach to your program:
5780
5781 @smallexample
5782 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5783 set pagination off
5784
5785 # Finally, turn it on!
5786 set non-stop on
5787 @end smallexample
5788
5789 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5790
5791 @table @code
5792 @kindex set non-stop
5793 @item set non-stop on
5794 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5795 @item set non-stop off
5796 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5797 @kindex show non-stop
5798 @item show non-stop
5799 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5800 @end table
5801
5802 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5803 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5804 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5805 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5806 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5807 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5808 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5809 default.
5810
5811 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5812 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5813 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5814
5815 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5816 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5817 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5818 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5819 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5820
5821 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5822 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5823 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5824 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5825 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5826
5827 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5828
5829 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5830 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5831 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5832 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5833 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5834 previously current thread.
5835
5836 @node Background Execution
5837 @subsection Background Execution
5838
5839 @cindex foreground execution
5840 @cindex background execution
5841 @cindex asynchronous execution
5842 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5843
5844 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5845 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5846 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5847 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5848 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5849 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5850
5851 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5852 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5853
5854 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5855 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5856 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5857 are:
5858
5859 @table @code
5860 @kindex run&
5861 @item run
5862 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5863
5864 @item attach
5865 @kindex attach&
5866 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5867
5868 @item step
5869 @kindex step&
5870 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5871
5872 @item stepi
5873 @kindex stepi&
5874 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5875
5876 @item next
5877 @kindex next&
5878 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5879
5880 @item nexti
5881 @kindex nexti&
5882 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5883
5884 @item continue
5885 @kindex continue&
5886 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5887
5888 @item finish
5889 @kindex finish&
5890 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5891
5892 @item until
5893 @kindex until&
5894 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5895
5896 @end table
5897
5898 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5899 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5900 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5901 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5902 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5903 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5904
5905 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5906 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5907
5908 @table @code
5909 @kindex interrupt
5910 @item interrupt
5911 @itemx interrupt -a
5912
5913 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5914 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5915 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5916 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5917 @end table
5918
5919 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5920 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5921
5922 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5923 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5924 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5925
5926 @table @code
5927 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5928 @cindex thread breakpoints
5929 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5930 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5931 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5932 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5933 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5934 specify some source line.
5935
5936 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5937 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5938 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
5939 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
5940 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5941
5942 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5943 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5944 program.
5945
5946 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5947 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5948 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5952 @end smallexample
5953
5954 @end table
5955
5956 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
5957 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
5958 thread list. For example:
5959
5960 @smallexample
5961 (@value{GDBP}) c
5962 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
5963 @end smallexample
5964
5965 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
5966 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
5967 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
5968 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
5969 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
5970 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
5971 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
5972 command.
5973
5974 @node Interrupted System Calls
5975 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5976
5977 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5978 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5979 @cindex premature return from system calls
5980 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5981 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5982 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5983 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5984 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5985 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5986 stop execution.
5987
5988 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5989 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5990 style anyways.
5991
5992 For example, do not write code like this:
5993
5994 @smallexample
5995 sleep (10);
5996 @end smallexample
5997
5998 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5999 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6000
6001 Instead, write this:
6002
6003 @smallexample
6004 int unslept = 10;
6005 while (unslept > 0)
6006 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6007 @end smallexample
6008
6009 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6010 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6011 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6012 @value{GDBN}.
6013
6014 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6015 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6016 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6017 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6018
6019 @node Observer Mode
6020 @subsection Observer Mode
6021
6022 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6023 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6024 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6025 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6026 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6027
6028 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6029 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6030 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6031 mode.
6032
6033 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6034 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6035 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6036 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6037 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6038
6039 @table @code
6040
6041 @kindex observer
6042 @item set observer on
6043 @itemx set observer off
6044 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6045 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6046 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6047 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6048
6049 @item show observer
6050 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6051
6052 @kindex may-write-registers
6053 @item set may-write-registers on
6054 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6055 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6056 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6057 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6058
6059 @item show may-write-registers
6060 Show the current permission to write registers.
6061
6062 @kindex may-write-memory
6063 @item set may-write-memory on
6064 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6065 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6066 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6067 defaults to @code{on}.
6068
6069 @item show may-write-memory
6070 Show the current permission to write memory.
6071
6072 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6073 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6074 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6075 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6076 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6077 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6078
6079 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6080 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6081
6082 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6083 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6084 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6085 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6086 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6087 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6088 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6089
6090 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6091 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6092
6093 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6094 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6095 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6096 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6097 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6098 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6099 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6100
6101 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6102 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6103
6104 @kindex may-interrupt
6105 @item set may-interrupt on
6106 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6107 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6108 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6109 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6110 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6111
6112 @item show may-interrupt
6113 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6114
6115 @end table
6116
6117 @node Reverse Execution
6118 @chapter Running programs backward
6119 @cindex reverse execution
6120 @cindex running programs backward
6121
6122 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6123 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6124 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6125 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6126
6127 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6128 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6129 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6130 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6131 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6132 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6133
6134 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6135 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6136 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6137 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6138 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6139 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6140 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6141 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6142 prior values@footnote{
6143 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6144 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6145 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6146
6147 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6148 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6149 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6150 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6151 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6152 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6153 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6154 }.
6155
6156 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6157 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6158
6159 @table @code
6160 @kindex reverse-continue
6161 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6162 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6163 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6164 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6165 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6166 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6167 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6168
6169 @kindex reverse-step
6170 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6171 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6172 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6173 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6174
6175 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6176 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6177 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6178 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6179 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6180 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6181
6182 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6183 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6184
6185 @kindex reverse-stepi
6186 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6187 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6188 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6189 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6190 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6191 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6192 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6193
6194 @kindex reverse-next
6195 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6196 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6197 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6198 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6199 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6200 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6201 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6202 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6203 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6204 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6205
6206 @kindex reverse-nexti
6207 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6208 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6209 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6210 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6211 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6212 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6213 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6214 frame) is reached.
6215
6216 @kindex reverse-finish
6217 @item reverse-finish
6218 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6219 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6220 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6221 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6222
6223 @kindex set exec-direction
6224 @item set exec-direction
6225 Set the direction of target execution.
6226 @item set exec-direction reverse
6227 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6228 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6229 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6230 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6231 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6232 @item set exec-direction forward
6233 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6234 This is the default.
6235 @end table
6236
6237
6238 @node Process Record and Replay
6239 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6240 @cindex process record and replay
6241 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6242
6243 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6244 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6245 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6246
6247 @cindex replay mode
6248 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6249 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6250 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6251 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6252 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6253 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6254 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6255 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6256 execution log.
6257
6258 @cindex record mode
6259 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6260 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6261 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6262 for future replay.
6263
6264 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6265 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6266 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6267 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6268 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6269 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6270
6271 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6272 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6273 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6274 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6275
6276 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6277 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6278
6279 @table @code
6280 @kindex target record
6281 @kindex target record-full
6282 @kindex target record-btrace
6283 @kindex record
6284 @kindex record full
6285 @kindex record btrace
6286 @kindex rec
6287 @kindex rec full
6288 @kindex rec btrace
6289 @item record @var{method}
6290 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6291 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6292 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6293 recording methods are available:
6294
6295 @table @code
6296 @item full
6297 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6298 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6299 execution.
6300
6301 @item btrace
6302 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6303 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6304 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6305 reverse execution.
6306
6307 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6308 @end table
6309
6310 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6311 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6312 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6313 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6314
6315 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6316 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6317
6318 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6319 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6320 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6321 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6322 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6323
6324 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6325 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6326 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6327 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6328 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6329 does not support these two modes.
6330
6331 @kindex record stop
6332 @kindex rec s
6333 @item record stop
6334 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6335 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6336 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6337
6338 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6339 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6340 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6341 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6342 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6343
6344 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6345 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6346 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6347 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6348 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6349
6350 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6351 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6352
6353 @kindex record goto
6354 @item record goto
6355 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6356 ways to specify the location to go to:
6357
6358 @table @code
6359 @item record goto begin
6360 @itemx record goto start
6361 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6362
6363 @item record goto end
6364 Go to the end of the execution log.
6365
6366 @item record goto @var{n}
6367 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6368 @end table
6369
6370 @kindex record save
6371 @item record save @var{filename}
6372 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6373 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6374 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6375
6376 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6377
6378 @kindex record restore
6379 @item record restore @var{filename}
6380 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6381 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6382
6383 @kindex set record full
6384 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6385 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6386 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6387 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6388
6389 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6390 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6391 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6392 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6393 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6394 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6395 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6396 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6397
6398 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6399 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6400 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6401
6402 @kindex show record full
6403 @item show record full insn-number-max
6404 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6405 recording method.
6406
6407 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6408 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6409 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6410 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6411 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6412 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6413 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6414 oldest one to be deleted.
6415
6416 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6417 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6418
6419 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6420 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6421
6422 @item set record full memory-query
6423 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6424 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6425 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6426 case.
6427
6428 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6429 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6430 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6431 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6432 results.
6433
6434 @item show record full memory-query
6435 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6436
6437 @kindex set record btrace
6438 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6439 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6440 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6441 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6442 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6443 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6444 You can use the following command for that:
6445
6446 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6447 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6448 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6449 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6450 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6451 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6452 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6453 position.
6454
6455 @kindex show record btrace
6456 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6457 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6458
6459 @kindex info record
6460 @item info record
6461 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6462 method:
6463
6464 @table @code
6465 @item full
6466 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6467 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6468
6469 @itemize @bullet
6470 @item
6471 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6472 @item
6473 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6474 @item
6475 Highest recorded instruction number.
6476 @item
6477 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6478 @item
6479 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6480 @item
6481 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6482 @end itemize
6483
6484 @item btrace
6485 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6486 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6487 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6488 @end table
6489
6490 @kindex record delete
6491 @kindex rec del
6492 @item record delete
6493 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6494 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6495 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6496 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6497
6498 @kindex record instruction-history
6499 @kindex rec instruction-history
6500 @item record instruction-history
6501 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6502 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6503 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6504 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6505 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6506
6507 @table @code
6508 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6509 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6510 @var{insn}.
6511
6512 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6513 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6514 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6515 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6516 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6517 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6518
6519 @item record instruction-history
6520 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6521
6522 @item record instruction-history -
6523 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6524
6525 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6526 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6527 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6528 number @var{end} is included.
6529 @end table
6530
6531 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6532
6533 @kindex set record
6534 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6535 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6536 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6537 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6538 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6539
6540 @kindex show record
6541 @item show record instruction-history-size
6542 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6543 instruction-history} command.
6544
6545 @kindex record function-call-history
6546 @kindex rec function-call-history
6547 @item record function-call-history
6548 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6549 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6550 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6551 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6552 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6553 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6554 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6555 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6556 given together.
6557
6558 @smallexample
6559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6560 1 void foo (void)
6561 2 @{
6562 3 @}
6563 4
6564 5 void bar (void)
6565 6 @{
6566 7 ...
6567 8 foo ();
6568 9 ...
6569 10 @}
6570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6571 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6572 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6573 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6574 @end smallexample
6575
6576 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6577 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6578 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6579 to print:
6580
6581 @table @code
6582 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6583 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6584
6585 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6586 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6587 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6588 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6589 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6590
6591 @item record function-call-history
6592 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6593
6594 @item record function-call-history -
6595 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6596
6597 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6598 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6599 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6600 @end table
6601
6602 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6603
6604 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6605 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6606 Define how many lines to print in the
6607 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6608 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6609
6610 @item show record function-call-history-size
6611 Show how many lines to print in the
6612 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6613 @end table
6614
6615
6616 @node Stack
6617 @chapter Examining the Stack
6618
6619 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6620 stopped and how it got there.
6621
6622 @cindex call stack
6623 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6624 is generated.
6625 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6626 the arguments of the call,
6627 and the local variables of the function being called.
6628 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6629 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6630 stack}.
6631
6632 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6633 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6634
6635 @cindex selected frame
6636 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6637 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6638 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6639 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6640 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6641 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6642
6643 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6644 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6645 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6646
6647 @menu
6648 * Frames:: Stack frames
6649 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6650 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6651 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6652 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6653
6654 @end menu
6655
6656 @node Frames
6657 @section Stack Frames
6658
6659 @cindex frame, definition
6660 @cindex stack frame
6661 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6662 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6663 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6664 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6665 which the function is executing.
6666
6667 @cindex initial frame
6668 @cindex outermost frame
6669 @cindex innermost frame
6670 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6671 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6672 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6673 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6674 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6675 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6676 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6677 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6678
6679 @cindex frame pointer
6680 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6681 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6682 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6683 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6684 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6685 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6686
6687 @cindex frame number
6688 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6689 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6690 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6691 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6692 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6693
6694 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6695 @c underflow problems.
6696 @cindex frameless execution
6697 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6698 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6699 @smallexample
6700 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6701 @end smallexample
6702 generates functions without a frame.)
6703 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6704 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6705 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6706 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6707 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6708 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6709 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6710
6711 @table @code
6712 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6713 @cindex current stack frame
6714 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6715 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6716 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6717 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6718 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6719
6720 @kindex select-frame
6721 @cindex selecting frame silently
6722 @item select-frame
6723 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6724 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6725 @code{frame}.
6726 @end table
6727
6728 @node Backtrace
6729 @section Backtraces
6730
6731 @cindex traceback
6732 @cindex call stack traces
6733 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6734 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6735 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6736 stack.
6737
6738 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6739 @table @code
6740 @kindex backtrace
6741 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6742 @item backtrace
6743 @itemx bt
6744 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6745 frames in the stack.
6746
6747 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6748 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6749
6750 @item backtrace @var{n}
6751 @itemx bt @var{n}
6752 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6753
6754 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6755 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6756 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6757
6758 @item backtrace full
6759 @itemx bt full
6760 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6761 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6762 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6763 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6764
6765 @item backtrace no-filters
6766 @itemx bt no-filters
6767 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6768 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6769 @itemx bt no-filters full
6770 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6771 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6772 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6773 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6774 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6775 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6776 support.
6777 @end table
6778
6779 @kindex where
6780 @kindex info stack
6781 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6782 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6783
6784 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6785 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6786 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6787 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6788 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6789 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6790 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6791 multi-threaded program.
6792
6793 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6794 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6795 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6796 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6797 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6798 line number.
6799
6800 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6801 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6802
6803 @smallexample
6804 @group
6805 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6806 at builtin.c:993
6807 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6808 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6809 at macro.c:71
6810 (More stack frames follow...)
6811 @end group
6812 @end smallexample
6813
6814 @noindent
6815 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6816 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6817 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6818
6819 @noindent
6820 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6821 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6822 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6823 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6824 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6825
6826 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6827 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6828 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6829 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6830 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6831 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6832 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6833 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6834 such a backtrace might look like:
6835
6836 @smallexample
6837 @group
6838 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6839 at builtin.c:993
6840 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6841 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6842 at macro.c:71
6843 (More stack frames follow...)
6844 @end group
6845 @end smallexample
6846
6847 @noindent
6848 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6849 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6850
6851 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6852 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6853 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6854
6855 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6856 @cindex program entry point
6857 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6858 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6859 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6860 @code{main}@footnote{
6861 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6862 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6863 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6864 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6865 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6866 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6867
6868 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6869 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6870
6871 @table @code
6872 @item set backtrace past-main
6873 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6874 @kindex set backtrace
6875 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6876
6877 @item set backtrace past-main off
6878 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6879 default.
6880
6881 @item show backtrace past-main
6882 @kindex show backtrace
6883 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6884
6885 @item set backtrace past-entry
6886 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6887 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6888 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6889 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6890
6891 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6892 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6893 application. This is the default.
6894
6895 @item show backtrace past-entry
6896 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6897
6898 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6899 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6900 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6901 @cindex backtrace limit
6902 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6903 or zero means unlimited levels.
6904
6905 @item show backtrace limit
6906 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6907 @end table
6908
6909 You can control how file names are displayed.
6910
6911 @table @code
6912 @item set filename-display
6913 @itemx set filename-display relative
6914 @cindex filename-display
6915 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6916
6917 @item set filename-display basename
6918 Display only basename of a filename.
6919
6920 @item set filename-display absolute
6921 Display an absolute filename.
6922
6923 @item show filename-display
6924 Show the current way to display filenames.
6925 @end table
6926
6927 @node Frame Filter Management
6928 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6929 @cindex managing frame filters
6930
6931 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6932 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6933
6934 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6935 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6936
6937 @table @code
6938 @kindex info frame-filter
6939 @item info frame-filter
6940 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6941 their name, priority and enabled status.
6942
6943 @kindex disable frame-filter
6944 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6945 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6946 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6947 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6948 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6949 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6950 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
6951 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
6952 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6953 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
6954 may be enabled again later.
6955
6956 @kindex enable frame-filter
6957 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
6958 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
6959 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
6960 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
6961 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
6962 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
6963 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
6964 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
6965 @var{filter-dictionary}.
6966
6967 Example:
6968
6969 @smallexample
6970 (gdb) info frame-filter
6971
6972 global frame-filters:
6973 Priority Enabled Name
6974 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6975 100 Yes Reverse
6976
6977 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6978 Priority Enabled Name
6979 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6980
6981 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6982 Priority Enabled Name
6983 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
6984
6985 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
6986 (gdb) info frame-filter
6987
6988 global frame-filters:
6989 Priority Enabled Name
6990 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
6991 100 Yes Reverse
6992
6993 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
6994 Priority Enabled Name
6995 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
6996
6997 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
6998 Priority Enabled Name
6999 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7000
7001 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7002 (gdb) info frame-filter
7003
7004 global frame-filters:
7005 Priority Enabled Name
7006 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7007 100 Yes Reverse
7008
7009 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7010 Priority Enabled Name
7011 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7012
7013 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7014 Priority Enabled Name
7015 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7016 @end smallexample
7017
7018 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7019 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7020 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7021 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7022 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7023 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7024 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7025
7026 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7027 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7028 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7029 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7030 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7031 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7032 dictionary resides.
7033
7034 Example:
7035
7036 @smallexample
7037 (gdb) info frame-filter
7038
7039 global frame-filters:
7040 Priority Enabled Name
7041 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7042 100 Yes Reverse
7043
7044 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7045 Priority Enabled Name
7046 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7047
7048 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7049 Priority Enabled Name
7050 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7051
7052 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7053 (gdb) info frame-filter
7054
7055 global frame-filters:
7056 Priority Enabled Name
7057 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7058 50 Yes Reverse
7059
7060 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7061 Priority Enabled Name
7062 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7063
7064 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7065 Priority Enabled Name
7066 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7067 @end smallexample
7068 @end table
7069
7070 @node Selection
7071 @section Selecting a Frame
7072
7073 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7074 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7075 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7076 of the stack frame just selected.
7077
7078 @table @code
7079 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7080 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7081 @item frame @var{n}
7082 @itemx f @var{n}
7083 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7084 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7085 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7086 @code{main}.
7087
7088 @item frame @var{addr}
7089 @itemx f @var{addr}
7090 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7091 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7092 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7093 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7094 switches between them.
7095
7096 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7097 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7098
7099 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7100 pointer and a program counter.
7101
7102 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7103 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7104
7105 @kindex up
7106 @item up @var{n}
7107 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7108 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7109 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7110
7111 @kindex down
7112 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7113 @item down @var{n}
7114 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7115 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7116 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7117 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7118 @end table
7119
7120 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7121 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7122 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7123 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7124
7125 @need 1000
7126 For example:
7127
7128 @smallexample
7129 @group
7130 (@value{GDBP}) up
7131 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7132 at env.c:10
7133 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7134 @end group
7135 @end smallexample
7136
7137 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7138 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7139 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7140 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7141 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7142 for details.
7143
7144 @table @code
7145 @kindex down-silently
7146 @kindex up-silently
7147 @item up-silently @var{n}
7148 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7149 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7150 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7151 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7152 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7153 distracting.
7154 @end table
7155
7156 @node Frame Info
7157 @section Information About a Frame
7158
7159 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7160 stack frame.
7161
7162 @table @code
7163 @item frame
7164 @itemx f
7165 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7166 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7167 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7168 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7169 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7170
7171 @kindex info frame
7172 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7173 @item info frame
7174 @itemx info f
7175 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7176 including:
7177
7178 @itemize @bullet
7179 @item
7180 the address of the frame
7181 @item
7182 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7183 @item
7184 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7185 @item
7186 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7187 @item
7188 the address of the frame's arguments
7189 @item
7190 the address of the frame's local variables
7191 @item
7192 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7193 @item
7194 which registers were saved in the frame
7195 @end itemize
7196
7197 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7198 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7199 the usual conventions.
7200
7201 @item info frame @var{addr}
7202 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7203 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7204 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7205 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7206 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7207 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7208
7209 @kindex info args
7210 @item info args
7211 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7212
7213 @item info locals
7214 @kindex info locals
7215 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7216 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7217 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7218
7219 @end table
7220
7221
7222 @node Source
7223 @chapter Examining Source Files
7224
7225 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7226 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7227 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7228 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7229 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7230 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7231 source files by explicit command.
7232
7233 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7234 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7235 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7236
7237 @menu
7238 * List:: Printing source lines
7239 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7240 * Edit:: Editing source files
7241 * Search:: Searching source files
7242 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7243 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7244 @end menu
7245
7246 @node List
7247 @section Printing Source Lines
7248
7249 @kindex list
7250 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7251 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7252 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7253 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7254 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7255
7256 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7257
7258 @table @code
7259 @item list @var{linenum}
7260 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7261 current source file.
7262
7263 @item list @var{function}
7264 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7265 @var{function}.
7266
7267 @item list
7268 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7269 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7270 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7271 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7272 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7273
7274 @item list -
7275 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7276 @end table
7277
7278 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7279 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7280 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7281
7282 @table @code
7283 @kindex set listsize
7284 @item set listsize @var{count}
7285 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7286 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7287 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7288 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7289
7290 @kindex show listsize
7291 @item show listsize
7292 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7293 @end table
7294
7295 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7296 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7297 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7298 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7299 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7300
7301 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7302 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7303 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7304 to specify some source line.
7305
7306 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7307
7308 @table @code
7309 @item list @var{linespec}
7310 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7311
7312 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7313 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7314 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7315 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7316 the same source file as the first linespec.
7317
7318 @item list ,@var{last}
7319 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7320
7321 @item list @var{first},
7322 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7323
7324 @item list +
7325 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7326
7327 @item list -
7328 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7329
7330 @item list
7331 As described in the preceding table.
7332 @end table
7333
7334 @node Specify Location
7335 @section Specifying a Location
7336 @cindex specifying location
7337 @cindex linespec
7338
7339 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7340 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7341 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7342 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7343
7344 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7345 @value{GDBN} understands:
7346
7347 @table @code
7348 @item @var{linenum}
7349 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7350
7351 @item -@var{offset}
7352 @itemx +@var{offset}
7353 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7354 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7355 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7356 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7357 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7358 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7359 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7360 linespec.
7361
7362 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7363 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7364 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7365 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7366 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7367 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7368 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7369
7370 @item @var{function}
7371 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7372 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7373
7374 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7375 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7376
7377 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7378 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7379 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7380 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7381 functions in different source files.
7382
7383 @item @var{label}
7384 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7385 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7386 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7387 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7388 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7389
7390 @item *@var{address}
7391 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7392 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7393 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7394 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7395 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7396 source files.
7397
7398 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7399 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7400 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7401 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7402 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7403 of @var{address}:
7404
7405 @table @code
7406 @item @var{expression}
7407 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7408
7409 @item @var{funcaddr}
7410 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7411 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7412 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7413 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7414 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7415 (although the Pascal form also works).
7416
7417 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7418 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7419
7420 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7421 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7422 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7423 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7424 functions with identical names in different source files.
7425 @end table
7426
7427 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7428 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7429 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7430 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7431 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7432 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7433
7434 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7435 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7436 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7437 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7438 each one of those probes.
7439
7440 @end table
7441
7442
7443 @node Edit
7444 @section Editing Source Files
7445 @cindex editing source files
7446
7447 @kindex edit
7448 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7449 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7450 The editing program of your choice
7451 is invoked with the current line set to
7452 the active line in the program.
7453 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7454 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7455
7456 @table @code
7457 @item edit @var{location}
7458 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7459 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7460 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7461 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7462 command most commonly used:
7463
7464 @table @code
7465 @item edit @var{number}
7466 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7467
7468 @item edit @var{function}
7469 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7470 @end table
7471
7472 @end table
7473
7474 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7475 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7476 @footnote{
7477 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7478 following command-line syntax:
7479 @smallexample
7480 ex +@var{number} file
7481 @end smallexample
7482 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7483 the file where to start editing.}.
7484 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7485 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7486 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7487 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7488 @smallexample
7489 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7490 export EDITOR
7491 gdb @dots{}
7492 @end smallexample
7493 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7494 @smallexample
7495 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7496 gdb @dots{}
7497 @end smallexample
7498
7499 @node Search
7500 @section Searching Source Files
7501 @cindex searching source files
7502
7503 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7504 regular expression.
7505
7506 @table @code
7507 @kindex search
7508 @kindex forward-search
7509 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7510 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7511 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7512 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7513 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7514 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7515 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7516 @code{fo}.
7517
7518 @kindex reverse-search
7519 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7520 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7521 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7522 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7523 this command as @code{rev}.
7524 @end table
7525
7526 @node Source Path
7527 @section Specifying Source Directories
7528
7529 @cindex source path
7530 @cindex directories for source files
7531 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7532 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7533 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7534 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7535 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7536 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7537 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7538
7539 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7540 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7541 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7542 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7543 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7544 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7545 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7546 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7547 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7548 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7549 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7550
7551 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7552 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7553 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7554 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7555 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7556 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7557
7558 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7559 source files.
7560
7561 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7562 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7563 each line is in the file.
7564
7565 @kindex directory
7566 @kindex dir
7567 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7568 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7569 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7570
7571 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7572 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7573
7574 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7575 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7576 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7577 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7578 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7579 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7580 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7581 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7582 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7583 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7584 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7585 name to look up the sources.
7586
7587 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7588 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7589 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7590 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7591 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7592 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7593 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7594 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7595
7596 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7597 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7598 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7599 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7600 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7601 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7602 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7603
7604 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7605 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7606 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7607 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7608 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7609 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7610 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7611 command.
7612
7613 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7614 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7615 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7616 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7617 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7618 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7619 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7620
7621 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7622 @cindex default source path substitution
7623 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7624 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7625 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7626 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7627 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7628 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7629 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7630 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7631 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7632 together.
7633
7634 @table @code
7635 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7636 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7637 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7638 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7639 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7640 part of absolute file names) or
7641 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7642 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7643
7644 @kindex cdir
7645 @kindex cwd
7646 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7647 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7648 @cindex compilation directory
7649 @cindex current directory
7650 @cindex working directory
7651 @cindex directory, current
7652 @cindex directory, compilation
7653 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7654 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7655 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7656 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7657 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7658 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7659
7660 @item directory
7661 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7662
7663 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7664 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7665
7666 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7667 @kindex set directories
7668 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7669 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7670
7671 @item show directories
7672 @kindex show directories
7673 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7674
7675 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7676 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7677 @kindex set substitute-path
7678 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7679 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7680 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7681
7682 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7683 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7684
7685 @smallexample
7686 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7687 @end smallexample
7688
7689 @noindent
7690 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7691 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7692 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7693
7694 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7695 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7696 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7697 the substitution.
7698
7699 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7700
7701 @smallexample
7702 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7703 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7704 @end smallexample
7705
7706 @noindent
7707 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7708 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7709 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7710 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7711
7712
7713 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7714 @kindex unset substitute-path
7715 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7716 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7717 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7718
7719 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7720
7721 @item show substitute-path [path]
7722 @kindex show substitute-path
7723 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7724 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7725
7726 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7727 rules.
7728
7729 @end table
7730
7731 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7732 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7733 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7734
7735 @enumerate
7736 @item
7737 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7738
7739 @item
7740 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7741 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7742 directories in one command.
7743 @end enumerate
7744
7745 @node Machine Code
7746 @section Source and Machine Code
7747 @cindex source line and its code address
7748
7749 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7750 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7751 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7752 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7753 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7754 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7755 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7756 well as hex.
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @kindex info line
7760 @item info line @var{linespec}
7761 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7762 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7763 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7764 @end table
7765
7766 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7767 the object code for the first line of function
7768 @code{m4_changequote}:
7769
7770 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7771 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7772 @smallexample
7773 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7774 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7775 @end smallexample
7776
7777 @noindent
7778 @cindex code address and its source line
7779 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7780 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7781 @smallexample
7782 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7783 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7784 @end smallexample
7785
7786 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7787 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7788 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7789 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7790 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7791 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7792 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7793 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7794 Variables}).
7795
7796 @table @code
7797 @kindex disassemble
7798 @cindex assembly instructions
7799 @cindex instructions, assembly
7800 @cindex machine instructions
7801 @cindex listing machine instructions
7802 @item disassemble
7803 @itemx disassemble /m
7804 @itemx disassemble /r
7805 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7806 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7807 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7808 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7809 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7810 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7811 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7812 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7813 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7814 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7815
7816 @table @code
7817 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7818 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7819 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7820 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7821 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7822 @end table
7823
7824 @noindent
7825 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7826 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7827
7828 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7829 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7830
7831 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7832 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7833 @end table
7834
7835 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7836 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7837
7838 @smallexample
7839 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7840 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7841 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7842 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7843 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7844 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7845 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7846 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7847 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7848 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7849 End of assembler dump.
7850 @end smallexample
7851
7852 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7853 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7854
7855 @smallexample
7856 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7857 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7858 5 @{
7859 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7860 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7861 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7862 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7863 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7864
7865 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7866 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7867 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7868
7869 7 return 0;
7870 8 @}
7871 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7872 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7873 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7874
7875 End of assembler dump.
7876 @end smallexample
7877
7878 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7879
7880 @smallexample
7881 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7882 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7883 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7884 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7885 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7886 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7887 End of assembler dump.
7888 @end smallexample
7889
7890 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7891 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7892 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7893 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7894
7895 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7896 mnemonics or other syntax.
7897
7898 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7899 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7900 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7901 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7902 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7903
7904 @table @code
7905 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7906 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7907 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7908 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7909 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7910 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7911
7912 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7913 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7914 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7915 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7916
7917 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7918 @item show disassembly-flavor
7919 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7920 @end table
7921
7922 @table @code
7923 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7924 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7925 @item set disassemble-next-line
7926 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7927 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7928 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7929 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7930 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7931 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7932 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7933 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7934 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7935 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7936 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7937 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7938 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7939 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7940 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7941 instruction.
7942 @end table
7943
7944
7945 @node Data
7946 @chapter Examining Data
7947
7948 @cindex printing data
7949 @cindex examining data
7950 @kindex print
7951 @kindex inspect
7952 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7953 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7954 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7955 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7956 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7957 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7958
7959 @table @code
7960 @item print @var{expr}
7961 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7962 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7963 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7964 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7965 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7966 Formats}.
7967
7968 @item print
7969 @itemx print /@var{f}
7970 @cindex reprint the last value
7971 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7972 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7973 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7977 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7978 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7979
7980 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7981 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7982 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7983 Table}.
7984
7985 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
7986 @kindex explore
7987 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
7988 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
7989 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
7990 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
7991 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
7992 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
7993 embedded in the higher level data types.
7994
7995 @table @code
7996 @item explore @var{arg}
7997 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
7998 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
7999 @end table
8000
8001 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8002 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8003 C program as
8004
8005 @smallexample
8006 struct SimpleStruct
8007 @{
8008 int i;
8009 double d;
8010 @};
8011
8012 struct ComplexStruct
8013 @{
8014 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8015 int arr[10];
8016 @};
8017 @end smallexample
8018
8019 @noindent
8020 followed by variable declarations as
8021
8022 @smallexample
8023 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8024 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8025 @end smallexample
8026
8027 @noindent
8028 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8029 @code{explore} command as follows.
8030
8031 @smallexample
8032 (gdb) explore cs
8033 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8034 the following fields:
8035
8036 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8037 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8038
8039 Enter the field number of choice:
8040 @end smallexample
8041
8042 @noindent
8043 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8044 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8045 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8046 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8047 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8048 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8049 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8050 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8051
8052 @smallexample
8053 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8054 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8055 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8056 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8057
8058 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8059 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8060
8061 Press enter to return to parent value:
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 @noindent
8065 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8066 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8067 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8068 to explore.
8069
8070 @smallexample
8071 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8072 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8073
8074 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8075
8076 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8077
8078 Press enter to return to parent value:
8079 @end smallexample
8080
8081 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8082 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8083 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8084 level data structure).
8085
8086 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8087 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8088 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8089 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8090 same example as above, your can explore the type
8091 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8092 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8093
8094 @smallexample
8095 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8096 @end smallexample
8097
8098 @noindent
8099 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8100 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8101 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8102 example.
8103
8104 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8105 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8106 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8107 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8108 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8109
8110 @table @code
8111 @item explore value @var{expr}
8112 @cindex explore value
8113 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8114 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8115 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8116 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8117 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8118
8119 @item explore type @var{arg}
8120 @cindex explore type
8121 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8122 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8123 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8124 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8125 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8126 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8127 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8128 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8129 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8130 @end table
8131
8132 @menu
8133 * Expressions:: Expressions
8134 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8135 * Variables:: Program variables
8136 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8137 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8138 * Memory:: Examining memory
8139 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8140 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8141 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8142 * Value History:: Value history
8143 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8144 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8145 * Registers:: Registers
8146 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8147 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8148 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8149 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8150 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8151 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8152 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8153 character set than GDB does
8154 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8155 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8156 @end menu
8157
8158 @node Expressions
8159 @section Expressions
8160
8161 @cindex expressions
8162 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8163 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8164 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8165 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8166 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8167 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8168 @ref{Compilation}.
8169
8170 @cindex arrays in expressions
8171 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8172 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8173 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8174 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8175 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8176 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8177
8178 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8179 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8180 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8181 languages.
8182
8183 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8184 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8185
8186 @cindex casts, in expressions
8187 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8188 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8189 at that address in memory.
8190 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8191
8192 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8193 to programming languages:
8194
8195 @table @code
8196 @item @@
8197 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8198 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8199
8200 @item ::
8201 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8202 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8203
8204 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8205 @cindex type casting memory
8206 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8207 @cindex casts, to view memory
8208 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8209 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8210 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8211 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8212 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8213 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8214 @end table
8215
8216 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8217 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8218 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8219
8220 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8221 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8222 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8223 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8224 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8225 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8226 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8227
8228 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8229 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8230 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8231 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8232 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8233 as well.
8234
8235 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8236 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8237 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8238 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8239 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8240 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8241 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8242 choices.
8243
8244 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8245 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8246 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8247
8248 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8249 @smallexample
8250 @group
8251 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8252 [0] cancel
8253 [1] all
8254 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8255 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8256 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8257 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8258 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8259 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8260 > 2 4 6
8261 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8262 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8263 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8264 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8265 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8266 breakpoints.
8267 (@value{GDBP})
8268 @end group
8269 @end smallexample
8270
8271 @table @code
8272 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8273 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8274 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8275
8276 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8277 is ambiguous.
8278
8279 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8280 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8281 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8282 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8283 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8284 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8285 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8286 in the use of the menu.
8287
8288 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8289 when an ambiguity is detected.
8290
8291 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8292 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8293
8294 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8295 @item show multiple-symbols
8296 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8297 @end table
8298
8299 @node Variables
8300 @section Program Variables
8301
8302 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8303 in your program.
8304
8305 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8306 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8307
8308 @itemize @bullet
8309 @item
8310 global (or file-static)
8311 @end itemize
8312
8313 @noindent or
8314
8315 @itemize @bullet
8316 @item
8317 visible according to the scope rules of the
8318 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8319 @end itemize
8320
8321 @noindent This means that in the function
8322
8323 @smallexample
8324 foo (a)
8325 int a;
8326 @{
8327 bar (a);
8328 @{
8329 int b = test ();
8330 bar (b);
8331 @}
8332 @}
8333 @end smallexample
8334
8335 @noindent
8336 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8337 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8338 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8339 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8340
8341 @cindex variable name conflict
8342 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8343 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8344 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8345 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8346 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8347 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8348 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8349
8350 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8351 @ifnotinfo
8352 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8353 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8354 @end ifnotinfo
8355 @smallexample
8356 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8357 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8358 @end smallexample
8359
8360 @noindent
8361 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8362 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8363 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8364 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8365
8366 @smallexample
8367 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8368 @end smallexample
8369
8370 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8371 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8372 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8373 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8374 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8375
8376 @smallexample
8377 void
8378 foo (int a)
8379 @{
8380 if (a < 10)
8381 bar (a);
8382 else
8383 process (a); /* Stop here */
8384 @}
8385
8386 int
8387 bar (int a)
8388 @{
8389 foo (a + 5);
8390 @}
8391 @end smallexample
8392
8393 @noindent
8394 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8395 here is what you might see
8396 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8397
8398 @smallexample
8399 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8400 $1 = 10
8401 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8402 $2 = 5
8403 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8404 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8405 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8406 $3 = 5
8407 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8408 $4 = 0
8409 @end smallexample
8410
8411 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8412 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8413 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8414 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8415 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8416
8417 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8418 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8419 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8420 @code{some_global}.
8421
8422 @smallexample
8423 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8424 $1 = 23
8425 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8426 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8427 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8428 $2 = 27
8429 @end smallexample
8430
8431 @cindex wrong values
8432 @cindex variable values, wrong
8433 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8434 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8435 @quotation
8436 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8437 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8438 scope, and just before exit.
8439 @end quotation
8440 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8441 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8442 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8443 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8444 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8445 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8446 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8447 variable definitions may be gone.
8448
8449 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8450 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8451 when compiling.
8452
8453 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8454 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8455 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8456 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8457 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8458 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8459 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8460
8461 @smallexample
8462 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8463 @end smallexample
8464
8465 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8466 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8467 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8468 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8469 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8470
8471 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8472 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8473 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8474 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8475
8476 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8477 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8478 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8479 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8480 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8481
8482 @smallexample
8483 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8484 29 i++;
8485 (gdb) next
8486 30 e (i);
8487 (gdb) print i
8488 $1 = 31
8489 (gdb) print i@@entry
8490 $2 = 30
8491 @end smallexample
8492
8493 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8494 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8495 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8496 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8497 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8498 For program code
8499
8500 @smallexample
8501 char var0[] = "A";
8502 signed char var1[] = "A";
8503 @end smallexample
8504
8505 You get during debugging
8506 @smallexample
8507 (gdb) print var0
8508 $1 = "A"
8509 (gdb) print var1
8510 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8511 @end smallexample
8512
8513 @node Arrays
8514 @section Artificial Arrays
8515
8516 @cindex artificial array
8517 @cindex arrays
8518 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8519 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8520 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8521 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8522 program.
8523
8524 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8525 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8526 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8527 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8528 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8529 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8530 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8531 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8532 example. If a program says
8533
8534 @smallexample
8535 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8536 @end smallexample
8537
8538 @noindent
8539 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8540
8541 @smallexample
8542 p *array@@len
8543 @end smallexample
8544
8545 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8546 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8547 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8548 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8549 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8550
8551 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8552 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8553 The value need not be in memory:
8554 @smallexample
8555 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8556 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8557 @end smallexample
8558
8559 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8560 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8561 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8562 @smallexample
8563 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8564 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8568 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8569 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8570 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8571 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8572 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8573 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8574 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8575 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8576 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8577
8578 @smallexample
8579 set $i = 0
8580 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8581 @key{RET}
8582 @key{RET}
8583 @dots{}
8584 @end smallexample
8585
8586 @node Output Formats
8587 @section Output Formats
8588
8589 @cindex formatted output
8590 @cindex output formats
8591 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8592 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8593 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8594 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8595 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8596
8597 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8598 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8599 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8600 letters supported are:
8601
8602 @table @code
8603 @item x
8604 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8605 hexadecimal.
8606
8607 @item d
8608 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8609
8610 @item u
8611 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8612
8613 @item o
8614 Print as integer in octal.
8615
8616 @item t
8617 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8618 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8619 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8620 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8621
8622 @item a
8623 @cindex unknown address, locating
8624 @cindex locate address
8625 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8626 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8627 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8628
8629 @smallexample
8630 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8631 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8632 @end smallexample
8633
8634 @noindent
8635 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8636 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8637
8638 @item c
8639 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8640 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8641 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8642 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8643
8644 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8645 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8646 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8647 data.
8648
8649 @item f
8650 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8651 using typical floating point syntax.
8652
8653 @item s
8654 @cindex printing strings
8655 @cindex printing byte arrays
8656 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8657 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8658 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8659 natural types.
8660
8661 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8662 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8663 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8664 array.
8665
8666 @item z
8667 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8668 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8669 to the size of the integer type.
8670
8671 @item r
8672 @cindex raw printing
8673 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8674 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8675 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8676 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8677 pretty-printer which might exist.
8678 @end table
8679
8680 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8681
8682 @smallexample
8683 p/x $pc
8684 @end smallexample
8685
8686 @noindent
8687 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8688 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8689
8690 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8691 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8692 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8693
8694 @node Memory
8695 @section Examining Memory
8696
8697 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8698 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8699
8700 @cindex examining memory
8701 @table @code
8702 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8703 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8704 @itemx x @var{addr}
8705 @itemx x
8706 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8707 @end table
8708
8709 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8710 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8711 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8712 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8713 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8714
8715 @table @r
8716 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8717 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8718 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8719 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8720 @c 4.1.2.
8721
8722 @item @var{f}, the display format
8723 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8724 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8725 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8726 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8727 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8728
8729 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8730 The unit size is any of
8731
8732 @table @code
8733 @item b
8734 Bytes.
8735 @item h
8736 Halfwords (two bytes).
8737 @item w
8738 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8739 @item g
8740 Giant words (eight bytes).
8741 @end table
8742
8743 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8744 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8745 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8746 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8747 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8748 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8749 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8750 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8751 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8752 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8753 be altered.
8754
8755 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8756 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8757 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8758 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8759 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8760 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8761 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8762 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8763 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8764 a value from memory).
8765 @end table
8766
8767 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8768 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8769 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8770 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8771 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8772
8773 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8774 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8775 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8776 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8777 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8778
8779 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8780 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8781 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8782 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8783 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8784 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8785 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8786 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8787 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8788
8789 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8790 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8791 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8792 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8793 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8794 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8795 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8796
8797 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8798 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8799
8800 @smallexample
8801 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8802 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8803 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8804 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8805 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8806 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8807 @end smallexample
8808
8809 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8810 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8811 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8812 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8813 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8814 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8815 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8816 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8817 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8818
8819 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8820 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8821 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8822
8823 @cindex remote memory comparison
8824 @cindex target memory comparison
8825 @cindex verify remote memory image
8826 @cindex verify target memory image
8827 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8828 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
8829 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
8830 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
8831 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
8832 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
8833
8834 @table @code
8835 @kindex compare-sections
8836 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8837 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8838 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8839 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8840 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8841 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
8842
8843 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
8844 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
8845 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
8846 @end table
8847
8848 @node Auto Display
8849 @section Automatic Display
8850 @cindex automatic display
8851 @cindex display of expressions
8852
8853 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8854 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8855 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8856 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8857 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8858 The automatic display looks like this:
8859
8860 @smallexample
8861 2: foo = 38
8862 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8867 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8868 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8869 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8870 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8871 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8872
8873 @table @code
8874 @kindex display
8875 @item display @var{expr}
8876 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8877 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8878
8879 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8880
8881 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8882 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8883 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8884 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8885 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8886
8887 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8888 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8889 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8890 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8891 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8892 @end table
8893
8894 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8895 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8896 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8897
8898 @table @code
8899 @kindex delete display
8900 @kindex undisplay
8901 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8902 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8903 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8904 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8905 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8906 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8907 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8908
8909 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8910 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8911
8912 @kindex disable display
8913 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8914 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8915 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8916 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8917 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8918 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8919 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8920 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8921
8922 @kindex enable display
8923 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8924 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8925 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8926 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8927 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8928 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8929 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8930
8931 @item display
8932 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8933 done when your program stops.
8934
8935 @kindex info display
8936 @item info display
8937 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8938 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8939 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8940 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8941 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8942 @end table
8943
8944 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8945 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
8946 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
8947 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
8948 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
8949 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
8950 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
8951 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
8952 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
8953 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
8954 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
8955
8956 @node Print Settings
8957 @section Print Settings
8958
8959 @cindex format options
8960 @cindex print settings
8961 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
8962 and symbols are printed.
8963
8964 @noindent
8965 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
8966
8967 @table @code
8968 @kindex set print
8969 @item set print address
8970 @itemx set print address on
8971 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
8972 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
8973 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
8974 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
8975 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
8976 @code{set print address on}:
8977
8978 @smallexample
8979 @group
8980 (@value{GDBP}) f
8981 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
8982 at input.c:530
8983 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8984 @end group
8985 @end smallexample
8986
8987 @item set print address off
8988 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
8989 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
8990
8991 @smallexample
8992 @group
8993 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
8994 (@value{GDBP}) f
8995 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
8996 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
8997 @end group
8998 @end smallexample
8999
9000 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9001 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9002 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9003 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9004
9005 @kindex show print
9006 @item show print address
9007 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9008 @end table
9009
9010 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9011 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9012 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9013 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9014 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9015 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9016 it prints a symbolic address:
9017
9018 @table @code
9019 @item set print symbol-filename on
9020 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9021 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9022 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9023 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9024
9025 @item set print symbol-filename off
9026 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9027 default.
9028
9029 @item show print symbol-filename
9030 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9031 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9032 @end table
9033
9034 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9035 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9036 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9037
9038 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9039 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9040
9041 @table @code
9042 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9043 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9044 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9045 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9046 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9047 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9048 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9049 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9050
9051 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9052 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9053 symbolic address.
9054 @end table
9055
9056 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9057 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9058 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9059 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9060 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9061 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9062 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9063 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9064
9065 @smallexample
9066 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9067 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9068 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9069 @end smallexample
9070
9071 @quotation
9072 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9073 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9074 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9075 @end quotation
9076
9077 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9078 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9079
9080 @table @code
9081 @item set print symbol on
9082 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9083 one exists.
9084
9085 @item set print symbol off
9086 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9087 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9088 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9089
9090 @item show print symbol
9091 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9092 address.
9093 @end table
9094
9095 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9096
9097 @table @code
9098 @item set print array
9099 @itemx set print array on
9100 @cindex pretty print arrays
9101 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9102 but uses more space. The default is off.
9103
9104 @item set print array off
9105 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9106
9107 @item show print array
9108 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9109 arrays.
9110
9111 @cindex print array indexes
9112 @item set print array-indexes
9113 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9114 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9115 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9116 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9117
9118 @item set print array-indexes off
9119 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9120
9121 @item show print array-indexes
9122 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9123 arrays.
9124
9125 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9126 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9127 @cindex number of array elements to print
9128 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9129 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9130 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9131 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9132 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9133 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9134 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9135 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9136
9137 @item show print elements
9138 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9139 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9140
9141 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9142 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9143 @cindex printing frame argument values
9144 @cindex print all frame argument values
9145 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9146 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9147 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9148 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9149 values are:
9150
9151 @table @code
9152 @item all
9153 The values of all arguments are printed.
9154
9155 @item scalars
9156 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9157 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9158 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9159 only scalar arguments are shown:
9160
9161 @smallexample
9162 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9163 at frame-args.c:23
9164 @end smallexample
9165
9166 @item none
9167 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9168 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9169
9170 @smallexample
9171 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9172 at frame-args.c:23
9173 @end smallexample
9174 @end table
9175
9176 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9177 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9178 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9179 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9180 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9181 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9182 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9183 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9184 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9185 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9186
9187 @item show print frame-arguments
9188 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9189
9190 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9191 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9192
9193 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9194 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9195 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9196 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9197 This is the default.
9198
9199 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9200 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9201
9202 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9203 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9204 @kindex set print entry-values
9205 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9206 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9207 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9208 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9209 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9210
9211 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9212 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9213 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9214 @code{no} setting.
9215
9216 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9217 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9218 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9219 this information.
9220
9221 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9222
9223 @table @code
9224 @item no
9225 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9226 point.
9227 @smallexample
9228 #0 equal (val=5)
9229 #0 different (val=6)
9230 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9231 #0 born (val=10)
9232 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9233 @end smallexample
9234
9235 @item only
9236 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9237 values are never printed.
9238 @smallexample
9239 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9240 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9241 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9242 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9243 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9244 @end smallexample
9245
9246 @item preferred
9247 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9248 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9249 value for such parameter.
9250 @smallexample
9251 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9252 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9253 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9254 #0 born (val=10)
9255 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9256 @end smallexample
9257
9258 @item if-needed
9259 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9260 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9261 parameter.
9262 @smallexample
9263 #0 equal (val=5)
9264 #0 different (val=6)
9265 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9266 #0 born (val=10)
9267 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9268 @end smallexample
9269
9270 @item both
9271 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9272 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9273 optimizations.
9274 @smallexample
9275 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9276 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9277 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9278 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9279 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9280 @end smallexample
9281
9282 @item compact
9283 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9284 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9285 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9286 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9287 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9288 @smallexample
9289 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9290 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9291 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9292 #0 born (val=10)
9293 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 @item default
9297 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9298 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9299 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9300 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9301 @smallexample
9302 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9303 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9304 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9305 #0 born (val=10)
9306 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9307 @end smallexample
9308 @end table
9309
9310 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9311 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9312
9313 @item show print entry-values
9314 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9315 entry.
9316
9317 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9318 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9319 @cindex repeated array elements
9320 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9321 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9322 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9323 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9324 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9325 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9326 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9327 is 10.
9328
9329 @item show print repeats
9330 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9331 elements.
9332
9333 @item set print null-stop
9334 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9335 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9336 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9337 contain only short strings.
9338 The default is off.
9339
9340 @item show print null-stop
9341 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9342 @sc{null} character.
9343
9344 @item set print pretty on
9345 @cindex print structures in indented form
9346 @cindex indentation in structure display
9347 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9348 per line, like this:
9349
9350 @smallexample
9351 @group
9352 $1 = @{
9353 next = 0x0,
9354 flags = @{
9355 sweet = 1,
9356 sour = 1
9357 @},
9358 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9359 @}
9360 @end group
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 @item set print pretty off
9364 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9365
9366 @smallexample
9367 @group
9368 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9369 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9370 @end group
9371 @end smallexample
9372
9373 @noindent
9374 This is the default format.
9375
9376 @item show print pretty
9377 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9378
9379 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9380 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9381 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9382 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9383 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9384 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9385 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9386 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9387
9388 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9389 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9390 international character sets, and is the default.
9391
9392 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9393 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9394
9395 @item set print union on
9396 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9397 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9398 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9399
9400 @item set print union off
9401 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9402 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9403 instead.
9404
9405 @item show print union
9406 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9407 structures and other unions.
9408
9409 For example, given the declarations
9410
9411 @smallexample
9412 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9413 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9414 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9415 Bug_forms;
9416
9417 struct thing @{
9418 Species it;
9419 union @{
9420 Tree_forms tree;
9421 Bug_forms bug;
9422 @} form;
9423 @};
9424
9425 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9426 @end smallexample
9427
9428 @noindent
9429 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9430
9431 @smallexample
9432 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9433 @end smallexample
9434
9435 @noindent
9436 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9437
9438 @smallexample
9439 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9440 @end smallexample
9441
9442 @noindent
9443 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9444 and in Pascal.
9445 @end table
9446
9447 @need 1000
9448 @noindent
9449 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9450
9451 @table @code
9452 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9453 @item set print demangle
9454 @itemx set print demangle on
9455 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9456 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9457 linkage. The default is on.
9458
9459 @item show print demangle
9460 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9461
9462 @item set print asm-demangle
9463 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9464 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9465 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9466 The default is off.
9467
9468 @item show print asm-demangle
9469 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9470 or demangled form.
9471
9472 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9473 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9474 @kindex set demangle-style
9475 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9476 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9477 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9478
9479 @table @code
9480 @item auto
9481 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9482 This is the default.
9483
9484 @item gnu
9485 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9486
9487 @item hp
9488 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9489
9490 @item lucid
9491 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9492
9493 @item arm
9494 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9495 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9496 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9497 require further enhancement to permit that.
9498
9499 @end table
9500 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9501
9502 @item show demangle-style
9503 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9504
9505 @item set print object
9506 @itemx set print object on
9507 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9508 @cindex display derived types
9509 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9510 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9511 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9512 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9513 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9514 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9515 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9516
9517 @item set print object off
9518 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9519 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9520
9521 @item show print object
9522 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9523
9524 @item set print static-members
9525 @itemx set print static-members on
9526 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9527 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9528
9529 @item set print static-members off
9530 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9531
9532 @item show print static-members
9533 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9534
9535 @item set print pascal_static-members
9536 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9537 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9538 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9539 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9540
9541 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9542 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9543
9544 @item show print pascal_static-members
9545 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9546
9547 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9548 @item set print vtbl
9549 @itemx set print vtbl on
9550 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9551 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9552 @cindex VTBL display
9553 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9554 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9555 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9556
9557 @item set print vtbl off
9558 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9559
9560 @item show print vtbl
9561 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9562 @end table
9563
9564 @node Pretty Printing
9565 @section Pretty Printing
9566
9567 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9568 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9569 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9570
9571 @menu
9572 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9573 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9574 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9575 @end menu
9576
9577 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9578 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9579
9580 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9581 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9582 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9583
9584 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9585 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9586 pretty-printers with their names.
9587 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9588 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9589 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9590 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9591
9592 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9593 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9594 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9595 do anything special.
9596
9597 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9598
9599 @itemize @bullet
9600 @item
9601 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9602 all inferiors.
9603
9604 @item
9605 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9606 when debugging that program.
9607 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9608
9609 @item
9610 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9611 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9612 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9613 @end itemize
9614
9615 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9616 pretty-printers are selected,
9617
9618 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9619 for new types.
9620
9621 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9622 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9623
9624 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9625
9626 @smallexample
9627 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9628 $1 = @{
9629 static npos = 4294967295,
9630 _M_dataplus = @{
9631 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9632 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9633 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9634 @},
9635 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9636 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9637 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9638 @}
9639 @}
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9643
9644 @smallexample
9645 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9646 $2 = "abcd"
9647 @end smallexample
9648
9649 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9650 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9651 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9652
9653 @table @code
9654 @kindex info pretty-printer
9655 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9656 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9657 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9658
9659 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9660 whose pretty-printers to list.
9661 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9662 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9663 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9664 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9665 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9666
9667 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9668 to list.
9669
9670 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9671 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9672 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9673 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9674
9675 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9676 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9677 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9678 @end table
9679
9680 Example:
9681
9682 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9683 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9684 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9685 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9686
9687 @smallexample
9688 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9689 library1.so:
9690 foo
9691 library2.so:
9692 bar
9693 bar1
9694 bar2
9695 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9696 library2.so:
9697 bar
9698 bar1
9699 bar2
9700 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9701 1 printer disabled
9702 2 of 3 printers enabled
9703 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9704 library1.so:
9705 foo [disabled]
9706 library2.so:
9707 bar
9708 bar1
9709 bar2
9710 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9711 1 printer disabled
9712 1 of 3 printers enabled
9713 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9714 library1.so:
9715 foo [disabled]
9716 library2.so:
9717 bar
9718 bar1 [disabled]
9719 bar2
9720 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9721 1 printer disabled
9722 0 of 3 printers enabled
9723 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9724 library1.so:
9725 foo [disabled]
9726 library2.so:
9727 bar [disabled]
9728 bar1 [disabled]
9729 bar2
9730 @end smallexample
9731
9732 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9733 as can each individual subprinter.
9734
9735 @node Value History
9736 @section Value History
9737
9738 @cindex value history
9739 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9740 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9741 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9742 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9743 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9744 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9745 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9746 symbol table.
9747
9748 @cindex @code{$}
9749 @cindex @code{$$}
9750 @cindex history number
9751 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9752 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9753 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9754 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9755 history number.
9756
9757 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9758 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9759 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9760 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9761 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9762 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9763 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9764
9765 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9766 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9767
9768 @smallexample
9769 p *$
9770 @end smallexample
9771
9772 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9773 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9774
9775 @smallexample
9776 p *$.next
9777 @end smallexample
9778
9779 @noindent
9780 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9781 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9782
9783 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9784 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9785
9786 @smallexample
9787 print x
9788 set x=5
9789 @end smallexample
9790
9791 @noindent
9792 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9793 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9794
9795 @table @code
9796 @kindex show values
9797 @item show values
9798 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9799 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9800 values} does not change the history.
9801
9802 @item show values @var{n}
9803 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9804
9805 @item show values +
9806 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9807 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9808 @end table
9809
9810 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9811 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9812
9813 @node Convenience Vars
9814 @section Convenience Variables
9815
9816 @cindex convenience variables
9817 @cindex user-defined variables
9818 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9819 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9820 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9821 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9822 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9823
9824 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9825 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9826 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9827 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9828 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9829
9830 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9831 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9832 For example:
9833
9834 @smallexample
9835 set $foo = *object_ptr
9836 @end smallexample
9837
9838 @noindent
9839 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9840 @code{object_ptr}.
9841
9842 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9843 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9844 value with another assignment at any time.
9845
9846 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9847 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9848 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9849 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9850
9851 @table @code
9852 @kindex show convenience
9853 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9854 @item show convenience
9855 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9856 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9857 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9858
9859 @kindex init-if-undefined
9860 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9861 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9862 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9863 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9864 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9865 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9866 override default values used in a command script.
9867
9868 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9869 any side-effects do not occur.
9870 @end table
9871
9872 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9873 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9874 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9875
9876 @smallexample
9877 set $i = 0
9878 print bar[$i++]->contents
9879 @end smallexample
9880
9881 @noindent
9882 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9883
9884 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9885 values likely to be useful.
9886
9887 @table @code
9888 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9889 @item $_
9890 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9891 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9892 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9893 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9894 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9895 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9896 to the type of @code{$__}.
9897
9898 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9899 @item $__
9900 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9901 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9902 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9903
9904 @item $_exitcode
9905 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9906 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9907 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9908 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9909
9910 @item $_exitsignal
9911 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9912 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9913 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9914 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9915
9916 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9917 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9918 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9919 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9920 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9921
9922 @smallexample
9923 #include <signal.h>
9924
9925 int
9926 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9927 @{
9928 raise (SIGALRM);
9929 return 0;
9930 @}
9931 @end smallexample
9932
9933 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9934 or signalled would be:
9935
9936 @smallexample
9937 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9938 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9939 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9940 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9941 >echo The program has exited\n
9942 >else
9943 >echo The program has signalled\n
9944 >end
9945 >end
9946 (@value{GDBP}) run
9947 Starting program:
9948
9949 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
9950 The program no longer exists.
9951 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9952 The program has signalled
9953 @end smallexample
9954
9955 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
9956 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
9957 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
9958 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
9959
9960 @smallexample
9961 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
9962 The program has exited
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @item $_exception
9966 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
9967 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
9968
9969 @item $_probe_argc
9970 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
9971 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
9972
9973 @item $_sdata
9974 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
9975 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
9976 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
9977 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
9978 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
9979
9980 @item $_siginfo
9981 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
9982 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
9983 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
9984 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
9985 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
9986
9987 @item $_tlb
9988 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
9989 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
9990 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
9991 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
9992 @xref{General Query Packets}.
9993 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
9994
9995 @end table
9996
9997 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9998 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9999 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10000
10001 @node Convenience Funs
10002 @section Convenience Functions
10003
10004 @cindex convenience functions
10005 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10006 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10007 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10008 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10009 @value{GDBN}.
10010
10011 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10012 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10013
10014 @table @code
10015
10016 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10017 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10018 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10019 returns zero.
10020
10021 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10022 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10023 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10024 it is @code{void}:
10025
10026 @smallexample
10027 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10028 $1 = void
10029 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10030 $2 = 1
10031 (@value{GDBP}) run
10032 Starting program: ./a.out
10033 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10034 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10035 $3 = 0
10036 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10037 $4 = 0
10038 @end smallexample
10039
10040 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10041 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10042 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10043 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10044 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10045 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10046 anymore.
10047
10048 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10049 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 void
10053 foo (void)
10054 @{
10055 @}
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10059
10060 @smallexample
10061 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10062 $1 = void
10063 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10064 $2 = 1
10065 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10066 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10067 $3 = void
10068 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10069 $4 = 1
10070 @end smallexample
10071
10072 @end table
10073
10074 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10075 @code{Python} support.
10076
10077 @table @code
10078
10079 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10080 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10081 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10082 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10083 Otherwise it returns zero.
10084
10085 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10086 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10087 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10088 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10089 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10090 regular expression support.
10091
10092 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10093 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10094 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10095 Otherwise it returns zero.
10096
10097 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10098 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10099 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10100
10101 @end table
10102
10103 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10104 convenience functions.
10105
10106 @table @code
10107 @item help function
10108 @kindex help function
10109 @cindex show all convenience functions
10110 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10111 @end table
10112
10113 @node Registers
10114 @section Registers
10115
10116 @cindex registers
10117 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10118 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10119 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10120 your machine.
10121
10122 @table @code
10123 @kindex info registers
10124 @item info registers
10125 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10126 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10127
10128 @kindex info all-registers
10129 @cindex floating point registers
10130 @item info all-registers
10131 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10132 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10133
10134 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10135 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10136 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10137 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10138 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10139 @end table
10140
10141 @cindex stack pointer register
10142 @cindex program counter register
10143 @cindex process status register
10144 @cindex frame pointer register
10145 @cindex standard registers
10146 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10147 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10148 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10149 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10150 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10151 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10152 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10153 you could print the program counter in hex with
10154
10155 @smallexample
10156 p/x $pc
10157 @end smallexample
10158
10159 @noindent
10160 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10161
10162 @smallexample
10163 x/i $pc
10164 @end smallexample
10165
10166 @noindent
10167 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10168 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10169 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10170 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10171 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10172 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10173 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10174
10175 @smallexample
10176 set $sp += 4
10177 @end smallexample
10178
10179 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10180 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10181 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10182 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10183 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10184 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10185 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10186
10187 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10188 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10189 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10190 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10191 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10192 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10193 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10194
10195 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10196 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10197 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10198 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10199 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10200 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10201 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10202 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10203 prints the data in both formats.
10204
10205 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10206 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10207 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10208 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10209 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10210 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10211 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10212
10213 @smallexample
10214 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10215 $1 = @{
10216 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10217 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10218 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10219 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10220 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10221 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10222 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10223 @}
10224 @end smallexample
10225
10226 @noindent
10227 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10228 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10229 value to a @code{struct} member:
10230
10231 @smallexample
10232 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10233 @end smallexample
10234
10235 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10236 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10237 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10238 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10239 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10240 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10241
10242 @cindex caller-saved registers
10243 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10244 @cindex volatile registers
10245 @cindex <not saved> values
10246 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10247 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10248 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10249 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10250 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10251 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10252 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10253 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10254 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10255 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10256 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10257 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10258 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10259 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10260 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10261 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10262 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10263 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10264 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10265 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10266 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10267 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10268 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10269
10270 @node Floating Point Hardware
10271 @section Floating Point Hardware
10272 @cindex floating point
10273
10274 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10275 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10276
10277 @table @code
10278 @kindex info float
10279 @item info float
10280 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10281 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10282 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10283 the ARM and x86 machines.
10284 @end table
10285
10286 @node Vector Unit
10287 @section Vector Unit
10288 @cindex vector unit
10289
10290 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10291 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10292
10293 @table @code
10294 @kindex info vector
10295 @item info vector
10296 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10297 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10298 @end table
10299
10300 @node OS Information
10301 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10302 @cindex OS information
10303
10304 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10305 you debug your program.
10306
10307 @cindex auxiliary vector
10308 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10309 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10310 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10311 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10312 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10313 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10314 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10315 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10316 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10317 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10318 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10319 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10320
10321 @table @code
10322 @kindex info auxv
10323 @item info auxv
10324 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10325 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10326 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10327 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10328 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10329 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10330 an unrecognized tag.
10331 @end table
10332
10333 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10334 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10335 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10336 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10337 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10338 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10339 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10340
10341 @table @code
10342 @kindex info os
10343 @item info os @var{infotype}
10344
10345 Display OS information of the requested type.
10346
10347 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10348
10349 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10350 @table @code
10351 @kindex info os processes
10352 @item processes
10353 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10354 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10355 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10356 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10357 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10358 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10359
10360 @kindex info os procgroups
10361 @item procgroups
10362 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10363 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10364 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10365 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10366 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10367 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10368 and the process group leader is listed first.
10369
10370 @kindex info os threads
10371 @item threads
10372 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10373 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10374 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10375 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10376 process is not listed.
10377
10378 @kindex info os files
10379 @item files
10380 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10381 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10382 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10383 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10384
10385 @kindex info os sockets
10386 @item sockets
10387 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10388 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10389 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10390 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10391 connection.
10392
10393 @kindex info os shm
10394 @item shm
10395 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10396 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10397 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10398 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10399 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10400 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10401 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10402
10403 @kindex info os semaphores
10404 @item semaphores
10405 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10406 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10407 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10408 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10409 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10410
10411 @kindex info os msg
10412 @item msg
10413 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10414 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10415 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10416 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10417 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10418 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10419 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10420 the message queue was last changed.
10421
10422 @kindex info os modules
10423 @item modules
10424 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10425 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10426 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10427 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10428 in memory.
10429 @end table
10430
10431 @item info os
10432 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10433 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10434 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10435 types, this command will report an error.
10436 @end table
10437
10438 @node Memory Region Attributes
10439 @section Memory Region Attributes
10440 @cindex memory region attributes
10441
10442 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10443 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10444 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10445 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10446 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10447 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10448 user can override the fetched regions.
10449
10450 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10451 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10452 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10453 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10454 all memory.
10455
10456 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10457 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10458
10459 @table @code
10460 @kindex mem
10461 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10462 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10463 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10464 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10465 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10466 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10467
10468 @item mem auto
10469 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10470 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10471
10472 @kindex delete mem
10473 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10474 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10475 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10476
10477 @kindex disable mem
10478 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10479 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10480 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10481 It may be enabled again later.
10482
10483 @kindex enable mem
10484 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10485 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10486
10487 @kindex info mem
10488 @item info mem
10489 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10490 for each region:
10491
10492 @table @emph
10493 @item Memory Region Number
10494 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10495 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10496 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10497
10498 @item Lo Address
10499 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10500
10501 @item Hi Address
10502 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10503
10504 @item Attributes
10505 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10506 @end table
10507 @end table
10508
10509
10510 @subsection Attributes
10511
10512 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10513 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10514 write accesses to a memory region.
10515
10516 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10517 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10518 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10519
10520 @table @code
10521 @item ro
10522 Memory is read only.
10523 @item wo
10524 Memory is write only.
10525 @item rw
10526 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10527 @end table
10528
10529 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10530 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10531 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10532 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10533 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10534
10535 @table @code
10536 @item 8
10537 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10538 @item 16
10539 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10540 @item 32
10541 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10542 @item 64
10543 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10544 @end table
10545
10546 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10547 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10548 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10549 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10550 @c
10551 @c @table @code
10552 @c @item hwbreak
10553 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10554 @c @item swbreak (default)
10555 @c @end table
10556
10557 @subsubsection Data Cache
10558 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10559 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10560 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10561 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10562 registers.
10563
10564 @table @code
10565 @item cache
10566 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10567 @item nocache
10568 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10569 @end table
10570
10571 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10572 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10573 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10574 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10575 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10576
10577 @table @code
10578 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10579 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10580 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10581 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10582 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10583 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10584 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10585 The default value is @code{on}.
10586 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10587 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10588 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10589 @end table
10590
10591
10592 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10593 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10594 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10595 @c
10596 @c @table @code
10597 @c @item verify
10598 @c @item noverify (default)
10599 @c @end table
10600
10601 @node Dump/Restore Files
10602 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10603 @cindex dump/restore files
10604 @cindex append data to a file
10605 @cindex dump data to a file
10606 @cindex restore data from a file
10607
10608 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10609 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10610 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10611 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10612 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10613 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10614 files.
10615
10616 @table @code
10617
10618 @kindex dump
10619 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10620 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10621 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10622 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10623
10624 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10625 @table @code
10626 @item binary
10627 Raw binary form.
10628 @item ihex
10629 Intel hex format.
10630 @item srec
10631 Motorola S-record format.
10632 @item tekhex
10633 Tektronix Hex format.
10634 @end table
10635
10636 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10637 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10638 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10639 form.
10640
10641 @kindex append
10642 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10643 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10644 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10645 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10646 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10647
10648 @kindex restore
10649 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10650 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10651 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10652 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10653 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10654
10655 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10656 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10657 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10658 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10659 from that location.
10660
10661 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10662 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10663 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10664 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10665
10666 @end table
10667
10668 @node Core File Generation
10669 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10670 @cindex dump core from inferior
10671
10672 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10673 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10674 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10675 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10676 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10677 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10678 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10679
10680 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10681 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10682 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10683
10684 @table @code
10685 @kindex gcore
10686 @kindex generate-core-file
10687 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10688 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10689 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10690 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10691 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10692 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10693
10694 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10695 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10696 @end table
10697
10698 @node Character Sets
10699 @section Character Sets
10700 @cindex character sets
10701 @cindex charset
10702 @cindex translating between character sets
10703 @cindex host character set
10704 @cindex target character set
10705
10706 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10707 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10708 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10709 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10710 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10711 @dfn{target character set}.
10712
10713 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10714 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10715 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10716 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10717 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10718 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10719 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10720 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10721 character and string literals in expressions.
10722
10723 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10724 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10725 target-charset} command, described below.
10726
10727 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10728 support:
10729
10730 @table @code
10731 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10732 @kindex set target-charset
10733 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10734 list of supported target character sets, type
10735 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10736
10737 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10738 @kindex set host-charset
10739 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10740
10741 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10742 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10743 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10744 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10745 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10746
10747 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10748 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10749 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10750
10751 @item set charset @var{charset}
10752 @kindex set charset
10753 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10754 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10755 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10756 for both host and target.
10757
10758 @item show charset
10759 @kindex show charset
10760 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10761
10762 @item show host-charset
10763 @kindex show host-charset
10764 Show the name of the current host character set.
10765
10766 @item show target-charset
10767 @kindex show target-charset
10768 Show the name of the current target character set.
10769
10770 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10771 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10772 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10773 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10774 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10775 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10776
10777 @item show target-wide-charset
10778 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10779 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10780 @end table
10781
10782 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10783 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10784 @file{charset-test.c}:
10785
10786 @smallexample
10787 #include <stdio.h>
10788
10789 char ascii_hello[]
10790 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10791 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10792 char ibm1047_hello[]
10793 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10794 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10795
10796 main ()
10797 @{
10798 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10799 @}
10800 @end smallexample
10801
10802 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10803 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10804 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10805
10806 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10807
10808 @smallexample
10809 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10810 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10811 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10812 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10813 @dots{}
10814 (@value{GDBP})
10815 @end smallexample
10816
10817 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10818 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10819 strings:
10820
10821 @smallexample
10822 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10823 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10824 (@value{GDBP})
10825 @end smallexample
10826
10827 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10828 initial character set:
10829 @smallexample
10830 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10831 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10832 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10833 (@value{GDBP})
10834 @end smallexample
10835
10836 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10837 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10838 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10839 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10840 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10841
10842 @smallexample
10843 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10844 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10845 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10846 $2 = 72 'H'
10847 (@value{GDBP})
10848 @end smallexample
10849
10850 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10851 literals you use in expressions:
10852
10853 @smallexample
10854 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10855 $3 = 43 '+'
10856 (@value{GDBP})
10857 @end smallexample
10858
10859 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10860 character.
10861
10862 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10863 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10864 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10868 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10869 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10870 $5 = 200 '\310'
10871 (@value{GDBP})
10872 @end smallexample
10873
10874 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10875 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10876
10877 @smallexample
10878 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10879 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10880 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10881 @end smallexample
10882
10883 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
10884 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
10885 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
10886 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
10887 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
10888
10889 @smallexample
10890 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
10891 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10892 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
10893 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
10894 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10895 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
10896 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10897 $7 = 72 '\110'
10898 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10899 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
10900 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10901 $9 = 200 'H'
10902 (@value{GDBP})
10903 @end smallexample
10904
10905 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
10906 string literals you use in expressions:
10907
10908 @smallexample
10909 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10910 $10 = 78 '+'
10911 (@value{GDBP})
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
10915 character.
10916
10917 @node Caching Target Data
10918 @section Caching Data of Targets
10919 @cindex caching data of targets
10920
10921 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
10922 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
10923 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
10924 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
10925 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
10926 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
10927 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
10928 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
10929 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
10930 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
10931 is executing.
10932 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
10933 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
10934 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
10935 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
10936 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
10937 in the code segment.
10938 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
10939 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
10940
10941 @table @code
10942 @kindex set remotecache
10943 @item set remotecache on
10944 @itemx set remotecache off
10945 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
10946 with old scripts.
10947
10948 @kindex show remotecache
10949 @item show remotecache
10950 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
10951
10952 @kindex set stack-cache
10953 @item set stack-cache on
10954 @itemx set stack-cache off
10955 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
10956 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
10957
10958 @kindex show stack-cache
10959 @item show stack-cache
10960 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
10961
10962 @kindex set code-cache
10963 @item set code-cache on
10964 @itemx set code-cache off
10965 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
10966 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
10967 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
10968
10969 @kindex show code-cache
10970 @item show code-cache
10971 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
10972 accesses.
10973
10974 @kindex info dcache
10975 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
10976 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
10977 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
10978 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
10979 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
10980 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
10981
10982 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
10983 printed in hex.
10984
10985 @item set dcache size @var{size}
10986 @cindex dcache size
10987 @kindex set dcache size
10988 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
10989
10990 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
10991 @cindex dcache line-size
10992 @kindex set dcache line-size
10993 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
10994 Must be a power of 2.
10995
10996 @item show dcache size
10997 @kindex show dcache size
10998 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
10999
11000 @item show dcache line-size
11001 @kindex show dcache line-size
11002 Show default size of dcache lines.
11003
11004 @end table
11005
11006 @node Searching Memory
11007 @section Search Memory
11008 @cindex searching memory
11009
11010 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11011 @code{find} command.
11012
11013 @table @code
11014 @kindex find
11015 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11016 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11017 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11018 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11019 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11020 @end table
11021
11022 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11023 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11024
11025 @table @r
11026 @item @var{s}, search query size
11027 The size of each search query value.
11028
11029 @table @code
11030 @item b
11031 bytes
11032 @item h
11033 halfwords (two bytes)
11034 @item w
11035 words (four bytes)
11036 @item g
11037 giant words (eight bytes)
11038 @end table
11039
11040 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11041 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11042 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11043
11044 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11045 value's type in the current language.
11046 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11047 pattern as a mixture of types.
11048 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11049 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11050 which is typically four bytes.
11051
11052 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11053 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11054 @end table
11055
11056 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11057 (@code{"}).
11058 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11059 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11060
11061 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11062 number of matches found.
11063
11064 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11065 @samp{$_}.
11066 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11067
11068 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11069
11070 @smallexample
11071 void
11072 hello ()
11073 @{
11074 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11075 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11076 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11077 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11078 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11079 @}
11080 @end smallexample
11081
11082 @noindent
11083 you get during debugging:
11084
11085 @smallexample
11086 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11087 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11088 1 pattern found
11089 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11090 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11091 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11092 2 patterns found
11093 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11094 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11095 1 pattern found
11096 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11097 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11098 1 pattern found
11099 (gdb) print $numfound
11100 $1 = 1
11101 (gdb) print $_
11102 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11103 @end smallexample
11104
11105 @node Optimized Code
11106 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11107 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11108 @cindex debugging optimized code
11109
11110 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11111 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11112 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11113 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11114 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11115 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11116 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11117
11118 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11119 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11120 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11121 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11122
11123 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11124 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11125 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11126 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11127 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11128 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11129
11130 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11131 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11132 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11133 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11134 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11135
11136 @menu
11137 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11138 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11139 @end menu
11140
11141 @node Inline Functions
11142 @section Inline Functions
11143 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11144
11145 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11146 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11147 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11148 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11149 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11150 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11151 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11152 @code{info frame} command.
11153
11154 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11155 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11156 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11157 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11158 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11159 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11160 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11161 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11162 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11163 local variables in the caller.
11164
11165 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11166 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11167 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11168 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11169 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11170 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11171 instructions are executed.
11172
11173 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11174 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11175 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11176 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11177
11178 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11179 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11180
11181 @itemize @bullet
11182 @item
11183 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11184 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11185 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11186 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11187 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11188 or inside the inlined function instead.
11189
11190 @item
11191 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11192 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11193 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11194 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11195
11196 @end itemize
11197
11198 @node Tail Call Frames
11199 @section Tail Call Frames
11200 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11201
11202 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11203 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11204 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11205 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11206 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11207
11208 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11209 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11210 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11211 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11212 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11213 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11214 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11215
11216 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11217 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11218 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11219 this information.
11220
11221 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11222 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11223
11224 @smallexample
11225 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11226 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11227 (gdb) info frame
11228 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11229 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11230 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11231 source language c++.
11232 Arglist at unknown address.
11233 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11234 @end smallexample
11235
11236 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11237 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11238 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11239 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11240 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11241 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11242
11243 @table @code
11244 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11245 @item set debug entry-values
11246 @kindex set debug entry-values
11247 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11248 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11249 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11250 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11251 result.
11252
11253 @item show debug entry-values
11254 @kindex show debug entry-values
11255 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11256 values at function entry and tail calls.
11257 @end table
11258
11259 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11260 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11261 reference by variable @code{x}):
11262
11263 @smallexample
11264 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11265 void (*x) (void) = c;
11266 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11267 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11268 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11269
11270 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11271 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11272 a () at t.c:3
11273 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11274 (gdb) bt
11275 #0 a () at t.c:3
11276 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11277 @end smallexample
11278
11279 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11280
11281 @smallexample
11282 int i;
11283 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11284 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11285 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11286 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11287 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11288 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11289 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11290 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11291
11292 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11293 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11294 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11295 (gdb) bt
11296 #0 f () at t.c:2
11297 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11298 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11299 @end smallexample
11300
11301 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11302 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11303
11304 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11305 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11306 @set ARROW @click{}
11307 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11308 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11309 @end ifset
11310 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11311 @set ARROW ->
11312 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11313 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11314 @end ifclear
11315
11316 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11317 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11318 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11319
11320 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11321 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11322 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11323 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11324 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11325 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11326
11327 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11328 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11329 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11330 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11331 omitted.
11332
11333 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11334 entry may fail:
11335
11336 @smallexample
11337 int v;
11338 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11339 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11340 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11341 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11342 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11343 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11344
11345 (gdb) bt
11346 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11347 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11348 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11349 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11350 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11351 @end smallexample
11352
11353 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11354 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11355 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11356 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11357 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11358
11359 @node Macros
11360 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11361
11362 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11363 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11364 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11365 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11366 where it was defined.
11367
11368 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11369 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11370 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11371 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11372
11373 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11374 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11375 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11376 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11377 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11378 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11379 see @ref{List}.
11380
11381 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11382 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11383 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11384
11385 @table @code
11386
11387 @kindex macro expand
11388 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11389 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11390 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11391 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11392 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11393 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11394 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11395 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11396 it can be any string of tokens.
11397
11398 @kindex macro exp1
11399 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11400 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11401 @cindex expand macro once
11402 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11403 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11404 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11405 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11406 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11407 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11408 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11409 can be any string of tokens.
11410
11411 @kindex info macro
11412 @cindex macro definition, showing
11413 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11414 @cindex macros, from debug info
11415 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11416 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11417 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11418 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11419 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11420 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11421
11422 @kindex info macros
11423 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11424 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11425 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11426 command-line where those definitions were established.
11427
11428 @kindex macro define
11429 @cindex user-defined macros
11430 @cindex defining macros interactively
11431 @cindex macros, user-defined
11432 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11433 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11434 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11435 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11436 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11437 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11438 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11439 @var{arglist}.
11440
11441 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11442 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11443 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11444 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11445 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11446
11447 @kindex macro undef
11448 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11449 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11450 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11451 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11452 in the program being debugged.
11453
11454 @kindex macro list
11455 @item macro list
11456 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11457 @end table
11458
11459 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11460 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11461 show our source files:
11462
11463 @smallexample
11464 $ cat sample.c
11465 #include <stdio.h>
11466 #include "sample.h"
11467
11468 #define M 42
11469 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11470
11471 main ()
11472 @{
11473 #define N 28
11474 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11475 #undef N
11476 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11477 #define N 1729
11478 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11479 @}
11480 $ cat sample.h
11481 #define Q <
11482 $
11483 @end smallexample
11484
11485 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11486 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11487 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11488 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11489 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11490 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11491 information.
11492
11493 @smallexample
11494 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11495 $
11496 @end smallexample
11497
11498 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11499
11500 @smallexample
11501 $ gdb -nw sample
11502 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11503 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11504 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11505 (@value{GDBP})
11506 @end smallexample
11507
11508 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11509 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11510 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11511
11512 @smallexample
11513 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11514 3
11515 4 #define M 42
11516 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11517 6
11518 7 main ()
11519 8 @{
11520 9 #define N 28
11521 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11522 11 #undef N
11523 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11524 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11525 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11526 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11527 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11528 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11529 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11530 #define Q <
11531 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11532 expands to: (42 + 1)
11533 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11534 expands to: once (M + 1)
11535 (@value{GDBP})
11536 @end smallexample
11537
11538 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11539 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11540 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11541 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11542
11543 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11544 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11545
11546 @smallexample
11547 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11548 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11549 (@value{GDBP}) run
11550 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11551
11552 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11553 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11554 (@value{GDBP})
11555 @end smallexample
11556
11557 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11558
11559 @smallexample
11560 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11561 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11562 #define N 28
11563 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11564 expands to: 28 < 42
11565 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11566 $1 = 1
11567 (@value{GDBP})
11568 @end smallexample
11569
11570 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11571 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11572 thereof) in force at each point:
11573
11574 @smallexample
11575 (@value{GDBP}) next
11576 Hello, world!
11577 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11578 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11579 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11580 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11581 (@value{GDBP}) next
11582 We're so creative.
11583 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11584 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11585 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11586 #define N 1729
11587 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11588 expands to: 1729 < 42
11589 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11590 $2 = 0
11591 (@value{GDBP})
11592 @end smallexample
11593
11594 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11595 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11596 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11597 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11598
11599 @smallexample
11600 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11601 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11602 -D__STDC__=1
11603 (@value{GDBP})
11604 @end smallexample
11605
11606
11607 @node Tracepoints
11608 @chapter Tracepoints
11609 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11610 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11611
11612 @cindex tracepoints
11613 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11614 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11615 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11616 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11617 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11618 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11619 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11620
11621 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11622 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11623 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11624 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11625 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11626 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11627 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11628 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11629 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11630 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11631 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11632
11633 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11634 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11635 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11636 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11637 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11638 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11639 Packets}.
11640
11641 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11642 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11643 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11644
11645 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11646
11647 @menu
11648 * Set Tracepoints::
11649 * Analyze Collected Data::
11650 * Tracepoint Variables::
11651 * Trace Files::
11652 @end menu
11653
11654 @node Set Tracepoints
11655 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11656
11657 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11658 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11659 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11660 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11661 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11662 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11663 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11664
11665 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11666 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11667 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11668 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11669 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11670 tracepoint was hit.
11671
11672 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11673 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11674 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11675 either.
11676
11677 @cindex fast tracepoints
11678 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11679 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11680 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11681
11682 @cindex static tracepoints
11683 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11684 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11685 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11686 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11687 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11688 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11689 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11690 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11691 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11692 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11693 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11694 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11695 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11696 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11697 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11698 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11699 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11700 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11701 static tracepoint marker.
11702
11703 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11704 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11705
11706 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11707 conditions and actions.
11708
11709 @menu
11710 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11711 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11712 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11713 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11714 * Trace State Variables::
11715 * Tracepoint Actions::
11716 * Listing Tracepoints::
11717 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11718 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11719 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11720 @end menu
11721
11722 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11723 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11724
11725 @table @code
11726 @cindex set tracepoint
11727 @kindex trace
11728 @item trace @var{location}
11729 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11730 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11731 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11732 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11733 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11734 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11735 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11736 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11737 in tracing}).
11738 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11739 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11740 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11741 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11742 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11743 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11744 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11745 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11746 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11747 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11748 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11749 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11750
11751 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11752
11753 @smallexample
11754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11755
11756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11757
11758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11759
11760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11761
11762 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11763 @end smallexample
11764
11765 @noindent
11766 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11767
11768 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11769 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11770 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11771 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11772 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11773 information on tracepoint conditions.
11774
11775 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11776 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11777 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11778 @kindex ftrace
11779 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11780 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11781 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11782 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11783 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11784 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11785 message.
11786
11787 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11788 @code{trace}.
11789
11790 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11791 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11792 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11793 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11794 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11795 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11796 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11797 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11798
11799 @example
11800 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11801 @end example
11802
11803 @noindent
11804 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11805 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11806
11807 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11808 @cindex set static tracepoint
11809 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11810 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11811 @kindex strace
11812 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11813 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11814 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11815 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11816 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11817
11818 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11819 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11820 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11821 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11822 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11823 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11824 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11825 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11826 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11827 tracing engine:
11828
11829 @smallexample
11830 main ()
11831 @{
11832 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11833 @}
11834 @end smallexample
11835
11836 @noindent
11837 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11838 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11839
11840 @smallexample
11841 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11842 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11843 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11844 Data: "str %s"
11845 [etc...]
11846 @end smallexample
11847
11848 @noindent
11849 so you may probe the marker above with:
11850
11851 @smallexample
11852 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11853 @end smallexample
11854
11855 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11856 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11857 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11858 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11859 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11860 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11861 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11862 the @samp{Data:} field.
11863
11864 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11865 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11866 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11867
11868 @vindex $tpnum
11869 @cindex last tracepoint number
11870 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11871 @cindex tracepoint number
11872 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11873 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11874
11875 @kindex delete tracepoint
11876 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11877 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11878 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11879 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11880 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11881
11882 Examples:
11883
11884 @smallexample
11885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
11886
11887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
11888 @end smallexample
11889
11890 @noindent
11891 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
11892 @end table
11893
11894 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11895 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
11896
11897 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
11898
11899 @table @code
11900 @kindex disable tracepoint
11901 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11902 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
11903 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
11904 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
11905 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
11906 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
11907 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
11908 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
11909 next trace experiment.
11910
11911 @kindex enable tracepoint
11912 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11913 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
11914 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
11915 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
11916 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
11917 next time a trace experiment is run.
11918 @end table
11919
11920 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
11921 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
11922
11923 @table @code
11924 @kindex passcount
11925 @cindex tracepoint pass count
11926 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
11927 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
11928 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
11929 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
11930 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
11931 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
11932 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
11933 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
11934 user.
11935
11936 Examples:
11937
11938 @smallexample
11939 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
11940 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
11941
11942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
11943 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
11944 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
11945 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
11946 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
11947 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
11948 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
11949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
11950 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
11951 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
11952 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
11953 @end smallexample
11954 @end table
11955
11956 @node Tracepoint Conditions
11957 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
11958 @cindex conditional tracepoints
11959 @cindex tracepoint conditions
11960
11961 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
11962 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
11963 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
11964 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
11965 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
11966 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
11967 is true.
11968
11969 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
11970 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
11971 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
11972 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
11973 just as with breakpoints.
11974
11975 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
11976 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
11977 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
11978 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
11979 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
11980 accesses, and so forth.
11981
11982 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
11983 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
11984 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
11985 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
11986 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
11987 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
11988 search through.
11989
11990 @smallexample
11991 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
11992 @end smallexample
11993
11994 @node Trace State Variables
11995 @subsection Trace State Variables
11996 @cindex trace state variables
11997
11998 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
11999 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12000 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12001 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12002 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12003 integers.
12004
12005 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12006 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12007 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12008 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12009
12010 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12011 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12012 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12013 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12014 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12015 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12016 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12017 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12018 variable with the same name.
12019
12020 @table @code
12021
12022 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12023 @kindex tvariable
12024 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12025 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12026 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12027 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12028 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12029 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12030 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12031 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12032 value. The default initial value is 0.
12033
12034 @item info tvariables
12035 @kindex info tvariables
12036 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12037 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12038 currently running.
12039
12040 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12041 @kindex delete tvariable
12042 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12043 are specified.
12044
12045 @end table
12046
12047 @node Tracepoint Actions
12048 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12049
12050 @table @code
12051 @kindex actions
12052 @cindex tracepoint actions
12053 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12054 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12055 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12056 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12057 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12058 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12059 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12060 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12061 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12062 @code{while-stepping}.
12063
12064 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12065 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12066 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12067
12068 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12069 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12070 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12071
12072 @smallexample
12073 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12074
12075 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12076
12077 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12078 @end smallexample
12079
12080 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12081 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12082 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12083 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12084 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12085 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12086 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12087 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12088
12089 @smallexample
12090 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12091 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12092 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12093 > collect bar,baz
12094 > collect $regs
12095 > while-stepping 12
12096 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12097 > end
12098 end
12099 @end smallexample
12100
12101 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12102 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12103 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12104 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12105 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12106 special arguments are supported:
12107
12108 @table @code
12109 @item $regs
12110 Collect all registers.
12111
12112 @item $args
12113 Collect all function arguments.
12114
12115 @item $locals
12116 Collect all local variables.
12117
12118 @item $_ret
12119 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12120 of a backtrace.
12121
12122 @item $_probe_argc
12123 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12124 tracepoint is located.
12125 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12126
12127 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12128 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12129 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12130 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12131
12132 @item $_sdata
12133 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12134 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12135 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12136 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12137 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12138 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12139 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12140 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12141 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12142
12143 @smallexample
12144 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12145 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12146 @end smallexample
12147
12148 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12149 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12150 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12151 @value{GDBN}.
12152 @end table
12153
12154 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12155 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12156 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12157
12158 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12159 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12160 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12161 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12162 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12163 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12164 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12165 @samp{mystr}.
12166
12167 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12168 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12169
12170 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12171 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12172 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12173 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12174 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12175 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12176 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12177 action were used.
12178
12179 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12180 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12181 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12182 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12183 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12184 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12185
12186 @smallexample
12187 > while-stepping 12
12188 > collect $regs, myglobal
12189 > end
12190 >
12191 @end smallexample
12192
12193 @noindent
12194 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12195 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12196 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12197 @code{stepping}.
12198
12199 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12200 @kindex set default-collect
12201 @cindex default collection action
12202 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12203 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12204 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12205 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12206 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12207 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12208
12209 @item show default-collect
12210 @kindex show default-collect
12211 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12212 tracepoint hit.
12213
12214 @end table
12215
12216 @node Listing Tracepoints
12217 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12218
12219 @table @code
12220 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12221 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12222 @cindex information about tracepoints
12223 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12224 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12225 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12226 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12227 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12228 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12229
12230 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12231 tracing:
12232
12233 @itemize @bullet
12234 @item
12235 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12236
12237 @item
12238 the state about installed on target of each location
12239 @end itemize
12240
12241 @smallexample
12242 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12243 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12244 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12245 while-stepping 20
12246 collect globfoo, $regs
12247 end
12248 collect globfoo2
12249 end
12250 pass count 1200
12251 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12252 collect $eip
12253 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12254 installed on target
12255 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12256 installed on target
12257 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12258 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12259 not installed on target
12260 (@value{GDBP})
12261 @end smallexample
12262
12263 @noindent
12264 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12265 @end table
12266
12267 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12268 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12269
12270 @table @code
12271 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12272 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12273 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12274 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12275 program.
12276
12277 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12278
12279 @table @emph
12280 @item Count
12281 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12282 stable identifier.
12283 @item ID
12284 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12285 @item Enabled or Disabled
12286 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12287 that are not enabled.
12288 @item Address
12289 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12290 @item What
12291 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12292 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12293 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12294 will be left blank.
12295 @end table
12296
12297 @noindent
12298 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12299
12300 @table @emph
12301 @item Data
12302 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12303 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12304 marker call.
12305 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12306 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12307 @end table
12308
12309 @smallexample
12310 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12311 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12312 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12313 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12314 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12315 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12316 Data: str %s
12317 (@value{GDBP})
12318 @end smallexample
12319 @end table
12320
12321 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12322 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12323
12324 @table @code
12325 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12326 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12327 @cindex collected data discarded
12328 @item tstart
12329 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12330 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12331 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12332 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12333 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12334 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12335 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12336 information, and so forth.
12337
12338 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12339 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12340 @item tstop
12341 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12342 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12343 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12344 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12345 needs to be stopped quickly.
12346
12347 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12348 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12349 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12350
12351 @kindex tstatus
12352 @cindex status of trace data collection
12353 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12354 @item tstatus
12355 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12356 collection.
12357 @end table
12358
12359 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12360
12361 @smallexample
12362 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12363 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12364 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12365 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12366 > while-stepping 11
12367 > collect $regs
12368 > end
12369 > end
12370 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12371 [time passes @dots{}]
12372 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12373 @end smallexample
12374
12375 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12376 @cindex disconnected tracing
12377 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12378 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12379 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12380 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12381 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12382 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12383 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12384 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12385
12386 @table @code
12387 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12388 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12389 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12390 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12391 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12392 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12393 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12394 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12395
12396 @item show disconnected-tracing
12397 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12398 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12399
12400 @end table
12401
12402 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12403 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12404 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12405 it will continue after reconnection.
12406
12407 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12408 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12409 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12410 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12411 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12412 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12413 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12414 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12415 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12416 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12417
12418 @cindex circular trace buffer
12419 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12420 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12421 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12422 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12423 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12424 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12425 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12426 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12427 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12428 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12429 the next run.
12430
12431 @table @code
12432 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12433 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12434 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12435 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12436 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12437 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12438 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12439
12440 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12441 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12442 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12443 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12444 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12445 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12446
12447 @end table
12448
12449 @table @code
12450 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12451 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12452 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12453 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12454 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12455 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12456 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12457 likes. This is also the default.
12458
12459 @item show trace-buffer-size
12460 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12461 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12462 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12463 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12464 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12465 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12466 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12467 @end table
12468
12469 @table @code
12470 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12471 @kindex set trace-user
12472
12473 @item show trace-user
12474 @kindex show trace-user
12475
12476 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12477 @kindex set trace-notes
12478 Set the trace run's notes.
12479
12480 @item show trace-notes
12481 @kindex show trace-notes
12482 Show the trace run's notes.
12483
12484 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12485 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12486 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12487 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12488 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12489
12490 @item show trace-stop-notes
12491 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12492 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12493
12494 @end table
12495
12496 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12497 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12498
12499 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12500 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12501 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12502 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12503 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12504 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12505 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12506 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12507 mentioned here.
12508
12509 @itemize @bullet
12510
12511 @item
12512 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12513 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12514 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12515 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12516 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12517 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12518 cannot be collected either.
12519
12520 @item
12521 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12522 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12523 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12524 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12525 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12526 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12527 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12528 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12529 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12530 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12531
12532 @item
12533 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12534 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12535 in a misleading way.
12536
12537 @item
12538 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12539 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12540 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12541 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12542 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12543 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12544 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12545 by @code{ptr}.
12546
12547 @item
12548 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12549 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12550 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12551 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12552 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12553 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12554 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12555 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12556 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12557 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12558 invalid address.
12559
12560 @item
12561 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12562 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12563 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12564 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12565 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12566 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12567 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12568 it to zero.
12569
12570 @end itemize
12571
12572 @node Analyze Collected Data
12573 @section Using the Collected Data
12574
12575 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12576 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12577 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12578 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12579 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12580 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12581 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12582 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12583 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12584 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12585 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12586 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12587 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12588 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12589 the buffer will fail.
12590
12591 @menu
12592 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12593 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12594 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12595 @end menu
12596
12597 @node tfind
12598 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12599
12600 @kindex tfind
12601 @cindex select trace snapshot
12602 @cindex find trace snapshot
12603 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12604 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12605 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12606 snapshot is selected.
12607
12608 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12609
12610 @table @code
12611 @item tfind start
12612 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12613 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12614
12615 @item tfind none
12616 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12617
12618 @item tfind end
12619 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12620
12621 @item tfind
12622 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12623
12624 @item tfind -
12625 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12626 retracing earlier steps.
12627
12628 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12629 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12630 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12631 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12632 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12633
12634 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12635 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12636 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12637 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12638 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12639
12640 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12641 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12642 addresses (exclusive).
12643
12644 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12645 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12646 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12647
12648 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12649 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12650 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12651 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12652 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12653 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12654 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12655 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12656 @end table
12657
12658 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12659 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12660 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12661 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12662 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12663 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12664 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12665 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12666 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12667 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12668 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12669 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12670 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12671 tracepoint as the current one.
12672
12673 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12674 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12675 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12676 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12677 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12678
12679 @smallexample
12680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12681 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12682 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12683 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12684 > tfind
12685 > end
12686
12687 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12688 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12689 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12690 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12691 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12692 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12693 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12694 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12695 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12696 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12697 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12698 @end smallexample
12699
12700 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12701 the buffer:
12702
12703 @smallexample
12704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12706 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12707 > tfind line
12708 > end
12709
12710 Frame 0, X = 1
12711 Frame 7, X = 2
12712 Frame 13, X = 255
12713 @end smallexample
12714
12715 @node tdump
12716 @subsection @code{tdump}
12717 @kindex tdump
12718 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12719 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12720
12721 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12722 the current trace snapshot.
12723
12724 @smallexample
12725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12727 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12728 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12729 > end
12730
12731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12732
12733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12734 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12735 at gdb_test.c:444
12736 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12737
12738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12739 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12740 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12741 d1 0x18 24
12742 d2 0x80 128
12743 d3 0x33 51
12744 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12745 d5 0x22 34
12746 d6 0xe0 224
12747 d7 0x380035 3670069
12748 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12749 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12750 a2 0x100 256
12751 a3 0x322000 3284992
12752 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12753 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12754 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12755 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12756 ps 0x0 0
12757 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12758 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12759 fpstatus 0x0 0
12760 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12761 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12762 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12763 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12764 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12765 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12766 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12767 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12768 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12769
12770 (@value{GDBP})
12771 @end smallexample
12772
12773 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12774 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12775 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12776 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12777
12778 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12779 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12780 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12781 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12782 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12783 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12784 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12785 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12786 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12787 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12788
12789 @node save tracepoints
12790 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12791 @kindex save tracepoints
12792 @kindex save-tracepoints
12793 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12794
12795 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12796 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12797 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12798 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12799 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12800 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12801
12802 @node Tracepoint Variables
12803 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12804 @cindex tracepoint variables
12805 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12806
12807 @table @code
12808 @vindex $trace_frame
12809 @item (int) $trace_frame
12810 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12811 snapshot is selected.
12812
12813 @vindex $tracepoint
12814 @item (int) $tracepoint
12815 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12816
12817 @vindex $trace_line
12818 @item (int) $trace_line
12819 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12820
12821 @vindex $trace_file
12822 @item (char []) $trace_file
12823 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12824
12825 @vindex $trace_func
12826 @item (char []) $trace_func
12827 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12828 @end table
12829
12830 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12831 use @code{output} instead.
12832
12833 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12834 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12835 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12836 which are managed by the target.
12837
12838 @smallexample
12839 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12840
12841 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12842 > output $trace_file
12843 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12844 > tfind
12845 > end
12846 @end smallexample
12847
12848 @node Trace Files
12849 @section Using Trace Files
12850 @cindex trace files
12851
12852 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12853 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12854 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12855 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12856 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12857
12858 @table @code
12859
12860 @kindex tsave
12861 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12862 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12863 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12864 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12865 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12866 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12867 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12868 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12869 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12870 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12871 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12872 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12873 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12874 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12875 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12876
12877 @kindex target tfile
12878 @kindex tfile
12879 @kindex target ctf
12880 @kindex ctf
12881 @item target tfile @var{filename}
12882 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
12883 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
12884 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
12885 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
12886 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
12887 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
12888 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
12889 the host.
12890
12891 @smallexample
12892 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
12893 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
12894 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
12895 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
12896 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
12897 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
12898 i = 0
12899 a = 0
12900 b = 1 '\001'
12901 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
12902 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
12903 (@value{GDBP}) p b
12904 $1 = 1
12905 @end smallexample
12906
12907 @end table
12908
12909 @node Overlays
12910 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
12911 @cindex overlays
12912
12913 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
12914 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
12915 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
12916 use overlays.
12917
12918 @menu
12919 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
12920 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
12921 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
12922 mapped by asking the inferior.
12923 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
12924 @end menu
12925
12926 @node How Overlays Work
12927 @section How Overlays Work
12928 @cindex mapped overlays
12929 @cindex unmapped overlays
12930 @cindex load address, overlay's
12931 @cindex mapped address
12932 @cindex overlay area
12933
12934 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
12935 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
12936 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
12937 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
12938 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
12939
12940 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
12941 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
12942 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
12943 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
12944 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
12945 largest overlay as well.
12946
12947 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
12948 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
12949 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
12950 there.
12951
12952 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
12953 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
12954 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
12955
12956 @smallexample
12957 @group
12958 Data Instruction Larger
12959 Address Space Address Space Address Space
12960 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
12961 | | | | | |
12962 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
12963 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
12964 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
12965 | and heap | | | | | |
12966 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
12967 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
12968 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
12969 | | | | | |
12970 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
12971 address | | | | | |
12972 | overlay | <-' | | |
12973 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
12974 | | <---. | | load address
12975 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
12976 | | | |
12977 +-----------+ | |
12978 +-----------+
12979 | |
12980 +-----------+
12981
12982 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
12983 @end group
12984 @end smallexample
12985
12986 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
12987 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
12988 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
12989 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
12990 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
12991 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
12992 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
12993 program and the overlay area.
12994
12995 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
12996 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
12997 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
12998 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
12999 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13000 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13001 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13002
13003 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13004 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13005 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13006
13007 @itemize @bullet
13008
13009 @item
13010 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13011 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13012 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13013 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13014
13015 @item
13016 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13017 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13018 your program's performance.
13019
13020 @item
13021 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13022 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13023 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13024 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13025 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13026 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13027 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13028
13029 @item
13030 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13031 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13032 instruction and data spaces.
13033
13034 @end itemize
13035
13036 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13037 improved in many ways:
13038
13039 @itemize @bullet
13040
13041 @item
13042 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13043 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13044 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13045 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13046 area in the usual way.
13047
13048 @item
13049 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13050 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13051
13052 @item
13053 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13054 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13055 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13056 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13057 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13058 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13059 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13060
13061 @end itemize
13062
13063
13064 @node Overlay Commands
13065 @section Overlay Commands
13066
13067 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13068 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13069 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13070 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13071 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13072 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13073
13074 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13075 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13076
13077 @table @code
13078 @item overlay off
13079 @kindex overlay
13080 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13081 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13082 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13083 overlay support is disabled.
13084
13085 @item overlay manual
13086 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13087 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13088 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13089 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13090 commands described below.
13091
13092 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13093 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13094 @cindex map an overlay
13095 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13096 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13097 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13098 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13099 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13100 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13101
13102 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13103 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13104 @cindex unmap an overlay
13105 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13106 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13107 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13108 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13109
13110 @item overlay auto
13111 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13112 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13113 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13114 Overlay Debugging}.
13115
13116 @item overlay load-target
13117 @itemx overlay load
13118 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13119 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13120 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13121 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13122 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13123 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13124
13125 @item overlay list-overlays
13126 @itemx overlay list
13127 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13128 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13129 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13130
13131 @end table
13132
13133 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13134 of the function the address falls in:
13135
13136 @smallexample
13137 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13138 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13139 @end smallexample
13140 @noindent
13141 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13142 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13143 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13144 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13145
13146 @smallexample
13147 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13148 No sections are mapped.
13149 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13150 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13151 @end smallexample
13152 @noindent
13153 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13154 name normally:
13155
13156 @smallexample
13157 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13158 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13159 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13160 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13161 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13162 @end smallexample
13163
13164 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13165 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13166 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13167 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13168 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13169
13170 @itemize @bullet
13171 @item
13172 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13173 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13174 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13175 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13176 @item
13177 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13178 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13179 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13180 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13181 breakpoints properly.
13182 @end itemize
13183
13184
13185 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13186 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13187 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13188
13189 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13190 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13191 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13192 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13193 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13194 current state of the overlays.
13195
13196 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13197 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13198
13199 @table @asis
13200
13201 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13202 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13203
13204 @smallexample
13205 struct
13206 @{
13207 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13208 unsigned long vma;
13209
13210 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13211 unsigned long size;
13212
13213 /* The overlay's load address. */
13214 unsigned long lma;
13215
13216 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13217 zero otherwise. */
13218 unsigned long mapped;
13219 @}
13220 @end smallexample
13221
13222 @item @code{_novlys}:
13223 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13224 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13225
13226 @end table
13227
13228 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13229 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13230 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13231 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13232 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13233 currently mapped.
13234
13235 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13236 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13237 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13238 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13239 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13240 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13241 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13242 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13243 are not being executed.
13244
13245 @node Overlay Sample Program
13246 @section Overlay Sample Program
13247 @cindex overlay example program
13248
13249 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13250 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13251 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13252 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13253 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13254 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13255 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13256
13257 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13258 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13259 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13260 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13261
13262 @table @file
13263 @item overlays.c
13264 The main program file.
13265 @item ovlymgr.c
13266 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13267 @item foo.c
13268 @itemx bar.c
13269 @itemx baz.c
13270 @itemx grbx.c
13271 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13272 @item d10v.ld
13273 @itemx m32r.ld
13274 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13275 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13276 @end table
13277
13278 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13279 cross-compiler like this:
13280
13281 @smallexample
13282 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13283 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13284 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13285 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13286 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13287 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13288 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13289 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13290 @end smallexample
13291
13292 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13293 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13294 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13295
13296
13297 @node Languages
13298 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13299 @cindex languages
13300
13301 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13302 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13303 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13304 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13305 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13306 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13307
13308 @cindex working language
13309 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13310 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13311 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13312 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13313 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13314 language}.
13315
13316 @menu
13317 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13318 * Show:: Displaying the language
13319 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13320 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13321 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13322 @end menu
13323
13324 @node Setting
13325 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13326
13327 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13328 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13329 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13330 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13331 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13332 are printed, etc.
13333
13334 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13335 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13336 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13337 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13338 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13339 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13340 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13341 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13342 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13343 Displaying the Language}.
13344
13345 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13346 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13347 another language. In that case, make the
13348 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13349 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13350 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13351
13352 @menu
13353 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13354 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13355 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13356 @end menu
13357
13358 @node Filenames
13359 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13360
13361 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13362 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13363
13364 @table @file
13365 @item .ada
13366 @itemx .ads
13367 @itemx .adb
13368 @itemx .a
13369 Ada source file.
13370
13371 @item .c
13372 C source file
13373
13374 @item .C
13375 @itemx .cc
13376 @itemx .cp
13377 @itemx .cpp
13378 @itemx .cxx
13379 @itemx .c++
13380 C@t{++} source file
13381
13382 @item .d
13383 D source file
13384
13385 @item .m
13386 Objective-C source file
13387
13388 @item .f
13389 @itemx .F
13390 Fortran source file
13391
13392 @item .mod
13393 Modula-2 source file
13394
13395 @item .s
13396 @itemx .S
13397 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13398 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13399 @end table
13400
13401 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13402 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13403
13404 @node Manually
13405 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13406
13407 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13408 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13409 your program.
13410
13411 @kindex set language
13412 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13413 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13414 a language, such as
13415 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13416 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13417
13418 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13419 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13420 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13421 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13422 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13423 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13424 command such as:
13425
13426 @smallexample
13427 print a = b + c
13428 @end smallexample
13429
13430 @noindent
13431 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13432 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13433 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13434 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13435
13436 @node Automatically
13437 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13438
13439 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13440 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13441 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13442 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13443 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13444 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13445 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13446 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13447 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13448
13449 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13450 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13451 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13452 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13453 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13454
13455 @node Show
13456 @section Displaying the Language
13457
13458 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13459 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13460
13461 @table @code
13462 @item show language
13463 @anchor{show language}
13464 @kindex show language
13465 Display the current working language. This is the
13466 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13467 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13468
13469 @item info frame
13470 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13471 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13472 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13473 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13474 information listed here.
13475
13476 @item info source
13477 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13478 Display the source language of this source file.
13479 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13480 information listed here.
13481 @end table
13482
13483 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13484 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13485 with a language explicitly:
13486
13487 @table @code
13488 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13489 @kindex set extension-language
13490 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13491 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13492
13493 @item info extensions
13494 @kindex info extensions
13495 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13496 @end table
13497
13498 @node Checks
13499 @section Type and Range Checking
13500
13501 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13502 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13503 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13504 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13505 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13506 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13507 errors when your program is running.
13508
13509 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13510 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13511 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13512 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13513
13514 @menu
13515 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13516 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13517 @end menu
13518
13519 @cindex type checking
13520 @cindex checks, type
13521 @node Type Checking
13522 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13523
13524 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13525 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13526 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13527 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13528
13529 @smallexample
13530 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13531
13532 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13533 $1 = 2
13534 @exdent but
13535 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13536 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13537 @end smallexample
13538
13539 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13540 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13541
13542 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13543 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13544 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13545 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13546 expressions like the second example above.
13547
13548 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13549 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13550 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13551 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13552 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13553 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13554
13555 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13556
13557 @kindex set check type
13558 @kindex show check type
13559 @table @code
13560 @item set check type on
13561 @itemx set check type off
13562 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13563 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13564 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13565
13566 @item show check type
13567 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13568 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13569 @end table
13570
13571 @cindex range checking
13572 @cindex checks, range
13573 @node Range Checking
13574 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13575
13576 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13577 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13578 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13579 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13580 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13581
13582 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13583 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13584 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13585 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13586
13587 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13588 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13589 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13590 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13591 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13592 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13593
13594 @smallexample
13595 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13596 @end smallexample
13597
13598 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13599 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13600 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13601
13602 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13603
13604 @kindex set check range
13605 @kindex show check range
13606 @table @code
13607 @item set check range auto
13608 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13609 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13610 each language.
13611
13612 @item set check range on
13613 @itemx set check range off
13614 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13615 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13616 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13617 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13618
13619 @item set check range warn
13620 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13621 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13622 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13623 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13624 systems).
13625
13626 @item show range
13627 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13628 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13629 @end table
13630
13631 @node Supported Languages
13632 @section Supported Languages
13633
13634 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13635 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13636 @c This is false ...
13637 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13638 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13639 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13640 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13641 language.
13642
13643 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13644 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13645 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13646 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13647 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13648 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13649 language reference or tutorial.
13650
13651 @menu
13652 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13653 * D:: D
13654 * Go:: Go
13655 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13656 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13657 * Fortran:: Fortran
13658 * Pascal:: Pascal
13659 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13660 * Ada:: Ada
13661 @end menu
13662
13663 @node C
13664 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13665
13666 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13667 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13668
13669 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13670 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13671 together.
13672
13673 @cindex C@t{++}
13674 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13675 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13676 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13677 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13678 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13679 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13680 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13681
13682 @menu
13683 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13684 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13685 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13686 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13687 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13688 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13689 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13690 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13691 @end menu
13692
13693 @node C Operators
13694 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13695
13696 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13697
13698 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13699 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13700 often defined on groups of types.
13701
13702 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13703
13704 @itemize @bullet
13705
13706 @item
13707 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13708 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13709
13710 @item
13711 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13712 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13713
13714 @item
13715 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13716
13717 @item
13718 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13719
13720 @end itemize
13721
13722 @noindent
13723 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13724 in order of increasing precedence:
13725
13726 @table @code
13727 @item ,
13728 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13729 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13730 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13731
13732 @item =
13733 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13734 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13735
13736 @item @var{op}=
13737 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13738 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13739 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13740 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13741 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13742
13743 @item ?:
13744 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13745 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13746 should be of an integral type.
13747
13748 @item ||
13749 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13750
13751 @item &&
13752 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13753
13754 @item |
13755 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13756
13757 @item ^
13758 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13759
13760 @item &
13761 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13762
13763 @item ==@r{, }!=
13764 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13765 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13766
13767 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13768 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13769 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13770 and non-zero for true.
13771
13772 @item <<@r{, }>>
13773 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13774
13775 @item @@
13776 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13777
13778 @item +@r{, }-
13779 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13780 pointer types.
13781
13782 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13783 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13784 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13785 integral types.
13786
13787 @item ++@r{, }--
13788 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13789 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13790 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13791 operation takes place.
13792
13793 @item *
13794 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13795 @code{++}.
13796
13797 @item &
13798 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13799
13800 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13801 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13802 to examine the address
13803 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13804 stored.
13805
13806 @item -
13807 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13808 precedence as @code{++}.
13809
13810 @item !
13811 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13812 @code{++}.
13813
13814 @item ~
13815 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13816 @code{++}.
13817
13818
13819 @item .@r{, }->
13820 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13821 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13822 pointer based on the stored type information.
13823 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13824
13825 @item .*@r{, }->*
13826 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13827
13828 @item []
13829 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13830 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13831
13832 @item ()
13833 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13834
13835 @item ::
13836 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13837 and @code{class} types.
13838
13839 @item ::
13840 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13841 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13842 above.
13843 @end table
13844
13845 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13846 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13847 predefined meaning.
13848
13849 @node C Constants
13850 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13851
13852 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13853
13854 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13855 following ways:
13856
13857 @itemize @bullet
13858 @item
13859 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13860 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13861 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13862 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13863 @code{long} value.
13864
13865 @item
13866 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13867 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13868 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13869 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13870 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13871 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13872 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13873 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13874 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13875 constant.
13876
13877 @item
13878 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13879 integral equivalents.
13880
13881 @item
13882 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
13883 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
13884 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
13885 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
13886 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
13887 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
13888 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
13889 @samp{\n} for newline.
13890
13891 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
13892 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
13893 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
13894 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13895
13896 @item
13897 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
13898 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
13899 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
13900 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
13901 characters.
13902
13903 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
13904 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
13905 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
13906
13907 @item
13908 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
13909 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
13910
13911 @item
13912 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
13913 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
13914 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
13915 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
13916 @end itemize
13917
13918 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
13919 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
13920
13921 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
13922 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
13923
13924 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
13925 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
13926 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
13927 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
13928 @quotation
13929 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
13930 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
13931 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
13932 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
13933 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
13934 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
13935 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
13936 code. @xref{Compilation}.
13937 @end quotation
13938
13939 @enumerate
13940
13941 @cindex member functions
13942 @item
13943 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
13944
13945 @smallexample
13946 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
13947 @end smallexample
13948
13949 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
13950 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
13951 @item
13952 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
13953 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
13954 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
13955 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
13956 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
13957
13958 @cindex call overloaded functions
13959 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
13960 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
13961 @item
13962 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
13963 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
13964 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
13965 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
13966 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
13967 default arguments.
13968
13969 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
13970 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
13971 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
13972 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
13973 number of function arguments.
13974
13975 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
13976 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
13977 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
13978
13979 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
13980 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
13981 @smallexample
13982 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
13983 @end smallexample
13984
13985 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
13986 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
13987
13988 @cindex reference declarations
13989 @item
13990 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
13991 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
13992 dereferenced.
13993
13994 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
13995 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
13996 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
13997 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
13998 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
13999
14000 @item
14001 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14002 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14003 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14004 necessary, for example in an expression like
14005 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14006 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14007 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14008
14009 @item
14010 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14011 specification.
14012 @end enumerate
14013
14014 @node C Defaults
14015 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14016
14017 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14018
14019 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14020 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14021 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14022 selects the working language.
14023
14024 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14025 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14026 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14027 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14028 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14029 for further details.
14030
14031 @node C Checks
14032 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14033
14034 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14035
14036 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14037 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14038 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14039 constants to pointers.
14040
14041 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14042 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14043 that is not itself an array.
14044
14045 @node Debugging C
14046 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14047
14048 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14049 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14050 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14051 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14052
14053 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14054 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14055 ,Expressions}.
14056
14057 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14058 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14059
14060 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14061
14062 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14063 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14064
14065 @table @code
14066 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14067 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14068 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14069 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14070 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14071 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14072
14073 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14074 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14075 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14076 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14077 classes.
14078 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14079
14080 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14081 @item catch throw
14082 @itemx catch rethrow
14083 @itemx catch catch
14084 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14085 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14086
14087 @cindex inheritance
14088 @item ptype @var{typename}
14089 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14090 @var{typename}.
14091 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14092
14093 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14094 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14095 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14096 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14097 multiple inheritance is in use.
14098
14099 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14100 @item set print demangle
14101 @itemx show print demangle
14102 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14103 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14104 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14105 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14106 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14107
14108 @item set print object
14109 @itemx show print object
14110 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14111 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14112
14113 @item set print vtbl
14114 @itemx show print vtbl
14115 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14116 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14117 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14118 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14119
14120 @kindex set overload-resolution
14121 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14122 @item set overload-resolution on
14123 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14124 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14125 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14126 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14127 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14128 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14129
14130 @item set overload-resolution off
14131 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14132 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14133 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14134 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14135 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14136 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14137 argument types.
14138
14139 @kindex show overload-resolution
14140 @item show overload-resolution
14141 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14142
14143 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14144 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14145 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14146 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14147 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14148 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14149 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14150 @end table
14151
14152 @node Decimal Floating Point
14153 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14154 @cindex decimal floating point format
14155
14156 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14157 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14158 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14159 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14160
14161 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14162 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14163 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14164 configured target.
14165
14166 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14167 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14168 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14169
14170 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14171 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14172 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14173
14174 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14175 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14176 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14177
14178 @node D
14179 @subsection D
14180
14181 @cindex D
14182 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14183 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14184 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14185
14186 @node Go
14187 @subsection Go
14188
14189 @cindex Go (programming language)
14190 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14191 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14192
14193 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14194
14195 @table @code
14196 @cindex current Go package
14197 @item The current Go package
14198 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14199 specifying global variables and functions.
14200
14201 For example, given the program:
14202
14203 @example
14204 package main
14205 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14206 func main () @{
14207 // ...
14208 @}
14209 @end example
14210
14211 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14212
14213 @example
14214 (gdb) p myglob
14215 (gdb) p main.myglob
14216 @end example
14217
14218 @cindex builtin Go types
14219 @item Builtin Go types
14220 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14221 as a string.
14222
14223 @cindex builtin Go functions
14224 @item Builtin Go functions
14225 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14226 function and handles it internally.
14227
14228 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14229 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14230 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14231 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14232 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14233 @end table
14234
14235 @node Objective-C
14236 @subsection Objective-C
14237
14238 @cindex Objective-C
14239 This section provides information about some commands and command
14240 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14241 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14242 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14243
14244 @menu
14245 * Method Names in Commands::
14246 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14247 @end menu
14248
14249 @node Method Names in Commands
14250 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14251
14252 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14253 names as line specifications:
14254
14255 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14256 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14257 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14258 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14259 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14260 @itemize
14261 @item @code{clear}
14262 @item @code{break}
14263 @item @code{info line}
14264 @item @code{jump}
14265 @item @code{list}
14266 @end itemize
14267
14268 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14269
14270 @smallexample
14271 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14272 @end smallexample
14273
14274 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14275 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14276 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14277 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14278 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14279 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14280 debugged, enter:
14281
14282 @smallexample
14283 break -[Fruit create]
14284 @end smallexample
14285
14286 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14287 enter:
14288
14289 @smallexample
14290 list +[NSText initialize]
14291 @end smallexample
14292
14293 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14294 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14295 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14296 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14297
14298 @smallexample
14299 break create
14300 @end smallexample
14301
14302 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14303 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14304 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14305 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14306 none apply.
14307
14308 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14309 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14310
14311 @smallexample
14312 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14313 @end smallexample
14314
14315 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14316 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14317 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14318 @kindex print-object
14319 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14320
14321 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14322
14323 @smallexample
14324 print -[@var{object} hash]
14325 @end smallexample
14326
14327 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14328 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14329 @noindent
14330 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14331 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14332 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14333 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14334 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14335 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14336
14337 @node OpenCL C
14338 @subsection OpenCL C
14339
14340 @cindex OpenCL C
14341 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14342
14343 @menu
14344 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14345 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14346 * OpenCL C Operators::
14347 @end menu
14348
14349 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14350 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14351
14352 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14353 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14354 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14355 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14356 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14357
14358 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14359 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14360
14361 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14362 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14363 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14364 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14365
14366 @node OpenCL C Operators
14367 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14368
14369 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14370 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14371 vector data types.
14372
14373 @node Fortran
14374 @subsection Fortran
14375 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14376
14377 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14378 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14379
14380 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14381 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14382 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14383 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14384 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14385 underscore.
14386
14387 @menu
14388 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14389 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14390 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14391 @end menu
14392
14393 @node Fortran Operators
14394 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14395
14396 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14397
14398 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14399 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14400 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14401
14402 @table @code
14403 @item **
14404 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14405 of the second one.
14406
14407 @item :
14408 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14409 represent a section of array.
14410
14411 @item %
14412 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14413 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14414 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14415 union type.
14416 @end table
14417
14418 @node Fortran Defaults
14419 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14420
14421 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14422
14423 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14424 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14425 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14426 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14427
14428 @node Special Fortran Commands
14429 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14430
14431 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14432
14433 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14434 such as displaying common blocks.
14435
14436 @table @code
14437 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14438 @kindex info common
14439 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14440 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14441 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14442 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14443 printed.
14444 @end table
14445
14446 @node Pascal
14447 @subsection Pascal
14448
14449 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14450 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14451 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14452 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14453 syntax.
14454
14455 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14456 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14457 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14458
14459 @node Modula-2
14460 @subsection Modula-2
14461
14462 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14463
14464 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14465 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14466 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14467 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14468 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14469 table.
14470
14471 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14472 @menu
14473 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14474 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14475 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14476 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14477 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14478 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14479 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14480 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14481 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14482 @end menu
14483
14484 @node M2 Operators
14485 @subsubsection Operators
14486 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14487
14488 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14489 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14490 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14491 following definitions hold:
14492
14493 @itemize @bullet
14494
14495 @item
14496 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14497 their subranges.
14498
14499 @item
14500 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14501
14502 @item
14503 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14504
14505 @item
14506 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14507 @var{type}}.
14508
14509 @item
14510 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14511
14512 @item
14513 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14514
14515 @item
14516 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14517 @end itemize
14518
14519 @noindent
14520 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14521 increasing precedence:
14522
14523 @table @code
14524 @item ,
14525 Function argument or array index separator.
14526
14527 @item :=
14528 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14529 @var{value}.
14530
14531 @item <@r{, }>
14532 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14533 types.
14534
14535 @item <=@r{, }>=
14536 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14537 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14538 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14539
14540 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14541 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14542 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14543 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14544 comment character.
14545
14546 @item IN
14547 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14548 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14549
14550 @item OR
14551 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14552
14553 @item AND@r{, }&
14554 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14555
14556 @item @@
14557 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14558
14559 @item +@r{, }-
14560 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14561 and difference on set types.
14562
14563 @item *
14564 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14565 on set types.
14566
14567 @item /
14568 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14569 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14570
14571 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14572 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14573 precedence as @code{*}.
14574
14575 @item -
14576 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14577
14578 @item ^
14579 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14580
14581 @item NOT
14582 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14583 @code{^}.
14584
14585 @item .
14586 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14587 precedence as @code{^}.
14588
14589 @item []
14590 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14591
14592 @item ()
14593 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14594 as @code{^}.
14595
14596 @item ::@r{, }.
14597 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14598 @end table
14599
14600 @quotation
14601 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14602 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14603 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14604 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14605 @end quotation
14606
14607
14608 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14609 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14610 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14611
14612 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14613 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14614
14615 @table @var
14616
14617 @item a
14618 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14619
14620 @item c
14621 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14622
14623 @item i
14624 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14625
14626 @item m
14627 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14628 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14629 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14630
14631 @item n
14632 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14633
14634 @item r
14635 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14636
14637 @item t
14638 represents a type.
14639
14640 @item v
14641 represents a variable.
14642
14643 @item x
14644 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14645 explanation of the function for details.
14646 @end table
14647
14648 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14649
14650 @table @code
14651 @item ABS(@var{n})
14652 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14653
14654 @item CAP(@var{c})
14655 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14656 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14657
14658 @item CHR(@var{i})
14659 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14660
14661 @item DEC(@var{v})
14662 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14663
14664 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14665 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14666 new value.
14667
14668 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14669 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14670 set.
14671
14672 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14673 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14674
14675 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14676 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14677
14678 @item INC(@var{v})
14679 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14680
14681 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14682 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14683 new value.
14684
14685 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14686 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14687 there. Returns the new set.
14688
14689 @item MAX(@var{t})
14690 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14691
14692 @item MIN(@var{t})
14693 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14694
14695 @item ODD(@var{i})
14696 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14697
14698 @item ORD(@var{x})
14699 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14700 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14701 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14702 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14703
14704 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14705 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14706 variable or a type.
14707
14708 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14709 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14710
14711 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14712 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14713 variable or a type.
14714
14715 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14716 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14717 @end table
14718
14719 @quotation
14720 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14721 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14722 an error.
14723 @end quotation
14724
14725 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14726 @node M2 Constants
14727 @subsubsection Constants
14728
14729 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14730 ways:
14731
14732 @itemize @bullet
14733
14734 @item
14735 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14736 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14737 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14738 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14739
14740 @item
14741 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14742 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14743 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14744 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14745 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14746 digits.
14747
14748 @item
14749 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14750 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14751 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14752 followed by a @samp{C}.
14753
14754 @item
14755 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14756 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14757 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14758 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14759 sequences.
14760
14761 @item
14762 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14763
14764 @item
14765 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14766 @code{FALSE}.
14767
14768 @item
14769 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14770
14771 @item
14772 Set constants are not yet supported.
14773 @end itemize
14774
14775 @node M2 Types
14776 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14777 @cindex Modula-2 types
14778
14779 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14780 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14781 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14782 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14783 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14784 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14785
14786 The first example contains the following section of code:
14787
14788 @smallexample
14789 VAR
14790 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14791 r: [20..40] ;
14792 @end smallexample
14793
14794 @noindent
14795 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14796 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14797
14798 @smallexample
14799 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14800 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14801 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14802 SET OF CHAR
14803 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14804 21
14805 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14806 [20..40]
14807 @end smallexample
14808
14809 @noindent
14810 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14811
14812 @smallexample
14813 VAR
14814 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14815 @end smallexample
14816
14817 @noindent
14818 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14819
14820 @smallexample
14821 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14822 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14823 @end smallexample
14824
14825 @noindent
14826 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14827 expressions using the debugger.
14828
14829 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14830 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14831
14832 @smallexample
14833 VAR
14834 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14835 @end smallexample
14836
14837 @smallexample
14838 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14839 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14840 @end smallexample
14841
14842 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14843 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14844 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14845 above.
14846
14847 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 TYPE
14851 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14852 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14853 VAR
14854 s: t ;
14855 BEGIN
14856 s := blue ;
14857 @end smallexample
14858
14859 @noindent
14860 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14861 and value of a variable.
14862
14863 @smallexample
14864 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14865 $1 = blue
14866 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14867 type = [blue..yellow]
14868 @end smallexample
14869
14870 @noindent
14871 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14872 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14873 their @code{C} counterparts.
14874
14875 @smallexample
14876 VAR
14877 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14878 BEGIN
14879 s[1] := 1 ;
14880 @end smallexample
14881
14882 @smallexample
14883 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14884 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
14885 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14886 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14887 @end smallexample
14888
14889 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
14890 pointer types as shown in this example:
14891
14892 @smallexample
14893 VAR
14894 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14895 BEGIN
14896 NEW(s) ;
14897 s^[1] := 1 ;
14898 @end smallexample
14899
14900 @noindent
14901 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
14902
14903 @smallexample
14904 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14905 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
14906 @end smallexample
14907
14908 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
14909 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
14910 types:
14911
14912 @smallexample
14913 TYPE
14914 foo = RECORD
14915 f1: CARDINAL ;
14916 f2: CHAR ;
14917 f3: myarray ;
14918 END ;
14919
14920 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
14921 myrange = [-2..2] ;
14922 VAR
14923 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
14924 @end smallexample
14925
14926 @noindent
14927 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
14928 below.
14929
14930 @smallexample
14931 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14932 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
14933 f1 : CARDINAL;
14934 f2 : CHAR;
14935 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
14936 END
14937 @end smallexample
14938
14939 @node M2 Defaults
14940 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
14941 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
14942
14943 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
14944 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
14945 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14946 selected the working language.
14947
14948 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
14949 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
14950 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
14951 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
14952
14953 @node Deviations
14954 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
14955 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
14956
14957 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
14958 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
14959
14960 @itemize @bullet
14961 @item
14962 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
14963 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
14964 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
14965 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
14966 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
14967 returned a pointer.)
14968
14969 @item
14970 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
14971 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
14972 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
14973 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
14974
14975 @item
14976 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
14977 argument.
14978
14979 @item
14980 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
14981 @end itemize
14982
14983 @node M2 Checks
14984 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
14985 @cindex Modula-2 checks
14986
14987 @quotation
14988 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
14989 range checking.
14990 @end quotation
14991 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
14992
14993 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
14994
14995 @itemize @bullet
14996 @item
14997 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
14998 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
14999
15000 @item
15001 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15002 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15003 @end itemize
15004
15005 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15006 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15007
15008 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15009 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15010
15011 @node M2 Scope
15012 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15013 @cindex scope
15014 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15015 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15016 @ifinfo
15017 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15018 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15019 @end ifinfo
15020 @ifnotinfo
15021 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15022 @end ifnotinfo
15023
15024 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15025 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15026 similar syntax:
15027
15028 @smallexample
15029
15030 @var{module} . @var{id}
15031 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15032 @end smallexample
15033
15034 @noindent
15035 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15036 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15037 identifier within your program, except another module.
15038
15039 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15040 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15041 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15042 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15043
15044 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15045 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15046 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15047 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15048 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15049 @var{module}.
15050
15051 @node GDB/M2
15052 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15053
15054 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15055 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15056 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15057 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15058 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15059 analogue in Modula-2.
15060
15061 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15062 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15063 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15064 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15065 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15066 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15067
15068 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15069 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15070 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15071
15072 @node Ada
15073 @subsection Ada
15074 @cindex Ada
15075
15076 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15077 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15078 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15079 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15080 to be difficult.
15081
15082
15083 @cindex expressions in Ada
15084 @menu
15085 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15086 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15087 in @value{GDBN}.
15088 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15089 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15090 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15091 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15092 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15093 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15094 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15095 Profile
15096 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15097 @end menu
15098
15099 @node Ada Mode Intro
15100 @subsubsection Introduction
15101 @cindex Ada mode, general
15102
15103 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15104 syntax, with some extensions.
15105 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15106
15107 @itemize @bullet
15108 @item
15109 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15110 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15111 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15112 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15113
15114 @item
15115 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15116 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15117
15118 @item
15119 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15120 @end itemize
15121
15122 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15123 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15124 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15125 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15126 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15127
15128 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15129 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15130 was translated from an Ada source file.
15131
15132 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15133 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15134 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15135 middle (to allow based literals).
15136
15137 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15138 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15139 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15140 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15141 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15142 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15143
15144 @node Omissions from Ada
15145 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15146 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15147
15148 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15149
15150 @itemize @bullet
15151 @item
15152 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15153
15154 @itemize @minus
15155 @item
15156 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15157 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15158
15159 @item
15160 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15161
15162 @item
15163 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15164
15165 @item
15166 @t{'Tag}.
15167
15168 @item
15169 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15170 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15171
15172 @item
15173 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15174 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15175
15176 @item
15177 @t{'Address}.
15178 @end itemize
15179
15180 @item
15181 The names in
15182 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15183 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15184 not currently available.
15185
15186 @item
15187 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15188 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15189 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15190 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15191 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15192 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15193 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15194 indeterminate values.
15195
15196 @item
15197 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15198 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15199 are not implemented.
15200
15201 @item
15202 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15203 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15204 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15205 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15206 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15207
15208 @smallexample
15209 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15210 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15211 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15212 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15213 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15214 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15215 @end smallexample
15216
15217 Changing a
15218 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15219 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15220 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15221 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15222 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15223 declared to have a type such as:
15224
15225 @smallexample
15226 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15227 Id : Integer;
15228 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15229 end record;
15230 @end smallexample
15231
15232 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15233 assignments:
15234
15235 @smallexample
15236 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15237 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15238 @end smallexample
15239
15240 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15241 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15242 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15243 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15244 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15245 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15246 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15247 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15248
15249 @item
15250 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15251
15252 @item
15253 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15254 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15255 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15256 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15257 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15258 the proper resolution.
15259
15260 @item
15261 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15262
15263 @item
15264 Entry calls are not implemented.
15265
15266 @item
15267 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15268 formats are not supported.
15269
15270 @item
15271 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15272
15273 @item
15274 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15275 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15276 context.
15277 Should your program
15278 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15279 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15280 @end itemize
15281
15282 @node Additions to Ada
15283 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15284 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15285
15286 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15287 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15288
15289 @itemize @bullet
15290 @item
15291 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15292 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15293 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15294 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15295 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15296 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15297 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15298 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15299
15300 @item
15301 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15302 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15303 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15304
15305 @item
15306 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15307 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15308
15309 @item
15310 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15311 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15312 @end itemize
15313
15314 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15315 additions specific to Ada:
15316
15317 @itemize @bullet
15318 @item
15319 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15320 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15321
15322 @smallexample
15323 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15324 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15325 @end smallexample
15326
15327 @item
15328 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15329 the value of its right-hand operand.
15330 This allows, for example,
15331 complex conditional breaks:
15332
15333 @smallexample
15334 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15335 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15336 @end smallexample
15337
15338 @item
15339 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15340 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15341 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15342 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15343 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15344 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15345 in strings. For example,
15346 @smallexample
15347 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15348 @end smallexample
15349 @noindent
15350 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15351 after each period.
15352
15353 @item
15354 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15355 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15356 to write
15357
15358 @smallexample
15359 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15360 @end smallexample
15361
15362 @item
15363 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15364 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15365 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15366 of 3 might print as
15367
15368 @smallexample
15369 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15370 @end smallexample
15371
15372 @noindent
15373 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15374 clause.
15375
15376 @item
15377 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15378 multi-character subsequence of
15379 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15380 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15381 in place of @t{a'length}.
15382
15383 @item
15384 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15385 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15386 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15387 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15388 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15389 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15390 For example,
15391 @smallexample
15392 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15393 @end smallexample
15394
15395 @item
15396 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15397 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15398 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15399 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15400 object.
15401
15402 @end itemize
15403
15404 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15405 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15406
15407 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15408 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15409 before reaching the main procedure.
15410 As defined in the Ada Reference
15411 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15412 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15413 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15414 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15415
15416 @node Ada Exceptions
15417 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15418
15419 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15420
15421 @table @code
15422 @kindex info exceptions
15423 @item info exceptions
15424 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15425 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15426 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15427 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15428 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15429 @end table
15430
15431 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15432 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15433 argument.
15434
15435 @smallexample
15436 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15437 All defined Ada exceptions:
15438 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15439 program_error: 0x613d20
15440 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15441 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15442 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15443 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15444 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15445 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15446 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15447 @end smallexample
15448
15449 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15450 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15451
15452 @node Ada Tasks
15453 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15454 @cindex Ada, tasking
15455
15456 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15457 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15458
15459 @table @code
15460 @kindex info tasks
15461 @item info tasks
15462 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15463
15464
15465 @smallexample
15466 @iftex
15467 @leftskip=0.5cm
15468 @end iftex
15469 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15470 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15471 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15472 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15473 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15474 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15475
15476 @end smallexample
15477
15478 @noindent
15479 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15480 task currently being inspected.
15481
15482 @table @asis
15483 @item ID
15484 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15485
15486 @item TID
15487 The Ada task ID.
15488
15489 @item P-ID
15490 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15491
15492 @item Pri
15493 The base priority of the task.
15494
15495 @item State
15496 Current state of the task.
15497
15498 @table @code
15499 @item Unactivated
15500 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15501 executing.
15502
15503 @item Runnable
15504 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15505 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15506
15507 @item Terminated
15508 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15509 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15510 terminated themselves.
15511
15512 @item Child Activation Wait
15513 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15514
15515 @item Accept Statement
15516 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15517
15518 @item Waiting on entry call
15519 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15520
15521 @item Async Select Wait
15522 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15523 select statement.
15524
15525 @item Delay Sleep
15526 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15527 alternative open.
15528
15529 @item Child Termination Wait
15530 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15531 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15532 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15533
15534 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15535 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15536 finish terminating.
15537
15538 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15539 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15540 @end table
15541
15542 @item Name
15543 Name of the task in the program.
15544
15545 @end table
15546
15547 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15548 @item info task @var{taskno}
15549 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15550 the following example:
15551 @smallexample
15552 @iftex
15553 @leftskip=0.5cm
15554 @end iftex
15555 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15556 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15557 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15558 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15559 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15560 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15561 Name: task_1
15562 Thread: 0x807f378
15563 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15564 Base Priority: 15
15565 State: Runnable
15566 @end smallexample
15567
15568 @item task
15569 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15570 @cindex current Ada task ID
15571 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15572
15573 @smallexample
15574 @iftex
15575 @leftskip=0.5cm
15576 @end iftex
15577 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15578 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15579 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15580 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15581 (@value{GDBP}) task
15582 [Current task is 2]
15583 @end smallexample
15584
15585 @item task @var{taskno}
15586 @cindex Ada task switching
15587 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15588 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15589 from the current task to the given task.
15590
15591 @smallexample
15592 @iftex
15593 @leftskip=0.5cm
15594 @end iftex
15595 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15596 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15597 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15598 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15599 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15600 [Switching to task 1]
15601 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15602 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15603 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15604 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15605 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15606 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15607 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15608 @end smallexample
15609
15610 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15611 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15612 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15613 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15614 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15615 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15616 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15617 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15618 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15619
15620 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15621 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15622 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15623 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15624 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15625
15626 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15627 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15628 program.
15629
15630 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15631 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15632 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15633
15634 For example,
15635
15636 @smallexample
15637 @iftex
15638 @leftskip=0.5cm
15639 @end iftex
15640 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15641 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15642 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15643 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15644 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15645 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15646 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15647 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15648 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15649 Continuing.
15650 task # 1 running
15651 task # 2 running
15652
15653 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15654 15 flush;
15655 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15656 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15657 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15658 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15659 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15660 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15661 @end smallexample
15662 @end table
15663
15664 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15665 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15666 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15667
15668 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15669 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15670 the platform being used.
15671 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15672 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
15673 as usual.
15674
15675 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
15676 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15677 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15678 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15679 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15680 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15681
15682 @node Ravenscar Profile
15683 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15684 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15685
15686 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15687 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15688 requirements.
15689
15690 @table @code
15691 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15692 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15693 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15694 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15695 Profile. This is the default.
15696
15697 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15698 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15699 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15700 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15701 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15702 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15703 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15704
15705 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15706 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15707 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15708 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15709
15710 @end table
15711
15712 @node Ada Glitches
15713 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15714 @cindex Ada, problems
15715
15716 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15717 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15718 @value{GDBN},
15719 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15720 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15721
15722 @itemize @bullet
15723 @item
15724 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15725 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15726
15727 @item
15728 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15729 argument lists are treated as positional).
15730
15731 @item
15732 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15733
15734 @item
15735 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15736 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15737 the host machine.
15738
15739 @item
15740 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15741 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15742 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15743 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15744 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15745 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15746 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15747 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15748 you can usually resolve the confusion
15749 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15750 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15751 @end itemize
15752
15753 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15754 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15755 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15756 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15757 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15758 enabled.
15759
15760 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15761 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15762 @table @code
15763
15764 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15765 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15766 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15767 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15768 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15769 This is the default.
15770
15771 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15772 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15773 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15774 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15775 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15776 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15777 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15778
15779 @end table
15780
15781 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15782 @cindex GNAT encoding
15783 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15784 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15785 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15786 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15787 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15788 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15789
15790 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15791 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15792 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15793 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15794 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15795 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15796 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15797 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15798
15799 @table @code
15800
15801 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15802 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15803 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15804 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15805
15806 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15807 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15808 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15809
15810 @end table
15811
15812 @node Unsupported Languages
15813 @section Unsupported Languages
15814
15815 @cindex unsupported languages
15816 @cindex minimal language
15817 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15818 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15819 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15820 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15821 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15822 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15823
15824 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15825 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15826 language.
15827
15828 @node Symbols
15829 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15830
15831 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15832 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15833 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15834 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15835 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15836 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15837 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15838
15839 @cindex symbol names
15840 @cindex names of symbols
15841 @cindex quoting names
15842 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15843 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15844 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15845 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15846 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15847 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15848 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15849 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15850
15851 @smallexample
15852 p 'foo.c'::x
15853 @end smallexample
15854
15855 @noindent
15856 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15857
15858 @table @code
15859 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15860 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15861 @kindex set case-sensitive
15862 @item set case-sensitive on
15863 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15864 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15865 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15866 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15867 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15868 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15869 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15870 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15871 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15872 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15873 case-insensitive matches.
15874
15875 @kindex show case-sensitive
15876 @item show case-sensitive
15877 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15878 lookups.
15879
15880 @kindex set print type methods
15881 @item set print type methods
15882 @itemx set print type methods on
15883 @itemx set print type methods off
15884 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
15885 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15886 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15887 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15888 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
15889 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
15890
15891 @kindex show print type methods
15892 @item show print type methods
15893 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
15894 classes.
15895
15896 @kindex set print type typedefs
15897 @item set print type typedefs
15898 @itemx set print type typedefs on
15899 @itemx set print type typedefs off
15900
15901 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
15902 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
15903 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
15904 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
15905 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
15906 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
15907 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
15908 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
15909 types.
15910
15911 @kindex show print type typedefs
15912 @item show print type typedefs
15913 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
15914 printing classes.
15915
15916 @kindex info address
15917 @cindex address of a symbol
15918 @item info address @var{symbol}
15919 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
15920 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
15921 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
15922 is always stored.
15923
15924 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
15925 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
15926 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
15927
15928 @kindex info symbol
15929 @cindex symbol from address
15930 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
15931 @item info symbol @var{addr}
15932 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
15933 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
15934 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
15935
15936 @smallexample
15937 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
15938 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
15939 @end smallexample
15940
15941 @noindent
15942 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
15943 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
15944
15945 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
15946 library containing the symbol is also printed:
15947
15948 @smallexample
15949 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
15950 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
15951 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
15952 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
15953 @end smallexample
15954
15955 @kindex whatis
15956 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
15957 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
15958 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
15959 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
15960
15961 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
15962 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
15963 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
15964
15965 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
15966 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
15967 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
15968 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
15969 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
15970 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
15971 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
15972 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
15973 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
15974
15975 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
15976 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
15977 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
15978 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
15979 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
15980 unroll it.
15981
15982 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
15983 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
15984 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
15985
15986 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
15987 Available flags are:
15988
15989 @table @code
15990 @item r
15991 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
15992 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
15993 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
15994
15995 @item m
15996 Do not print methods defined in the class.
15997
15998 @item M
15999 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16000 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16001
16002 @item t
16003 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16004 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16005 names are substituted when printing other types.
16006
16007 @item T
16008 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16009 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16010 @end table
16011
16012 @kindex ptype
16013 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16014 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16015 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16016 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16017
16018 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16019 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16020 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16021 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16022 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16023 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16024 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16025 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16026
16027 For example, for this variable declaration:
16028
16029 @smallexample
16030 typedef double real_t;
16031 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16032 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16033 complex_t var;
16034 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16035 @end smallexample
16036
16037 @noindent
16038 the two commands give this output:
16039
16040 @smallexample
16041 @group
16042 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16043 type = complex_t
16044 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16045 type = struct complex @{
16046 real_t real;
16047 double imag;
16048 @}
16049 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16050 type = struct complex
16051 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16052 type = struct complex
16053 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16054 type = struct complex @{
16055 real_t real;
16056 double imag;
16057 @}
16058 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16059 type = real_t *
16060 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16061 type = double *
16062 @end group
16063 @end smallexample
16064
16065 @noindent
16066 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16067 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16068
16069 @cindex incomplete type
16070 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16071 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16072 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16073 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16074 given these declarations:
16075
16076 @smallexample
16077 struct foo;
16078 struct foo *fooptr;
16079 @end smallexample
16080
16081 @noindent
16082 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16083
16084 @smallexample
16085 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16086 $1 = <incomplete type>
16087 @end smallexample
16088
16089 @noindent
16090 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16091 completely specified.
16092
16093 @kindex info types
16094 @item info types @var{regexp}
16095 @itemx info types
16096 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16097 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16098 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16099 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16100 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16101 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16102 name is @code{value}.
16103
16104 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16105 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16106 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16107
16108 @kindex info type-printers
16109 @item info type-printers
16110 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16111 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16112 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16113 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16114 type printers.
16115
16116 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16117
16118 @kindex enable type-printer
16119 @kindex disable type-printer
16120 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16121 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16122 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16123
16124 @kindex info scope
16125 @cindex local variables
16126 @item info scope @var{location}
16127 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16128 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16129 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16130 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16131 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16132
16133 @smallexample
16134 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16135 Scope for command_line_handler:
16136 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16137 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16138 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16139 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16140 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16141 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16142 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16143 @end smallexample
16144
16145 @noindent
16146 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16147 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16148 collect}.
16149
16150 @kindex info source
16151 @item info source
16152 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16153 the function containing the current point of execution:
16154 @itemize @bullet
16155 @item
16156 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16157 @item
16158 the directory it was compiled in,
16159 @item
16160 its length, in lines,
16161 @item
16162 which programming language it is written in,
16163 @item
16164 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16165 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16166 @item
16167 whether the debugging information includes information about
16168 preprocessor macros.
16169 @end itemize
16170
16171
16172 @kindex info sources
16173 @item info sources
16174 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16175 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16176 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16177
16178 @kindex info functions
16179 @item info functions
16180 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16181
16182 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16183 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16184 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16185 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16186 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16187 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16188 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16189 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16190
16191 @kindex info variables
16192 @item info variables
16193 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16194 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16195
16196 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16197 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16198 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16199 @var{regexp}.
16200
16201 @kindex info classes
16202 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16203 @item info classes
16204 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16205 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16206 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16207 expression.
16208
16209 @kindex info selectors
16210 @item info selectors
16211 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16212 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16213 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16214 expression.
16215
16216 @ignore
16217 This was never implemented.
16218 @kindex info methods
16219 @item info methods
16220 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16221 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16222 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16223 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16224 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16225 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16226 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16227 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16228 @end ignore
16229
16230 @cindex opaque data types
16231 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16232 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16233 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16234 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16235 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16236 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16237 another source file. The default is on.
16238
16239 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16240 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16241
16242 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16243 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16244 is printed as follows:
16245 @smallexample
16246 @{<no data fields>@}
16247 @end smallexample
16248
16249 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16250 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16251 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16252
16253 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16254 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16255 @item set print symbol-loading
16256 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16257 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16258 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16259 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16260 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16261 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16262 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16263 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16264 can be annoying.
16265 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16266 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16267 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16268 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16269
16270 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16271 @item show print symbol-loading
16272 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16273 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16274
16275 @kindex maint print symbols
16276 @cindex symbol dump
16277 @kindex maint print psymbols
16278 @cindex partial symbol dump
16279 @kindex maint print msymbols
16280 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16281 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16282 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16283 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16284 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16285 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16286 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16287 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16288 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16289 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16290 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16291 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16292 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16293 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16294 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16295 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16296 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16297 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16298
16299 @kindex maint info symtabs
16300 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16301 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16302 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16303 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16304 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16305 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16306 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16307
16308 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16309 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16310 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16311 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16312 structure in more detail. For example:
16313
16314 @smallexample
16315 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16316 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16317 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16318 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16319 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16320 readin no
16321 fullname (null)
16322 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16323 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16324 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16325 dependencies (none)
16326 @}
16327 @}
16328 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16329 (@value{GDBP})
16330 @end smallexample
16331 @noindent
16332 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16333 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16334 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16335 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16336 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16337
16338 @smallexample
16339 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16340 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16341 line 1574.
16342 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16343 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16344 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16345 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16346 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16347 dirname (null)
16348 fullname (null)
16349 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16350 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16351 debugformat DWARF 2
16352 @}
16353 @}
16354 (@value{GDBP})
16355 @end smallexample
16356 @end table
16357
16358
16359 @node Altering
16360 @chapter Altering Execution
16361
16362 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16363 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16364 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16365 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16366 program.
16367
16368 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16369 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16370 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16371
16372 @menu
16373 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16374 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16375 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16376 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16377 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16378 * Patching:: Patching your program
16379 @end menu
16380
16381 @node Assignment
16382 @section Assignment to Variables
16383
16384 @cindex assignment
16385 @cindex setting variables
16386 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16387 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16388
16389 @smallexample
16390 print x=4
16391 @end smallexample
16392
16393 @noindent
16394 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16395 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16396 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16397 information on operators in supported languages.
16398
16399 @kindex set variable
16400 @cindex variables, setting
16401 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16402 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16403 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16404 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16405 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16406
16407 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16408 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16409 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16410 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16411 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16412 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16413 command @code{set width}:
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16417 type = double
16418 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16419 $4 = 13
16420 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16421 Invalid syntax in expression.
16422 @end smallexample
16423
16424 @noindent
16425 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16426 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16427
16428 @smallexample
16429 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16430 @end smallexample
16431
16432 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16433 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16434 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16435 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16436 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16437 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 @group
16441 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16442 type = double
16443 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16444 $1 = 1
16445 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16446 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16447 $2 = 1
16448 (@value{GDBP}) r
16449 The program being debugged has been started already.
16450 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16451 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16452 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16453 Invalid bfd target.
16454 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16455 The current BFD target is "=4".
16456 @end group
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @noindent
16460 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16461 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16462 @code{g}, use
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16466 @end smallexample
16467
16468 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16469 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16470 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16471 same length or shorter.
16472 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16473 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16474
16475 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16476 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16477 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16478 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16479 and representation in memory), and
16480
16481 @smallexample
16482 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16483 @end smallexample
16484
16485 @noindent
16486 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16487
16488 @node Jumping
16489 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16490
16491 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16492 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16493 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16494
16495 @table @code
16496 @kindex jump
16497 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16498 @item jump @var{linespec}
16499 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16500 @itemx jump @var{location}
16501 @itemx j @var{location}
16502 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16503 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16504 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16505 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16506 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16507 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16508
16509 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16510 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16511 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16512 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16513 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16514 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16515 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16516 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16517 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16518 @end table
16519
16520 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16521 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16522 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16523 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16524 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16525 example,
16526
16527 @smallexample
16528 set $pc = 0x485
16529 @end smallexample
16530
16531 @noindent
16532 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16533 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16534 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16535
16536 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16537 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16538 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16539 detail.
16540
16541 @c @group
16542 @node Signaling
16543 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16544 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16545
16546 @table @code
16547 @kindex signal
16548 @item signal @var{signal}
16549 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
16550 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16551 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16552 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16553
16554 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16555 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16556 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16557 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16558 signal.
16559
16560 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16561 after executing the command.
16562 @end table
16563 @c @end group
16564
16565 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16566 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16567 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16568 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16569 passes the signal directly to your program.
16570
16571
16572 @node Returning
16573 @section Returning from a Function
16574
16575 @table @code
16576 @cindex returning from a function
16577 @kindex return
16578 @item return
16579 @itemx return @var{expression}
16580 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16581 command. If you give an
16582 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16583 value.
16584 @end table
16585
16586 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16587 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16588 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16589 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16590
16591 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16592 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16593 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16594 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16595 of functions.
16596
16597 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16598 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16599 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16600 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16601 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16602
16603 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16604 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16605 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16606 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16607 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16608 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16609 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16610 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16611 assignment into the right register(s).
16612
16613 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16614 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16615 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16616 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16617 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16618 into a @code{long long int}:
16619
16620 @smallexample
16621 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16622 29 return 31;
16623 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16624 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16625 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16626 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16627 (@value{GDBP})
16628 @end smallexample
16629
16630 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16631 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16632 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16633 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16634 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16635 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16636 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16637 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16638
16639 @smallexample
16640 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16641 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16642 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16643 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16644 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16645 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16646 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16647 (@value{GDBP})
16648 @end smallexample
16649
16650 @node Calling
16651 @section Calling Program Functions
16652
16653 @table @code
16654 @cindex calling functions
16655 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16656 @item print @var{expr}
16657 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16658 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16659 debugged.
16660
16661 @kindex call
16662 @item call @var{expr}
16663 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16664 returned values.
16665
16666 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16667 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16668 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16669 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16670 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16671 value history.
16672 @end table
16673
16674 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16675 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16676 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16677 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16678
16679 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16680 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16681 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16682 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16683 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16684 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16685 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16686 in that case is controlled by the
16687 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16688
16689 @table @code
16690 @item set unwindonsignal
16691 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16692 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16693 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16694 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16695 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16696 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16697 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16698 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16699 received.
16700
16701 @item show unwindonsignal
16702 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16703 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16704 @value{GDBN}.
16705
16706 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16707 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16708 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16709 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16710 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16711 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16712 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16713 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16714 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16715 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16716
16717 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16718 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16719 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16720 @value{GDBN}.
16721
16722 @end table
16723
16724 @cindex weak alias functions
16725 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16726 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16727 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16728 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16729 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16730 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16731 function instead.
16732
16733 @node Patching
16734 @section Patching Programs
16735
16736 @cindex patching binaries
16737 @cindex writing into executables
16738 @cindex writing into corefiles
16739
16740 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16741 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16742 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16743 patching your program's binary.
16744
16745 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16746 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16747 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16748 repairs.
16749
16750 @table @code
16751 @kindex set write
16752 @item set write on
16753 @itemx set write off
16754 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16755 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16756 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16757
16758 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16759 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16760 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16761
16762 @item show write
16763 @kindex show write
16764 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16765 as well as reading.
16766 @end table
16767
16768 @node GDB Files
16769 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16770
16771 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16772 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16773 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16774 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16775
16776 @menu
16777 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16778 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16779 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16780 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16781 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16782 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16783 @end menu
16784
16785 @node Files
16786 @section Commands to Specify Files
16787
16788 @cindex symbol table
16789 @cindex core dump file
16790
16791 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16792 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16793 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16794 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16795
16796 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16797 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16798 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16799 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16800 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16801 new files are useful.
16802
16803 @table @code
16804 @cindex executable file
16805 @kindex file
16806 @item file @var{filename}
16807 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16808 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16809 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16810 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16811 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16812 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16813 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16814 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16815
16816 @cindex unlinked object files
16817 @cindex patching object files
16818 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16819 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16820 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16821 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16822 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16823 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16824 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16825 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16826
16827 @item file
16828 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16829 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16830
16831 @kindex exec-file
16832 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16833 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16834 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16835 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16836 discard information on the executable file.
16837
16838 @kindex symbol-file
16839 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16840 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16841 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16842 table and program to run from the same file.
16843
16844 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16845 program's symbol table.
16846
16847 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16848 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16849 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
16850 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
16851 @value{GDBN}.
16852
16853 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
16854 executing it once.
16855
16856 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
16857 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
16858 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
16859 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
16860 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
16861 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
16862 optimized code.
16863
16864 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
16865 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
16866 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
16867 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
16868 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
16869
16870 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
16871 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
16872 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
16873 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
16874 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
16875 Warnings and Messages}.)
16876
16877 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
16878 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
16879 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
16880 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
16881 in stabs format.
16882
16883 @kindex readnow
16884 @cindex reading symbols immediately
16885 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
16886 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16887 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
16888 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
16889 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
16890 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
16891 entire symbol table available.
16892
16893 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
16894 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
16895 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
16896 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
16897 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
16898 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
16899 @c files.
16900
16901 @kindex core-file
16902 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
16903 @itemx core
16904 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
16905 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
16906 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
16907 executable file itself for other parts.
16908
16909 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
16910 to be used.
16911
16912 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
16913 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
16914 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
16915 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
16916 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
16917
16918 @kindex add-symbol-file
16919 @cindex dynamic linking
16920 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
16921 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
16922 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
16923 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
16924 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
16925 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
16926 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
16927 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
16928 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
16929 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
16930 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
16931 @var{address} as an expression.
16932
16933 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
16934 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
16935 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
16936 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
16937
16938 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
16939
16940 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
16941 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
16942 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
16943 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
16944 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
16945 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
16946 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
16947 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
16948 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
16949
16950 @itemize @bullet
16951 @item
16952 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
16953 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
16954 @item
16955 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
16956 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
16957 @item
16958 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
16959 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16960 @end itemize
16961
16962 @noindent
16963 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
16964 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
16965 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
16966 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
16967 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
16968 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
16969 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
16970 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
16971 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
16972 way.
16973
16974 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16975
16976 @kindex remove-symbol-file
16977 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
16978 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
16979 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
16980 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
16981 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
16982
16983 @smallexample
16984 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
16985 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
16986 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
16987 (y or n) y
16988 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
16989 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
16990 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
16991 (gdb)
16992 @end smallexample
16993
16994
16995 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
16996
16997 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
16998 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
16999 @cindex load symbols from memory
17000 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17001 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17002 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17003 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17004 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17005 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17006 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17007 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17008 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17009
17010 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
17011 @kindex assf
17012 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
17013 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
17014 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
17015 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
17016
17017 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
17018 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
17019 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
17020 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
17021 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
17022 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
17023 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
17024 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
17025
17026 @kindex section
17027 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17028 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17029 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17030 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17031 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17032 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17033 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17034 their addresses.
17035
17036 @kindex info files
17037 @kindex info target
17038 @item info files
17039 @itemx info target
17040 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17041 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17042 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17043 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17044 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17045 current ones.
17046
17047 @kindex maint info sections
17048 @item maint info sections
17049 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17050 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17051 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17052 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17053 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17054 may be arbitrarily combined):
17055
17056 @table @code
17057 @item ALLOBJ
17058 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17059 @item @var{sections}
17060 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17061 @item @var{section-flags}
17062 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17063 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17064 @table @code
17065 @item ALLOC
17066 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17067 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17068 @item LOAD
17069 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17070 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17071 @item RELOC
17072 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17073 @item READONLY
17074 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17075 @item CODE
17076 Section contains executable code only.
17077 @item DATA
17078 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17079 @item ROM
17080 Section will reside in ROM.
17081 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17082 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17083 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17084 Section is not empty.
17085 @item NEVER_LOAD
17086 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17087 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17088 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17089 COFF shared library information.
17090 @item IS_COMMON
17091 Section contains common symbols.
17092 @end table
17093 @end table
17094 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17095 @cindex read-only sections
17096 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17097 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17098 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17099 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17100 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17101 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17102 enhancement to debugging performance.
17103
17104 The default is off.
17105
17106 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17107 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17108 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17109 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17110
17111 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17112 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17113 @end table
17114
17115 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17116 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17117 name and remembers it that way.
17118
17119 @cindex shared libraries
17120 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17121 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17122 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17123
17124 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17125 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17126
17127 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17128 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17129 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17130 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17131 debugging a core file).
17132
17133 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17134 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17135
17136 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17137 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17138 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17139
17140 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17141 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17142 particularly large or there are many of them.
17143
17144 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17145 commands:
17146
17147 @table @code
17148 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17149 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17150 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17151 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17152 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17153 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17154 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17155 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17156
17157 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17158 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17159 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17160 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17161 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17162 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17163 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17164 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17165 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17166
17167 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17168 @item show auto-solib-add
17169 Display the current autoloading mode.
17170 @end table
17171
17172 @cindex load shared library
17173 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17174 command:
17175
17176 @table @code
17177 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17178 @kindex info share
17179 @item info share @var{regex}
17180 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17181 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17182 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17183 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17184
17185 @kindex sharedlibrary
17186 @kindex share
17187 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17188 @itemx share @var{regex}
17189 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17190 Unix regular expression.
17191 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17192 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17193 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17194 loaded.
17195
17196 @item nosharedlibrary
17197 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17198 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17199 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17200 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17201 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17202 discarded.
17203 @end table
17204
17205 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17206 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17207 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17208 Catchpoints}).
17209
17210 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17211 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17212 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17213 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17214
17215 @table @code
17216 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17217 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17218 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17219 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17220 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17221 shared library.
17222
17223 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17224 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17225 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17226 library events happen.
17227 @end table
17228
17229 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17230 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17231 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17232 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17233 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17234 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17235 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17236 not.
17237
17238 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17239 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17240 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17241 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17242 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17243
17244 @table @code
17245 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17246 @cindex system root, alternate
17247 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17248 @kindex set sysroot
17249 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17250 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17251 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17252 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17253 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17254 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17255 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17256 under @var{path}.
17257
17258 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17259 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17260 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17261 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17262 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17263 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17264 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17265 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17266 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17267
17268 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17269 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17270 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17271 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17272 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17273
17274 @smallexample
17275 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17276 @end smallexample
17277
17278 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17279 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17280 system:
17281
17282 @smallexample
17283 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17284 @end smallexample
17285
17286 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17287 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17288 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17289 colons:
17290
17291 @smallexample
17292 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17293 @end smallexample
17294
17295 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17296 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17297 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17298 @samp{z}):
17299
17300 @smallexample
17301 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17302 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17303 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17304 @end smallexample
17305
17306 @noindent
17307 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17308 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17309 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17310
17311 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17312 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17313
17314 @smallexample
17315 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17316 @end smallexample
17317
17318 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17319 if you don't want or need to.
17320
17321 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17322 sysroot}.
17323
17324 @cindex default system root
17325 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17326 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17327 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17328 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17329 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17330 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17331 location.
17332
17333 @kindex show sysroot
17334 @item show sysroot
17335 Display the current shared library prefix.
17336
17337 @kindex set solib-search-path
17338 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17339 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17340 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17341 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17342 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17343 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17344 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17345 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17346 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17347 of shared library symbols.
17348
17349 @kindex show solib-search-path
17350 @item show solib-search-path
17351 Display the current shared library search path.
17352
17353 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17354 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17355 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17356 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17357 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17358
17359 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17360 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17361 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17362 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17363 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17364 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17365 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17366 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17367 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17368 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17369 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17370 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17371 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17372 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17373 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17374 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17375 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17376 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17377 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17378 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17379 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17380 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17381
17382 @table @code
17383 @item unix
17384 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17385 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17386 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17387 the forward slash.
17388
17389 @item dos-based
17390 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17391 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17392 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17393 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17394 considered directory separators.
17395
17396 @item auto
17397 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17398 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17399 This is the default.
17400 @end table
17401 @end table
17402
17403 @cindex file name canonicalization
17404 @cindex base name differences
17405 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17406 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17407 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17408 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17409 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17410 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17411 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17412 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17413 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17414 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17415 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17416 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17417 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17418 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17419 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17420
17421 @table @code
17422 @item set basenames-may-differ
17423 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17424 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17425
17426 @item show basenames-may-differ
17427 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17428 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17429 @end table
17430
17431 @node Separate Debug Files
17432 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17433 @cindex separate debugging information files
17434 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17435 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17436 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17437 @cindex global debugging information directories
17438 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17439 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17440
17441 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17442 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17443 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17444 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17445 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17446 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17447 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17448
17449 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17450 file:
17451
17452 @itemize @bullet
17453 @item
17454 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17455 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17456 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17457 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17458 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17459 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17460 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17461 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17462
17463 @item
17464 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17465 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17466 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17467 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17468 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17469 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17470 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17471 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17472 below.
17473 @end itemize
17474
17475 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17476 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17477
17478 @itemize @bullet
17479 @item
17480 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17481 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17482 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17483 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17484 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17485
17486 @item
17487 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17488 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17489 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17490 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17491 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17492 hex characters, not 10.)
17493 @end itemize
17494
17495 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17496 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17497 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17498 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17499 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17500 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17501
17502 @itemize @minus
17503 @item
17504 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17505 @item
17506 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17507 @item
17508 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17509 @item
17510 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17511 @end itemize
17512
17513 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17514 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17515 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17516 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17517 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17518
17519 @table @code
17520
17521 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17522 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17523 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17524 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17525 concatenating them by a path separator.
17526
17527 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17528 @item show debug-file-directory
17529 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17530 information files.
17531
17532 @end table
17533
17534 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17535 @cindex debug link sections
17536 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17537 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17538
17539 @itemize
17540 @item
17541 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17542 a zero byte,
17543 @item
17544 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17545 boundary within the section, and
17546 @item
17547 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17548 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17549 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17550 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17551 @end itemize
17552
17553 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17554 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17555 described above.
17556
17557 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17558 @cindex build ID sections
17559 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17560 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17561 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17562 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17563 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17564 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17565 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17566 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17567 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17568
17569 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17570 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17571 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17572 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17573 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17574 in an ordinary executable.
17575
17576 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17577 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17578 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17579 following commands:
17580
17581 @smallexample
17582 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17583 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17584 @end smallexample
17585
17586 @noindent
17587 These commands remove the debugging
17588 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17589 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17590 two files:
17591
17592 @itemize @bullet
17593 @item
17594 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17595 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17596
17597 @smallexample
17598 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17599 @end smallexample
17600
17601 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17602 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17603 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17604 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17605
17606 @item
17607 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17608 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17609 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17610 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17611 @end itemize
17612
17613 @noindent
17614
17615 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17616 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17617 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17618
17619 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17620 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17621 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17622 @c different ways!
17623 @ifhtml
17624 @display
17625 @html
17626 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17627 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17628 @end html
17629 @end display
17630 @end ifhtml
17631 @ifnothtml
17632 @display
17633 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17634 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17635 @end display
17636 @end ifnothtml
17637
17638 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17639 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17640 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17641 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17642 CRC.
17643
17644 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17645 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
17646 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
17647 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
17648 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17649
17650 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17651 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17652 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17653 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17654 @code{0xffffffff}.
17655
17656 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17657 @smallexample
17658 unsigned long
17659 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17660 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17661 @{
17662 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17663 @{
17664 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17665 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17666 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17667 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17668 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17669 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17670 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17671 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17672 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17673 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17674 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17675 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17676 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17677 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17678 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17679 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17680 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17681 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17682 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17683 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17684 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17685 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17686 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17687 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17688 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17689 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17690 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17691 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17692 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17693 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17694 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17695 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17696 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17697 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17698 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17699 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17700 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17701 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17702 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17703 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17704 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17705 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17706 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17707 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17708 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17709 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17710 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17711 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17712 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17713 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17714 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17715 0x2d02ef8d
17716 @};
17717 unsigned char *end;
17718
17719 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17720 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17721 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17722 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17723 @}
17724 @end smallexample
17725
17726 @noindent
17727 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17728
17729 @node MiniDebugInfo
17730 @section Debugging information in a special section
17731 @cindex separate debug sections
17732 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17733
17734 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17735 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17736 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17737 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17738
17739 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17740 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17741 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17742 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17743 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17744 debugging information might be included in the section.
17745
17746 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17747 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17748 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17749
17750 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17751 standard utilities:
17752
17753 @smallexample
17754 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17755 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17756 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17757 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17758
17759 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17760 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17761 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17762 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17763 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17764 | sort > funcsyms
17765
17766 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17767 # table.
17768 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17769
17770 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17771 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17772
17773 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17774 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17775 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17776 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17777
17778 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17779 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17780
17781 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17782 # original binary.
17783 xz mini_debuginfo
17784 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17785 @end smallexample
17786
17787 @node Index Files
17788 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17789 @cindex index files
17790 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17791
17792 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17793 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17794 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17795 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17796 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17797 startup.
17798
17799 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17800 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17801 using @command{objcopy}.
17802
17803 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17804
17805 @table @code
17806 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17807 @kindex save gdb-index
17808 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17809 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17810 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17811 @var{directory}.
17812 @end table
17813
17814 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17815 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17816
17817 @smallexample
17818 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17819 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17820 @end smallexample
17821
17822 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17823 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17824 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17825 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17826 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17827 The default is @code{off}.
17828 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17829 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17830
17831 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17832 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17833
17834 @smallexample
17835 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17836 @end smallexample
17837
17838 Instead you must do, for example,
17839
17840 @smallexample
17841 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17842 @end smallexample
17843
17844 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17845 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17846 currently work for programs using Ada.
17847
17848 @node Symbol Errors
17849 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
17850
17851 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
17852 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
17853 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
17854 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
17855 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
17856 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
17857 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
17858 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
17859 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
17860 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17861 Messages}).
17862
17863 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
17864
17865 @table @code
17866 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
17867
17868 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
17869 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
17870 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
17871 in its outer scope blocks.
17872
17873 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
17874 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
17875 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
17876 function.
17877
17878 @item block at @var{address} out of order
17879
17880 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
17881 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
17882 do so.
17883
17884 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
17885 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
17886 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
17887 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
17888 Messages}.)
17889
17890 @item bad block start address patched
17891
17892 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
17893 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
17894 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
17895
17896 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
17897 starting on the previous source line.
17898
17899 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
17900
17901 @cindex foo
17902 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
17903 larger than the size of the string table.
17904
17905 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
17906 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
17907 with this name.
17908
17909 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
17910
17911 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
17912 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
17913 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
17914
17915 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
17916 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
17917 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
17918 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
17919 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
17920 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
17921
17922 @item stub type has NULL name
17923
17924 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
17925
17926 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
17927 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
17928 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
17929 it.
17930
17931 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
17932
17933 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
17934
17935 @end table
17936
17937 @node Data Files
17938 @section GDB Data Files
17939
17940 @cindex prefix for data files
17941 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
17942 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
17943
17944 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
17945 is currently using.
17946
17947 @table @code
17948 @kindex set data-directory
17949 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
17950 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
17951 to @var{directory}.
17952
17953 @kindex show data-directory
17954 @item show data-directory
17955 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
17956 @end table
17957
17958 @cindex default data directory
17959 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
17960 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
17961 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
17962 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17963 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
17964 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17965 location.
17966
17967 The data directory may also be specified with the
17968 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
17969 @xref{Mode Options}.
17970
17971 @node Targets
17972 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
17973
17974 @cindex debugging target
17975 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
17976
17977 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
17978 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
17979 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
17980 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
17981 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
17982 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
17983 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
17984 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
17985
17986 @cindex target architecture
17987 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
17988 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
17989 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
17990 command.
17991
17992 @table @code
17993 @kindex set architecture
17994 @kindex show architecture
17995 @item set architecture @var{arch}
17996 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
17997 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
17998 supported architectures.
17999
18000 @item show architecture
18001 Show the current target architecture.
18002
18003 @item set processor
18004 @itemx processor
18005 @kindex set processor
18006 @kindex show processor
18007 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18008 and @code{show architecture}.
18009 @end table
18010
18011 @menu
18012 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18013 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18014 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18015 @end menu
18016
18017 @node Active Targets
18018 @section Active Targets
18019
18020 @cindex stacking targets
18021 @cindex active targets
18022 @cindex multiple targets
18023
18024 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18025 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18026 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18027 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18028 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18029 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18030 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18031 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18032 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18033
18034 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18035 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18036 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18037 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18038
18039 @node Target Commands
18040 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18041
18042 @table @code
18043 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18044 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18045 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18046 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18047 protocol of the target machine.
18048
18049 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18050 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18051 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18052
18053 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18054 after executing the command.
18055
18056 @kindex help target
18057 @item help target
18058 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18059 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18060 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18061
18062 @item help target @var{name}
18063 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18064 select it.
18065
18066 @kindex set gnutarget
18067 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18068 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18069 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18070 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18071 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18072 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18073
18074 @quotation
18075 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18076 you must know the actual BFD name.
18077 @end quotation
18078
18079 @noindent
18080 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18081
18082 @kindex show gnutarget
18083 @item show gnutarget
18084 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18085 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18086 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18087 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18088 @end table
18089
18090 @cindex common targets
18091 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18092 configuration):
18093
18094 @table @code
18095 @kindex target
18096 @item target exec @var{program}
18097 @cindex executable file target
18098 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18099 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18100
18101 @item target core @var{filename}
18102 @cindex core dump file target
18103 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18104 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18105
18106 @item target remote @var{medium}
18107 @cindex remote target
18108 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18109 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18110 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18111
18112 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18113 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18114
18115 @smallexample
18116 target remote /dev/ttya
18117 @end smallexample
18118
18119 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18120 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18121 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18122 clobbered by the download.
18123
18124 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18125 @cindex built-in simulator target
18126 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18127 In general,
18128 @smallexample
18129 target sim
18130 load
18131 run
18132 @end smallexample
18133 @noindent
18134 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18135 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18136 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18137 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18138 Processors}.
18139
18140 @item target native
18141 @cindex native target
18142 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18143 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18144 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18145 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18146
18147 @end table
18148
18149 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18150 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18151
18152 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18153 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18154 various aspects of this process.
18155
18156 @table @code
18157
18158 @item set hash
18159 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18160 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18161 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18162 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18163 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18164 monitor.
18165
18166 @item show hash
18167 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18168 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18169
18170 @item set debug monitor
18171 @kindex set debug monitor
18172 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18173 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18174 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18175
18176 @item show debug monitor
18177 @kindex show debug monitor
18178 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18179 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18180 @end table
18181
18182 @table @code
18183
18184 @kindex load @var{filename}
18185 @item load @var{filename}
18186 @anchor{load}
18187 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18188 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18189 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18190 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18191 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18192 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18193
18194 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18195 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18196 target is @dots{}}''
18197
18198 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18199 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18200 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18201 specifies a fixed address.
18202 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18203
18204 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18205 load programs into flash memory.
18206
18207 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18208 @end table
18209
18210 @node Byte Order
18211 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18212
18213 @cindex choosing target byte order
18214 @cindex target byte order
18215
18216 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18217 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18218 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18219 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18220 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18221 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18222
18223 @table @code
18224 @kindex set endian
18225 @item set endian big
18226 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18227
18228 @item set endian little
18229 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18230
18231 @item set endian auto
18232 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18233 executable.
18234
18235 @item show endian
18236 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18237
18238 @end table
18239
18240 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18241 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18242 target system.
18243
18244
18245 @node Remote Debugging
18246 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18247 @cindex remote debugging
18248
18249 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18250 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18251 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18252 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18253 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18254
18255 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18256 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18257 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18258 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18259 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18260 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18261
18262 Other remote targets may be available in your
18263 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18264
18265 @menu
18266 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18267 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18268 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18269 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18270 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18271 @end menu
18272
18273 @node Connecting
18274 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18275
18276 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18277 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18278 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18279 program as the first argument.
18280
18281 @cindex @code{target remote}
18282 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18283 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18284 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18285 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18286 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18287 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18288
18289 @table @code
18290
18291 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18292 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18293 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18294 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18295
18296 @smallexample
18297 target remote /dev/ttyb
18298 @end smallexample
18299
18300 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18301 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18302 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18303 @code{target} command.
18304
18305 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18306 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18307 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18308 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18309 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18310 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18311 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18312 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18313 target.
18314
18315 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18316 @code{manyfarms}:
18317
18318 @smallexample
18319 target remote manyfarms:2828
18320 @end smallexample
18321
18322 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18323 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18324 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18325 port 1234 on your local machine:
18326
18327 @smallexample
18328 target remote :1234
18329 @end smallexample
18330 @noindent
18331
18332 Note that the colon is still required here.
18333
18334 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18335 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18336 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18337 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18338
18339 @smallexample
18340 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18341 @end smallexample
18342
18343 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18344 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18345 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18346 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18347
18348 @item target remote | @var{command}
18349 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18350 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18351 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18352 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18353 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18354 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18355 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18356 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18357
18358 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18359 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18360 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18361
18362 @end table
18363
18364 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18365 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18366 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18367 need to use @kbd{run}.
18368
18369 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18370 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18371 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18372 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18373 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18374 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18375 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18376
18377 @smallexample
18378 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18379 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18380 @end smallexample
18381
18382 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18383 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18384 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18385 goes back to waiting.
18386
18387 @table @code
18388 @kindex detach (remote)
18389 @item detach
18390 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18391 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18392 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18393 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18394 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18395
18396 @kindex disconnect
18397 @item disconnect
18398 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18399 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18400 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18401 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18402 another target.
18403
18404 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18405 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18406 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18407 @kindex monitor
18408 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18409 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18410 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18411 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18412 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18413 and implement.
18414 @end table
18415
18416 @node File Transfer
18417 @section Sending files to a remote system
18418 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18419 @cindex file transfer
18420 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18421
18422 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18423 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18424 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18425 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18426 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18427 the only way to upload or download files.
18428
18429 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18430
18431 @table @code
18432 @kindex remote put
18433 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18434 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18435 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18436
18437 @kindex remote get
18438 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18439 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18440 on the host system.
18441
18442 @kindex remote delete
18443 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18444 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18445
18446 @end table
18447
18448 @node Server
18449 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18450
18451 @kindex gdbserver
18452 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18453 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18454 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18455 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18456
18457 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18458 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18459 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18460 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18461 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18462 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18463 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18464 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18465 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18466 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18467 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18468 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18469 choice for debugging.
18470
18471 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18472 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18473 protocol.
18474
18475 @quotation
18476 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18477 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18478 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18479 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18480 @code{gdbserver}.
18481 @end quotation
18482
18483 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18484 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18485 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18486
18487 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18488 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18489 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18490 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18491 system does all the symbol handling.
18492
18493 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18494 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18495 syntax is:
18496
18497 @smallexample
18498 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18499 @end smallexample
18500
18501 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18502 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18503 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18504 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18505 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18506 @file{/dev/com1}:
18507
18508 @smallexample
18509 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18510 @end smallexample
18511
18512 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18513 with it.
18514
18515 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18516
18517 @smallexample
18518 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18519 @end smallexample
18520
18521 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18522 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18523 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18524 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18525 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18526 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18527 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18528 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18529 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18530 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18531 @code{target remote} command.
18532
18533 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18534 with ssh:
18535
18536 @smallexample
18537 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18538 @end smallexample
18539
18540 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18541 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18542 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18543 You could elide it if you want to.
18544
18545 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18546 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18547 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18548 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18549
18550 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18551 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18552 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18553
18554 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18555 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18556
18557 @smallexample
18558 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18559 @end smallexample
18560
18561 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18562 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18563
18564 @pindex pidof
18565 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18566 @code{pidof} utility:
18567
18568 @smallexample
18569 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18570 @end smallexample
18571
18572 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18573 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18574 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18575
18576 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18577 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18578 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18579
18580 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18581 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18582 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18583 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18584
18585 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18586 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18587 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18588 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18589 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18590 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18591 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18592 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18593 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18594
18595 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18596 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18597 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18598 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18599 the program you want to debug.
18600
18601 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18602 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18603 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18604 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18605 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18606 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18607
18608 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18609
18610 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18611
18612 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18613 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18614 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18615 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18616 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18617 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18618 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18619 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18620
18621 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18622 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18623 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18624
18625 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18626 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18627 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18628 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18629 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18630 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18631 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18632 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18633 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18634 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18635 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18636 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18637
18638 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18639 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18640
18641 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18642 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18643 status information about the debugging process.
18644 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18645 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18646 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18647 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18648
18649 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18650 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18651 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18652 Possible options are:
18653
18654 @table @code
18655 @item none
18656 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18657 @item all
18658 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18659 @item timestamps
18660 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18661 @end table
18662
18663 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18664 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18665
18666 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18667 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18668 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18669 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18670 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18671
18672 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18673 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18674 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18675 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18676
18677 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18678 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18679 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18680 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18681
18682 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18683 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18684 environment:
18685
18686 @smallexample
18687 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18688 @end smallexample
18689
18690 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18691
18692 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18693
18694 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18695 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18696 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18697 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18698
18699 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18700 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18701 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18702 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18703 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18704 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18705 programs.
18706
18707 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18708 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18709 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18710 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18711 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18712 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18713 already on the target.
18714
18715 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18716 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18717 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18718
18719 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18720 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18721 Here are the available commands.
18722
18723 @table @code
18724 @item monitor help
18725 List the available monitor commands.
18726
18727 @item monitor set debug 0
18728 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18729 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18730
18731 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18732 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18733 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18734 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18735
18736 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18737 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18738 Possible options are:
18739
18740 @table @code
18741 @item none
18742 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18743 @item all
18744 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18745 @item timestamps
18746 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18747 @end table
18748
18749 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18750 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18751
18752 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18753 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18754 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18755 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18756 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18757 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18758
18759 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18760 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18761
18762 @item monitor exit
18763 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18764 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18765 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18766 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18767 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18768
18769 @end table
18770
18771 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18772 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18773
18774 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18775 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18776
18777 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18778 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18779 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18780 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18781 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18782 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18783 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18784 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18785 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18786 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18787 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18788 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18789
18790 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18791
18792 @table @code
18793 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18794
18795 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18796 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18797 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18798
18799 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18800
18801 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18802 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18803 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18804 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18805 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18806 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18807
18808 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18809
18810 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18811 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18812 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18813 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18814 command for that. For example:
18815
18816 @smallexample
18817 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18818 @end smallexample
18819
18820 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18821 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18822 @end table
18823
18824 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18825 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18826 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18827 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18828 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18829 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18830 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18831 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18832 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18833 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18834
18835 @smallexample
18836 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18837 @end smallexample
18838
18839 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18840
18841 @smallexample
18842 $ gdb myprogram
18843 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18844 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18845 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18846 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18847 @end smallexample
18848
18849 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
18850 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
18851 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
18852 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
18853 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
18854 tracing.
18855
18856 @node Remote Configuration
18857 @section Remote Configuration
18858
18859 @kindex set remote
18860 @kindex show remote
18861 This section documents the configuration options available when
18862 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
18863 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
18864 system-call-allowed}.
18865
18866 @table @code
18867 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
18868 @cindex address size for remote targets
18869 @cindex bits in remote address
18870 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
18871 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
18872 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
18873 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
18874
18875 @item show remoteaddresssize
18876 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
18877
18878 @item set serial baud @var{n}
18879 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
18880 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
18881 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
18882 remote targets.
18883
18884 @item show serial baud
18885 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
18886
18887 @item set remotebreak
18888 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18889 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
18890 @anchor{set remotebreak}
18891 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
18892 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
18893 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
18894 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
18895 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
18896
18897 @item show remotebreak
18898 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
18899 interrupt the remote program.
18900
18901 @item set remoteflow on
18902 @itemx set remoteflow off
18903 @kindex set remoteflow
18904 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
18905 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
18906
18907 @item show remoteflow
18908 @kindex show remoteflow
18909 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
18910
18911 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
18912 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
18913 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
18914 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
18915 @code{ascii}.
18916
18917 @item show remotelogbase
18918 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
18919 protocol.
18920
18921 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
18922 @cindex record serial communications on file
18923 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
18924 default is not to record at all.
18925
18926 @item show remotelogfile.
18927 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
18928 serial communications.
18929
18930 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
18931 @cindex timeout for serial communications
18932 @cindex remote timeout
18933 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
18934 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
18935
18936 @item show remotetimeout
18937 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
18938 responses.
18939
18940 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
18941 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
18942 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
18943 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
18944 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
18945 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
18946 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
18947 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
18948
18949 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
18950 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
18951 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
18952 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
18953 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
18954 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
18955 as unlimited.
18956
18957 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
18958 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
18959 a remote hardware watchpoint.
18960
18961 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
18962 @itemx show remote exec-file
18963 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
18964 @cindex executable file, for remote target
18965 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
18966 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
18967 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
18968 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
18969
18970 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
18971 @cindex interrupt remote programs
18972 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
18973 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
18974 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
18975 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
18976 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
18977 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
18978 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
18979 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
18980
18981 @item show interrupt-sequence
18982 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
18983 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
18984 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
18985 also known as Magic SysRq g.
18986
18987 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
18988 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
18989 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
18990 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
18991 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
18992 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
18993
18994 @item show interrupt-on-connect
18995 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
18996 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
18997
18998 @kindex set tcp
18999 @kindex show tcp
19000 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19001 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19002 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19003 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19004 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19005 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19006 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19007 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19008 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19009
19010 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19011 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19012
19013 @item show tcp auto-retry
19014 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19015
19016 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19017 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19018 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19019 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19020 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19021 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19022 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19023 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19024 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19025 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19026 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19027
19028 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19029 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19030 @end table
19031
19032 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19033 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19034 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19035 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19036 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19037 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19038 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19039 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19040 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19041
19042 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19043 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19044 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19045 @value{GDBN} developers.
19046
19047 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19048 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19049 are:
19050
19051 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19052 @item Command Name
19053 @tab Remote Packet
19054 @tab Related Features
19055
19056 @item @code{fetch-register}
19057 @tab @code{p}
19058 @tab @code{info registers}
19059
19060 @item @code{set-register}
19061 @tab @code{P}
19062 @tab @code{set}
19063
19064 @item @code{binary-download}
19065 @tab @code{X}
19066 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19067
19068 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19069 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19070 @tab @code{info auxv}
19071
19072 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19073 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19074 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19075
19076 @item @code{attach}
19077 @tab @code{vAttach}
19078 @tab @code{attach}
19079
19080 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19081 @tab @code{vCont}
19082 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19083
19084 @item @code{run}
19085 @tab @code{vRun}
19086 @tab @code{run}
19087
19088 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19089 @tab @code{Z0}
19090 @tab @code{break}
19091
19092 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19093 @tab @code{Z1}
19094 @tab @code{hbreak}
19095
19096 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19097 @tab @code{Z2}
19098 @tab @code{watch}
19099
19100 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19101 @tab @code{Z3}
19102 @tab @code{rwatch}
19103
19104 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19105 @tab @code{Z4}
19106 @tab @code{awatch}
19107
19108 @item @code{target-features}
19109 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19110 @tab @code{set architecture}
19111
19112 @item @code{library-info}
19113 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19114 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19115
19116 @item @code{memory-map}
19117 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19118 @tab @code{info mem}
19119
19120 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19121 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19122 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19123
19124 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19125 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19126 @tab @code{info spu}
19127
19128 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19129 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19130 @tab @code{info spu}
19131
19132 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19133 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19134 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19135
19136 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19137 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19138 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19139
19140 @item @code{threads}
19141 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19142 @tab @code{info threads}
19143
19144 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19145 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19146 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19147
19148 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19149 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19150 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19151
19152 @item @code{search-memory}
19153 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19154 @tab @code{find}
19155
19156 @item @code{supported-packets}
19157 @tab @code{qSupported}
19158 @tab Remote communications parameters
19159
19160 @item @code{pass-signals}
19161 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19162 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19163
19164 @item @code{program-signals}
19165 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19166 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19167
19168 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19169 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19170 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19171
19172 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19173 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19174 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19175
19176 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19177 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19178 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19179
19180 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19181 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19182 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19183
19184 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19185 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19186 @tab @code{remote delete}
19187
19188 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19189 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19190 @tab Host I/O
19191
19192 @item @code{noack-packet}
19193 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19194 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19195
19196 @item @code{osdata}
19197 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19198 @tab @code{info os}
19199
19200 @item @code{query-attached}
19201 @tab @code{qAttached}
19202 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19203
19204 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19205 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19206 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19207
19208 @item @code{trace-status}
19209 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19210 @tab @code{tstatus}
19211
19212 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19213 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19214 @tab Traceframe info
19215
19216 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19217 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19218 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19219
19220 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19221 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19222 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19223
19224 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19225 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19226 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19227 @end multitable
19228
19229 @node Remote Stub
19230 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19231
19232 @cindex debugging stub, example
19233 @cindex remote stub, example
19234 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19235 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19236 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19237 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19238 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19239 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19240 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19241 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19242
19243 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19244 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19245 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19246 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19247 program, you need:
19248
19249 @enumerate
19250 @item
19251 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19252 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19253 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19254
19255 @item
19256 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19257 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19258
19259 @item
19260 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19261 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19262 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19263 documentation.
19264 @end enumerate
19265
19266 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19267 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19268 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19269
19270 @table @emph
19271 @item On the host,
19272 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19273 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19274 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19275
19276 @item On the target,
19277 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19278 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19279 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19280
19281 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19282 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19283 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19284 @end table
19285
19286 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19287 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19288 @sc{sparc} boards.
19289
19290 @cindex remote serial stub list
19291 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19292
19293 @table @code
19294
19295 @item i386-stub.c
19296 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19297 @cindex Intel
19298 @cindex i386
19299 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19300
19301 @item m68k-stub.c
19302 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19303 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19304 @cindex m680x0
19305 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19306
19307 @item sh-stub.c
19308 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19309 @cindex Renesas
19310 @cindex SH
19311 For Renesas SH architectures.
19312
19313 @item sparc-stub.c
19314 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19315 @cindex Sparc
19316 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19317
19318 @item sparcl-stub.c
19319 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19320 @cindex Fujitsu
19321 @cindex SparcLite
19322 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19323
19324 @end table
19325
19326 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19327 recently added stubs.
19328
19329 @menu
19330 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19331 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19332 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19333 @end menu
19334
19335 @node Stub Contents
19336 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19337
19338 @cindex remote serial stub
19339 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19340 subroutines:
19341
19342 @table @code
19343 @item set_debug_traps
19344 @findex set_debug_traps
19345 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19346 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19347 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19348 program's startup code.
19349
19350 @item handle_exception
19351 @findex handle_exception
19352 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19353 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19354 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19355 run when a trap is triggered.
19356
19357 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19358 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19359 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19360 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19361 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19362 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19363 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19364 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19365 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19366 machine.
19367
19368 @item breakpoint
19369 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19370 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19371 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19372 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19373 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19374 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19375 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19376 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19377 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19378 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19379 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19380
19381 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19382 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19383 start of your debugging session.
19384 @end table
19385
19386 @node Bootstrapping
19387 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19388
19389 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19390 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19391 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19392 debugging target machine.
19393
19394 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19395 serial port.
19396
19397 @table @code
19398 @item int getDebugChar()
19399 @findex getDebugChar
19400 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19401 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19402 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19403
19404 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19405 @findex putDebugChar
19406 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19407 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19408 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19409 @end table
19410
19411 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19412 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19413 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19414 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19415 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19416 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19417 remote system to stop.
19418
19419 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19420 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19421 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19422 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19423
19424 Other routines you need to supply are:
19425
19426 @table @code
19427 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19428 @findex exceptionHandler
19429 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19430 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19431 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19432 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19433 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19434 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19435 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19436 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19437 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19438 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19439 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19440 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19441 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19442
19443 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19444 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19445 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19446 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19447 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19448
19449 @item void flush_i_cache()
19450 @findex flush_i_cache
19451 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19452 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19453 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19454
19455 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19456 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19457 @end table
19458
19459 @noindent
19460 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19461
19462 @table @code
19463 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19464 @findex memset
19465 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19466 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19467 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19468 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19469 @end table
19470
19471 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19472 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19473 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19474 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19475
19476
19477 @node Debug Session
19478 @subsection Putting it All Together
19479
19480 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19481 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19482 steps.
19483
19484 @enumerate
19485 @item
19486 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19487 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19488 @display
19489 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19490 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19491 @end display
19492
19493 @item
19494 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19495 procedure is called:
19496
19497 @smallexample
19498 set_debug_traps();
19499 breakpoint();
19500 @end smallexample
19501
19502 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19503 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19504 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19505 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19506 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19507 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19508 progress.
19509
19510 @item
19511 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19512 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19513
19514 @smallexample
19515 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19516 @end smallexample
19517
19518 @noindent
19519 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19520 function in your program, that function is called when
19521 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19522 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19523 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19524
19525 @item
19526 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19527 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19528
19529 @item
19530 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19531 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19532
19533 @item
19534 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19535 @c document that. FIXME.
19536 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19537 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19538
19539 @item
19540 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19541 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19542
19543 @end enumerate
19544
19545 @node Configurations
19546 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19547
19548 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19549 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19550 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19551
19552 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19553 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19554 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19555 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19556 are quite different from each other.
19557
19558 @menu
19559 * Native::
19560 * Embedded OS::
19561 * Embedded Processors::
19562 * Architectures::
19563 @end menu
19564
19565 @node Native
19566 @section Native
19567
19568 This section describes details specific to particular native
19569 configurations.
19570
19571 @menu
19572 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19573 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19574 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19575 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19576 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19577 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19578 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19579 @end menu
19580
19581 @node HP-UX
19582 @subsection HP-UX
19583
19584 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19585 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19586 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19587
19588
19589 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19590 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19591
19592 @cindex libkvm
19593 @cindex kernel memory image
19594 @cindex kernel crash dump
19595
19596 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19597 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19598 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19599 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19600 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19601 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19602 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19603 @code{kvm} target:
19604
19605 @smallexample
19606 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19607 @end smallexample
19608
19609 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19610 argument:
19611
19612 @smallexample
19613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19614 @end smallexample
19615
19616 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19617 available:
19618
19619 @table @code
19620 @kindex kvm
19621 @item kvm pcb
19622 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19623
19624 @item kvm proc
19625 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19626 modern FreeBSD systems.
19627 @end table
19628
19629 @node SVR4 Process Information
19630 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19631 @cindex /proc
19632 @cindex examine process image
19633 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19634
19635 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19636 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19637 process using file-system subroutines.
19638
19639 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19640 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19641 information about the process running your program, or about any
19642 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19643 @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, and Irix, but
19644 not HP-UX, for example.
19645
19646 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19647 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19648
19649 @table @code
19650 @kindex info proc
19651 @cindex process ID
19652 @item info proc
19653 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19654 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19655 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19656 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19657 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19658 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19659 executable file's absolute file name.
19660
19661 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19662 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19663 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19664 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19665 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19666 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19667
19668 @item info proc cmdline
19669 @cindex info proc cmdline
19670 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19671 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19672
19673 @item info proc cwd
19674 @cindex info proc cwd
19675 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19676 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19677
19678 @item info proc exe
19679 @cindex info proc exe
19680 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19681 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19682
19683 @item info proc mappings
19684 @cindex memory address space mappings
19685 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19686 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19687 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19688 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19689 memory access rights to that range.
19690
19691 @item info proc stat
19692 @itemx info proc status
19693 @cindex process detailed status information
19694 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19695 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19696 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19697 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19698 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19699 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19700 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19701
19702 @item info proc all
19703 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19704 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19705
19706 @ignore
19707 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19708 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19709 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19710 @kindex info proc times
19711 @item info proc times
19712 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19713 its children.
19714
19715 @kindex info proc id
19716 @item info proc id
19717 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19718 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19719 @end ignore
19720
19721 @item set procfs-trace
19722 @kindex set procfs-trace
19723 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19724 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19725
19726 @item show procfs-trace
19727 @kindex show procfs-trace
19728 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19729
19730 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19731 @kindex set procfs-file
19732 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19733 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19734 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19735 standard output.
19736
19737 @item show procfs-file
19738 @kindex show procfs-file
19739 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19740
19741 @item proc-trace-entry
19742 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19743 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19744 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19745 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19746 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19747 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19748 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19749 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19750 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19751
19752 @item info pidlist
19753 @kindex info pidlist
19754 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19755 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19756 processes and all the threads within each process.
19757
19758 @item info meminfo
19759 @kindex info meminfo
19760 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19761 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19762 @end table
19763
19764 @node DJGPP Native
19765 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19766 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19767 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19768 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19769
19770 @cindex DPMI
19771 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19772 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19773 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19774 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19775
19776 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19777 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19778 subsection describes those commands.
19779
19780 @table @code
19781 @kindex info dos
19782 @item info dos
19783 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19784 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19785
19786 @kindex sysinfo
19787 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19788 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19789 @item info dos sysinfo
19790 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19791 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19792 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19793
19794 @cindex GDT
19795 @cindex LDT
19796 @cindex IDT
19797 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19798 @cindex descriptor tables display
19799 @item info dos gdt
19800 @itemx info dos ldt
19801 @itemx info dos idt
19802 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19803 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19804 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19805 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19806 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19807 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19808 rights.
19809
19810 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19811 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19812 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19813 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19814 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19815
19816 @cindex garbled pointers
19817 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19818 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19819 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19820 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19821 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19822 debugged program's data segment:
19823
19824 @smallexample
19825 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19826 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19827 @end smallexample
19828
19829 @noindent
19830 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19831 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19832
19833 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19834 @item info dos pde
19835 @itemx info dos pte
19836 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19837 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19838 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19839 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19840 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19841 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19842 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19843 that is currently in use.
19844
19845 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19846 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19847 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19848 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19849 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19850 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
19851 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
19852
19853 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
19854 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
19855 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
19856 controller.
19857
19858 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
19859
19860 @cindex physical address from linear address
19861 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
19862 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
19863 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
19864 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
19865 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
19866 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
19867 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
19868
19869 @smallexample
19870 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
19871 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
19872 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
19873 @end smallexample
19874
19875 @noindent
19876 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
19877 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
19878 attributes of that page.
19879
19880 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
19881 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
19882 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
19883 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
19884 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
19885 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
19886
19887 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
19888 transfer buffer:
19889
19890 @smallexample
19891 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
19892 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
19893 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
19894 @end smallexample
19895
19896 @noindent
19897 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
19898 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
19899 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
19900 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
19901 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
19902
19903 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
19904 @end table
19905
19906 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
19907 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
19908 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
19909 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
19910
19911 @table @code
19912 @kindex set com1base
19913 @kindex set com1irq
19914 @kindex set com2base
19915 @kindex set com2irq
19916 @kindex set com3base
19917 @kindex set com3irq
19918 @kindex set com4base
19919 @kindex set com4irq
19920 @item set com1base @var{addr}
19921 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
19922 port.
19923
19924 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
19925 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
19926 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
19927
19928 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
19929 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
19930 other 3 COM ports.
19931
19932 @kindex show com1base
19933 @kindex show com1irq
19934 @kindex show com2base
19935 @kindex show com2irq
19936 @kindex show com3base
19937 @kindex show com3irq
19938 @kindex show com4base
19939 @kindex show com4irq
19940 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
19941 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
19942 lines used by the COM ports.
19943
19944 @item info serial
19945 @kindex info serial
19946 @cindex DOS serial port status
19947 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
19948 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
19949 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
19950 counts of various errors encountered so far.
19951 @end table
19952
19953
19954 @node Cygwin Native
19955 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
19956 @cindex MS Windows debugging
19957 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
19958 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
19959
19960 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
19961 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
19962
19963 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
19964 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
19965 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
19966 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
19967 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
19968 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
19969 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
19970 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
19971
19972 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
19973 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
19974 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
19975
19976 @table @code
19977 @kindex info w32
19978 @item info w32
19979 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
19980 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19981
19982 @item info w32 selector
19983 This command displays information returned by
19984 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
19985 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
19986 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
19987 Without argument, this command displays information
19988 about the six segment registers.
19989
19990 @item info w32 thread-information-block
19991 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
19992 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
19993 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
19994
19995 @kindex info dll
19996 @item info dll
19997 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
19998
19999 @kindex dll-symbols
20000 @item dll-symbols
20001 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
20002 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
20003
20004 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
20005 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
20006
20007 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20008 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20009 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20010 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20011 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20012 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20013 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20014 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20015 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20016 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20017 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20018
20019 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20020 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20021 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20022 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20023
20024 @kindex set new-console
20025 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20026 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20027 be started in a new console on next start.
20028 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20029 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20030
20031 @kindex show new-console
20032 @item show new-console
20033 Displays whether a new console is used
20034 when the debuggee is started.
20035
20036 @kindex set new-group
20037 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20038 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20039 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20040 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20041 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20042
20043 @kindex show new-group
20044 @item show new-group
20045 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20046
20047 @kindex set debugevents
20048 @item set debugevents
20049 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20050 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20051 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20052 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20053 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20054
20055 @kindex set debugexec
20056 @item set debugexec
20057 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20058 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20059
20060 @kindex set debugexceptions
20061 @item set debugexceptions
20062 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20063 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20064
20065 @kindex set debugmemory
20066 @item set debugmemory
20067 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20068 and writes by the debugger.
20069
20070 @kindex set shell
20071 @item set shell
20072 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20073 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20074
20075 @kindex show shell
20076 @item show shell
20077 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20078
20079 @end table
20080
20081 @menu
20082 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20083 @end menu
20084
20085 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20086 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20087 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20088 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20089
20090 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20091 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20092 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20093 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20094 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20095 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20096 ``minimal symbols''.
20097
20098 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20099 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20100 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20101 program run once to completion.
20102
20103 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20104
20105 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20106 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20107 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20108 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20109 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20110 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20111 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20112 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20113 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20114
20115 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20116 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20117 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20118 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20119 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20120 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20124 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20125
20126 Non-debugging symbols:
20127 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20128 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20129 @end smallexample
20130
20131 @smallexample
20132 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20133 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20134
20135 Non-debugging symbols:
20136 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20137 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20138 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20139 [etc...]
20140 @end smallexample
20141
20142 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20143
20144 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20145 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20146 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20147 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20148 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20149 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20150 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20151
20152 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20153 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20154 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20155 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20156 problem:
20157
20158 @smallexample
20159 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20160 $1 = 268572168
20161 @end smallexample
20162
20163 @smallexample
20164 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20165 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20166 @end smallexample
20167
20168 And two possible solutions:
20169
20170 @smallexample
20171 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20172 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20173 @end smallexample
20174
20175 @smallexample
20176 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20177 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20178 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20179 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20180 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20181 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20182 @end smallexample
20183
20184 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20185 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20186 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20187 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20188 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20189
20190 @smallexample
20191 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20192 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20193 @end smallexample
20194
20195 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20196 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20197 safe.
20198
20199 @node Hurd Native
20200 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20201 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20202
20203 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20204 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20205
20206 @table @code
20207 @item set signals
20208 @itemx set sigs
20209 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20210 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20211 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20212 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20213 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20214 @code{signals}.
20215
20216 @item show signals
20217 @itemx show sigs
20218 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20219 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20220 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20221
20222 @item set signal-thread
20223 @itemx set sigthread
20224 @kindex set signal-thread
20225 @kindex set sigthread
20226 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20227 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20228 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20229 signal-thread}.
20230
20231 @item show signal-thread
20232 @itemx show sigthread
20233 @kindex show signal-thread
20234 @kindex show sigthread
20235 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20236 delivered a signal.
20237
20238 @item set stopped
20239 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20240 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20241 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20242 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20243
20244 @item show stopped
20245 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20246 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20247 stopped.
20248
20249 @item set exceptions
20250 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20251 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20252 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20253 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20254 trapping on.
20255
20256 @item show exceptions
20257 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20258 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20259
20260 @item set task pause
20261 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20262 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20263 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20264 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20265 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20266 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20267 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20268 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20269 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20270
20271 @item show task pause
20272 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20273 Show the current state of task suspension.
20274
20275 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20276 @cindex task suspend count
20277 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20278 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20279 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20280
20281 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20282 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20283
20284 @item set task exception-port
20285 @itemx set task excp
20286 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20287 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20288 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20289 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20290
20291 @item set noninvasive
20292 @cindex noninvasive task options
20293 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20294 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20295 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20296 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20297
20298 @item info send-rights
20299 @itemx info receive-rights
20300 @itemx info port-rights
20301 @itemx info port-sets
20302 @itemx info dead-names
20303 @itemx info ports
20304 @itemx info psets
20305 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20306 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20307 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20308 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20309 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20310 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20311 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20312 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20313 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20314
20315 @item set thread pause
20316 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20317 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20318 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20319 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20320 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20321 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20322 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20323 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20324 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20325 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20326 only the current thread.
20327
20328 @item show thread pause
20329 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20330 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20331
20332 @item set thread run
20333 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20334
20335 @item show thread run
20336 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20337
20338 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20339 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20340 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20341 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20342 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20343 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20344 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20345
20346 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20347 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20348 detaching.
20349
20350 @item set thread exception-port
20351 @itemx set thread excp
20352 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20353 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20354 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20355
20356 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20357 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20358 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20359 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20360
20361 @item set thread default
20362 @itemx show thread default
20363 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20364 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20365 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20366 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20367 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20368 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20369 the non-default commands.
20370 @end table
20371
20372 @node Darwin
20373 @subsection Darwin
20374 @cindex Darwin
20375
20376 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20377
20378 @table @code
20379 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20380 @kindex set debug darwin
20381 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20382 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20383
20384 @item show debug darwin
20385 @kindex show debug darwin
20386 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20387
20388 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20389 @kindex set debug mach-o
20390 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20391 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20392 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20393 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20394 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20395 usage.
20396
20397 @item show debug mach-o
20398 @kindex show debug mach-o
20399 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20400
20401 @item set mach-exceptions on
20402 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20403 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20404 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20405 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20406 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20407 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20408
20409 @item show mach-exceptions
20410 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20411 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20412 @end table
20413
20414
20415 @node Embedded OS
20416 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20417
20418 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20419 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20420 architectures.
20421
20422 @menu
20423 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20424 @end menu
20425
20426 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20427 various real-time operating systems.
20428
20429 @node VxWorks
20430 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
20431
20432 @cindex VxWorks
20433
20434 @table @code
20435
20436 @kindex target vxworks
20437 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
20438 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
20439 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
20440
20441 @end table
20442
20443 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
20444 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
20445
20446 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
20447 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
20448 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
20449 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
20450 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
20451 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
20452 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
20453
20454 @table @code
20455 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
20456 @kindex vxworks-timeout
20457 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
20458 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
20459 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
20460 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
20461 of a thin network line.
20462 @end table
20463
20464 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
20465 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
20466 procedures.
20467
20468 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
20469 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
20470 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
20471 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
20472 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
20473 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
20474 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
20475 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
20476 manual.
20477 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
20478
20479 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
20480 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
20481 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
20482 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
20483
20484 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
20485
20486 @smallexample
20487 (vxgdb)
20488 @end smallexample
20489
20490 @menu
20491 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
20492 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
20493 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
20494 @end menu
20495
20496 @node VxWorks Connection
20497 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
20498
20499 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
20500 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
20501
20502 @smallexample
20503 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
20504 @end smallexample
20505
20506 @need 750
20507 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
20508
20509 @smallexample
20510 Attaching remote machine across net...
20511 Connected to tt.
20512 @end smallexample
20513
20514 @need 1000
20515 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
20516 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
20517 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
20518 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
20519 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
20520
20521 @smallexample
20522 prog.o: No such file or directory.
20523 @end smallexample
20524
20525 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
20526 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
20527 command again.
20528
20529 @node VxWorks Download
20530 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
20531
20532 @cindex download to VxWorks
20533 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
20534 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
20535 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
20536 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
20537 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
20538 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
20539 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
20540 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
20541 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
20542 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
20543 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
20544 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
20545 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
20546 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
20547 program, type this on VxWorks:
20548
20549 @smallexample
20550 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
20551 @end smallexample
20552
20553 @noindent
20554 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
20555
20556 @smallexample
20557 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
20558 (vxgdb) load prog.o
20559 @end smallexample
20560
20561 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
20565 @end smallexample
20566
20567 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
20568 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
20569 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
20570 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
20571 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
20572 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
20573 table.)
20574
20575 @node VxWorks Attach
20576 @subsubsection Running Tasks
20577
20578 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
20579 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
20580 follows:
20581
20582 @smallexample
20583 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
20584 @end smallexample
20585
20586 @noindent
20587 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
20588 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
20589 the time of attachment.
20590
20591 @node Embedded Processors
20592 @section Embedded Processors
20593
20594 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20595 configurations.
20596
20597 @cindex send command to simulator
20598 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20599 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20600
20601 @table @code
20602 @item sim @var{command}
20603 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20604 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20605 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20606 acceptable commands.
20607 @end table
20608
20609
20610 @menu
20611 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20612 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20613 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20614 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20615 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20616 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20617 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20618 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20619 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20620 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20621 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20622 * CRIS:: CRIS
20623 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20624 @end menu
20625
20626 @node ARM
20627 @subsection ARM
20628 @cindex ARM RDI
20629
20630 @table @code
20631 @kindex target rdi
20632 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20633 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20634 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20635 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20636
20637 @kindex target rdp
20638 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20639 ARM Demon monitor.
20640
20641 @end table
20642
20643 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20644
20645 @table @code
20646 @item set arm disassembler
20647 @kindex set arm
20648 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20649 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20650
20651 @item show arm disassembler
20652 @kindex show arm
20653 Show the current disassembly style.
20654
20655 @item set arm apcs32
20656 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20657 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20658
20659 @item show arm apcs32
20660 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20661
20662 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20663 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20664 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20665
20666 @table @code
20667 @item auto
20668 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20669 @item softfpa
20670 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20671 processors.
20672 @item fpa
20673 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20674 @item softvfp
20675 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20676 @item vfp
20677 VFP co-processor.
20678 @end table
20679
20680 @item show arm fpu
20681 Show the current type of the FPU.
20682
20683 @item set arm abi
20684 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20685
20686 @item show arm abi
20687 Show the currently used ABI.
20688
20689 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20690 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20691 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20692 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20693 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20694 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20695 register).
20696
20697 @item show arm fallback-mode
20698 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20699
20700 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20701 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20702 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20703 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20704 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20705
20706 @item show arm force-mode
20707 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20708
20709 @item set debug arm
20710 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20711 target support subsystem.
20712
20713 @item show debug arm
20714 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20715 @end table
20716
20717 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20718 using the RDI interface:
20719
20720 @table @code
20721 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20722 @kindex rdilogfile
20723 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20724 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20725 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20726 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20727 @file{rdi.log}.
20728
20729 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20730 @kindex rdilogenable
20731 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20732 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20733 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20734 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20735 are logged to a file.
20736
20737 @item set rdiromatzero
20738 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20739 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20740 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20741 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20742 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20743 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20744
20745 @item show rdiromatzero
20746 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20747 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20748
20749 @item set rdiheartbeat
20750 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20751 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20752 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20753 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20754 well as the Angel monitor.
20755
20756 @item show rdiheartbeat
20757 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20758 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20759 @end table
20760
20761 @table @code
20762 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20763 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20764
20765 @table @code
20766 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20767 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
20768 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20769 The default value is @code{all}.
20770
20771 @table @code
20772 @item none
20773 @item demon
20774 @item angel
20775 @item redboot
20776 @item all
20777 @end table
20778 @end table
20779 @end table
20780
20781 @node M32R/D
20782 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20783
20784 @table @code
20785 @kindex target m32r
20786 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20787 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20788
20789 @kindex target m32rsdi
20790 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20791 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20792 @end table
20793
20794 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20795
20796 @table @code
20797 @item set download-path @var{path}
20798 @kindex set download-path
20799 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20800 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20801
20802 @item show download-path
20803 @kindex show download-path
20804 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20805
20806 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20807 @kindex set board-address
20808 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20809 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20810
20811 @item show board-address
20812 @kindex show board-address
20813 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20814
20815 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20816 @kindex set server-address
20817 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20818 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20819 host machine.
20820
20821 @item show server-address
20822 @kindex show server-address
20823 Display the IP address of the download server.
20824
20825 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20826 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20827 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20828 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20829 executable file is uploaded.
20830
20831 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20832 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20833 Test the @code{upload} command.
20834 @end table
20835
20836 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20837
20838 @table @code
20839 @item sdireset
20840 @kindex sdireset
20841 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20842 This command resets the SDI connection.
20843
20844 @item sdistatus
20845 @kindex sdistatus
20846 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20847
20848 @item debug_chaos
20849 @kindex debug_chaos
20850 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20851 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20852
20853 @item use_debug_dma
20854 @kindex use_debug_dma
20855 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20856
20857 @item use_mon_code
20858 @kindex use_mon_code
20859 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20860
20861 @item use_ib_break
20862 @kindex use_ib_break
20863 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20864
20865 @item use_dbt_break
20866 @kindex use_dbt_break
20867 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20868 @end table
20869
20870 @node M68K
20871 @subsection M68k
20872
20873 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20874 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20875
20876 @table @code
20877
20878 @kindex target dbug
20879 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20880 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20881
20882 @end table
20883
20884 @node MicroBlaze
20885 @subsection MicroBlaze
20886 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20887 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20888
20889 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20890 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20891 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20892 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20893 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20894 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20895 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20896 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20897 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20898 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20899 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20900
20901 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20902
20903 @table @code
20904 @item target remote :1234
20905 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20906 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20907
20908 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20909 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20910 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20911
20912 @item load
20913 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20914
20915 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20916 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20917
20918 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20919 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20920 @end table
20921
20922 @node MIPS Embedded
20923 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20924
20925 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20926 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20927 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20928 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20929
20930 @need 1000
20931 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20932
20933 @table @code
20934 @item target mips @var{port}
20935 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20936 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20937 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20938 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20939 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20940 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20941 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20942
20943 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20944 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20945 debugger:
20946
20947 @smallexample
20948 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20949 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20950 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20951 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20952 (@value{GDBP}) run
20953 @end smallexample
20954
20955 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20956 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20957 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20958 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20959 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20960
20961 @item target pmon @var{port}
20962 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20963 PMON ROM monitor.
20964
20965 @item target ddb @var{port}
20966 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20967 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20968
20969 @item target lsi @var{port}
20970 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20971 LSI variant of PMON.
20972
20973 @kindex target r3900
20974 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20975 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20976
20977 @kindex target array
20978 @item target array @var{dev}
20979 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20980
20981 @end table
20982
20983
20984 @noindent
20985 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20986
20987 @table @code
20988 @item set mipsfpu double
20989 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20990 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20991 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20992 @itemx show mipsfpu
20993 @kindex set mipsfpu
20994 @kindex show mipsfpu
20995 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20996 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20997 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20998 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20999 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21000 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21001 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21002 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21003 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21004 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21005 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21006 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21007 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21008
21009 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21010 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21011 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21012
21013 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21014 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21015
21016 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21017 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21018 @itemx show timeout
21019 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21020 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21021 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21022 @kindex set timeout
21023 @kindex show timeout
21024 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21025 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21026 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21027 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21028 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21029 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21030 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21031 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21032 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21033 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21034
21035 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21036 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21037 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21038 to run before stopping.
21039
21040 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21041 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21042 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21043 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21044 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21045 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21046
21047 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21048 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21049 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21050 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21051
21052 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21053 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21054 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21055 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21056 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21057 @table @asis
21058 @item pmon target
21059 @samp{PMON}
21060 @item ddb target
21061 @samp{NEC010}
21062 @item lsi target
21063 @samp{PMON>}
21064 @end table
21065
21066 @item show monitor-prompt
21067 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21068 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21069 remote monitor.
21070
21071 @item set monitor-warnings
21072 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21073 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21074 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21075 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21076 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21077
21078 @item show monitor-warnings
21079 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21080 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21081
21082 @item pmon @var{command}
21083 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21084 @cindex send PMON command
21085 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21086 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21087 @end table
21088
21089 @node PowerPC Embedded
21090 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21091
21092 @cindex DVC register
21093 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21094 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21095
21096 @smallexample
21097 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21098 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21099 @end smallexample
21100
21101 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21102 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21103 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21104 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21105 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21106 or newer.
21107
21108 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21109 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21110 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21111 watching variables of scalar types.
21112
21113 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21114 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21115
21116 @smallexample
21117 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21118 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21119 @end smallexample
21120
21121 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21122 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21123
21124 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21125 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21126 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21127 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21128 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21129 use the @code{break-range} command.
21130
21131 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21132
21133 @table @code
21134 @kindex break-range
21135 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21136 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21137 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21138 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21139 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21140 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21141 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21142 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21143 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21144
21145 @kindex set powerpc
21146 @item set powerpc soft-float
21147 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21148 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21149 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21150 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21151
21152 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21153 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21154 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21155 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21156 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21157 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21158 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21159 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21160
21161 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21162 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21163 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21164 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21165 address of its first byte.
21166
21167 @kindex target dink32
21168 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21169 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21170
21171 @kindex target ppcbug
21172 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21173 @kindex target ppcbug1
21174 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21175 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21176
21177 @kindex target sds
21178 @item target sds @var{dev}
21179 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21180 @end table
21181
21182 @cindex SDS protocol
21183 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21184 by @value{GDBN}:
21185
21186 @table @code
21187 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21188 @kindex set sdstimeout
21189 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21190 default is 2 seconds.
21191
21192 @item show sdstimeout
21193 @kindex show sdstimeout
21194 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21195
21196 @item sds @var{command}
21197 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21198 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21199 @end table
21200
21201
21202 @node PA
21203 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21204
21205 @table @code
21206
21207 @kindex target op50n
21208 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21209 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21210
21211 @kindex target w89k
21212 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21213 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21214
21215 @end table
21216
21217 @node Sparclet
21218 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21219
21220 @cindex Sparclet
21221
21222 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21223 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21224 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21225 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21226 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21227
21228 @table @code
21229 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21230 @kindex remotetimeout
21231 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21232 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21233 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21234 @end table
21235
21236 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21237 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21238 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21239 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21240 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21241
21242 @smallexample
21243 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21244 @end smallexample
21245
21246 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21247
21248 @smallexample
21249 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21250 @end smallexample
21251
21252 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21253 Once you have set
21254 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21255 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21256 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21257
21258 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21259
21260 @smallexample
21261 (gdbslet)
21262 @end smallexample
21263
21264 @menu
21265 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21266 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21267 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21268 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21269 @end menu
21270
21271 @node Sparclet File
21272 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21273
21274 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21275
21276 @smallexample
21277 (gdbslet) file prog
21278 @end smallexample
21279
21280 @need 1000
21281 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21282 @value{GDBN} locates
21283 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21284 path.
21285 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21286 files will be searched as well.
21287 @value{GDBN} locates
21288 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21289 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21290 If it fails
21291 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21292
21293 @smallexample
21294 prog: No such file or directory.
21295 @end smallexample
21296
21297 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21298 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21299 @code{target} command again.
21300
21301 @node Sparclet Connection
21302 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21303
21304 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21305 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21306
21307 @smallexample
21308 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21309 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21310 main () at ../prog.c:3
21311 @end smallexample
21312
21313 @need 750
21314 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21315
21316 @smallexample
21317 Connected to ttya.
21318 @end smallexample
21319
21320 @node Sparclet Download
21321 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21322
21323 @cindex download to Sparclet
21324 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21325 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21326 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21327 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21328 command.
21329 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21330 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21331 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21332 of each of the file's sections.
21333 For instance, if the program
21334 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21335 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21336
21337 @smallexample
21338 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21339 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21340 @end smallexample
21341
21342 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21343 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21344 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21345
21346 @node Sparclet Execution
21347 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21348
21349 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21350 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21351 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21352 manual for the list of commands.
21353
21354 @smallexample
21355 (gdbslet) b main
21356 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21357 (gdbslet) run
21358 Starting program: prog
21359 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21360 3 char *symarg = 0;
21361 (gdbslet) step
21362 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21363 (gdbslet)
21364 @end smallexample
21365
21366 @node Sparclite
21367 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21368
21369 @table @code
21370
21371 @kindex target sparclite
21372 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21373 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21374 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21375 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21376 remote protocol.
21377
21378 @end table
21379
21380 @node Z8000
21381 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21382
21383 @cindex Z8000
21384 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21385 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21386
21387 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21388 a Z8000 simulator.
21389
21390 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21391 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21392 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21393 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21394
21395 @table @code
21396 @item target sim @var{args}
21397 @kindex sim
21398 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21399 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21400 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21401 @end table
21402
21403 @noindent
21404 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21405 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21406 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21407 to run your program, and so on.
21408
21409 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21410 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21411 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21412
21413 @table @code
21414
21415 @item cycles
21416 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21417
21418 @item insts
21419 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21420
21421 @item time
21422 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21423
21424 @end table
21425
21426 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21427 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21428 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21429 simulated clock ticks.
21430
21431 @node AVR
21432 @subsection Atmel AVR
21433 @cindex AVR
21434
21435 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21436 following AVR-specific commands:
21437
21438 @table @code
21439 @item info io_registers
21440 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21441 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21442 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21443 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21444 @end table
21445
21446 @node CRIS
21447 @subsection CRIS
21448 @cindex CRIS
21449
21450 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21451 following CRIS-specific commands:
21452
21453 @table @code
21454 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21455 @cindex CRIS version
21456 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21457 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21458 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21459
21460 @item show cris-version
21461 Show the current CRIS version.
21462
21463 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21464 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21465 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21466 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21467 @code{R59}.
21468
21469 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21470 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21471
21472 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21473 @cindex CRIS mode
21474 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21475 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21476 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21477
21478 @item show cris-mode
21479 Show the current CRIS mode.
21480 @end table
21481
21482 @node Super-H
21483 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21484 @cindex Super-H
21485
21486 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21487 commands:
21488
21489 @table @code
21490 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21491 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21492 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21493 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21494 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21495 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21496 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21497 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21498 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21499 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21500 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21501 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21502
21503 @item show sh calling-convention
21504 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21505 Show the current calling convention setting.
21506
21507 @end table
21508
21509
21510 @node Architectures
21511 @section Architectures
21512
21513 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21514 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21515
21516 @menu
21517 * AArch64::
21518 * i386::
21519 * Alpha::
21520 * MIPS::
21521 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21522 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21523 * PowerPC::
21524 * Nios II::
21525 @end menu
21526
21527 @node AArch64
21528 @subsection AArch64
21529 @cindex AArch64 support
21530
21531 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21532 following special commands:
21533
21534 @table @code
21535 @item set debug aarch64
21536 @kindex set debug aarch64
21537 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21538 messages are to be displayed.
21539
21540 @item show debug aarch64
21541 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21542
21543 @end table
21544
21545 @node i386
21546 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21547
21548 @table @code
21549 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21550 @kindex set struct-convention
21551 @cindex struct return convention
21552 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21553 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21554 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21555 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21556 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21557 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21558 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21559 be returned in a register.
21560
21561 @item show struct-convention
21562 @kindex show struct-convention
21563 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21564 from functions.
21565 @end table
21566
21567 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21568 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21569
21570 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21571 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21572 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21573 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21574 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21575 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21576 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21577
21578 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21579 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21580 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21581 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21582 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21583 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21584
21585 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21586 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21587 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21588
21589 @smallexample
21590 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21591 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21592 @end smallexample
21593
21594 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21595 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21596 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21597 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21598 the pointer.
21599
21600 @node Alpha
21601 @subsection Alpha
21602
21603 See the following section.
21604
21605 @node MIPS
21606 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21607
21608 @cindex stack on Alpha
21609 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21610 @cindex Alpha stack
21611 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21612 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21613 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21614 find the beginning of a function.
21615
21616 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21617 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21618 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21619 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21620 commands:
21621
21622 @table @code
21623 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21624 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21625 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21626 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21627 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21628 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21629 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21630 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21631
21632 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21633 Display the current limit.
21634 @end table
21635
21636 @noindent
21637 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21638 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21639
21640 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21641 programs:
21642
21643 @table @code
21644 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21645 @kindex set mips abi
21646 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21647 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21648 values of @var{arg} are:
21649
21650 @table @samp
21651 @item auto
21652 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21653 default).
21654 @item o32
21655 @item o64
21656 @item n32
21657 @item n64
21658 @item eabi32
21659 @item eabi64
21660 @end table
21661
21662 @item show mips abi
21663 @kindex show mips abi
21664 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21665
21666 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21667 @kindex set mips compression
21668 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21669 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21670 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21671 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21672 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21673 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21674 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21675 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21676 provided by the executable.
21677
21678 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21679 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21680 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21681 identified as such.
21682
21683 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21684 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21685 implicitly from an executable.
21686
21687 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21688 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21689 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21690 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21691 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21692
21693 @item show mips compression
21694 @kindex show mips compression
21695 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21696 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21697
21698 @item set mipsfpu
21699 @itemx show mipsfpu
21700 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21701
21702 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21703 @kindex set mips mask-address
21704 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21705 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21706 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21707 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21708 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21709
21710 @item show mips mask-address
21711 @kindex show mips mask-address
21712 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21713 not.
21714
21715 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21716 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21717 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21718 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21719 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21720 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21721
21722 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21723 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21724 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21725
21726 @item set debug mips
21727 @kindex set debug mips
21728 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21729 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21730
21731 @item show debug mips
21732 @kindex show debug mips
21733 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21734 @end table
21735
21736
21737 @node HPPA
21738 @subsection HPPA
21739 @cindex HPPA support
21740
21741 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21742 following special commands:
21743
21744 @table @code
21745 @item set debug hppa
21746 @kindex set debug hppa
21747 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21748 messages are to be displayed.
21749
21750 @item show debug hppa
21751 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21752
21753 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21754 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21755 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21756 given @var{address}.
21757
21758 @end table
21759
21760
21761 @node SPU
21762 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21763 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21764 @cindex SPU
21765
21766 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21767 it provides the following special commands:
21768
21769 @table @code
21770 @item info spu event
21771 @kindex info spu
21772 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21773 and pending event status.
21774
21775 @item info spu signal
21776 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21777 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21778 notification channels.
21779
21780 @item info spu mailbox
21781 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21782 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21783 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21784
21785 @item info spu dma
21786 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21787 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21788 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21789
21790 @item info spu proxydma
21791 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21792 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21793 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21794
21795 @end table
21796
21797 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21798 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21799 special commands:
21800
21801 @table @code
21802 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21803 @kindex set spu
21804 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21805 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21806 function. The default is @code{off}.
21807
21808 @item show spu stop-on-load
21809 @kindex show spu
21810 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21811
21812 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21813 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21814 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21815 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21816 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21817 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21818
21819 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21820 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21821
21822 @end table
21823
21824 @node PowerPC
21825 @subsection PowerPC
21826 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21827
21828 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21829 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21830 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21831 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21832 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21833
21834 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21835 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21836 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21837
21838 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21839 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21840
21841 @node Nios II
21842 @subsection Nios II
21843 @cindex Nios II architecture
21844
21845 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21846 it provides the following special commands:
21847
21848 @table @code
21849
21850 @item set debug nios2
21851 @kindex set debug nios2
21852 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21853 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21854
21855 @item show debug nios2
21856 @kindex show debug nios2
21857 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21858 @end table
21859
21860 @node Controlling GDB
21861 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21862
21863 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21864 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21865 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21866 described here.
21867
21868 @menu
21869 * Prompt:: Prompt
21870 * Editing:: Command editing
21871 * Command History:: Command history
21872 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21873 * Numbers:: Numbers
21874 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21875 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21876 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21877 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21878 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21879 @end menu
21880
21881 @node Prompt
21882 @section Prompt
21883
21884 @cindex prompt
21885
21886 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21887 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21888 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21889 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21890 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21891 which one you are talking to.
21892
21893 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21894 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21895 or a prompt that does not.
21896
21897 @table @code
21898 @kindex set prompt
21899 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21900 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21901
21902 @kindex show prompt
21903 @item show prompt
21904 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21905 @end table
21906
21907 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21908 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21909 are:
21910
21911 @table @code
21912 @kindex set extended-prompt
21913 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21914 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21915 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21916 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21917 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21918 is displayed.
21919
21920 For example:
21921
21922 @smallexample
21923 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21924 @end smallexample
21925
21926 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21927 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21928
21929 @kindex show extended-prompt
21930 @item show extended-prompt
21931 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21932 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21933 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21934 @end table
21935
21936 @node Editing
21937 @section Command Editing
21938 @cindex readline
21939 @cindex command line editing
21940
21941 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21942 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21943 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21944 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21945 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21946 debugging sessions.
21947
21948 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21949 command @code{set}.
21950
21951 @table @code
21952 @kindex set editing
21953 @cindex editing
21954 @item set editing
21955 @itemx set editing on
21956 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21957
21958 @item set editing off
21959 Disable command line editing.
21960
21961 @kindex show editing
21962 @item show editing
21963 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21964 @end table
21965
21966 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21967 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21968 @end ifset
21969 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21970 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21971 @end ifclear
21972 for more details about the Readline
21973 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21974 encouraged to read that chapter.
21975
21976 @node Command History
21977 @section Command History
21978 @cindex command history
21979
21980 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21981 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21982 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21983 history facility.
21984
21985 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21986 package, to provide the history facility.
21987 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21988 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21989 @end ifset
21990 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21991 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21992 @end ifclear
21993 for the detailed description of the History library.
21994
21995 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21996 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21997 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21998 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21999 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22000 pressed on a line by itself.
22001
22002 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22003 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22004 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22005 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22006
22007 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22008 history.
22009
22010 @table @code
22011 @cindex history substitution
22012 @cindex history file
22013 @kindex set history filename
22014 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22015 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22016 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22017 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22018 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22019 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22020 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22021 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22022 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22023 is not set.
22024
22025 @cindex save command history
22026 @kindex set history save
22027 @item set history save
22028 @itemx set history save on
22029 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22030 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22031
22032 @item set history save off
22033 Stop recording command history in a file.
22034
22035 @cindex history size
22036 @kindex set history size
22037 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22038 @item set history size @var{size}
22039 @itemx set history size unlimited
22040 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22041 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22042 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22043 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22044 history list is unlimited.
22045 @end table
22046
22047 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22048 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22049 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22050 @end ifset
22051 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22052 @xref{Event Designators},
22053 @end ifclear
22054 for more details.
22055
22056 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22057 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22058 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22059 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22060 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22061 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22062 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22063 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22064
22065 The commands to control history expansion are:
22066
22067 @table @code
22068 @item set history expansion on
22069 @itemx set history expansion
22070 @kindex set history expansion
22071 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22072
22073 @item set history expansion off
22074 Disable history expansion.
22075
22076 @c @group
22077 @kindex show history
22078 @item show history
22079 @itemx show history filename
22080 @itemx show history save
22081 @itemx show history size
22082 @itemx show history expansion
22083 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22084 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22085 @c @end group
22086 @end table
22087
22088 @table @code
22089 @kindex show commands
22090 @cindex show last commands
22091 @cindex display command history
22092 @item show commands
22093 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22094
22095 @item show commands @var{n}
22096 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22097
22098 @item show commands +
22099 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22100 @end table
22101
22102 @node Screen Size
22103 @section Screen Size
22104 @cindex size of screen
22105 @cindex pauses in output
22106
22107 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22108 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22109 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22110 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22111 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22112 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22113 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22114 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22115
22116 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22117 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22118 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22119 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22120 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22121 width} commands:
22122
22123 @table @code
22124 @kindex set height
22125 @kindex set width
22126 @kindex show width
22127 @kindex show height
22128 @item set height @var{lpp}
22129 @itemx set height unlimited
22130 @itemx show height
22131 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22132 @itemx set width unlimited
22133 @itemx show width
22134 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22135 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22136 commands display the current settings.
22137
22138 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22139 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22140 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22141 buffer.
22142
22143 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22144 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22145
22146 @item set pagination on
22147 @itemx set pagination off
22148 @kindex set pagination
22149 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22150 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22151 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22152 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22153
22154 @item show pagination
22155 @kindex show pagination
22156 Show the current pagination mode.
22157 @end table
22158
22159 @node Numbers
22160 @section Numbers
22161 @cindex number representation
22162 @cindex entering numbers
22163
22164 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22165 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22166 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22167 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22168 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22169 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22170 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22171 both input and output with the commands described below.
22172
22173 @table @code
22174 @kindex set input-radix
22175 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22176 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22177 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22178 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22179 example, any of
22180
22181 @smallexample
22182 set input-radix 012
22183 set input-radix 10.
22184 set input-radix 0xa
22185 @end smallexample
22186
22187 @noindent
22188 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22189 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22190 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22191 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22192 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22193 change the radix.
22194
22195 @kindex set output-radix
22196 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22197 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22198 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22199 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22200
22201 @kindex show input-radix
22202 @item show input-radix
22203 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22204
22205 @kindex show output-radix
22206 @item show output-radix
22207 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22208
22209 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22210 @itemx show radix
22211 @kindex set radix
22212 @kindex show radix
22213 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22214 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22215 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22216 default value of 10.
22217
22218 @end table
22219
22220 @node ABI
22221 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22222
22223 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22224 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22225 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22226 current ABI.
22227
22228 @cindex OS ABI
22229 @kindex set osabi
22230 @kindex show osabi
22231 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22232
22233 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22234 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22235 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22236 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22237 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22238 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22239 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22240 platform provides.
22241
22242 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22243 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22244 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22245 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22246
22247 @table @code
22248 @item show osabi
22249 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22250
22251 @item set osabi
22252 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22253
22254 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22255 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22256 @end table
22257
22258 @cindex float promotion
22259
22260 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22261 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22262 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22263 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22264 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22265 @code{double} and then passed.
22266
22267 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22268 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22269 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22270
22271 @table @code
22272 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22273 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22274 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22275 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22276 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22277
22278 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22279 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22280 functions.
22281
22282 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22283 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22284 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22285 @end table
22286
22287 @kindex set cp-abi
22288 @kindex show cp-abi
22289 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22290 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22291 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22292 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22293 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22294 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22295 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22296 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22297 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22298 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22299 ``auto''.
22300
22301 @table @code
22302 @item show cp-abi
22303 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22304
22305 @item set cp-abi
22306 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22307
22308 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22309 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22310 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22311 @end table
22312
22313 @node Auto-loading
22314 @section Automatically loading associated files
22315 @cindex auto-loading
22316
22317 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22318 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22319 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22320 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22321 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22322 sources).
22323
22324 @menu
22325 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22326 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22327
22328 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22329 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22330 @end menu
22331
22332 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22333 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22334 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22335
22336 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22337 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22338 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22339
22340 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22341 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22342
22343 @table @code
22344 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22345 @kindex set auto-load off
22346 @item set auto-load off
22347 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22348 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22349 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22350 @smallexample
22351 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22352 @end smallexample
22353
22354 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22355 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22356 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22357 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22358 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22359 @code{set auto-load no}.
22360
22361 @anchor{show auto-load}
22362 @kindex show auto-load
22363 @item show auto-load
22364 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22365 or disabled.
22366
22367 @smallexample
22368 (gdb) show auto-load
22369 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22370 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22371 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22372 is on.
22373 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22374 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22375 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22376 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22377 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22378 @end smallexample
22379
22380 @anchor{info auto-load}
22381 @kindex info auto-load
22382 @item info auto-load
22383 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22384 not.
22385
22386 @smallexample
22387 (gdb) info auto-load
22388 gdb-scripts:
22389 Loaded Script
22390 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22391 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22392 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22393 loaded.
22394 python-scripts:
22395 Loaded Script
22396 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22397 @end smallexample
22398 @end table
22399
22400 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22401
22402 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22403 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22404 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22405 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22406 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22407 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22408 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22409 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22410 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22411 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22412 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22413 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22414 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22415 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22416 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22417 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22418 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22419 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22420 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22421 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22422 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22423 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22424 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22425 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22426 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22427 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22428 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22429 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22430 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22431 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22432 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22433 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22434 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22435 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22436 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22437 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22438 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22439 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22440 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22441 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22442 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22443 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22444 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22445 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22446 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22447 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22448 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22449 @end multitable
22450
22451 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22452 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22453 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22454
22455 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22456 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22457 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22458
22459 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22460 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22461
22462 @table @code
22463 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22464 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22465 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22466 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22467 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22468
22469 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22470 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22471 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22472 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22473 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22474
22475 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22476 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22477 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22478 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22479 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22480 @end table
22481
22482 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22483 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22484 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22485
22486 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22487
22488 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22489 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22490
22491 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22492 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22493 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22494 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22495 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22496 library.
22497
22498 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22499 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22500
22501 @table @code
22502 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22503 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22504 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22505 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22506
22507 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22508 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22509 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22510 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22511 enabled or disabled.
22512
22513 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22514 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22515 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22516 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22517 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22518 @end table
22519
22520 @node Auto-loading safe path
22521 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22522 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22523
22524 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22525 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22526 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22527 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22528 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22529
22530 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22531 get loaded:
22532
22533 @smallexample
22534 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22535 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22536 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22537 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22538 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22539 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22540 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22541 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22542 @end smallexample
22543
22544 @noindent
22545 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22546 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22547
22548 @smallexample
22549 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22550 @end smallexample
22551
22552 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22553
22554 @table @code
22555 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22556 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22557 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22558 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22559 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22560 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22561 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22562 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22563 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22564 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22565
22566 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22567 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22568 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22569
22570 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22571 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22572 @item show auto-load safe-path
22573 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22574 scripts.
22575
22576 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22577 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22578 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22579 Add an entry (or list of entries) the list of directories trusted for automatic
22580 loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited by the
22581 host platform path separator in use.
22582 @end table
22583
22584 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22585 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22586 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22587 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22588 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22589
22590 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22591 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22592 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22593 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22594 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22595 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22596 init file in the current directory
22597 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22598
22599 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22600 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22601
22602 @table @asis
22603 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22604 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22605 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22606 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22607
22608 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22609 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22610 @value{GDBN} session.
22611
22612 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22613 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22614 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22615 from trusted sources.
22616
22617 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22618 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22619 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22620 trusted sources.
22621 @end table
22622
22623 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22624 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22625
22626 @table @asis
22627 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22628 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22629
22630 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22631 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22632 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22633 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22634 @end table
22635
22636 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22637 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22638 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22639 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22640 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22641 recommended to be entered.
22642
22643 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22644 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22645 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22646
22647 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22648 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22649 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22650 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22651 be printed.
22652
22653 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22654 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22655 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22656
22657 @smallexample
22658 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22659 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22660 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22661 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22662 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22663 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22664 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22665 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22666 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22667 @end smallexample
22668
22669 @table @code
22670 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22671 @kindex set debug auto-load
22672 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22673 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22674
22675 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22676 @kindex show debug auto-load
22677 @item show debug auto-load
22678 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22679 on or off.
22680 @end table
22681
22682 @node Messages/Warnings
22683 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22684
22685 @cindex verbose operation
22686 @cindex optional warnings
22687 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22688 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22689 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22690 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22691
22692 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22693 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22694 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22695
22696 @table @code
22697 @kindex set verbose
22698 @item set verbose on
22699 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22700
22701 @item set verbose off
22702 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22703
22704 @kindex show verbose
22705 @item show verbose
22706 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22707 @end table
22708
22709 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22710 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22711 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22712 Symbol Files}).
22713
22714 @table @code
22715
22716 @kindex set complaints
22717 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22718 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22719 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22720 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22721 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22722
22723 @kindex show complaints
22724 @item show complaints
22725 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22726
22727 @end table
22728
22729 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22730 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22731 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22732 you try to run a program which is already running:
22733
22734 @smallexample
22735 (@value{GDBP}) run
22736 The program being debugged has been started already.
22737 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22738 @end smallexample
22739
22740 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22741 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22742
22743 @table @code
22744
22745 @kindex set confirm
22746 @cindex flinching
22747 @cindex confirmation
22748 @cindex stupid questions
22749 @item set confirm off
22750 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22751 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22752 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22753
22754 @item set confirm on
22755 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22756
22757 @kindex show confirm
22758 @item show confirm
22759 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22760
22761 @end table
22762
22763 @cindex command tracing
22764 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22765 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22766 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22767 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22768
22769 @table @code
22770 @kindex set trace-commands
22771 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22772 @item set trace-commands on
22773 Enable command tracing.
22774 @item set trace-commands off
22775 Disable command tracing.
22776 @item show trace-commands
22777 Display the current state of command tracing.
22778 @end table
22779
22780 @node Debugging Output
22781 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22782 @cindex optional debugging messages
22783
22784 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22785 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22786 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22787 section documents those commands.
22788
22789 @table @code
22790 @kindex set exec-done-display
22791 @item set exec-done-display
22792 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22793 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22794 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22795 @kindex show exec-done-display
22796 @item show exec-done-display
22797 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22798 notification.
22799 @kindex set debug
22800 @cindex ARM AArch64
22801 @item set debug aarch64
22802 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22803 The default is off.
22804 @kindex show debug
22805 @item show debug aarch64
22806 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22807 ARM AArch64.
22808 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22809 @cindex architecture debugging info
22810 @item set debug arch
22811 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22812 @item show debug arch
22813 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22814 @item set debug aix-solib
22815 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22816 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22817 support module. The default is off.
22818 @item show debug aix-thread
22819 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22820 @item set debug aix-thread
22821 @cindex AIX threads
22822 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22823 module.
22824 @item show debug aix-thread
22825 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22826 @item set debug check-physname
22827 @cindex physname
22828 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22829 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22830 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22831 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22832 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22833 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22834 @item show debug check-physname
22835 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22836 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22837 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22838 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22839 exported symbols. The default is off.
22840 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22841 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22842 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22843 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22844 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22845 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22846 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22847 A value of zero turns off the display.
22848 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22849 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22850 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22851 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22852 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22853 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22854 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22855 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22856 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22857 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22858 @item set debug displaced
22859 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22860 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22861 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22862 @item show debug displaced
22863 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22864 related to displaced stepping.
22865 @item set debug event
22866 @cindex event debugging info
22867 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22868 default is off.
22869 @item show debug event
22870 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22871 info.
22872 @item set debug expression
22873 @cindex expression debugging info
22874 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22875 expression parsing. The default is off.
22876 @item show debug expression
22877 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22878 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22879 @item set debug frame
22880 @cindex frame debugging info
22881 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22882 default is off.
22883 @item show debug frame
22884 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22885 info.
22886 @item set debug gnu-nat
22887 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22888 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22889 @item show debug gnu-nat
22890 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22891 @item set debug infrun
22892 @cindex inferior debugging info
22893 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22894 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22895 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22896 @item show debug infrun
22897 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22898 @item set debug jit
22899 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22900 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22901 @item show debug jit
22902 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22903 @item set debug lin-lwp
22904 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22905 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22906 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22907 @item show debug lin-lwp
22908 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22909 @item set debug mach-o
22910 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22911 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22912 processing. The default is off.
22913 @item show debug mach-o
22914 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22915 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22916 @item set debug notification
22917 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22918 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22919 The default is off.
22920 @item show debug notification
22921 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22922 @item set debug observer
22923 @cindex observer debugging info
22924 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22925 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22926 @item show debug observer
22927 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22928 @item set debug overload
22929 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22930 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22931 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22932 is off.
22933 @item show debug overload
22934 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22935 debugging info.
22936 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22937 @cindex debug expression parser
22938 @item set debug parser
22939 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22940 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22941 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22942 details. The default is off.
22943 @item show debug parser
22944 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22945 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22946 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22947 @cindex debug remote protocol
22948 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22949 @cindex display remote packets
22950 @item set debug remote
22951 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22952 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22953 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22954 @item show debug remote
22955 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22956 @item set debug serial
22957 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22958 default is off.
22959 @item show debug serial
22960 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22961 info.
22962 @item set debug solib-frv
22963 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22964 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22965 @item show debug solib-frv
22966 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22967 messages.
22968 @item set debug symfile
22969 @cindex symbol file functions
22970 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22971 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22972 @item show debug symfile
22973 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22974 @item set debug symtab-create
22975 @cindex symbol table creation
22976 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22977 The default is 0 (off).
22978 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22979 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22980 @item show debug symtab-create
22981 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22982 @item set debug target
22983 @cindex target debugging info
22984 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22985 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22986 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22987 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
22988 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
22989 @item show debug target
22990 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22991 info.
22992 @item set debug timestamp
22993 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22994 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22995 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22996 message.
22997 @item show debug timestamp
22998 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22999 debugging info.
23000 @item set debug varobj
23001 @cindex variable object debugging info
23002 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23003 info. The default is off.
23004 @item show debug varobj
23005 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23006 debugging info.
23007 @item set debug xml
23008 @cindex XML parser debugging
23009 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23010 @item show debug xml
23011 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23012 @end table
23013
23014 @node Other Misc Settings
23015 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23016 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23017
23018 @table @code
23019 @kindex set interactive-mode
23020 @item set interactive-mode
23021 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23022 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23023 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23024 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23025 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23026 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23027 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23028 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23029
23030 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23031 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23032 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23033 inside a cygwin window.
23034
23035 @kindex show interactive-mode
23036 @item show interactive-mode
23037 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23038 @end table
23039
23040 @node Extending GDB
23041 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23042 @cindex extending GDB
23043
23044 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23045 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23046 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23047 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23048 being debugged.
23049
23050 @menu
23051 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23052 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23053 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23054 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23055 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23056 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23057 @end menu
23058
23059 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23060 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23061 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23062 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23063 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23064 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23065
23066 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23067 setting:
23068
23069 @table @code
23070 @kindex set script-extension
23071 @kindex show script-extension
23072 @item set script-extension off
23073 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23074
23075 @item set script-extension soft
23076 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23077 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23078 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23079 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23080
23081 @item set script-extension strict
23082 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23083 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23084 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23085
23086 @item show script-extension
23087 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23088
23089 @end table
23090
23091 @node Sequences
23092 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23093
23094 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23095 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23096 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23097 files.
23098
23099 @menu
23100 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23101 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23102 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23103 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23104 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23105 @end menu
23106
23107 @node Define
23108 @subsection User-defined Commands
23109
23110 @cindex user-defined command
23111 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23112 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23113 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23114 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23115 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23116 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23117
23118 @smallexample
23119 define adder
23120 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23121 end
23122 @end smallexample
23123
23124 @noindent
23125 To execute the command use:
23126
23127 @smallexample
23128 adder 1 2 3
23129 @end smallexample
23130
23131 @noindent
23132 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23133 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23134 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23135 functions calls.
23136
23137 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23138 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23139 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23140 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23141
23142 @smallexample
23143 define adder
23144 if $argc == 2
23145 print $arg0 + $arg1
23146 end
23147 if $argc == 3
23148 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23149 end
23150 end
23151 @end smallexample
23152
23153 @table @code
23154
23155 @kindex define
23156 @item define @var{commandname}
23157 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23158 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23159 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23160 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23161 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23162 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23163
23164 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23165 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23166 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23167
23168 @kindex document
23169 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23170 @item document @var{commandname}
23171 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23172 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23173 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23174 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23175 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23176 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23177
23178 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23179 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23180 does not change the documentation.
23181
23182 @kindex dont-repeat
23183 @cindex don't repeat command
23184 @item dont-repeat
23185 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23186 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23187 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23188
23189 @kindex help user-defined
23190 @item help user-defined
23191 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23192 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23193 included (if any).
23194
23195 @kindex show user
23196 @item show user
23197 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23198 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23199 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23200 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23201 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23202
23203 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23204 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23205 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23206 @item show max-user-call-depth
23207 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23208 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23209 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23210 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23211 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23212 @end table
23213
23214 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23215 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23216
23217 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23218 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23219 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23220
23221 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23222 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23223 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23224 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23225
23226 @node Hooks
23227 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23228 @cindex command hooks
23229 @cindex hooks, for commands
23230 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23231
23232 @kindex hook
23233 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23234 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23235 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23236 before that command.
23237
23238 @cindex hooks, post-command
23239 @kindex hookpost
23240 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23241 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23242 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23243 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23244 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23245
23246 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23247 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23248
23249 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23250 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23251
23252 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23253 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23254 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23255 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23256 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23257
23258 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23259 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23260 you could define:
23261
23262 @smallexample
23263 define hook-stop
23264 handle SIGALRM nopass
23265 end
23266
23267 define hook-run
23268 handle SIGALRM pass
23269 end
23270
23271 define hook-continue
23272 handle SIGALRM pass
23273 end
23274 @end smallexample
23275
23276 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23277 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23278 you could define:
23279
23280 @smallexample
23281 define hook-echo
23282 echo <<<---
23283 end
23284
23285 define hookpost-echo
23286 echo --->>>\n
23287 end
23288
23289 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23290 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23291 (@value{GDBP})
23292
23293 @end smallexample
23294
23295 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23296 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23297 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23298 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23299 @c or not?
23300 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23301 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23302 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23303
23304 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23305 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23306 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23307
23308 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23309 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23310
23311 @node Command Files
23312 @subsection Command Files
23313
23314 @cindex command files
23315 @cindex scripting commands
23316 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23317 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23318 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23319 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23320 terminal.
23321
23322 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23323 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23324 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23325 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23326 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23327
23328 @table @code
23329 @kindex source
23330 @cindex execute commands from a file
23331 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23332 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23333 @end table
23334
23335 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23336 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23337 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23338 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23339 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23340
23341 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23342 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23343 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23344 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23345 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23346 is not relevant to scripts.
23347
23348 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23349 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23350 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23351 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23352 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23353 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23354 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23355 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23356 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23357 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23358 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23359 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23360 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23361 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23362
23363 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23364 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23365 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23366
23367 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23368 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23369 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23370 when called from command files.
23371
23372 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23373 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23374 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23375 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23376 the next command.
23377
23378 @smallexample
23379 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23380 @end smallexample
23381
23382 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23383 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23384 would be directed to @file{log}.
23385
23386 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23387 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23388 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23389 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23390 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23391 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23392 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23393 conditionally, etc.
23394
23395 @table @code
23396 @kindex if
23397 @kindex else
23398 @item if
23399 @itemx else
23400 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23401 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23402 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23403 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23404 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23405 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23406 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23407
23408 @kindex while
23409 @item while
23410 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23411 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23412 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23413 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23414 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23415 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23416
23417 @kindex loop_break
23418 @item loop_break
23419 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23420 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23421 line.
23422
23423 @kindex loop_continue
23424 @item loop_continue
23425 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23426 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23427 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23428 the controlling expression.
23429
23430 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23431 @item end
23432 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23433 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23434 @end table
23435
23436
23437 @node Output
23438 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23439
23440 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23441 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23442 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23443 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23444 want.
23445
23446 @table @code
23447 @kindex echo
23448 @item echo @var{text}
23449 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23450 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23451 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23452 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23453 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23454 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23455 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23456 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23457 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23458 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23459 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23460
23461 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23462 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23463
23464 @smallexample
23465 echo This is some text\n\
23466 which is continued\n\
23467 onto several lines.\n
23468 @end smallexample
23469
23470 produces the same output as
23471
23472 @smallexample
23473 echo This is some text\n
23474 echo which is continued\n
23475 echo onto several lines.\n
23476 @end smallexample
23477
23478 @kindex output
23479 @item output @var{expression}
23480 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23481 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23482 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23483 on expressions.
23484
23485 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23486 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23487 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23488 Formats}, for more information.
23489
23490 @kindex printf
23491 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23492 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23493 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23494 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23495 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23496 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23497 executing the code below:
23498
23499 @smallexample
23500 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23501 @end smallexample
23502
23503 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23504 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23505 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23506 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23507 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23508 printed.
23509
23510 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23511
23512 @smallexample
23513 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23514 @end smallexample
23515
23516 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23517 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23518 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23519
23520 @itemize @bullet
23521 @item
23522 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23523
23524 @item
23525 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23526 width.
23527
23528 @item
23529 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23530 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23531
23532 @item
23533 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23534 supported.
23535
23536 @item
23537 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23538
23539 @item
23540 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23541 @end itemize
23542
23543 @noindent
23544 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23545 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23546 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23547 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23548
23549 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23550 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23551 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23552 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23553 supported.
23554
23555 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23556 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23557 together with a floating point specifier.
23558 letters:
23559
23560 @itemize @bullet
23561 @item
23562 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23563
23564 @item
23565 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23566
23567 @item
23568 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23569 @end itemize
23570
23571 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23572 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23573 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23574
23575 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23576 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23577
23578 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23579 @smallexample
23580 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23581 @end smallexample
23582
23583 @kindex eval
23584 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23585 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23586 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23587
23588 @end table
23589
23590 @node Auto-loading sequences
23591 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23592 @cindex native script auto-loading
23593
23594 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23595 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23596 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23597 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23598
23599 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23600 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23601
23602 @table @code
23603 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23604 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23605 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23606 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23607
23608 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23609 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23610 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23611 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23612 disabled.
23613
23614 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23615 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23616 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23617 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23618 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23619 auto-loaded.
23620 @end table
23621
23622 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23623 matching names are printed.
23624
23625 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23626 @include python.texi
23627
23628 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23629 @include guile.texi
23630
23631 @node Auto-loading extensions
23632 @section Auto-loading extensions
23633 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23634
23635 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23636 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23637 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23638 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23639 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23640
23641 @menu
23642 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23643 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23644 * Which flavor to choose?::
23645 @end menu
23646
23647 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23648 debugging commands and features.
23649
23650 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23651 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23652 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23653 for more information.
23654 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23655 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23656
23657 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23658 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23659
23660 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23661 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23662 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23663 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23664 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23665
23666 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23667 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23668 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23669 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23670
23671 @table @code
23672 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23673 GDB's own command language
23674 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23675 Python
23676 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23677 Guile
23678 @end table
23679
23680 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23681 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23682 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23683 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23684 script in the specified extension language.
23685
23686 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23687 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23688
23689 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23690 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23691
23692 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23693 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23694 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23695 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23696 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23697 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23698
23699 @table @code
23700 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23701 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23702 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23703 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23704 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23705 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23706
23707 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23708 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23709
23710 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23711 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23712 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23713 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23714
23715 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23716 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23717 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23718 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23719 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23720 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23721 platform.
23722
23723 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23724 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23725 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23726
23727 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23728 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23729 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23730 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23731 @end table
23732
23733 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23734 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23735 @var{objfile} is opened.
23736 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23737 is evaluated more than once.
23738
23739 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23740 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23741 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23742
23743 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23744 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23745 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23746 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23747 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23748 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23749
23750 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23751 current directory and then along the source search path
23752 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23753 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23754 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23755
23756 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23757 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23758
23759 @example
23760 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23761 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23762 asm("\
23763 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23764 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23765 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23766 .popsection \n\
23767 ");
23768 @end example
23769
23770 @noindent
23771 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23772 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23773
23774 @example
23775 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23776 @end example
23777
23778 The script name may include directories if desired.
23779
23780 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23781 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23782
23783 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23784 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23785 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23786 will remove duplicates.
23787
23788 @node Which flavor to choose?
23789 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23790
23791 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23792 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23793
23794 @noindent
23795 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23796
23797 @itemize @bullet
23798 @item
23799 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23800
23801 @item
23802 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23803
23804 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23805 in the source search path.
23806 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23807 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23808
23809 @item
23810 Doesn't require source code additions.
23811 @end itemize
23812
23813 @noindent
23814 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23815
23816 @itemize @bullet
23817 @item
23818 Works with static linking.
23819
23820 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23821 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23822 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23823 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23824 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23825
23826 @item
23827 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23828
23829 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23830 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23831
23832 @item
23833 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23834
23835 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23836 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23837 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23838 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23839 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23840 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23841 @end itemize
23842
23843 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23844 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23845
23846 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23847 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23848 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23849
23850 @subsection Python comes first
23851
23852 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23853 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23854 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23855 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23856 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23857 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23858 pretty-printed form of a value).
23859 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23860 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23861 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23862
23863 @node Aliases
23864 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23865 @cindex aliases for commands
23866
23867 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23868 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23869 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23870 that involves less typing.
23871
23872 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23873 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23874 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23875
23876 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23877 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23878 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23879
23880 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23881
23882 @table @code
23883
23884 @kindex alias
23885 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23886
23887 @end table
23888
23889 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23890 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23891 underscores.
23892
23893 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23894 that is being aliased.
23895
23896 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23897 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23898 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23899
23900 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23901 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23902
23903 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23904 of a command so that there is less to type.
23905 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23906 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23907 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23908 The following will accomplish this.
23909
23910 @smallexample
23911 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23912 @end smallexample
23913
23914 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23915 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23916 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23917 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23918
23919 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23920 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23921 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23922 of a command.
23923
23924 @smallexample
23925 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23926 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23927 (gdb) set p elms 20
23928 (gdb) show p elms
23929 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23930 @end smallexample
23931
23932 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23933 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23934 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23935
23936 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23937 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23938
23939 @smallexample
23940 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23941 @end smallexample
23942
23943 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23944 alias for a more complex command.
23945 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23946
23947 @smallexample
23948 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23949 (gdb) spe 20
23950 @end smallexample
23951
23952 @node Interpreters
23953 @chapter Command Interpreters
23954 @cindex command interpreters
23955
23956 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23957 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23958 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23959
23960 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23961 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23962 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23963 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23964
23965 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23966 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23967 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23968 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23969
23970 @table @code
23971 @item console
23972 @cindex console interpreter
23973 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23974 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23975 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23976
23977 @item mi
23978 @cindex mi interpreter
23979 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23980 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23981 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23982 Interface}.
23983
23984 @item mi2
23985 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23986 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23987
23988 @item mi1
23989 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23990 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23991
23992 @end table
23993
23994 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23995 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23996 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23997 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23998 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23999 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24000 the IDE inoperable!
24001
24002 @kindex interpreter-exec
24003 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24004 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24005 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24006 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24007
24008 @smallexample
24009 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24010 @end smallexample
24011
24012 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24013 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24014
24015 @node TUI
24016 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24017 @cindex TUI
24018 @cindex Text User Interface
24019
24020 @menu
24021 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24022 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24023 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24024 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24025 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24026 @end menu
24027
24028 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24029 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24030 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24031 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24032 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24033 is available.
24034
24035 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24036 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24037 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24038 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24039 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24040
24041 @node TUI Overview
24042 @section TUI Overview
24043
24044 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24045
24046 @table @emph
24047 @item command
24048 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24049 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24050 managed using readline.
24051
24052 @item source
24053 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24054 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24055
24056 @item assembly
24057 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24058
24059 @item register
24060 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24061 when their values change.
24062 @end table
24063
24064 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24065 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24066 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24067 indicates the breakpoint type:
24068
24069 @table @code
24070 @item B
24071 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24072
24073 @item b
24074 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24075
24076 @item H
24077 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24078
24079 @item h
24080 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24081 @end table
24082
24083 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24084
24085 @table @code
24086 @item +
24087 Breakpoint is enabled.
24088
24089 @item -
24090 Breakpoint is disabled.
24091 @end table
24092
24093 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24094 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24095 changes.
24096
24097 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24098 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24099 layouts:
24100
24101 @itemize @bullet
24102 @item
24103 source only,
24104
24105 @item
24106 assembly only,
24107
24108 @item
24109 source and assembly,
24110
24111 @item
24112 source and registers, or
24113
24114 @item
24115 assembly and registers.
24116 @end itemize
24117
24118 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24119
24120 @table @emph
24121 @item target
24122 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24123 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24124
24125 @item process
24126 Gives the current process or thread number.
24127 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24128
24129 @item function
24130 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24131 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24132 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24133 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24134
24135 @item line
24136 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24137 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24138
24139 @item pc
24140 Indicates the current program counter address.
24141 @end table
24142
24143 @node TUI Keys
24144 @section TUI Key Bindings
24145 @cindex TUI key bindings
24146
24147 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24148 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24149 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24150 @end ifset
24151 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24152 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24153 @end ifclear
24154 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24155 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24156
24157 @table @kbd
24158 @kindex C-x C-a
24159 @item C-x C-a
24160 @kindex C-x a
24161 @itemx C-x a
24162 @kindex C-x A
24163 @itemx C-x A
24164 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24165 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24166 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24167 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24168 The screen is then refreshed.
24169
24170 @kindex C-x 1
24171 @item C-x 1
24172 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24173 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24174 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24175
24176 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24177
24178 @kindex C-x 2
24179 @item C-x 2
24180 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24181 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24182 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24183 previous layout and the new one.
24184
24185 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24186
24187 @kindex C-x o
24188 @item C-x o
24189 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24190 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24191 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24192
24193 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24194
24195 @kindex C-x s
24196 @item C-x s
24197 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24198 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24199 @end table
24200
24201 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24202
24203 @table @asis
24204 @kindex PgUp
24205 @item @key{PgUp}
24206 Scroll the active window one page up.
24207
24208 @kindex PgDn
24209 @item @key{PgDn}
24210 Scroll the active window one page down.
24211
24212 @kindex Up
24213 @item @key{Up}
24214 Scroll the active window one line up.
24215
24216 @kindex Down
24217 @item @key{Down}
24218 Scroll the active window one line down.
24219
24220 @kindex Left
24221 @item @key{Left}
24222 Scroll the active window one column left.
24223
24224 @kindex Right
24225 @item @key{Right}
24226 Scroll the active window one column right.
24227
24228 @kindex C-L
24229 @item @kbd{C-L}
24230 Refresh the screen.
24231 @end table
24232
24233 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24234 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24235 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24236 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24237 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24238
24239 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24240 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24241 @cindex TUI single key mode
24242
24243 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24244 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24245 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24246
24247 @table @kbd
24248 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24249 @item c
24250 continue
24251
24252 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24253 @item d
24254 down
24255
24256 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24257 @item f
24258 finish
24259
24260 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24261 @item n
24262 next
24263
24264 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24265 @item q
24266 exit the SingleKey mode.
24267
24268 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24269 @item r
24270 run
24271
24272 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24273 @item s
24274 step
24275
24276 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24277 @item u
24278 up
24279
24280 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24281 @item v
24282 info locals
24283
24284 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24285 @item w
24286 where
24287 @end table
24288
24289 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24290 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24291 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24292 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24293 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24294 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24295
24296
24297 @node TUI Commands
24298 @section TUI-specific Commands
24299 @cindex TUI commands
24300
24301 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24302 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24303 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24304 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24305
24306 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24307 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24308 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24309 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24310 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24311
24312 @table @code
24313 @item info win
24314 @kindex info win
24315 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24316
24317 @item layout next
24318 @kindex layout
24319 Display the next layout.
24320
24321 @item layout prev
24322 Display the previous layout.
24323
24324 @item layout src
24325 Display the source window only.
24326
24327 @item layout asm
24328 Display the assembly window only.
24329
24330 @item layout split
24331 Display the source and assembly window.
24332
24333 @item layout regs
24334 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24335
24336 @item focus next
24337 @kindex focus
24338 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24339
24340 @item focus prev
24341 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24342
24343 @item focus src
24344 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24345
24346 @item focus asm
24347 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24348
24349 @item focus regs
24350 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24351
24352 @item focus cmd
24353 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24354
24355 @item refresh
24356 @kindex refresh
24357 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24358
24359 @item tui reg float
24360 @kindex tui reg
24361 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24362
24363 @item tui reg general
24364 Show the general registers in the register window.
24365
24366 @item tui reg next
24367 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24368 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24369 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24370 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24371
24372 @item tui reg system
24373 Show the system registers in the register window.
24374
24375 @item update
24376 @kindex update
24377 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24378
24379 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24380 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24381 @kindex winheight
24382 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24383 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24384 decrease it.
24385
24386 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24387 @kindex tabset
24388 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24389 @end table
24390
24391 @node TUI Configuration
24392 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24393 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24394
24395 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24396
24397 @table @code
24398 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24399 @kindex set tui border-kind
24400 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24401 The possible values are the following:
24402 @table @code
24403 @item space
24404 Use a space character to draw the border.
24405
24406 @item ascii
24407 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24408
24409 @item acs
24410 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24411 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24412 @end table
24413
24414 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24415 @kindex set tui border-mode
24416 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24417 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24418 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24419 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24420 @table @code
24421 @item normal
24422 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24423
24424 @item standout
24425 Use standout mode.
24426
24427 @item reverse
24428 Use reverse video mode.
24429
24430 @item half
24431 Use half bright mode.
24432
24433 @item half-standout
24434 Use half bright and standout mode.
24435
24436 @item bold
24437 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24438
24439 @item bold-standout
24440 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24441 @end table
24442 @end table
24443
24444 @node Emacs
24445 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24446
24447 @cindex Emacs
24448 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24449 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24450 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24451 @value{GDBN}.
24452
24453 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24454 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24455 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24456 created Emacs buffer.
24457 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24458
24459 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24460 things:
24461
24462 @itemize @bullet
24463 @item
24464 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24465 the GUD buffer.
24466
24467 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24468 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24469
24470 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24471 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24472 in this way.
24473
24474 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24475 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24476 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24477 stop.
24478
24479 @item
24480 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24481
24482 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24483 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24484 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24485 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24486 and the source.
24487
24488 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24489 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24490 @end itemize
24491
24492 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24493 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24494 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24495 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24496
24497 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24498 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24499 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24500 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24501 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24502 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24503 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24504 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24505 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24506
24507 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24508 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24509 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24510 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24511
24512 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24513 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24514 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24515 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24516 one you want.
24517
24518 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24519 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24520
24521 @table @kbd
24522 @item C-h m
24523 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24524
24525 @item C-c C-s
24526 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24527 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24528
24529 @item C-c C-n
24530 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24531 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24532 to show the current file and location.
24533
24534 @item C-c C-i
24535 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24536 display window accordingly.
24537
24538 @item C-c C-f
24539 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24540 @code{finish} command.
24541
24542 @item C-c C-r
24543 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24544 command.
24545
24546 @item C-c <
24547 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24548 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24549 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24550
24551 @item C-c >
24552 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24553 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24554 @end table
24555
24556 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24557 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24558
24559 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24560 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24561 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24562 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24563 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24564 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24565 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24566
24567 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24568 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24569 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24570 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24571 frame.
24572
24573 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24574 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24575 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24576 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24577 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24578 to correspond properly with the code.
24579
24580 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24581 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24582 Emacs Manual}).
24583
24584 @node GDB/MI
24585 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24586
24587 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24588
24589 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24590 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24591 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24592 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24593 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24594 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24595
24596 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24597 in the form of a reference manual.
24598
24599 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24600 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24601 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24602
24603 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24604
24605 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24606 This chapter uses the following notation:
24607
24608 @itemize @bullet
24609 @item
24610 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24611
24612 @item
24613 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24614 it may or may not be given.
24615
24616 @item
24617 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24618 may repeat zero or more times.
24619
24620 @item
24621 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24622 may repeat one or more times.
24623
24624 @item
24625 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24626 @end itemize
24627
24628 @ignore
24629 @heading Dependencies
24630 @end ignore
24631
24632 @menu
24633 * GDB/MI General Design::
24634 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24635 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24636 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24637 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24638 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24639 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24640 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24641 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24642 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24643 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24644 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24645 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24646 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24647 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24648 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24649 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24650 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24651 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24652 @ignore
24653 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24654 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24655 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24656 @end ignore
24657 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24658 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24659 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24660 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24661 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24662 @end menu
24663
24664 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24665 @node GDB/MI General Design
24666 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24667 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24668
24669 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24670 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24671 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24672 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24673 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24674 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24675 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24676 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24677 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24678 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24679
24680 The important examples of notifications are:
24681 @itemize @bullet
24682
24683 @item
24684 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24685 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24686 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24687 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24688 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24689 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24690 command itself was successfully executed.
24691
24692 @item
24693 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24694 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24695 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24696 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24697 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24698 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24699
24700 @item
24701 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24702 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24703 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24704 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24705 orthogonal frontend design.
24706
24707 @end itemize
24708
24709 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24710 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24711 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24712 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24713 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24714 the user interface.
24715
24716
24717 @menu
24718 * Context management::
24719 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24720 * Thread groups::
24721 @end menu
24722
24723 @node Context management
24724 @subsection Context management
24725
24726 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24727
24728 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24729 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24730 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24731 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24732 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24733 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24734 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24735 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24736 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24737
24738 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24739 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24740 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24741 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24742 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24743 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24744 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24745 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24746 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24747 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24748 for thread and frame to operate on.
24749
24750 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24751 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24752 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24753 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24754 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24755 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24756 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24757 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24758 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24759 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24760
24761 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24762 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24763 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24764 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24765 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24766 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24767 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24768 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24769 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24770 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24771 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24772 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24773 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24774 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24775 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24776 @samp{--frame} options.
24777
24778 @subsubsection Language
24779
24780 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24781 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24782 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24783 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24784 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24785 For instance:
24786
24787 @smallexample
24788 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24789 ^done,value="4"
24790 (gdb)
24791 @end smallexample
24792
24793 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24794 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24795 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24796
24797 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24798 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24799
24800 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24801 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24802 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24803 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24804 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24805 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24806 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24807 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24808 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24809
24810 @table @code
24811 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
24812 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
24813 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
24814
24815 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
24816 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
24817 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
24818
24819 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
24820 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
24821 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
24822 MI commands even while the target is running.
24823
24824 @item -gdb-show mi-async
24825 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
24826 @end table
24827
24828 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
24829 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
24830 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
24831 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
24832 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
24833 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
24834
24835 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24836 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24837 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24838 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24839 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24840 are running.
24841
24842 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24843 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24844 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24845 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24846 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24847 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24848 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24849 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24850 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24851 @samp{--thread} option).
24852
24853 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24854 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24855 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24856 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24857
24858 @node Thread groups
24859 @subsection Thread groups
24860 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24861 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24862 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24863 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24864 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24865
24866 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24867 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24868 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24869 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24870 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24871 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24872 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24873 into processes.
24874
24875 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24876 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24877 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24878 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24879 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24880 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24881 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24882 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24883 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24884 the members of specific thread group.
24885
24886 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24887 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24888 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24889 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24890 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24891 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24892 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24893 after attaching to that thread group.
24894
24895 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24896 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24897 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24898 such thread groups.
24899
24900 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24901 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24902 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24903
24904 @menu
24905 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24906 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24907 @end menu
24908
24909 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24910 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24911
24912 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24913 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24914 @table @code
24915 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24916 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24917
24918 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24919 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24920 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24921
24922 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24923 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24924 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24925
24926 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24927 "any sequence of digits"
24928
24929 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24930 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24931
24932 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24933 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24934
24935 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24936 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24937
24938 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24939 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24940 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24941
24942 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24943 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24944
24945 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24946 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24947 @end table
24948
24949 @noindent
24950 Notes:
24951
24952 @itemize @bullet
24953 @item
24954 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24955 output is described below.
24956
24957 @item
24958 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24959 finishes.
24960
24961 @item
24962 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24963 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24964 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24965 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24966 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24967 @end itemize
24968
24969 Pragmatics:
24970
24971 @itemize @bullet
24972 @item
24973 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24974
24975 @item
24976 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24977 @end itemize
24978
24979 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24980 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24981
24982 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24983 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24984 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24985 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24986 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24987 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24988
24989 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24990 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24991 @var{token}.
24992
24993 @table @code
24994 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24995 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24996
24997 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24998 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24999
25000 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25001 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25002
25003 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25004 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25005
25006 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25007 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25008
25009 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25010 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25011
25012 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25013 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25014
25015 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25016 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25017
25018 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25019 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25020
25021 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25022 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25023 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25024
25025 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25026 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25027
25028 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25029 @code{ @var{string} }
25030
25031 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25032 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25033
25034 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25035 @code{@var{c-string}}
25036
25037 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25038 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25039
25040 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25041 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25042 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25043
25044 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25045 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25046
25047 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25048 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25049
25050 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25051 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25052
25053 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25054 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25055
25056 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25057 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25058
25059 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25060 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25061 @end table
25062
25063 @noindent
25064 Notes:
25065
25066 @itemize @bullet
25067 @item
25068 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25069
25070 @item
25071 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25072 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25073 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25074 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25075 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25076 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25077 prior command.
25078
25079 @item
25080 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25081 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25082 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25083 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25084
25085 @item
25086 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25087 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25088 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25089 @samp{*}.
25090
25091 @item
25092 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25093 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25094 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25095 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25096
25097 @item
25098 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25099 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25100 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25101 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25102
25103 @item
25104 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25105 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25106 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25107
25108 @item
25109 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25110 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25111 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25112 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25113
25114 @item
25115 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25116 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25117 @var{values}.
25118
25119
25120 @end itemize
25121
25122 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25123 details about the various output records.
25124
25125 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25126 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25127 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25128
25129 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25130 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25131
25132 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25133 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25134 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25135 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25136 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25137 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25138
25139 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25140 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25141 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25142
25143 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25144 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25145 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25146 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25147
25148 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25149 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25150
25151 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25152 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25153 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25154 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25155 might change.
25156
25157 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25158 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25159 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25160 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25161
25162 @itemize @bullet
25163 @item
25164 New MI commands may be added.
25165
25166 @item
25167 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25168
25169 @item
25170 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25171 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25172
25173 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25174 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25175
25176 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25177 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25178 @end itemize
25179
25180 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25181 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25182 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25183 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25184 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25185
25186 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25187 @c version?
25188
25189 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25190 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25191 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25192 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25193 @cindex mailing lists
25194
25195 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25196 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25197 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25198
25199 @menu
25200 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25201 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25202 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25203 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25204 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25205 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25206 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25207 @end menu
25208
25209 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25210 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25211
25212 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25213 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25214 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25215 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25216
25217 @table @code
25218 @findex ^done
25219 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25220 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25221 values.
25222
25223 @item "^running"
25224 @findex ^running
25225 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25226 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25227 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25228 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25229 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25230 which threads are resumed.
25231
25232 @item "^connected"
25233 @findex ^connected
25234 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25235
25236 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25237 @findex ^error
25238 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25239 the corresponding error message.
25240
25241 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25242 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25243 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25244
25245 @table @samp
25246 @item "undefined-command"
25247 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25248 @end table
25249
25250 @item "^exit"
25251 @findex ^exit
25252 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25253
25254 @end table
25255
25256 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25257 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25258
25259 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25260 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25261 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25262 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25263 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25264
25265 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25266 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25267 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25268 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25269 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25270
25271 @table @code
25272 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25273 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25274 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25275
25276 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25277 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25278 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25279 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25280
25281 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25282 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25283 internals.
25284 @end table
25285
25286 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25287 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25288
25289 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25290 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25291 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25292 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25293 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25294 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25295
25296 The following is the list of possible async records:
25297
25298 @table @code
25299
25300 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25301 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25302 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25303 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25304 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25305 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25306 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25307 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25308 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25309 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25310
25311 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25312 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25313 following values:
25314
25315 @table @code
25316 @item breakpoint-hit
25317 A breakpoint was reached.
25318 @item watchpoint-trigger
25319 A watchpoint was triggered.
25320 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25321 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25322 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25323 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25324 @item function-finished
25325 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25326 @item location-reached
25327 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25328 @item watchpoint-scope
25329 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25330 @item end-stepping-range
25331 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25332 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25333 @item exited-signalled
25334 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25335 @item exited
25336 The inferior exited.
25337 @item exited-normally
25338 The inferior exited normally.
25339 @item signal-received
25340 A signal was received by the inferior.
25341 @item solib-event
25342 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25343 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25344 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25345 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25346 @item fork
25347 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25348 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25349 @item vfork
25350 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25351 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25352 @item syscall-entry
25353 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25354 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25355 @item syscall-entry
25356 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25357 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25358 @item exec
25359 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25360 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25361 @end table
25362
25363 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25364 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25365 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25366 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25367 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25368 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25369 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25370 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25371 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25372 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25373 if such information is not available.
25374
25375 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25376 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25377 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25378 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25379 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25380 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25381 cannot be used in any way.
25382
25383 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25384 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25385 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25386 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25387 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25388 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25389
25390 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25391 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25392 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25393 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25394 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25395 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25396
25397 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25398 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25399 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25400 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25401 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25402
25403 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25404 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25405 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25406 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25407 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25408 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25409 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25410
25411 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25412 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25413 that thread.
25414
25415 @item =library-loaded,...
25416 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25417 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25418 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25419 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25420 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25421 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25422 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25423 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25424 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25425 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25426 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25427 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25428 thread groups.
25429
25430 @item =library-unloaded,...
25431 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25432 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25433 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25434 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25435 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25436 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25437 thread groups.
25438
25439 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25440 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25441 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25442 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25443 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25444
25445 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25446 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25447 initial value @var{initial}.
25448
25449 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25450 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25451 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25452 trace state variables are deleted.
25453
25454 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25455 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25456 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25457 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25458 value of trace state variable is known.
25459
25460 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25461 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25462 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25463 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25464 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25465 user.
25466
25467 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25468 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25469 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25470
25471 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25472 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25473
25474 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25475 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25476 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25477 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25478 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25479
25480 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25481 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25482 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25483 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25484 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25485 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25486
25487 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25488 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25489 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25490 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25491 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25492 executable code.
25493 @end table
25494
25495 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25496 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25497
25498 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25499 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25500 following fields:
25501
25502 @table @code
25503 @item number
25504 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25505 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25506 @samp{1.2}.
25507
25508 @item type
25509 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25510 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25511
25512 @item catch-type
25513 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25514 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25515
25516 @item disp
25517 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25518 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25519 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25520
25521 @item enabled
25522 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25523 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25524 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25525
25526 @item addr
25527 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25528 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25529 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25530 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25531 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25532
25533 @item func
25534 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25535 If not known, this field is not present.
25536
25537 @item filename
25538 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25539 If not known, this field is not present.
25540
25541 @item fullname
25542 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25543 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25544
25545 @item line
25546 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25547 If not known, this field is not present.
25548
25549 @item at
25550 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25551 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25552 by a symbol name.
25553
25554 @item pending
25555 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25556 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25557
25558 @item evaluated-by
25559 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25560 @samp{target}.
25561
25562 @item thread
25563 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25564 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25565
25566 @item task
25567 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25568 field will hold the task identifier.
25569
25570 @item cond
25571 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25572
25573 @item ignore
25574 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25575
25576 @item enable
25577 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25578
25579 @item traceframe-usage
25580 FIXME.
25581
25582 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25583 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25584
25585 @item mask
25586 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25587
25588 @item pass
25589 A tracepoint's pass count.
25590
25591 @item original-location
25592 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25593 This field is optional.
25594
25595 @item times
25596 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25597
25598 @item installed
25599 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25600 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25601 is not.
25602
25603 @item what
25604 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25605
25606 @end table
25607
25608 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25609 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25610
25611 @smallexample
25612 -> -break-insert main
25613 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25614 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25615 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25616 times="0"@}
25617 <- (gdb)
25618 @end smallexample
25619
25620 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25621 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25622
25623 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25624 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25625 fields:
25626
25627 @table @code
25628 @item level
25629 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25630 zero. This field is always present.
25631
25632 @item func
25633 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25634 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25635
25636 @item addr
25637 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25638
25639 @item file
25640 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25641 address. This field may be absent.
25642
25643 @item line
25644 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25645 may be absent.
25646
25647 @item from
25648 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25649 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25650
25651 @end table
25652
25653 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25654 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25655
25656 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25657 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25658
25659 @table @code
25660 @item id
25661 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25662 always present.
25663
25664 @item target-id
25665 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25666
25667 @item details
25668 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25669 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25670 frontend. This field is optional.
25671
25672 @item state
25673 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25674 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25675
25676 @item core
25677 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25678 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25679 @end table
25680
25681 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25682 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25683
25684 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25685 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25686 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25687 the @code{exception-name} field.
25688
25689 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25690 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25691 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25692 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25693
25694 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25695 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25696 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25697 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25698
25699 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25700 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25701
25702 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25703
25704 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25705 information of the breakpoint.
25706
25707 @smallexample
25708 -> -break-insert main
25709 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25710 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25711 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25712 times="0"@}
25713 <- (gdb)
25714 @end smallexample
25715
25716 @subheading Program Execution
25717
25718 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25719 reason that execution stopped.
25720
25721 @smallexample
25722 -> -exec-run
25723 <- ^running
25724 <- (gdb)
25725 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25726 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25727 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25728 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25729 <- (gdb)
25730 -> -exec-continue
25731 <- ^running
25732 <- (gdb)
25733 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25734 <- (gdb)
25735 @end smallexample
25736
25737 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25738
25739 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25740
25741 @smallexample
25742 -> (gdb)
25743 <- -gdb-exit
25744 <- ^exit
25745 @end smallexample
25746
25747 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25748 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25749 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25750 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25751 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25752 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25753
25754 @subheading A Bad Command
25755
25756 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25757
25758 @smallexample
25759 -> -rubbish
25760 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25761 <- (gdb)
25762 @end smallexample
25763
25764
25765 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25766 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25767 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25768
25769 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25770 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25771
25772 @subheading Motivation
25773
25774 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25775
25776 @subheading Introduction
25777
25778 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25779
25780 @subheading Commands
25781
25782 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25783
25784 @subsubheading Synopsis
25785
25786 @smallexample
25787 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25788 @end smallexample
25789
25790 @subsubheading Result
25791
25792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25793
25794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25795
25796 @subsubheading Example
25797
25798 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25799 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25800
25801
25802 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25803 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25804 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25805
25806 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25807 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25808 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25809 breakpoints.
25810
25811 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25812 @findex -break-after
25813
25814 @subsubheading Synopsis
25815
25816 @smallexample
25817 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25818 @end smallexample
25819
25820 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25821 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25822 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25823 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25824
25825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25826
25827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25828
25829 @subsubheading Example
25830
25831 @smallexample
25832 (gdb)
25833 -break-insert main
25834 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25835 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25836 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25837 times="0"@}
25838 (gdb)
25839 -break-after 1 3
25840 ~
25841 ^done
25842 (gdb)
25843 -break-list
25844 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25845 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25846 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25847 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25848 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25849 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25850 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25851 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25852 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25853 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25854 (gdb)
25855 @end smallexample
25856
25857 @ignore
25858 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25859 @findex -break-catch
25860 @end ignore
25861
25862 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25863 @findex -break-commands
25864
25865 @subsubheading Synopsis
25866
25867 @smallexample
25868 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25869 @end smallexample
25870
25871 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25872 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25873 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25874 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25875 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25876 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25877
25878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25879
25880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25881
25882 @subsubheading Example
25883
25884 @smallexample
25885 (gdb)
25886 -break-insert main
25887 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25888 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25889 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25890 times="0"@}
25891 (gdb)
25892 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25893 ^done
25894 (gdb)
25895 @end smallexample
25896
25897 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25898 @findex -break-condition
25899
25900 @subsubheading Synopsis
25901
25902 @smallexample
25903 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25904 @end smallexample
25905
25906 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25907 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25908 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25909 command below).
25910
25911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25912
25913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25914
25915 @subsubheading Example
25916
25917 @smallexample
25918 (gdb)
25919 -break-condition 1 1
25920 ^done
25921 (gdb)
25922 -break-list
25923 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25924 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25925 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25926 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25927 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25928 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25929 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25930 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25931 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25932 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25933 (gdb)
25934 @end smallexample
25935
25936 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25937 @findex -break-delete
25938
25939 @subsubheading Synopsis
25940
25941 @smallexample
25942 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25943 @end smallexample
25944
25945 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25946 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25947
25948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25949
25950 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25951
25952 @subsubheading Example
25953
25954 @smallexample
25955 (gdb)
25956 -break-delete 1
25957 ^done
25958 (gdb)
25959 -break-list
25960 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25961 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25962 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25963 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25964 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25965 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25966 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25967 body=[]@}
25968 (gdb)
25969 @end smallexample
25970
25971 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25972 @findex -break-disable
25973
25974 @subsubheading Synopsis
25975
25976 @smallexample
25977 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25978 @end smallexample
25979
25980 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25981 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25982
25983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25984
25985 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25986
25987 @subsubheading Example
25988
25989 @smallexample
25990 (gdb)
25991 -break-disable 2
25992 ^done
25993 (gdb)
25994 -break-list
25995 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25996 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25997 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25998 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25999 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26000 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26001 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26002 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26003 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26004 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26005 (gdb)
26006 @end smallexample
26007
26008 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26009 @findex -break-enable
26010
26011 @subsubheading Synopsis
26012
26013 @smallexample
26014 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26015 @end smallexample
26016
26017 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26018
26019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26020
26021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26022
26023 @subsubheading Example
26024
26025 @smallexample
26026 (gdb)
26027 -break-enable 2
26028 ^done
26029 (gdb)
26030 -break-list
26031 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26032 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26033 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26034 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26035 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26036 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26037 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26038 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26039 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26040 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26041 (gdb)
26042 @end smallexample
26043
26044 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26045 @findex -break-info
26046
26047 @subsubheading Synopsis
26048
26049 @smallexample
26050 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26051 @end smallexample
26052
26053 @c REDUNDANT???
26054 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26055
26056 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26057 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26058 table.
26059
26060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26061
26062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26063
26064 @subsubheading Example
26065 N.A.
26066
26067 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26068 @findex -break-insert
26069
26070 @subsubheading Synopsis
26071
26072 @smallexample
26073 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26074 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26075 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26076 @end smallexample
26077
26078 @noindent
26079 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26080
26081 @itemize @bullet
26082 @item function
26083 @c @item +offset
26084 @c @item -offset
26085 @c @item linenum
26086 @item filename:linenum
26087 @item filename:function
26088 @item *address
26089 @end itemize
26090
26091 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26092
26093 @table @samp
26094 @item -t
26095 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26096 @item -h
26097 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26098 @item -f
26099 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26100 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26101 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26102 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26103 cannot be parsed.
26104 @item -d
26105 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26106 @item -a
26107 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26108 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26109 @item -c @var{condition}
26110 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26111 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26112 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26113 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26114 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26115 @end table
26116
26117 @subsubheading Result
26118
26119 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26120 resulting breakpoint.
26121
26122 Note: this format is open to change.
26123 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26124
26125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26126
26127 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26128 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26129
26130 @subsubheading Example
26131
26132 @smallexample
26133 (gdb)
26134 -break-insert main
26135 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26136 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26137 times="0"@}
26138 (gdb)
26139 -break-insert -t foo
26140 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26141 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26142 times="0"@}
26143 (gdb)
26144 -break-list
26145 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26146 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26147 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26148 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26149 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26150 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26151 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26152 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26153 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26154 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26155 times="0"@},
26156 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26157 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26158 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26159 times="0"@}]@}
26160 (gdb)
26161 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26162 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26163 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26164 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26165 @c times="0"@}
26166 @c (gdb)
26167 @end smallexample
26168
26169 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26170 @findex -dprintf-insert
26171
26172 @subsubheading Synopsis
26173
26174 @smallexample
26175 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26176 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26177 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26178 [ @var{argument} ]
26179 @end smallexample
26180
26181 @noindent
26182 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26183
26184 @itemize @bullet
26185 @item @var{function}
26186 @c @item +offset
26187 @c @item -offset
26188 @c @item @var{linenum}
26189 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26190 @item @var{filename}:function
26191 @item *@var{address}
26192 @end itemize
26193
26194 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26195
26196 @table @samp
26197 @item -t
26198 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26199 @item -f
26200 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26201 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26202 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26203 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26204 cannot be parsed.
26205 @item -d
26206 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26207 @item -c @var{condition}
26208 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26209 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26210 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26211 to @var{ignore-count}.
26212 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26213 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26214 @end table
26215
26216 @subsubheading Result
26217
26218 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26219 resulting breakpoint.
26220
26221 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26222
26223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26224
26225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26226
26227 @subsubheading Example
26228
26229 @smallexample
26230 (gdb)
26231 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26232 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26233 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26234 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26235 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26236 original-location="foo"@}
26237 (gdb)
26238 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26239 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26240 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26241 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26242 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26243 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26244 (gdb)
26245 @end smallexample
26246
26247 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26248 @findex -break-list
26249
26250 @subsubheading Synopsis
26251
26252 @smallexample
26253 -break-list
26254 @end smallexample
26255
26256 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26257
26258 @table @samp
26259 @item Number
26260 number of the breakpoint
26261 @item Type
26262 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26263 @item Disposition
26264 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26265 or @samp{nokeep}
26266 @item Enabled
26267 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26268 @item Address
26269 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26270 @item What
26271 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26272 name, line number
26273 @item Thread-groups
26274 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26275 @item Times
26276 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26277 @end table
26278
26279 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26280 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26281
26282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26283
26284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26285
26286 @subsubheading Example
26287
26288 @smallexample
26289 (gdb)
26290 -break-list
26291 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26292 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26293 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26294 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26295 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26296 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26297 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26298 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26299 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26300 times="0"@},
26301 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26302 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26303 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26304 (gdb)
26305 @end smallexample
26306
26307 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26308
26309 @smallexample
26310 (gdb)
26311 -break-list
26312 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26313 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26314 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26315 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26316 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26317 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26318 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26319 body=[]@}
26320 (gdb)
26321 @end smallexample
26322
26323 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26324 @findex -break-passcount
26325
26326 @subsubheading Synopsis
26327
26328 @smallexample
26329 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26330 @end smallexample
26331
26332 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26333 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26334 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26335 command @samp{passcount}.
26336
26337 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26338 @findex -break-watch
26339
26340 @subsubheading Synopsis
26341
26342 @smallexample
26343 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26344 @end smallexample
26345
26346 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26347 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26348 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26349 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26350 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26351 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26352 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26353 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26354
26355 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26356 breakpoints inserted.
26357
26358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26359
26360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26361 @samp{rwatch}.
26362
26363 @subsubheading Example
26364
26365 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26366
26367 @smallexample
26368 (gdb)
26369 -break-watch x
26370 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26371 (gdb)
26372 -exec-continue
26373 ^running
26374 (gdb)
26375 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26376 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26377 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26378 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26379 (gdb)
26380 @end smallexample
26381
26382 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26383 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26384 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26385
26386 @smallexample
26387 (gdb)
26388 -break-watch C
26389 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26390 (gdb)
26391 -exec-continue
26392 ^running
26393 (gdb)
26394 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26395 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26396 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26397 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26398 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26399 (gdb)
26400 -exec-continue
26401 ^running
26402 (gdb)
26403 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26404 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26405 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26406 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26407 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26408 (gdb)
26409 @end smallexample
26410
26411 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26412 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26413 deleted.
26414
26415 @smallexample
26416 (gdb)
26417 -break-watch C
26418 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26419 (gdb)
26420 -break-list
26421 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26422 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26423 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26424 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26425 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26426 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26427 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26428 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26429 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26430 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26431 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26432 times="1"@},
26433 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26434 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26435 (gdb)
26436 -exec-continue
26437 ^running
26438 (gdb)
26439 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26440 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26441 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26442 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26443 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26444 (gdb)
26445 -break-list
26446 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26447 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26448 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26449 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26450 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26451 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26452 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26453 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26454 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26455 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26456 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26457 times="1"@},
26458 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26459 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26460 (gdb)
26461 -exec-continue
26462 ^running
26463 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26464 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26465 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26466 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26467 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26468 (gdb)
26469 -break-list
26470 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26471 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26472 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26473 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26474 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26475 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26476 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26477 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26478 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26479 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26480 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26481 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26482 (gdb)
26483 @end smallexample
26484
26485
26486 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26487 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26488 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26489
26490 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26491 catchpoints.
26492
26493 @menu
26494 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26495 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26496 @end menu
26497
26498 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26499 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26500
26501 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26502 @findex -catch-load
26503
26504 @subsubheading Synopsis
26505
26506 @smallexample
26507 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26508 @end smallexample
26509
26510 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26511 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26512 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26513 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26514 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26515
26516
26517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26518
26519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26520
26521 @subsubheading Example
26522
26523 @smallexample
26524 -catch-load -t foo.so
26525 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26526 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26527 (gdb)
26528 @end smallexample
26529
26530
26531 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26532 @findex -catch-unload
26533
26534 @subsubheading Synopsis
26535
26536 @smallexample
26537 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26538 @end smallexample
26539
26540 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26541 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26542 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26543 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26544 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26545
26546 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26547
26548 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26549
26550 @subsubheading Example
26551
26552 @smallexample
26553 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26554 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26555 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26556 (gdb)
26557 @end smallexample
26558
26559 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26560 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26561
26562 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26563 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26564
26565 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26566 @findex -catch-assert
26567
26568 @subsubheading Synopsis
26569
26570 @smallexample
26571 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26572 @end smallexample
26573
26574 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26575
26576 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26577
26578 @table @samp
26579 @item -c @var{condition}
26580 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26581 @item -d
26582 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26583 @item -t
26584 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26585 @end table
26586
26587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26588
26589 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26590
26591 @subsubheading Example
26592
26593 @smallexample
26594 -catch-assert
26595 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26596 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26597 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26598 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26599 (gdb)
26600 @end smallexample
26601
26602 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26603 @findex -catch-exception
26604
26605 @subsubheading Synopsis
26606
26607 @smallexample
26608 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26609 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26610 @end smallexample
26611
26612 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26613 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26614 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26615 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26616 catchpoints.
26617
26618 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26619
26620 @table @samp
26621 @item -c @var{condition}
26622 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26623 @item -d
26624 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26625 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26626 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26627 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26628 @item -t
26629 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26630 @item -u
26631 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26632 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26633 @end table
26634
26635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26636
26637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26638 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26639
26640 @subsubheading Example
26641
26642 @smallexample
26643 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26644 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26645 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26646 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26647 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26648 (gdb)
26649 @end smallexample
26650
26651 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26652 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26653 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26654
26655 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26656 @findex -exec-arguments
26657
26658
26659 @subsubheading Synopsis
26660
26661 @smallexample
26662 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26663 @end smallexample
26664
26665 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26666 @samp{-exec-run}.
26667
26668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26669
26670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26671
26672 @subsubheading Example
26673
26674 @smallexample
26675 (gdb)
26676 -exec-arguments -v word
26677 ^done
26678 (gdb)
26679 @end smallexample
26680
26681
26682 @ignore
26683 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26684 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26685
26686 @subsubheading Synopsis
26687
26688 @smallexample
26689 -exec-show-arguments
26690 @end smallexample
26691
26692 Print the arguments of the program.
26693
26694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26695
26696 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26697
26698 @subsubheading Example
26699 N.A.
26700 @end ignore
26701
26702
26703 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26704 @findex -environment-cd
26705
26706 @subsubheading Synopsis
26707
26708 @smallexample
26709 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26710 @end smallexample
26711
26712 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26713
26714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26715
26716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26717
26718 @subsubheading Example
26719
26720 @smallexample
26721 (gdb)
26722 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26723 ^done
26724 (gdb)
26725 @end smallexample
26726
26727
26728 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26729 @findex -environment-directory
26730
26731 @subsubheading Synopsis
26732
26733 @smallexample
26734 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26735 @end smallexample
26736
26737 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26738 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26739 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26740 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26741 occurs as normal.
26742 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26743 multiple directories in a single command
26744 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26745 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26746 If blanks are needed as
26747 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26748 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26749 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26750 character must not be used
26751 in any directory name.
26752 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26753
26754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26755
26756 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26757
26758 @subsubheading Example
26759
26760 @smallexample
26761 (gdb)
26762 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26763 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26764 (gdb)
26765 -environment-directory ""
26766 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26767 (gdb)
26768 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26769 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26770 (gdb)
26771 -environment-directory -r
26772 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26773 (gdb)
26774 @end smallexample
26775
26776
26777 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26778 @findex -environment-path
26779
26780 @subsubheading Synopsis
26781
26782 @smallexample
26783 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26784 @end smallexample
26785
26786 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26787 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26788 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26789 supplied in addition to the
26790 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26791 occurs as normal.
26792 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26793 multiple directories in a single command
26794 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26795 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26796 If blanks are needed as
26797 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26798 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26799 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26800 character must not be used
26801 in any directory name.
26802 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26803
26804
26805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26806
26807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26808
26809 @subsubheading Example
26810
26811 @smallexample
26812 (gdb)
26813 -environment-path
26814 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26815 (gdb)
26816 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26817 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26818 (gdb)
26819 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26820 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26821 (gdb)
26822 @end smallexample
26823
26824
26825 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26826 @findex -environment-pwd
26827
26828 @subsubheading Synopsis
26829
26830 @smallexample
26831 -environment-pwd
26832 @end smallexample
26833
26834 Show the current working directory.
26835
26836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26837
26838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26839
26840 @subsubheading Example
26841
26842 @smallexample
26843 (gdb)
26844 -environment-pwd
26845 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26846 (gdb)
26847 @end smallexample
26848
26849 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26850 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26851 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26852
26853
26854 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26855 @findex -thread-info
26856
26857 @subsubheading Synopsis
26858
26859 @smallexample
26860 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26861 @end smallexample
26862
26863 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26864 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26865 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26866 also reports the current thread.
26867
26868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26869
26870 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26871 about all threads.
26872
26873 @subsubheading Result
26874
26875 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26876 defined for a given thread:
26877
26878 @table @samp
26879 @item current
26880 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26881
26882 @item id
26883 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26884
26885 @item target-id
26886 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26887
26888 @item details
26889 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26890 field is optional.
26891
26892 @item name
26893 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26894 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26895 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26896 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26897 field is omitted.
26898
26899 @item frame
26900 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26901
26902 @item state
26903 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26904 values:
26905
26906 @table @code
26907 @item stopped
26908 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26909 threads.
26910
26911 @item running
26912 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26913 threads.
26914
26915 @end table
26916
26917 @item core
26918 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26919 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26920
26921 @end table
26922
26923 @subsubheading Example
26924
26925 @smallexample
26926 -thread-info
26927 ^done,threads=[
26928 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26929 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26930 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26931 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26932 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26933 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26934 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26935 state="running"@}],
26936 current-thread-id="1"
26937 (gdb)
26938 @end smallexample
26939
26940 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26941 @findex -thread-list-ids
26942
26943 @subsubheading Synopsis
26944
26945 @smallexample
26946 -thread-list-ids
26947 @end smallexample
26948
26949 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26950 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26951
26952 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26953 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26954
26955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26956
26957 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26958
26959 @subsubheading Example
26960
26961 @smallexample
26962 (gdb)
26963 -thread-list-ids
26964 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26965 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26966 (gdb)
26967 @end smallexample
26968
26969
26970 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26971 @findex -thread-select
26972
26973 @subsubheading Synopsis
26974
26975 @smallexample
26976 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26977 @end smallexample
26978
26979 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26980 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26981
26982 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26983 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26984
26985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26986
26987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26988
26989 @subsubheading Example
26990
26991 @smallexample
26992 (gdb)
26993 -exec-next
26994 ^running
26995 (gdb)
26996 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26997 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26998 (gdb)
26999 -thread-list-ids
27000 ^done,
27001 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27002 number-of-threads="3"
27003 (gdb)
27004 -thread-select 3
27005 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27006 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27007 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27008 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27009 (gdb)
27010 @end smallexample
27011
27012 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27013 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27014 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27015
27016 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27017 @findex -ada-task-info
27018
27019 @subsubheading Synopsis
27020
27021 @smallexample
27022 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27023 @end smallexample
27024
27025 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27026 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27027
27028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27029
27030 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27031 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27032
27033 @subsubheading Result
27034
27035 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27036 defined for each Ada task:
27037
27038 @table @samp
27039 @item current
27040 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27041
27042 @item id
27043 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27044
27045 @item task-id
27046 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27047
27048 @item thread-id
27049 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27050
27051 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27052 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27053 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27054
27055 @item parent-id
27056 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27057 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27058
27059 @item priority
27060 The base priority of the task.
27061
27062 @item state
27063 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27064 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27065
27066 @item name
27067 The name of the task.
27068
27069 @end table
27070
27071 @subsubheading Example
27072
27073 @smallexample
27074 -ada-task-info
27075 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27076 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27077 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27078 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27079 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27080 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27081 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27082 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27083 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27084 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27085 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27086 (gdb)
27087 @end smallexample
27088
27089 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27090 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27091 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27092
27093 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27094 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27095 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27096 other cases.
27097
27098 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27099 @findex -exec-continue
27100
27101 @subsubheading Synopsis
27102
27103 @smallexample
27104 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27105 @end smallexample
27106
27107 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27108 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27109 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27110 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27111 @itemize @bullet
27112 @item
27113 breakpoints or watchpoints
27114 @item
27115 signals or exceptions
27116 @item
27117 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27118 @item
27119 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27120 @end itemize
27121 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27122 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27123 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27124 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27125 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27126 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27127
27128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27129
27130 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27131
27132 @subsubheading Example
27133
27134 @smallexample
27135 -exec-continue
27136 ^running
27137 (gdb)
27138 @@Hello world
27139 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27140 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27141 line="13"@}
27142 (gdb)
27143 @end smallexample
27144
27145
27146 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27147 @findex -exec-finish
27148
27149 @subsubheading Synopsis
27150
27151 @smallexample
27152 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27153 @end smallexample
27154
27155 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27156 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27157 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27158 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27159 function was called.
27160
27161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27162
27163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27164
27165 @subsubheading Example
27166
27167 Function returning @code{void}.
27168
27169 @smallexample
27170 -exec-finish
27171 ^running
27172 (gdb)
27173 @@hello from foo
27174 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27175 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27176 (gdb)
27177 @end smallexample
27178
27179 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27180 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27181 value itself.
27182
27183 @smallexample
27184 -exec-finish
27185 ^running
27186 (gdb)
27187 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27188 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27189 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27190 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27191 (gdb)
27192 @end smallexample
27193
27194
27195 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27196 @findex -exec-interrupt
27197
27198 @subsubheading Synopsis
27199
27200 @smallexample
27201 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27202 @end smallexample
27203
27204 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27205 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27206 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27207 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27208 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27209
27210 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27211 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27212 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27213 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27214
27215 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27216 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27217 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27218 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27219
27220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27221
27222 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27223
27224 @subsubheading Example
27225
27226 @smallexample
27227 (gdb)
27228 111-exec-continue
27229 111^running
27230
27231 (gdb)
27232 222-exec-interrupt
27233 222^done
27234 (gdb)
27235 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27236 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27237 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27238 (gdb)
27239
27240 (gdb)
27241 -exec-interrupt
27242 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27243 (gdb)
27244 @end smallexample
27245
27246 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27247 @findex -exec-jump
27248
27249 @subsubheading Synopsis
27250
27251 @smallexample
27252 -exec-jump @var{location}
27253 @end smallexample
27254
27255 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27256 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27257 different forms of @var{location}.
27258
27259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27260
27261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27262
27263 @subsubheading Example
27264
27265 @smallexample
27266 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27267 *running,thread-id="all"
27268 ^running
27269 @end smallexample
27270
27271
27272 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27273 @findex -exec-next
27274
27275 @subsubheading Synopsis
27276
27277 @smallexample
27278 -exec-next [--reverse]
27279 @end smallexample
27280
27281 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27282 of the next source line is reached.
27283
27284 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27285 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27286 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27287 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27288 source line where the function was called.
27289
27290
27291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27292
27293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27294
27295 @subsubheading Example
27296
27297 @smallexample
27298 -exec-next
27299 ^running
27300 (gdb)
27301 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27302 (gdb)
27303 @end smallexample
27304
27305
27306 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27307 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27308
27309 @subsubheading Synopsis
27310
27311 @smallexample
27312 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27313 @end smallexample
27314
27315 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27316 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27317 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27318 printed as well.
27319
27320 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27321 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27322 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27323 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27324 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27325
27326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27327
27328 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27329
27330 @subsubheading Example
27331
27332 @smallexample
27333 (gdb)
27334 -exec-next-instruction
27335 ^running
27336
27337 (gdb)
27338 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27339 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27340 (gdb)
27341 @end smallexample
27342
27343
27344 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27345 @findex -exec-return
27346
27347 @subsubheading Synopsis
27348
27349 @smallexample
27350 -exec-return
27351 @end smallexample
27352
27353 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27354 Displays the new current frame.
27355
27356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27357
27358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27359
27360 @subsubheading Example
27361
27362 @smallexample
27363 (gdb)
27364 200-break-insert callee4
27365 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27366 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27367 (gdb)
27368 000-exec-run
27369 000^running
27370 (gdb)
27371 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27372 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27373 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27374 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27375 (gdb)
27376 205-break-delete
27377 205^done
27378 (gdb)
27379 111-exec-return
27380 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27381 args=[@{name="strarg",
27382 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27383 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27384 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27385 (gdb)
27386 @end smallexample
27387
27388
27389 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27390 @findex -exec-run
27391
27392 @subsubheading Synopsis
27393
27394 @smallexample
27395 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27396 @end smallexample
27397
27398 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27399 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27400 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27401 the program has exited exceptionally.
27402
27403 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27404 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27405 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27406 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27407 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27408
27409 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27410 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27411 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27412 (@pxref{Starting}).
27413
27414 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27415
27416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27417
27418 @subsubheading Examples
27419
27420 @smallexample
27421 (gdb)
27422 -break-insert main
27423 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27424 (gdb)
27425 -exec-run
27426 ^running
27427 (gdb)
27428 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27429 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27430 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27431 (gdb)
27432 @end smallexample
27433
27434 @noindent
27435 Program exited normally:
27436
27437 @smallexample
27438 (gdb)
27439 -exec-run
27440 ^running
27441 (gdb)
27442 x = 55
27443 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27444 (gdb)
27445 @end smallexample
27446
27447 @noindent
27448 Program exited exceptionally:
27449
27450 @smallexample
27451 (gdb)
27452 -exec-run
27453 ^running
27454 (gdb)
27455 x = 55
27456 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27457 (gdb)
27458 @end smallexample
27459
27460 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27461 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27462
27463 @smallexample
27464 (gdb)
27465 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27466 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27467 @end smallexample
27468
27469
27470 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27471
27472
27473 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27474 @findex -exec-step
27475
27476 @subsubheading Synopsis
27477
27478 @smallexample
27479 -exec-step [--reverse]
27480 @end smallexample
27481
27482 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27483 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27484 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27485 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27486 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27487 previously executed source line.
27488
27489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27490
27491 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27492
27493 @subsubheading Example
27494
27495 Stepping into a function:
27496
27497 @smallexample
27498 -exec-step
27499 ^running
27500 (gdb)
27501 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27502 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27503 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27504 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27505 (gdb)
27506 @end smallexample
27507
27508 Regular stepping:
27509
27510 @smallexample
27511 -exec-step
27512 ^running
27513 (gdb)
27514 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27515 (gdb)
27516 @end smallexample
27517
27518
27519 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27520 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27521
27522 @subsubheading Synopsis
27523
27524 @smallexample
27525 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27526 @end smallexample
27527
27528 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27529 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27530 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27531 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27532 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27533 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27534 as well.
27535
27536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27537
27538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27539
27540 @subsubheading Example
27541
27542 @smallexample
27543 (gdb)
27544 -exec-step-instruction
27545 ^running
27546
27547 (gdb)
27548 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27549 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27550 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27551 (gdb)
27552 -exec-step-instruction
27553 ^running
27554
27555 (gdb)
27556 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27557 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27558 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27559 (gdb)
27560 @end smallexample
27561
27562
27563 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27564 @findex -exec-until
27565
27566 @subsubheading Synopsis
27567
27568 @smallexample
27569 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27570 @end smallexample
27571
27572 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27573 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27574 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27575 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27576
27577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27578
27579 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27580
27581 @subsubheading Example
27582
27583 @smallexample
27584 (gdb)
27585 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27586 ^running
27587 (gdb)
27588 x = 55
27589 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27590 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27591 (gdb)
27592 @end smallexample
27593
27594 @ignore
27595 @subheading -file-clear
27596 Is this going away????
27597 @end ignore
27598
27599 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27600 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27601 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27602
27603 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27604 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27605
27606 @smallexample
27607 -enable-frame-filters
27608 @end smallexample
27609
27610 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27611 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27612 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27613 request that this functionality be enabled.
27614
27615 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27616
27617 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27618 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27619
27620 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27621 @findex -stack-info-frame
27622
27623 @subsubheading Synopsis
27624
27625 @smallexample
27626 -stack-info-frame
27627 @end smallexample
27628
27629 Get info on the selected frame.
27630
27631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27632
27633 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27634 (without arguments).
27635
27636 @subsubheading Example
27637
27638 @smallexample
27639 (gdb)
27640 -stack-info-frame
27641 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27642 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27643 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27644 (gdb)
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27648 @findex -stack-info-depth
27649
27650 @subsubheading Synopsis
27651
27652 @smallexample
27653 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27654 @end smallexample
27655
27656 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27657 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27658
27659 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27660
27661 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27662
27663 @subsubheading Example
27664
27665 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27666
27667 @smallexample
27668 (gdb)
27669 -stack-info-depth
27670 ^done,depth="12"
27671 (gdb)
27672 -stack-info-depth 4
27673 ^done,depth="4"
27674 (gdb)
27675 -stack-info-depth 12
27676 ^done,depth="12"
27677 (gdb)
27678 -stack-info-depth 11
27679 ^done,depth="11"
27680 (gdb)
27681 -stack-info-depth 13
27682 ^done,depth="12"
27683 (gdb)
27684 @end smallexample
27685
27686 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27687 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27688 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27689
27690 @subsubheading Synopsis
27691
27692 @smallexample
27693 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27694 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27695 @end smallexample
27696
27697 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27698 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27699 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27700 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27701 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27702 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27703 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27704 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27705
27706 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27707 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27708 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27709 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27710 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27711 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27712
27713 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27714 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27715 are still displayed, however.
27716
27717 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27718 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27719
27720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27721
27722 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27723 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27724 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27725
27726 @subsubheading Example
27727
27728 @smallexample
27729 (gdb)
27730 -stack-list-frames
27731 ^done,
27732 stack=[
27733 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27734 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27735 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27736 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27737 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27738 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27739 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27740 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27741 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27742 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27743 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27744 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27745 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27746 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27747 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27748 (gdb)
27749 -stack-list-arguments 0
27750 ^done,
27751 stack-args=[
27752 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27753 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27754 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27755 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27756 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27757 (gdb)
27758 -stack-list-arguments 1
27759 ^done,
27760 stack-args=[
27761 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27762 frame=@{level="1",
27763 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27764 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27765 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27766 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27767 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27768 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27769 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27770 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27771 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27772 (gdb)
27773 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27774 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27775 (gdb)
27776 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27777 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27778 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27779 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27780 (gdb)
27781 @end smallexample
27782
27783 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27784
27785
27786 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27787 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27788 @findex -stack-list-frames
27789
27790 @subsubheading Synopsis
27791
27792 @smallexample
27793 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27794 @end smallexample
27795
27796 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27797 following info:
27798
27799 @table @samp
27800 @item @var{level}
27801 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27802 @item @var{addr}
27803 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27804 @item @var{func}
27805 Function name.
27806 @item @var{file}
27807 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27808 @item @var{fullname}
27809 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27810 @item @var{line}
27811 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27812 @item @var{from}
27813 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27814 if the frame's function is not known.
27815 @end table
27816
27817 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27818 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27819 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27820 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27821 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27822 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27823 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27824 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27825 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27826
27827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27828
27829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27830
27831 @subsubheading Example
27832
27833 Full stack backtrace:
27834
27835 @smallexample
27836 (gdb)
27837 -stack-list-frames
27838 ^done,stack=
27839 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27840 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27841 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27842 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27843 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27844 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27845 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27846 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27847 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27848 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27849 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27850 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27851 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27852 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27853 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27854 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27855 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27856 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27857 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27858 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27859 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27860 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27861 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27862 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27863 (gdb)
27864 @end smallexample
27865
27866 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27867
27868 @smallexample
27869 (gdb)
27870 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27871 ^done,stack=
27872 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27873 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27874 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27875 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27876 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27877 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27878 (gdb)
27879 @end smallexample
27880
27881 Show a single frame:
27882
27883 @smallexample
27884 (gdb)
27885 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27886 ^done,stack=
27887 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27888 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27889 (gdb)
27890 @end smallexample
27891
27892
27893 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27894 @findex -stack-list-locals
27895 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27896
27897 @subsubheading Synopsis
27898
27899 @smallexample
27900 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27901 @end smallexample
27902
27903 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27904 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27905 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27906 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27907 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27908 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27909 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27910 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27911 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27912 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27913
27914 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27915 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27916 variables are still displayed, however.
27917
27918 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27919 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27920
27921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27922
27923 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27924
27925 @subsubheading Example
27926
27927 @smallexample
27928 (gdb)
27929 -stack-list-locals 0
27930 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27931 (gdb)
27932 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27933 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27934 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27935 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27936 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27937 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27938 (gdb)
27939 @end smallexample
27940
27941 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27942 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27943 @findex -stack-list-variables
27944
27945 @subsubheading Synopsis
27946
27947 @smallexample
27948 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27949 @end smallexample
27950
27951 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27952 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27953 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27954 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27955 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27956 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27957 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27958
27959 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27960 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27961 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27962
27963 @subsubheading Example
27964
27965 @smallexample
27966 (gdb)
27967 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27968 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27969 (gdb)
27970 @end smallexample
27971
27972
27973 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27974 @findex -stack-select-frame
27975
27976 @subsubheading Synopsis
27977
27978 @smallexample
27979 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27980 @end smallexample
27981
27982 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27983 the stack.
27984
27985 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27986 option to every command.
27987
27988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27989
27990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27991 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27992
27993 @subsubheading Example
27994
27995 @smallexample
27996 (gdb)
27997 -stack-select-frame 2
27998 ^done
27999 (gdb)
28000 @end smallexample
28001
28002 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28003 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28004 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28005
28006 @ignore
28007
28008 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28009
28010 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28011 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28012 used by @code{Insight}.
28013
28014 The two main reasons for that are:
28015
28016 @enumerate 1
28017 @item
28018 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28019
28020 @item
28021 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28022 now).
28023 @end enumerate
28024
28025 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28026 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28027 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28028 hints about their use.
28029
28030 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28031 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28032 least, the following operations:
28033
28034 @itemize @bullet
28035 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28036 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28037 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28038 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28039 @end itemize
28040
28041 @end ignore
28042
28043 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28044
28045 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28046
28047 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28048 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28049 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28050 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28051 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28052 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28053 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28054 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28055 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28056 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28057 object, or to change display format.
28058
28059 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28060 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28061 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28062 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28063 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28064 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28065 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28066 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28067 child will be created.
28068
28069 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28070 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28071 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28072 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28073 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28074
28075 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28076 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28077 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28078 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28079 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28080 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28081 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28082 variables that frontend has created.
28083
28084 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28085 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28086 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28087 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28088 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28089 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28090 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28091 implicitly updated.
28092
28093 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28094 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28095 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28096 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28097 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28098 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28099 frame. Consider this example:
28100
28101 @smallexample
28102 void do_work(...)
28103 @{
28104 struct work_state state;
28105
28106 if (...)
28107 do_work(...);
28108 @}
28109 @end smallexample
28110
28111 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28112 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28113 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28114 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28115 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28116
28117 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28118 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28119 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28120 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28121 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28122 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28123
28124 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28125 access this functionality:
28126
28127 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28128 @item @strong{Operation}
28129 @tab @strong{Description}
28130
28131 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28132 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28133 @item @code{-var-create}
28134 @tab create a variable object
28135 @item @code{-var-delete}
28136 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28137 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28138 @tab set the display format of this variable
28139 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28140 @tab show the display format of this variable
28141 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28142 @tab tells how many children this object has
28143 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28144 @tab return a list of the object's children
28145 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28146 @tab show the type of this variable object
28147 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28148 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28149 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28150 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28151 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28152 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28153 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28154 @tab get the value of this variable
28155 @item @code{-var-assign}
28156 @tab set the value of this variable
28157 @item @code{-var-update}
28158 @tab update the variable and its children
28159 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28160 @tab set frozeness attribute
28161 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28162 @tab set range of children to display on update
28163 @end multitable
28164
28165 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28166 how it can be used.
28167
28168 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28169
28170 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28171 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28172
28173 @smallexample
28174 -enable-pretty-printing
28175 @end smallexample
28176
28177 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28178 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28179 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28180 request that this functionality be enabled.
28181
28182 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28183
28184 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28185 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28186
28187 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28188 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28189
28190 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28191 @findex -var-create
28192
28193 @subsubheading Synopsis
28194
28195 @smallexample
28196 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28197 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28198 @end smallexample
28199
28200 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28201 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28202 register.
28203
28204 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28205 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28206 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28207 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28208 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28209
28210 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28211 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28212 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28213 object must be created.
28214
28215 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28216 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28217
28218 @itemize @bullet
28219 @item
28220 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28221
28222 @item
28223 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28224
28225 @item
28226 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28227 @end itemize
28228
28229 @cindex dynamic varobj
28230 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28231 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28232 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28233 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28234 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28235 compatibility for existing clients.
28236
28237 @subsubheading Result
28238
28239 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28240 are:
28241
28242 @table @samp
28243 @item name
28244 The name of the varobj.
28245
28246 @item numchild
28247 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28248 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28249 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28250
28251 @item value
28252 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28253 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28254 will not be interesting.
28255
28256 @item type
28257 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28258 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28259 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28260 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28261 @emph{declared} one.
28262
28263 @item thread-id
28264 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28265 thread's identifier.
28266
28267 @item has_more
28268 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28269 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28270
28271 @item dynamic
28272 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28273 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28274 then this attribute will not be present.
28275
28276 @item displayhint
28277 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28278 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28279 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28280 @end table
28281
28282 Typical output will look like this:
28283
28284 @smallexample
28285 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28286 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28287 @end smallexample
28288
28289
28290 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28291 @findex -var-delete
28292
28293 @subsubheading Synopsis
28294
28295 @smallexample
28296 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28297 @end smallexample
28298
28299 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28300 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28301
28302 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28303
28304
28305 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28306 @findex -var-set-format
28307
28308 @subsubheading Synopsis
28309
28310 @smallexample
28311 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28312 @end smallexample
28313
28314 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28315 @var{format-spec}.
28316
28317 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28318 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28319
28320 @smallexample
28321 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28322 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28323 @end smallexample
28324
28325 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28326 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28327 for pointers, etc.).
28328
28329 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28330 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28331
28332 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28333 @findex -var-show-format
28334
28335 @subsubheading Synopsis
28336
28337 @smallexample
28338 -var-show-format @var{name}
28339 @end smallexample
28340
28341 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28342
28343 @smallexample
28344 @var{format} @expansion{}
28345 @var{format-spec}
28346 @end smallexample
28347
28348
28349 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28350 @findex -var-info-num-children
28351
28352 @subsubheading Synopsis
28353
28354 @smallexample
28355 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28356 @end smallexample
28357
28358 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28359
28360 @smallexample
28361 numchild=@var{n}
28362 @end smallexample
28363
28364 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28365 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28366 be available.
28367
28368
28369 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28370 @findex -var-list-children
28371
28372 @subsubheading Synopsis
28373
28374 @smallexample
28375 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28376 @end smallexample
28377 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28378
28379 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28380 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28381 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28382 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28383 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28384 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28385 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28386 and unions.
28387
28388 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28389 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28390 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28391 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28392 reported.
28393
28394 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28395 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28396 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28397 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28398 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28399 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28400 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28401 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28402 the visible items.
28403
28404 For each child the following results are returned:
28405
28406 @table @var
28407
28408 @item name
28409 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28410
28411 @item exp
28412 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28413 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28414
28415 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28416 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28417
28418 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28419 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28420 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28421 type and value are not present.
28422
28423 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28424 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28425 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28426
28427 @item numchild
28428 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28429 0.
28430
28431 @item type
28432 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28433 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28434 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28435 @emph{declared} one.
28436
28437 @item value
28438 If values were requested, this is the value.
28439
28440 @item thread-id
28441 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28442 Otherwise this result is not present.
28443
28444 @item frozen
28445 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28446
28447 @item displayhint
28448 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28449 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28450 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28451
28452 @item dynamic
28453 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28454 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28455 then this attribute will not be present.
28456
28457 @end table
28458
28459 The result may have its own attributes:
28460
28461 @table @samp
28462 @item displayhint
28463 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28464 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28465 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28466
28467 @item has_more
28468 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28469 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28470 @end table
28471
28472 @subsubheading Example
28473
28474 @smallexample
28475 (gdb)
28476 -var-list-children n
28477 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28478 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28479 (gdb)
28480 -var-list-children --all-values n
28481 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28482 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28483 @end smallexample
28484
28485
28486 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28487 @findex -var-info-type
28488
28489 @subsubheading Synopsis
28490
28491 @smallexample
28492 -var-info-type @var{name}
28493 @end smallexample
28494
28495 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28496 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28497 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28498
28499 @smallexample
28500 type=@var{typename}
28501 @end smallexample
28502
28503
28504 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28505 @findex -var-info-expression
28506
28507 @subsubheading Synopsis
28508
28509 @smallexample
28510 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28511 @end smallexample
28512
28513 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28514 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28515 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28516
28517 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28518 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28519
28520 @smallexample
28521 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28522 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28523 @end smallexample
28524
28525 @noindent
28526 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28527 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28528
28529 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28530 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28531 is of limited use.
28532
28533 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28534 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28535
28536 @subsubheading Synopsis
28537
28538 @smallexample
28539 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28540 @end smallexample
28541
28542 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28543 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28544 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28545 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28546 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28547 watchpoint from a variable object.
28548
28549 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28550 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28551
28552 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28553 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28554 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28555 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28556 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28557 @smallexample
28558 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28559 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28560 @end smallexample
28561
28562 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28563 @findex -var-show-attributes
28564
28565 @subsubheading Synopsis
28566
28567 @smallexample
28568 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28569 @end smallexample
28570
28571 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28572
28573 @smallexample
28574 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28575 @end smallexample
28576
28577 @noindent
28578 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28579
28580 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28581 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28582
28583 @subsubheading Synopsis
28584
28585 @smallexample
28586 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28587 @end smallexample
28588
28589 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28590 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28591 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28592 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28593 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28594 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28595 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28596
28597 @smallexample
28598 value=@var{value}
28599 @end smallexample
28600
28601 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28602 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28603
28604 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28605 @findex -var-assign
28606
28607 @subsubheading Synopsis
28608
28609 @smallexample
28610 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28611 @end smallexample
28612
28613 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28614 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28615 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28616 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28617
28618 @subsubheading Example
28619
28620 @smallexample
28621 (gdb)
28622 -var-assign var1 3
28623 ^done,value="3"
28624 (gdb)
28625 -var-update *
28626 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28627 (gdb)
28628 @end smallexample
28629
28630 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28631 @findex -var-update
28632
28633 @subsubheading Synopsis
28634
28635 @smallexample
28636 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28637 @end smallexample
28638
28639 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28640 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28641 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28642 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28643 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28644 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28645 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28646 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28647 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28648 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28649 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28650 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28651 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28652
28653 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28654 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28655 diagnostic.
28656
28657 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28658 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28659
28660 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28661 @samp{changelist}.
28662
28663 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28664
28665 @table @samp
28666 @item name
28667 The name of the varobj.
28668
28669 @item value
28670 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28671 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28672
28673 @item in_scope
28674 @anchor{-var-update}
28675 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28676
28677 @table @code
28678 @item "true"
28679 The variable object's current value is valid.
28680
28681 @item "false"
28682 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28683 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28684 scope.
28685
28686 @item "invalid"
28687 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28688 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28689 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28690 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28691 objects.
28692 @end table
28693
28694 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28695 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28696
28697 @item type_changed
28698 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28699 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28700 be @samp{false}.
28701
28702 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28703 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28704 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28705 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28706 unset.
28707
28708 @item new_type
28709 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28710 hold the new type.
28711
28712 @item new_num_children
28713 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28714 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28715
28716 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28717 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28718 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28719 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28720 children which may be available.
28721
28722 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28723 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28724 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28725 only happen at the end of the update range).
28726
28727 @item displayhint
28728 The display hint, if any.
28729
28730 @item has_more
28731 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28732 available outside the varobj's update range.
28733
28734 @item dynamic
28735 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28736 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28737 then this attribute will not be present.
28738
28739 @item new_children
28740 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28741 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28742 be listed in this attribute.
28743 @end table
28744
28745 @subsubheading Example
28746
28747 @smallexample
28748 (gdb)
28749 -var-assign var1 3
28750 ^done,value="3"
28751 (gdb)
28752 -var-update --all-values var1
28753 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28754 type_changed="false"@}]
28755 (gdb)
28756 @end smallexample
28757
28758 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28759 @findex -var-set-frozen
28760 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28761
28762 @subsubheading Synopsis
28763
28764 @smallexample
28765 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28766 @end smallexample
28767
28768 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28769 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28770 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28771 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28772 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28773 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28774 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28775 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28776 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28777 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28778 @code{-var-update} does.
28779
28780 @subsubheading Example
28781
28782 @smallexample
28783 (gdb)
28784 -var-set-frozen V 1
28785 ^done
28786 (gdb)
28787 @end smallexample
28788
28789 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28790 @findex -var-set-update-range
28791 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28792
28793 @subsubheading Synopsis
28794
28795 @smallexample
28796 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28797 @end smallexample
28798
28799 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28800 @code{-var-update}.
28801
28802 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28803 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28804 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28805 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28806
28807 @subsubheading Example
28808
28809 @smallexample
28810 (gdb)
28811 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28812 ^done
28813 @end smallexample
28814
28815 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28816 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28817 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28818
28819 @subsubheading Synopsis
28820
28821 @smallexample
28822 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28823 @end smallexample
28824
28825 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28826
28827 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28828 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28829
28830 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28831 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28832 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28833 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28834 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28835 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28836 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28837
28838 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28839 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28840 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28841 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28842
28843 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28844 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28845 can be used to check this.
28846
28847 @subsubheading Example
28848
28849 Resetting the visualizer:
28850
28851 @smallexample
28852 (gdb)
28853 -var-set-visualizer V None
28854 ^done
28855 @end smallexample
28856
28857 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28858
28859 @smallexample
28860 (gdb)
28861 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28862 ^done
28863 @end smallexample
28864
28865 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28866 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28867
28868 @smallexample
28869 (gdb)
28870 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28871 ^done
28872 @end smallexample
28873
28874 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28875 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28876 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28877
28878 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28879 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28880 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28881 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28882
28883 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28884 @c @subheading -data-assign
28885 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28886 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28887 @c set variable
28888 @c @subsubheading Example
28889 @c N.A.
28890
28891 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28892 @findex -data-disassemble
28893
28894 @subsubheading Synopsis
28895
28896 @smallexample
28897 -data-disassemble
28898 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28899 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28900 -- @var{mode}
28901 @end smallexample
28902
28903 @noindent
28904 Where:
28905
28906 @table @samp
28907 @item @var{start-addr}
28908 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28909 @item @var{end-addr}
28910 is the end address
28911 @item @var{filename}
28912 is the name of the file to disassemble
28913 @item @var{linenum}
28914 is the line number to disassemble around
28915 @item @var{lines}
28916 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28917 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28918 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28919 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28920 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28921 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28922 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28923 are displayed.
28924 @item @var{mode}
28925 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28926 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28927 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28928 @end table
28929
28930 @subsubheading Result
28931
28932 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28933 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28934 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28935
28936 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28937 following fields:
28938
28939 @table @code
28940 @item address
28941 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28942
28943 @item func-name
28944 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28945
28946 @item offset
28947 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28948
28949 @item inst
28950 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28951
28952 @item opcodes
28953 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28954 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28955
28956 @end table
28957
28958 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28959 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28960
28961 @table @code
28962 @item line
28963 The line number within @samp{file}.
28964
28965 @item file
28966 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28967 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28968 used.
28969
28970 @item fullname
28971 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28972 using the source file search path
28973 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28974 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28975
28976 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28977 present in the debug information.
28978
28979 @item line_asm_insn
28980 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28981 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28982 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28983 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28984 @samp{opcodes}.
28985
28986 @end table
28987
28988 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28989 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28990 adjust its format.
28991
28992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28993
28994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28995
28996 @subsubheading Example
28997
28998 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28999
29000 @smallexample
29001 (gdb)
29002 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29003 ^done,
29004 asm_insns=[
29005 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29006 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29007 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29008 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29009 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29010 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29011 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29012 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29013 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29014 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29015 (gdb)
29016 @end smallexample
29017
29018 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29019 @code{main}.
29020
29021 @smallexample
29022 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29023 ^done,asm_insns=[
29024 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29025 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29026 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29027 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29028 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29029 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29030 [@dots{}]
29031 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29032 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29033 (gdb)
29034 @end smallexample
29035
29036 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29037
29038 @smallexample
29039 (gdb)
29040 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29041 ^done,asm_insns=[
29042 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29043 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29044 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29045 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29046 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29047 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29048 (gdb)
29049 @end smallexample
29050
29051 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29052
29053 @smallexample
29054 (gdb)
29055 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29056 ^done,asm_insns=[
29057 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29058 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29059 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29060 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29061 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29062 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29063 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29064 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29065 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29066 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29067 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29068 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29069 (gdb)
29070 @end smallexample
29071
29072
29073 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29074 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29075
29076 @subsubheading Synopsis
29077
29078 @smallexample
29079 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29080 @end smallexample
29081
29082 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29083 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29084 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29085
29086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29087
29088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29089 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29090 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29091
29092 @subsubheading Example
29093
29094 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29095 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29096 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29097 output.
29098
29099 @smallexample
29100 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29101 211^done,value="1"
29102 (gdb)
29103 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29104 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29105 (gdb)
29106 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29107 411^done,value="4"
29108 (gdb)
29109 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29110 511^done,value="4"
29111 (gdb)
29112 @end smallexample
29113
29114
29115 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29116 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29117
29118 @subsubheading Synopsis
29119
29120 @smallexample
29121 -data-list-changed-registers
29122 @end smallexample
29123
29124 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29125
29126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29127
29128 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29129 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29130
29131 @subsubheading Example
29132
29133 On a PPC MBX board:
29134
29135 @smallexample
29136 (gdb)
29137 -exec-continue
29138 ^running
29139
29140 (gdb)
29141 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29142 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29143 line="5"@}
29144 (gdb)
29145 -data-list-changed-registers
29146 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29147 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29148 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29149 (gdb)
29150 @end smallexample
29151
29152
29153 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29154 @findex -data-list-register-names
29155
29156 @subsubheading Synopsis
29157
29158 @smallexample
29159 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29160 @end smallexample
29161
29162 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29163 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29164 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29165 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29166 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29167 include empty register names.
29168
29169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29170
29171 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29172 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29173 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29174
29175 @subsubheading Example
29176
29177 For the PPC MBX board:
29178 @smallexample
29179 (gdb)
29180 -data-list-register-names
29181 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29182 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29183 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29184 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29185 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29186 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29187 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29188 (gdb)
29189 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29190 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29191 (gdb)
29192 @end smallexample
29193
29194 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29195 @findex -data-list-register-values
29196
29197 @subsubheading Synopsis
29198
29199 @smallexample
29200 -data-list-register-values
29201 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29202 @end smallexample
29203
29204 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29205 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29206 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29207 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29208 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29209 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29210
29211 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29212
29213 @table @code
29214 @item x
29215 Hexadecimal
29216 @item o
29217 Octal
29218 @item t
29219 Binary
29220 @item d
29221 Decimal
29222 @item r
29223 Raw
29224 @item N
29225 Natural
29226 @end table
29227
29228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29229
29230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29231 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29232
29233 @subsubheading Example
29234
29235 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29236 don't appear in the actual output):
29237
29238 @smallexample
29239 (gdb)
29240 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29241 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29242 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29243 (gdb)
29244 -data-list-register-values x
29245 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29246 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29247 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29248 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29249 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29250 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29251 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29252 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29253 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29254 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29255 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29256 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29257 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29258 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29259 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29260 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29261 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29262 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29263 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29264 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29265 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29266 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29267 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29268 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29269 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29270 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29271 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29272 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29273 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29274 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29275 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29276 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29277 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29278 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29279 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29280 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29281 (gdb)
29282 @end smallexample
29283
29284
29285 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29286 @findex -data-read-memory
29287
29288 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29289
29290 @subsubheading Synopsis
29291
29292 @smallexample
29293 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29294 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29295 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29296 @end smallexample
29297
29298 @noindent
29299 where:
29300
29301 @table @samp
29302 @item @var{address}
29303 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29304 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29305 quoted using the C convention.
29306
29307 @item @var{word-format}
29308 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29309 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29310 ,Output Formats}).
29311
29312 @item @var{word-size}
29313 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29314
29315 @item @var{nr-rows}
29316 The number of rows in the output table.
29317
29318 @item @var{nr-cols}
29319 The number of columns in the output table.
29320
29321 @item @var{aschar}
29322 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29323 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29324 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29325 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29326
29327 @item @var{byte-offset}
29328 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29329 @end table
29330
29331 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29332 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29333 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29334 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29335 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29336 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29337 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29338 @samp{addr}.
29339
29340 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29341 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29342 @samp{prev-page}.
29343
29344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29345
29346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29347 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29348
29349 @subsubheading Example
29350
29351 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29352 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29353 word. Display each word in hex.
29354
29355 @smallexample
29356 (gdb)
29357 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29358 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29359 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29360 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29361 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29362 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29363 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29364 (gdb)
29365 @end smallexample
29366
29367 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29368 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29369
29370 @smallexample
29371 (gdb)
29372 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29373 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29374 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29375 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29376 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29377 (gdb)
29378 @end smallexample
29379
29380 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29381 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29382 used as the non-printable character.
29383
29384 @smallexample
29385 (gdb)
29386 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29387 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29388 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29389 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29390 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29391 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29392 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29393 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29394 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29395 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29396 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29397 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29398 (gdb)
29399 @end smallexample
29400
29401 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29402 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29403
29404 @subsubheading Synopsis
29405
29406 @smallexample
29407 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29408 @var{address} @var{count}
29409 @end smallexample
29410
29411 @noindent
29412 where:
29413
29414 @table @samp
29415 @item @var{address}
29416 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29417 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29418 quoted using the C convention.
29419
29420 @item @var{count}
29421 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29422
29423 @item @var{byte-offset}
29424 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29425 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29426 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29427 perform address arithmetics itself.
29428
29429 @end table
29430
29431 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29432 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29433 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29434 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29435 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29436 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29437
29438 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29439 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29440 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29441 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29442 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29443 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29444 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29445 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29446
29447 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29448 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29449 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29450 and has the following fields:
29451
29452 @table @code
29453 @item begin
29454 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29455
29456 @item end
29457 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29458
29459 @item offset
29460 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29461 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29462
29463 @item contents
29464 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29465
29466 @end table
29467
29468
29469
29470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29471
29472 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29473
29474 @subsubheading Example
29475
29476 @smallexample
29477 (gdb)
29478 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29479 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29480 end="0xbffff15e",
29481 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29482 (gdb)
29483 @end smallexample
29484
29485
29486 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29487 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29488
29489 @subsubheading Synopsis
29490
29491 @smallexample
29492 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29493 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29494 @end smallexample
29495
29496 @noindent
29497 where:
29498
29499 @table @samp
29500 @item @var{address}
29501 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29502 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29503 quoted using the C convention.
29504
29505 @item @var{contents}
29506 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29507
29508 @item @var{count}
29509 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29510 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29511 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29512
29513 @end table
29514
29515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29516
29517 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29518
29519 @subsubheading Example
29520
29521 @smallexample
29522 (gdb)
29523 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29524 ^done
29525 (gdb)
29526 @end smallexample
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 (gdb)
29530 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29531 ^done
29532 (gdb)
29533 @end smallexample
29534
29535 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29536 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29537 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29538
29539 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29540 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29541
29542 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29543 @findex -trace-find
29544
29545 @subsubheading Synopsis
29546
29547 @smallexample
29548 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29549 @end smallexample
29550
29551 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29552 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29553 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29554
29555 @table @samp
29556
29557 @item none
29558 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29559
29560 @item frame-number
29561 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29562 that index.
29563
29564 @item tracepoint-number
29565 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29566 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29567
29568 @item pc
29569 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29570 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29571 address.
29572
29573 @item pc-inside-range
29574 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29575 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29576 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29577
29578 @item pc-outside-range
29579 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29580 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29581 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29582
29583 @item line
29584 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29585 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29586 the specified location.
29587
29588 @end table
29589
29590 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29591 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29592
29593 @table @samp
29594 @item found
29595 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29596 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29597
29598 @item traceframe
29599 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29600 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29601
29602 @item tracepoint
29603 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29604 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29605
29606 @item frame
29607 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29608 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29609 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29610
29611 @end table
29612
29613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29614
29615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29616
29617 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29618 @findex -trace-define-variable
29619
29620 @subsubheading Synopsis
29621
29622 @smallexample
29623 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29624 @end smallexample
29625
29626 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29627 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29628 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29629 with the @samp{$} character.
29630
29631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29632
29633 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29634
29635 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29636 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29637
29638 @subsubheading Synopsis
29639
29640 @smallexample
29641 -trace-frame-collected
29642 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29643 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29644 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29645 [--memory-contents]
29646 @end smallexample
29647
29648 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29649 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29650 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29651 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29652 See the output description table below for more details.
29653
29654 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29655 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29656 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29657 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29658 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29659
29660 For instance, if the actions were
29661 @smallexample
29662 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29663 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29664 @end smallexample
29665
29666 @noindent
29667 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29668 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29669 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29670 objects would be computed expressions.
29671
29672 An example output would be:
29673
29674 @smallexample
29675 (gdb)
29676 -trace-frame-collected
29677 ^done,
29678 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29679 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29680 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29681 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29682 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29683 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29684 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29685 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29686 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29687 ...
29688 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29689 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29690 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29691 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29692 (gdb)
29693 @end smallexample
29694
29695 Where:
29696
29697 @table @code
29698 @item explicit-variables
29699 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29700 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29701 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29702 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29703 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29704 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29705 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29706 arrays, structures and unions.
29707
29708 @item computed-expressions
29709 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29710 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29711 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29712 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29713
29714 @item registers
29715 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29716 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29717 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29718 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29719 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29720
29721 @item tvars
29722 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29723 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29724 current value are returned.
29725
29726 @item memory
29727 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29728 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29729 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29730
29731 @table @code
29732 @item address
29733 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29734
29735 @item length
29736 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29737
29738 @item contents
29739 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29740 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29741
29742 @end table
29743
29744 @end table
29745
29746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29747
29748 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29749
29750 @subsubheading Example
29751
29752 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29753 @findex -trace-list-variables
29754
29755 @subsubheading Synopsis
29756
29757 @smallexample
29758 -trace-list-variables
29759 @end smallexample
29760
29761 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29762 table has the following fields:
29763
29764 @table @samp
29765 @item name
29766 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29767
29768 @item initial
29769 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29770 field is always present.
29771
29772 @item current
29773 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29774 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29775 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29776 presently running.
29777
29778 @end table
29779
29780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29781
29782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29783
29784 @subsubheading Example
29785
29786 @smallexample
29787 (gdb)
29788 -trace-list-variables
29789 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29790 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29791 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29792 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29793 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29794 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29795 (gdb)
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798 @subheading -trace-save
29799 @findex -trace-save
29800
29801 @subsubheading Synopsis
29802
29803 @smallexample
29804 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29805 @end smallexample
29806
29807 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29808 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29809 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29810 to perform the save.
29811
29812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29813
29814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29815
29816
29817 @subheading -trace-start
29818 @findex -trace-start
29819
29820 @subsubheading Synopsis
29821
29822 @smallexample
29823 -trace-start
29824 @end smallexample
29825
29826 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29827 have any fields.
29828
29829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29830
29831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29832
29833 @subheading -trace-status
29834 @findex -trace-status
29835
29836 @subsubheading Synopsis
29837
29838 @smallexample
29839 -trace-status
29840 @end smallexample
29841
29842 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29843 the following fields:
29844
29845 @table @samp
29846
29847 @item supported
29848 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29849 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29850 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29851 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29852 started. This field is always present.
29853
29854 @item running
29855 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29856 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29857 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29858
29859 @item stop-reason
29860 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29861 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29862 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29863 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29864 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29865 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29866 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29867 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29868 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29869
29870 @item stopping-tracepoint
29871 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29872 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29873 @samp{passcount}.
29874
29875 @item frames
29876 @itemx frames-created
29877 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29878 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29879 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29880 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29881
29882 @item buffer-size
29883 @itemx buffer-free
29884 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29885 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29886
29887 @item circular
29888 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29889 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29890 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29891 and may fill up.
29892
29893 @item disconnected
29894 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29895 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29896 that the trace run will stop.
29897
29898 @item trace-file
29899 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29900 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29901
29902 @end table
29903
29904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29905
29906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29907
29908 @subheading -trace-stop
29909 @findex -trace-stop
29910
29911 @subsubheading Synopsis
29912
29913 @smallexample
29914 -trace-stop
29915 @end smallexample
29916
29917 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29918 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29919 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29920
29921 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29922
29923 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29924
29925
29926 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29927 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29928 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29929
29930
29931 @ignore
29932 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29933 @findex -symbol-info-address
29934
29935 @subsubheading Synopsis
29936
29937 @smallexample
29938 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29939 @end smallexample
29940
29941 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29942
29943 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29944
29945 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29946
29947 @subsubheading Example
29948 N.A.
29949
29950
29951 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29952 @findex -symbol-info-file
29953
29954 @subsubheading Synopsis
29955
29956 @smallexample
29957 -symbol-info-file
29958 @end smallexample
29959
29960 Show the file for the symbol.
29961
29962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29963
29964 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29965 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29966
29967 @subsubheading Example
29968 N.A.
29969
29970
29971 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29972 @findex -symbol-info-function
29973
29974 @subsubheading Synopsis
29975
29976 @smallexample
29977 -symbol-info-function
29978 @end smallexample
29979
29980 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29981
29982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29983
29984 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29985
29986 @subsubheading Example
29987 N.A.
29988
29989
29990 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29991 @findex -symbol-info-line
29992
29993 @subsubheading Synopsis
29994
29995 @smallexample
29996 -symbol-info-line
29997 @end smallexample
29998
29999 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30000
30001 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30002
30003 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30004 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30005
30006 @subsubheading Example
30007 N.A.
30008
30009
30010 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30011 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30012
30013 @subsubheading Synopsis
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30017 @end smallexample
30018
30019 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30020
30021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30022
30023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30024
30025 @subsubheading Example
30026 N.A.
30027
30028
30029 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30030 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30031
30032 @subsubheading Synopsis
30033
30034 @smallexample
30035 -symbol-list-functions
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038 List the functions in the executable.
30039
30040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30041
30042 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30043 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30044
30045 @subsubheading Example
30046 N.A.
30047 @end ignore
30048
30049
30050 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30051 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30052
30053 @subsubheading Synopsis
30054
30055 @smallexample
30056 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30057 @end smallexample
30058
30059 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30060 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30061 ascending PC order.
30062
30063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30064
30065 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30066
30067 @subsubheading Example
30068 @smallexample
30069 (gdb)
30070 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30071 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30072 (gdb)
30073 @end smallexample
30074
30075
30076 @ignore
30077 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30078 @findex -symbol-list-types
30079
30080 @subsubheading Synopsis
30081
30082 @smallexample
30083 -symbol-list-types
30084 @end smallexample
30085
30086 List all the type names.
30087
30088 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30089
30090 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30091 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30092
30093 @subsubheading Example
30094 N.A.
30095
30096
30097 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30098 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30099
30100 @subsubheading Synopsis
30101
30102 @smallexample
30103 -symbol-list-variables
30104 @end smallexample
30105
30106 List all the global and static variable names.
30107
30108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30109
30110 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30111
30112 @subsubheading Example
30113 N.A.
30114
30115
30116 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30117 @findex -symbol-locate
30118
30119 @subsubheading Synopsis
30120
30121 @smallexample
30122 -symbol-locate
30123 @end smallexample
30124
30125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30126
30127 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30128
30129 @subsubheading Example
30130 N.A.
30131
30132
30133 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30134 @findex -symbol-type
30135
30136 @subsubheading Synopsis
30137
30138 @smallexample
30139 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30140 @end smallexample
30141
30142 Show type of @var{variable}.
30143
30144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30145
30146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30147 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30148
30149 @subsubheading Example
30150 N.A.
30151 @end ignore
30152
30153
30154 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30155 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30156 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30157
30158 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30159 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30160
30161 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30162 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30163
30164 @subsubheading Synopsis
30165
30166 @smallexample
30167 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30168 @end smallexample
30169
30170 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30171 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30172 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30173 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30174 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30175 notification.
30176
30177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30178
30179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30180
30181 @subsubheading Example
30182
30183 @smallexample
30184 (gdb)
30185 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30186 ^done
30187 (gdb)
30188 @end smallexample
30189
30190
30191 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30192 @findex -file-exec-file
30193
30194 @subsubheading Synopsis
30195
30196 @smallexample
30197 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30198 @end smallexample
30199
30200 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30201 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30202 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30203 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30204 notification.
30205
30206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30207
30208 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30209
30210 @subsubheading Example
30211
30212 @smallexample
30213 (gdb)
30214 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30215 ^done
30216 (gdb)
30217 @end smallexample
30218
30219
30220 @ignore
30221 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30222 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30223
30224 @subsubheading Synopsis
30225
30226 @smallexample
30227 -file-list-exec-sections
30228 @end smallexample
30229
30230 List the sections of the current executable file.
30231
30232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30233
30234 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30235 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30236 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30237
30238 @subsubheading Example
30239 N.A.
30240 @end ignore
30241
30242
30243 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30244 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30245
30246 @subsubheading Synopsis
30247
30248 @smallexample
30249 -file-list-exec-source-file
30250 @end smallexample
30251
30252 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30253 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30254 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30255 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30256
30257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30258
30259 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30260
30261 @subsubheading Example
30262
30263 @smallexample
30264 (gdb)
30265 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30266 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30267 (gdb)
30268 @end smallexample
30269
30270
30271 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30272 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30273
30274 @subsubheading Synopsis
30275
30276 @smallexample
30277 -file-list-exec-source-files
30278 @end smallexample
30279
30280 List the source files for the current executable.
30281
30282 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30283 name) of a source file.
30284
30285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30286
30287 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30288 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30289
30290 @subsubheading Example
30291 @smallexample
30292 (gdb)
30293 -file-list-exec-source-files
30294 ^done,files=[
30295 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30296 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30297 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30298 (gdb)
30299 @end smallexample
30300
30301 @ignore
30302 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30303 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30304
30305 @subsubheading Synopsis
30306
30307 @smallexample
30308 -file-list-shared-libraries
30309 @end smallexample
30310
30311 List the shared libraries in the program.
30312
30313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30314
30315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30316
30317 @subsubheading Example
30318 N.A.
30319
30320
30321 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30322 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30323
30324 @subsubheading Synopsis
30325
30326 @smallexample
30327 -file-list-symbol-files
30328 @end smallexample
30329
30330 List symbol files.
30331
30332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30333
30334 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30335
30336 @subsubheading Example
30337 N.A.
30338 @end ignore
30339
30340
30341 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30342 @findex -file-symbol-file
30343
30344 @subsubheading Synopsis
30345
30346 @smallexample
30347 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30348 @end smallexample
30349
30350 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30351 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30352 produced, except for a completion notification.
30353
30354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30355
30356 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30357
30358 @subsubheading Example
30359
30360 @smallexample
30361 (gdb)
30362 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30363 ^done
30364 (gdb)
30365 @end smallexample
30366
30367 @ignore
30368 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30369 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30370 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30371
30372 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30373
30374 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30375
30376 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30377
30378 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30379
30380 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30381
30382 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30383
30384 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30385
30386 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30387
30388 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30389 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30390 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30391
30392 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30393
30394 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30395
30396 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30397
30398 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30399 @end ignore
30400
30401
30402 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30403 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30404 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30405
30406
30407 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30408 @findex -target-attach
30409
30410 @subsubheading Synopsis
30411
30412 @smallexample
30413 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30414 @end smallexample
30415
30416 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30417 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30418 group, the id previously returned by
30419 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30420
30421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30422
30423 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30424
30425 @subsubheading Example
30426 @smallexample
30427 (gdb)
30428 -target-attach 34
30429 =thread-created,id="1"
30430 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30431 ^done
30432 (gdb)
30433 @end smallexample
30434
30435 @ignore
30436 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30437 @findex -target-compare-sections
30438
30439 @subsubheading Synopsis
30440
30441 @smallexample
30442 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30443 @end smallexample
30444
30445 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30446 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30447
30448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30449
30450 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30451
30452 @subsubheading Example
30453 N.A.
30454 @end ignore
30455
30456
30457 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30458 @findex -target-detach
30459
30460 @subsubheading Synopsis
30461
30462 @smallexample
30463 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30464 @end smallexample
30465
30466 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30467 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30468 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30469
30470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30471
30472 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30473
30474 @subsubheading Example
30475
30476 @smallexample
30477 (gdb)
30478 -target-detach
30479 ^done
30480 (gdb)
30481 @end smallexample
30482
30483
30484 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30485 @findex -target-disconnect
30486
30487 @subsubheading Synopsis
30488
30489 @smallexample
30490 -target-disconnect
30491 @end smallexample
30492
30493 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30494 generally not resumed.
30495
30496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30497
30498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30499
30500 @subsubheading Example
30501
30502 @smallexample
30503 (gdb)
30504 -target-disconnect
30505 ^done
30506 (gdb)
30507 @end smallexample
30508
30509
30510 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30511 @findex -target-download
30512
30513 @subsubheading Synopsis
30514
30515 @smallexample
30516 -target-download
30517 @end smallexample
30518
30519 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30520 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30521
30522 @table @samp
30523 @item section
30524 The name of the section.
30525 @item section-sent
30526 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30527 @item section-size
30528 The size of the section.
30529 @item total-sent
30530 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30531 @item total-size
30532 The size of the overall executable to download.
30533 @end table
30534
30535 @noindent
30536 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30537 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30538
30539 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30540 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30541
30542 @table @samp
30543 @item section
30544 The name of the section.
30545 @item section-size
30546 The size of the section.
30547 @item total-size
30548 The size of the overall executable to download.
30549 @end table
30550
30551 @noindent
30552 At the end, a summary is printed.
30553
30554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30555
30556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30557
30558 @subsubheading Example
30559
30560 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30561 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30562
30563 @smallexample
30564 (gdb)
30565 -target-download
30566 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30567 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30568 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30569 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30570 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30571 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30572 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30573 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30574 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30575 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30576 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30577 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30578 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30579 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30580 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30581 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30582 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30583 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30584 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30585 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30586 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30587 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30588 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30589 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30590 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30591 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30592 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30593 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30594 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30595 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30596 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30597 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30598 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30599 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30600 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30601 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30602 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30603 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30604 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30605 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30606 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30607 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30608 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30609 write-rate="429"
30610 (gdb)
30611 @end smallexample
30612
30613
30614 @ignore
30615 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30616 @findex -target-exec-status
30617
30618 @subsubheading Synopsis
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 -target-exec-status
30622 @end smallexample
30623
30624 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30625 not, for instance).
30626
30627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30628
30629 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30630
30631 @subsubheading Example
30632 N.A.
30633
30634
30635 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30636 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30637
30638 @subsubheading Synopsis
30639
30640 @smallexample
30641 -target-list-available-targets
30642 @end smallexample
30643
30644 List the possible targets to connect to.
30645
30646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30647
30648 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30649
30650 @subsubheading Example
30651 N.A.
30652
30653
30654 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30655 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30656
30657 @subsubheading Synopsis
30658
30659 @smallexample
30660 -target-list-current-targets
30661 @end smallexample
30662
30663 Describe the current target.
30664
30665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30666
30667 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30668 other things).
30669
30670 @subsubheading Example
30671 N.A.
30672
30673
30674 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30675 @findex -target-list-parameters
30676
30677 @subsubheading Synopsis
30678
30679 @smallexample
30680 -target-list-parameters
30681 @end smallexample
30682
30683 @c ????
30684 @end ignore
30685
30686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30687
30688 No equivalent.
30689
30690 @subsubheading Example
30691 N.A.
30692
30693
30694 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30695 @findex -target-select
30696
30697 @subsubheading Synopsis
30698
30699 @smallexample
30700 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30701 @end smallexample
30702
30703 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30704
30705 @table @samp
30706 @item @var{type}
30707 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30708 @item @var{parameters}
30709 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30710 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30711 @end table
30712
30713 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30714 which the target program is, in the following form:
30715
30716 @smallexample
30717 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30718 args=[@var{arg list}]
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30722
30723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30724
30725 @subsubheading Example
30726
30727 @smallexample
30728 (gdb)
30729 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30730 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30731 (gdb)
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30735 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30736 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30737
30738
30739 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30740 @findex -target-file-put
30741
30742 @subsubheading Synopsis
30743
30744 @smallexample
30745 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30746 @end smallexample
30747
30748 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30749 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30750
30751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30752
30753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30754
30755 @subsubheading Example
30756
30757 @smallexample
30758 (gdb)
30759 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30760 ^done
30761 (gdb)
30762 @end smallexample
30763
30764
30765 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30766 @findex -target-file-get
30767
30768 @subsubheading Synopsis
30769
30770 @smallexample
30771 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30772 @end smallexample
30773
30774 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30775 on the host system.
30776
30777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30778
30779 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30780
30781 @subsubheading Example
30782
30783 @smallexample
30784 (gdb)
30785 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30786 ^done
30787 (gdb)
30788 @end smallexample
30789
30790
30791 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30792 @findex -target-file-delete
30793
30794 @subsubheading Synopsis
30795
30796 @smallexample
30797 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30798 @end smallexample
30799
30800 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30801
30802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30803
30804 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30805
30806 @subsubheading Example
30807
30808 @smallexample
30809 (gdb)
30810 -target-file-delete remotefile
30811 ^done
30812 (gdb)
30813 @end smallexample
30814
30815
30816 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30817 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30818 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30819
30820 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30821 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30822
30823 @subsubheading Synopsis
30824
30825 @smallexample
30826 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30827 @end smallexample
30828
30829 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30830 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30831 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30832
30833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30834
30835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30836
30837 @subsubheading Result
30838
30839 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30840 defined for each exception:
30841
30842 @table @samp
30843 @item name
30844 The name of the exception.
30845
30846 @item address
30847 The address of the exception.
30848
30849 @end table
30850
30851 @subsubheading Example
30852
30853 @smallexample
30854 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30855 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30856 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30857 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30858 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30859 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30860 @end smallexample
30861
30862 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30863
30864 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30865 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30866 Catchpoint Commands}.
30867
30868
30869 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30870 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30871 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30872
30873 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30874 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30875 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30876 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30877
30878 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30879 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30880 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30881
30882 @subsubheading Synopsis
30883
30884 @smallexample
30885 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30886 @end smallexample
30887
30888 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30889
30890 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30891 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30892 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30893 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30894 dash.
30895
30896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30897
30898 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30899
30900 @subsubheading Result
30901
30902 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30903
30904 @table @samp
30905 @item exists
30906 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30907 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30908
30909 @end table
30910
30911 @subsubheading Example
30912
30913 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30914
30915 @smallexample
30916 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30917 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30918 @end smallexample
30919
30920 @noindent
30921 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30922 to the debugger:
30923
30924 @smallexample
30925 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30926 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30927 @end smallexample
30928
30929 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30930 @findex -list-features
30931 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30932
30933 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30934 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30935 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30936 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30937 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30938 startup.
30939
30940 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30941 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30942 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30943 is given below.
30944
30945 Example output:
30946
30947 @smallexample
30948 (gdb) -list-features
30949 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30950 @end smallexample
30951
30952 The current list of features is:
30953
30954 @ftable @samp
30955 @item frozen-varobjs
30956 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30957 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30958 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30959 @item pending-breakpoints
30960 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30961 command.
30962 @item python
30963 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30964 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30965 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30966 @item thread-info
30967 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30968 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30969 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30970 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30971 @item breakpoint-notifications
30972 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30973 CLI will be announced via async records.
30974 @item ada-task-info
30975 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30976 @item language-option
30977 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30978 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30979 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30980 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30981 @item undefined-command-error-code
30982 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30983 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30984 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30985 @item exec-run-start-option
30986 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30987 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30988 @end ftable
30989
30990 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30991 @findex -list-target-features
30992
30993 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30994 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30995 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30996 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30997 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30998 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30999 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31000 Example output:
31001
31002 @smallexample
31003 (gdb) -list-target-features
31004 ^done,result=["async"]
31005 @end smallexample
31006
31007 The current list of features is:
31008
31009 @table @samp
31010 @item async
31011 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31012 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31013 while the target is running.
31014
31015 @item reverse
31016 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31017 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31018
31019 @end table
31020
31021 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31022 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31023 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31024
31025 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31026
31027 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31028 @findex -gdb-exit
31029
31030 @subsubheading Synopsis
31031
31032 @smallexample
31033 -gdb-exit
31034 @end smallexample
31035
31036 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31037
31038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31039
31040 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31041
31042 @subsubheading Example
31043
31044 @smallexample
31045 (gdb)
31046 -gdb-exit
31047 ^exit
31048 @end smallexample
31049
31050
31051 @ignore
31052 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31053 @findex -exec-abort
31054
31055 @subsubheading Synopsis
31056
31057 @smallexample
31058 -exec-abort
31059 @end smallexample
31060
31061 Kill the inferior running program.
31062
31063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31064
31065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31066
31067 @subsubheading Example
31068 N.A.
31069 @end ignore
31070
31071
31072 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31073 @findex -gdb-set
31074
31075 @subsubheading Synopsis
31076
31077 @smallexample
31078 -gdb-set
31079 @end smallexample
31080
31081 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31082 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31083
31084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31085
31086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31087
31088 @subsubheading Example
31089
31090 @smallexample
31091 (gdb)
31092 -gdb-set $foo=3
31093 ^done
31094 (gdb)
31095 @end smallexample
31096
31097
31098 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31099 @findex -gdb-show
31100
31101 @subsubheading Synopsis
31102
31103 @smallexample
31104 -gdb-show
31105 @end smallexample
31106
31107 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31108
31109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31110
31111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31112
31113 @subsubheading Example
31114
31115 @smallexample
31116 (gdb)
31117 -gdb-show annotate
31118 ^done,value="0"
31119 (gdb)
31120 @end smallexample
31121
31122 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31123
31124
31125 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31126 @findex -gdb-version
31127
31128 @subsubheading Synopsis
31129
31130 @smallexample
31131 -gdb-version
31132 @end smallexample
31133
31134 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31135
31136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31137
31138 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31139 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31140
31141 @subsubheading Example
31142
31143 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31144 @c box in TeX.
31145 @smallexample
31146 (gdb)
31147 -gdb-version
31148 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31149 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31150 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31151 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31152 ~ certain conditions.
31153 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31154 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31155 ~ details.
31156 ~This GDB was configured as
31157 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31158 ^done
31159 (gdb)
31160 @end smallexample
31161
31162 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31163 @findex -list-thread-groups
31164
31165 @subheading Synopsis
31166
31167 @smallexample
31168 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31169 @end smallexample
31170
31171 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31172 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31173 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31174 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31175 top-level thread groups.
31176
31177 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31178 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31179 available on the target.
31180
31181 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31182 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31183 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31184 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31185 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31186 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31187 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31188 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31189
31190 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31191 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31192 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31193 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31194 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31195 @samp{threads} field.
31196
31197 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31198 the following caveats:
31199
31200 @itemize @bullet
31201 @item
31202 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31203 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31204 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31205
31206 @item
31207 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31208 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31209 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31210 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31211 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31212 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31213
31214 @end itemize
31215
31216 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31217 have the following fields:
31218
31219 @table @code
31220 @item id
31221 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31222 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31223 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31224
31225 @item type
31226 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31227 valid type.
31228
31229 @item pid
31230 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31231 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31232
31233 @item num_children
31234 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31235 absent for an available thread group.
31236
31237 @item threads
31238 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31239 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31240 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31241
31242 @item cores
31243 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31244 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31245 such information is not available.
31246
31247 @item executable
31248 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31249 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31250 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31251
31252 @end table
31253
31254 @subheading Example
31255
31256 @smallexample
31257 @value{GDBP}
31258 -list-thread-groups
31259 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31260 -list-thread-groups 17
31261 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31262 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31263 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31264 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31265 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31266 -list-thread-groups --available
31267 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31268 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31269 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31270 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31271 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31272 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31273 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31274 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31275 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31276 @end smallexample
31277
31278 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31279 @findex -info-os
31280
31281 @subsubheading Synopsis
31282
31283 @smallexample
31284 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31285 @end smallexample
31286
31287 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31288 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31289 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31290 of data of that type.
31291
31292 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31293 system.
31294
31295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31296
31297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31298
31299 @subsubheading Example
31300
31301 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31302 like this:
31303
31304 @smallexample
31305 @value{GDBP}
31306 -info-os
31307 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31308 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31309 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31310 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31311 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31312 col2="Processes"@},
31313 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31314 col2="Process groups"@},
31315 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31316 col2="Threads"@},
31317 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31318 col2="File descriptors"@},
31319 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31320 col2="Sockets"@},
31321 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31322 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31323 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31324 col2="Semaphores"@},
31325 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31326 col2="Message queues"@},
31327 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31328 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31329 @value{GDBP}
31330 -info-os processes
31331 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31332 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31333 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31334 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31335 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31336 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31337 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31338 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31339 ...
31340 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31341 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31342 (gdb)
31343 @end smallexample
31344
31345 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31346 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31347 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31348 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31349 @code{info os} omits it.)
31350
31351 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31352 @findex -add-inferior
31353
31354 @subheading Synopsis
31355
31356 @smallexample
31357 -add-inferior
31358 @end smallexample
31359
31360 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31361 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31362 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31363 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31364 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31365 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31366
31367 @subheading Example
31368
31369 @smallexample
31370 @value{GDBP}
31371 -add-inferior
31372 ^done,inferior="i3"
31373 @end smallexample
31374
31375 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31376 @findex -interpreter-exec
31377
31378 @subheading Synopsis
31379
31380 @smallexample
31381 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31382 @end smallexample
31383 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31384
31385 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31386
31387 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31388
31389 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31390
31391 @subheading Example
31392
31393 @smallexample
31394 (gdb)
31395 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31396 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31397 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31398 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31399 ^done
31400 (gdb)
31401 @end smallexample
31402
31403 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31404 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31405
31406 @subheading Synopsis
31407
31408 @smallexample
31409 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31410 @end smallexample
31411
31412 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31413
31414 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31415
31416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31417
31418 @subheading Example
31419
31420 @smallexample
31421 (gdb)
31422 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31423 ^done
31424 (gdb)
31425 @end smallexample
31426
31427 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31428 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31429
31430 @subheading Synopsis
31431
31432 @smallexample
31433 -inferior-tty-show
31434 @end smallexample
31435
31436 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31437
31438 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31439
31440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31441
31442 @subheading Example
31443
31444 @smallexample
31445 (gdb)
31446 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31447 ^done
31448 (gdb)
31449 -inferior-tty-show
31450 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31451 (gdb)
31452 @end smallexample
31453
31454 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31455 @findex -enable-timings
31456
31457 @subheading Synopsis
31458
31459 @smallexample
31460 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31461 @end smallexample
31462
31463 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31464 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31465 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31466 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31467
31468 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31469
31470 No equivalent.
31471
31472 @subheading Example
31473
31474 @smallexample
31475 (gdb)
31476 -enable-timings
31477 ^done
31478 (gdb)
31479 -break-insert main
31480 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31481 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31482 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31483 times="0"@},
31484 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31485 (gdb)
31486 -enable-timings no
31487 ^done
31488 (gdb)
31489 -exec-run
31490 ^running
31491 (gdb)
31492 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31493 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31494 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31495 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31496 (gdb)
31497 @end smallexample
31498
31499 @node Annotations
31500 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31501
31502 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31503 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31504 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31505 relatively high level.
31506
31507 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31508 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31509
31510 @ignore
31511 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31512 @end ignore
31513
31514 @menu
31515 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31516 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31517 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31518 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31519 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31520 * Annotations for Running::
31521 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31522 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31523 @end menu
31524
31525 @node Annotations Overview
31526 @section What is an Annotation?
31527 @cindex annotations
31528
31529 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31530 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31531 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31532 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31533 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31534 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31535 cannot contain newline characters.
31536
31537 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31538 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31539 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31540 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31541 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31542 means those three characters as output.
31543
31544 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31545 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31546 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31547 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31548 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31549 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31550 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31551 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31552 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31553
31554 @table @code
31555 @kindex set annotate
31556 @item set annotate @var{level}
31557 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31558 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31559
31560 @item show annotate
31561 @kindex show annotate
31562 Show the current annotation level.
31563 @end table
31564
31565 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31566
31567 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31568
31569 @smallexample
31570 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31571 GNU gdb 6.0
31572 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31573 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31574 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31575 under certain conditions.
31576 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31577 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31578 for details.
31579 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31580
31581 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31582 (@value{GDBP})
31583 ^Z^Zprompt
31584 @kbd{quit}
31585
31586 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31587 $
31588 @end smallexample
31589
31590 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31591 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31592 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31593 output from @value{GDBN}.
31594
31595 @node Server Prefix
31596 @section The Server Prefix
31597 @cindex server prefix
31598
31599 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31600 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31601 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31602 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31603 a transparent manner.
31604
31605 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31606 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31607 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31608 @code{print} command.
31609
31610 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31611 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31612
31613 @node Prompting
31614 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31615
31616 @cindex annotations for prompts
31617 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31618 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31619 over, etc.
31620
31621 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31622 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31623 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31624 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31625 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31626 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31627 features the following annotations:
31628
31629 @smallexample
31630 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31631 ^Z^Zprompt
31632 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31633 @end smallexample
31634
31635 The input types are
31636
31637 @table @code
31638 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31639 @findex prompt annotation
31640 @findex post-prompt annotation
31641 @item prompt
31642 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31643
31644 @findex pre-commands annotation
31645 @findex commands annotation
31646 @findex post-commands annotation
31647 @item commands
31648 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31649 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31650
31651 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31652 @findex overload-choice annotation
31653 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31654 @item overload-choice
31655 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31656
31657 @findex pre-query annotation
31658 @findex query annotation
31659 @findex post-query annotation
31660 @item query
31661 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31662
31663 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31664 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31665 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31666 @item prompt-for-continue
31667 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31668 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31669 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31670 presence of annotations.
31671 @end table
31672
31673 @node Errors
31674 @section Errors
31675 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31676
31677 @findex quit annotation
31678 @smallexample
31679 ^Z^Zquit
31680 @end smallexample
31681
31682 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31683
31684 @findex error annotation
31685 @smallexample
31686 ^Z^Zerror
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31690
31691 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31692 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31693 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31694 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31695 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31696 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31697 to the top level.
31698
31699 @findex error-begin annotation
31700 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31701
31702 @smallexample
31703 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31704 @end smallexample
31705
31706 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31707 message.
31708
31709 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31710 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31711 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31712
31713 @node Invalidation
31714 @section Invalidation Notices
31715
31716 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31717 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31718 changed.
31719
31720 @table @code
31721 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31722 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31723
31724 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31725 have changed.
31726
31727 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31728 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31729
31730 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31731 deleted a breakpoint.
31732 @end table
31733
31734 @node Annotations for Running
31735 @section Running the Program
31736 @cindex annotations for running programs
31737
31738 @findex starting annotation
31739 @findex stopping annotation
31740 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31741 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31742
31743 @smallexample
31744 ^Z^Zstarting
31745 @end smallexample
31746
31747 is output. When the program stops,
31748
31749 @smallexample
31750 ^Z^Zstopped
31751 @end smallexample
31752
31753 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31754 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31755
31756 @table @code
31757 @findex exited annotation
31758 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31759 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31760 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31761
31762 @findex signalled annotation
31763 @findex signal-name annotation
31764 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31765 @findex signal-string annotation
31766 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31767 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31768 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31769 annotation continues:
31770
31771 @smallexample
31772 @var{intro-text}
31773 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31774 @var{name}
31775 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31776 @var{middle-text}
31777 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31778 @var{string}
31779 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31780 @var{end-text}
31781 @end smallexample
31782
31783 @noindent
31784 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31785 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31786 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
31787 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31788 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31789
31790 @findex signal annotation
31791 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31792 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31793 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31794 terminated with it.
31795
31796 @findex breakpoint annotation
31797 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31798 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31799
31800 @findex watchpoint annotation
31801 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31802 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31803 @end table
31804
31805 @node Source Annotations
31806 @section Displaying Source
31807 @cindex annotations for source display
31808
31809 @findex source annotation
31810 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31811
31812 @smallexample
31813 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31814 @end smallexample
31815
31816 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31817 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31818 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31819 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31820 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31821 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31822 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31823 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31824 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31825 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31826 depend on the language).
31827
31828 @node JIT Interface
31829 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31830 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31831 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31832
31833 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31834 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31835 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31836 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31837
31838 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31839 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31840 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31841 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31842 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31843 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31844
31845 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31846 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31847 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31848 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31849 LLVM JIT.
31850
31851 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31852 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31853 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31854 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31855 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31856 out about additional code.
31857
31858 @menu
31859 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31860 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31861 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31862 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31863 @end menu
31864
31865 @node Declarations
31866 @section JIT Declarations
31867
31868 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31869 implement the interface:
31870
31871 @smallexample
31872 typedef enum
31873 @{
31874 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31875 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31876 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31877 @} jit_actions_t;
31878
31879 struct jit_code_entry
31880 @{
31881 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31882 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31883 const char *symfile_addr;
31884 uint64_t symfile_size;
31885 @};
31886
31887 struct jit_descriptor
31888 @{
31889 uint32_t version;
31890 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31891 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31892 uint32_t action_flag;
31893 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31894 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31895 @};
31896
31897 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31898 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31899
31900 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31901 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31902 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31903 @end smallexample
31904
31905 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31906 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31907 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31908
31909 @node Registering Code
31910 @section Registering Code
31911
31912 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31913
31914 @itemize @bullet
31915 @item
31916 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31917 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31918
31919 @item
31920 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31921 file.
31922
31923 @item
31924 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31925
31926 @item
31927 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31928
31929 @item
31930 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31931 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31932 @end itemize
31933
31934 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31935 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31936 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31937 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31938
31939 @node Unregistering Code
31940 @section Unregistering Code
31941
31942 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31943
31944 @itemize @bullet
31945 @item
31946 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31947
31948 @item
31949 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31950
31951 @item
31952 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31953 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31954 @end itemize
31955
31956 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31957 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31958
31959 @node Custom Debug Info
31960 @section Custom Debug Info
31961 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31962 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31963
31964 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31965 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31966 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31967 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31968 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31969 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31970 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31971 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31972 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31973
31974 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31975 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31976 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31977 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31978 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31979 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31980 compiler.
31981
31982 @menu
31983 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31984 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31985 @end menu
31986
31987 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31988 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31989 @kindex jit-reader-load
31990 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31991
31992 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31993 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31994
31995 @table @code
31996 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31997 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
31998 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31999 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32000 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32001 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32002 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32003
32004 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32005 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32006 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32007 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32008 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32009
32010 @item jit-reader-unload
32011 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32012
32013 @end table
32014
32015 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32016 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32017 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32018
32019 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32020 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32021
32022 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32023 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32024 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32025 the system include directory.
32026
32027 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32028 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32029 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32030
32031 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32032 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32033
32034 @findex gdb_init_reader
32035 @smallexample
32036 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32037 @end smallexample
32038
32039 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32040
32041 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32042 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32043 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32044 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32045 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32046 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32047
32048 @smallexample
32049 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32050 @{
32051 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32052 int reader_version;
32053
32054 /* For use by the reader. */
32055 void *priv_data;
32056
32057 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32058 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32059 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32060 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32061 @};
32062 @end smallexample
32063
32064 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32065 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32066
32067 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32068 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32069 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32070 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32071 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32072 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32073 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32074 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32075 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32076 target's address space.
32077
32078 @node In-Process Agent
32079 @chapter In-Process Agent
32080 @cindex debugging agent
32081 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32082 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32083 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32084 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32085 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32086 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32087 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32088 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32089 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32090 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32091 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32092 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32093 behavior without interrupting it.
32094
32095 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32096 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32097 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32098 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32099 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32100 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32101 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32102 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32103 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32104
32105 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32106 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32107 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32108 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32109
32110 @anchor{Control Agent}
32111 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32112 debugging with the following commands:
32113
32114 @table @code
32115 @kindex set agent on
32116 @item set agent on
32117 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32118 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32119 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32120 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32121 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32122 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32123
32124 @kindex set agent off
32125 @item set agent off
32126 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32127 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32128
32129 @kindex show agent
32130 @item show agent
32131 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32132 the in-process agent.
32133 @end table
32134
32135 @menu
32136 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32137 @end menu
32138
32139 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32140 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32141 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32142
32143 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32144 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32145 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32146 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32147 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32148 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32149 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32150 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32151 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32152
32153 @menu
32154 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32155 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32156 @end menu
32157
32158 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32159 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32160 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32161
32162 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32163 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32164
32165 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32166 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32167 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32168 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32169
32170 @enumerate
32171 @item
32172 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32173 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32174 @item
32175 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32176 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32177 the other one.
32178 @end enumerate
32179
32180 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32181
32182 @enumerate
32183 @item
32184 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32185 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32186 @anchor{agent expression object}
32187 @item
32188 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32189 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32190 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32191 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32192 @item
32193 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32194 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32195
32196 @end enumerate
32197
32198 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32199 object:
32200
32201 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32202 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32203 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32204 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32205 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32206 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32207 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32208 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32209 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32210 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32211 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32212 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32213 memory address for collecting.
32214 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32215 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32216 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32217 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32218 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32219 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32220 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32221 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32222 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32223 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32224 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32225 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32226 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32227 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32228 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32229 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32230 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32231 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32232 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32233 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32234 @ref{agent expression object}
32235 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32236 @ref{agent expression object}
32237 @item actions @tab variable
32238 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32239 @end multitable
32240
32241 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32242 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32243 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32244
32245 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32246 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32247
32248 @table @samp
32249
32250 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32251 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32252 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32253 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32254 in IPA finally.
32255
32256 Replies:
32257 @table @samp
32258 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32259 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32260 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32261 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32262 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32263 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32264 @item E @var{NN}
32265 for an error
32266
32267 @end table
32268
32269 @item close
32270 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32271 is about to kill inferiors.
32272
32273 @item qTfSTM
32274 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32275 @item qTsSTM
32276 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32277 @item qTSTMat
32278 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32279 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32280 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32281
32282 Replies:
32283 @table @samp
32284 @item E @var{NN}
32285 for an error
32286 @end table
32287 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32288 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32289 @end table
32290
32291 @node GDB Bugs
32292 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32293 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32294 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32295
32296 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32297
32298 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32299 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32300 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32301 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32302
32303 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32304 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32305
32306 @menu
32307 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32308 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32309 @end menu
32310
32311 @node Bug Criteria
32312 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32313 @cindex bug criteria
32314
32315 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32316
32317 @itemize @bullet
32318 @cindex fatal signal
32319 @cindex debugger crash
32320 @cindex crash of debugger
32321 @item
32322 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32323 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32324
32325 @cindex error on valid input
32326 @item
32327 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32328 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32329 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32330
32331 @cindex invalid input
32332 @item
32333 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32334 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32335 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32336 for traditional practice''.
32337
32338 @item
32339 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32340 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32341 @end itemize
32342
32343 @node Bug Reporting
32344 @section How to Report Bugs
32345 @cindex bug reports
32346 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32347
32348 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32349 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32350 contact that organization first.
32351
32352 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32353 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32354 distribution.
32355 @c should add a web page ref...
32356
32357 @ifset BUGURL
32358 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32359 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32360 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32361 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32362 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32363 be used.
32364
32365 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32366 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32367 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32368 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32369
32370 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32371 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32372 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32373 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32374 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32375 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32376 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32377 bug reports to the mailing list.
32378 @end ifset
32379 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32380 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32381 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32382 @end ifclear
32383 @end ifset
32384
32385 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32386 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32387 fact or leave it out, state it!
32388
32389 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32390 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32391 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32392 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32393 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32394 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32395 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32396 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32397 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32398
32399 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32400 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32401 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32402 self-contained.
32403
32404 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32405 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32406 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32407 bugs properly.
32408
32409 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32410
32411 @itemize @bullet
32412 @item
32413 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32414 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32415 version}.
32416
32417 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32418 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32419
32420 @item
32421 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32422 version number.
32423
32424 @item
32425 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32426 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32427 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32428 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32429
32430 @item
32431 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32432 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32433
32434 @item
32435 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32436 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32437 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32438 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32439 those compilers.
32440
32441 @item
32442 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32443 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32444 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32445 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32446
32447 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32448 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32449
32450 @item
32451 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32452 reproduce the bug.
32453
32454 @item
32455 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32456 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32457
32458 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32459 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32460 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32461 a chance to make a mistake.
32462
32463 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32464 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32465 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32466 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32467 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32468 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32469 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32470 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32471
32472 @pindex script
32473 @cindex recording a session script
32474 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32475 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32476 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32477 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32478
32479 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32480 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32481
32482 @item
32483 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32484 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32485 it by context, not by line number.
32486
32487 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32488 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32489
32490 @end itemize
32491
32492 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32493
32494 @itemize @bullet
32495 @item
32496 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32497
32498 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32499 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32500 changes will not affect it.
32501
32502 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32503 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32504 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32505 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32506
32507 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32508 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32509 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32510 less time, and so on.
32511
32512 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32513 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32514
32515 @item
32516 A patch for the bug.
32517
32518 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32519 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32520 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32521 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32522
32523 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32524 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32525 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32526 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32527
32528 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32529 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32530 help us to understand.
32531
32532 @item
32533 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32534
32535 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32536 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32537 @end itemize
32538
32539 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32540 @c and consists of the two following files:
32541 @c rluser.texi
32542 @c hsuser.texi
32543 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32544 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32545 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32546 @include rluser.texi
32547 @include hsuser.texi
32548 @end ifclear
32549
32550 @node In Memoriam
32551 @appendix In Memoriam
32552
32553 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32554 contributors:
32555
32556 @table @code
32557 @item Fred Fish
32558 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32559 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32560 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32561
32562 @item Michael Snyder
32563 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32564 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32565 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32566 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32567 @end table
32568
32569 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32570 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32571
32572 @node Formatting Documentation
32573 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32574
32575 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32576 @cindex reference card
32577 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32578 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32579 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32580 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32581 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32582 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32583
32584 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32585 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32586
32587 @smallexample
32588 make refcard.dvi
32589 @end smallexample
32590
32591 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32592 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32593 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32594 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32595 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32596
32597 @cindex documentation
32598
32599 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32600 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32601 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32602 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32603 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32604 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32605
32606 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32607 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32608 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32609 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32610 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32611 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32612 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32613 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32614
32615 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32616 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32617 @code{makeinfo}.
32618
32619 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32620 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32621 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32622
32623 @smallexample
32624 cd gdb
32625 make gdb.info
32626 @end smallexample
32627
32628 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32629 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32630 Texinfo definitions file.
32631
32632 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32633 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32634 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32635 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32636 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32637 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32638 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32639
32640 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32641 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32642 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32643 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32644 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32645 directory.
32646
32647 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32648 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32649 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32650 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32651
32652 @smallexample
32653 make gdb.dvi
32654 @end smallexample
32655
32656 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32657
32658 @node Installing GDB
32659 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32660 @cindex installation
32661
32662 @menu
32663 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32664 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32665 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32666 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32667 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32668 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32669 @end menu
32670
32671 @node Requirements
32672 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32673 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32674
32675 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32676 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32677
32678 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32679 @table @asis
32680 @item ISO C90 compiler
32681 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32682 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32683
32684 @end table
32685
32686 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32687 @table @asis
32688 @item Expat
32689 @anchor{Expat}
32690 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32691 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32692 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32693 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32694 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32695 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32696
32697 Expat is used for:
32698
32699 @itemize @bullet
32700 @item
32701 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32702 @item
32703 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32704 @item
32705 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32706 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32707 @item
32708 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32709 @item
32710 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32711 @item
32712 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32713 @end itemize
32714
32715 @item zlib
32716 @cindex compressed debug sections
32717 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32718 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32719 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32720 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32721 information in such binaries.
32722
32723 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32724 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32725 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32726
32727 @item iconv
32728 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32729 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32730 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32731 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32732
32733 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32734 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32735 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32736 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32737
32738 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32739 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32740 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32741
32742 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32743 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32744 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32745 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32746 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32747 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32748 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32749 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32750 @end table
32751
32752 @node Running Configure
32753 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32754 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32755 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32756 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32757 build the @code{gdb} program.
32758 @iftex
32759 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32760 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32761 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32762 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32763 @end iftex
32764
32765 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32766 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32767 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32768
32769 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32770 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32771
32772 @table @code
32773 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32774 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32775
32776 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32777 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32778
32779 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32780 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32781
32782 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32783 @sc{gnu} include files
32784
32785 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32786 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32787
32788 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32789 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32790
32791 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32792 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32793
32794 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32795 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32796
32797 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32798 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32799 @end table
32800
32801 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32802 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32803 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32804
32805 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32806 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32807 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32808 argument.
32809
32810 For example:
32811
32812 @smallexample
32813 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32814 ./configure @var{host}
32815 make
32816 @end smallexample
32817
32818 @noindent
32819 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32820 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32821 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32822 correct value by examining your system.)
32823
32824 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32825 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32826 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32827 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32828
32829 @need 750
32830 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32831 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32832 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32833
32834 @smallexample
32835 sh configure @var{host}
32836 @end smallexample
32837
32838 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32839 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32840 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32841 @file{configure}
32842 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32843 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32844
32845 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32846 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32847 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32848 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32849 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32850 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32851 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32852 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32853 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32854
32855 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32856 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32857 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32858 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32859 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32860
32861 @node Separate Objdir
32862 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32863
32864 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32865 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32866 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32867 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32868 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32869 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32870 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32871 program specified there.
32872
32873 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32874 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32875 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32876 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32877 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32878 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32879
32880 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32881 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32882
32883 @smallexample
32884 @group
32885 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32886 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32887 cd ../gdb-sun4
32888 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32889 make
32890 @end group
32891 @end smallexample
32892
32893 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32894 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32895 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32896 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32897 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32898 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32899
32900 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32901 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32902 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32903 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32904 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32905
32906 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32907 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32908 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32909 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32910 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32911 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32912
32913 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32914 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32915 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32916
32917 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32918 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32919 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32920 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32921 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32922
32923 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32924 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32925 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32926 with each other.
32927
32928 @node Config Names
32929 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32930
32931 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32932 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32933 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32934 of information in the following pattern:
32935
32936 @smallexample
32937 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32938 @end smallexample
32939
32940 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32941 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32942 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32943
32944 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32945 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32946 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32947 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32948 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32949 abbreviations---for example:
32950
32951 @smallexample
32952 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32953 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32954 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32955 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32956 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32957 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32958 % sh config.sub sun4
32959 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32960 % sh config.sub sun3
32961 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32962 % sh config.sub i986v
32963 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32964 @end smallexample
32965
32966 @noindent
32967 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32968 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32969
32970 @node Configure Options
32971 @section @file{configure} Options
32972
32973 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32974 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32975 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32976 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32977
32978 @smallexample
32979 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32980 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32981 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32982 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32983 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32984 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32985 @var{host}
32986 @end smallexample
32987
32988 @noindent
32989 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32990 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32991 @samp{--}.
32992
32993 @table @code
32994 @item --help
32995 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32996
32997 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32998 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32999 @file{@var{dir}}.
33000
33001 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33002 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33003 @file{@var{dir}}.
33004
33005 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33006 @need 2000
33007 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33008 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33009 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33010 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33011 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33012 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33013 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33014 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33015 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33016 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33017 @var{dirname}.
33018
33019 @item --norecursion
33020 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33021 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33022
33023 @item --target=@var{target}
33024 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33025 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33026 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33027
33028 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33029
33030 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33031 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33032
33033 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33034 @end table
33035
33036 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33037 needed for special purposes only.
33038
33039 @node System-wide configuration
33040 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33041 @cindex system-wide init file
33042
33043 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33044 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33045 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33046
33047 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33048
33049 @table @code
33050 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33051 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33052 @var{file}.
33053 @end table
33054
33055 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33056 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33057
33058 @itemize @bullet
33059 @item
33060 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33061 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33062 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33063 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33064 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33065 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33066
33067 @item
33068 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33069 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33070 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33071 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33072 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33073 @end itemize
33074
33075 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33076 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33077 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33078 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33079 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33080 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33081 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33082 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33083 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33084 reread.
33085
33086 @menu
33087 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33088 @end menu
33089
33090 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33091 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33092 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33093
33094 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33095 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33096 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33097 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33098 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33099 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33100
33101 The following scripts are currently available:
33102 @itemize @bullet
33103
33104 @item @file{elinos.py}
33105 @pindex elinos.py
33106 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33107 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33108 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33109 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33110 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33111 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33112
33113 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33114 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33115 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33116 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33117 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33118 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33119
33120 @end itemize
33121
33122 @node Maintenance Commands
33123 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33124 @cindex maintenance commands
33125 @cindex internal commands
33126
33127 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33128 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33129 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33130 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33131 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33132
33133 @table @code
33134 @kindex maint agent
33135 @kindex maint agent-eval
33136 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33137 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33138 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33139 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33140 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33141 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33142 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33143 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33144 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33145 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33146 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33147 addition and return the sum.
33148 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33149 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33150
33151 @kindex maint agent-printf
33152 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33153 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33154 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33155 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33156 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33157
33158 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33159 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33160 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33161 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33162 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33163 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33164 is shown:
33165
33166 @table @code
33167 @item breakpoint
33168 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33169
33170 @item watchpoint
33171 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33172
33173 @item longjmp
33174 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33175 @code{longjmp} calls.
33176
33177 @item longjmp resume
33178 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33179
33180 @item until
33181 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33182
33183 @item finish
33184 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33185
33186 @item shlib events
33187 Shared library events.
33188
33189 @end table
33190
33191 @kindex maint info bfds
33192 @item maint info bfds
33193 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33194 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33195
33196 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33197 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33198 @cindex displaced stepping support
33199 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33200 @item set displaced-stepping
33201 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33202 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33203 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33204 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33205 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33206 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33207
33208 @table @code
33209 @item set displaced-stepping on
33210 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33211 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33212
33213 @item set displaced-stepping off
33214 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33215 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33216
33217 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33218 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33219 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33220 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33221 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33222 @end table
33223
33224 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33225 @item maint check-psymtabs
33226 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33227 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33228
33229 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33230 @item maint check-symtabs
33231 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33232
33233 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33234 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33235 Expand symbol tables.
33236 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33237 names matching @var{regexp}.
33238
33239 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33240 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33241 @cindex demangler crashes
33242 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33243 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33244 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33245 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33246 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33247 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33248 option to terminate the current session.
33249
33250 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33251 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33252 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33253
33254 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33255 @item maint cplus namespace
33256 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33257
33258 @kindex maint demangle
33259 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33260 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33261
33262 @kindex maint deprecate
33263 @kindex maint undeprecate
33264 @cindex deprecated commands
33265 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33266 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33267 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33268 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33269 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33270 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33271 the replacement as part of the warning.
33272
33273 @kindex maint dump-me
33274 @item maint dump-me
33275 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33276 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33277 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33278 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33279
33280 @kindex maint internal-error
33281 @kindex maint internal-warning
33282 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33283 @cindex demangler crashes
33284 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33285 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33286 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33287
33288 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33289 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33290 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33291 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33292 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33293 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33294 @value{GDBN} session.
33295
33296 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33297 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33298
33299 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33300
33301 @smallexample
33302 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33303 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33304 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33305 debugging may prove unreliable.
33306 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33307 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33308 (@value{GDBP})
33309 @end smallexample
33310
33311 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33312 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33313 @cindex demangler crashes
33314
33315 @kindex maint set internal-error
33316 @kindex maint show internal-error
33317 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33318 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33319 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33320 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33321 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33322 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33323 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33324 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33325 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33326 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33327 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33328 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33329 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33330 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33331 described in the table below.
33332
33333 @table @samp
33334 @item quit
33335 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33336 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33337
33338 @item corefile
33339 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33340 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33341 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33342 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33343 disabled.
33344 @end table
33345
33346 @kindex maint packet
33347 @item maint packet @var{text}
33348 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33349 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33350 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33351 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33352 checksum.
33353
33354 @kindex maint print architecture
33355 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33356 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33357 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33358
33359 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33360 @item maint print c-tdesc
33361 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33362 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33363 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33364
33365 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33366 @item maint print dummy-frames
33367 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33368
33369 @smallexample
33370 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33371 @dots{}
33372 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33373 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33374 58 return (a + b);
33375 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33376 @dots{}
33377 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33378 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
33379 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
33380 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
33381 (@value{GDBP})
33382 @end smallexample
33383
33384 Takes an optional file parameter.
33385
33386 @kindex maint print registers
33387 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33388 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33389 @kindex maint print register-groups
33390 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33391 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33392 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33393 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33394 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33395 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33396 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33397
33398 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33399 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33400 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33401 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33402 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33403 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33404 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33405 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33406
33407 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33408 write the information.
33409
33410 @kindex maint print reggroups
33411 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33412 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33413 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33414 information.
33415
33416 The register groups info looks like this:
33417
33418 @smallexample
33419 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33420 Group Type
33421 general user
33422 float user
33423 all user
33424 vector user
33425 system user
33426 save internal
33427 restore internal
33428 @end smallexample
33429
33430 @kindex flushregs
33431 @item flushregs
33432 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33433
33434 @kindex maint print objfiles
33435 @cindex info for known object files
33436 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33437 Print a dump of all known object files.
33438 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33439 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33440 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33441
33442 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33443 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33444 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33445 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33446 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33447 matching @var{regexp}.
33448 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33449 and the full path if known.
33450 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33451
33452 @kindex maint print statistics
33453 @cindex bcache statistics
33454 @item maint print statistics
33455 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33456 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33457 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33458 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33459 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33460 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33461 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33462 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33463 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33464 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33465 lengths.
33466
33467 @kindex maint print target-stack
33468 @cindex target stack description
33469 @item maint print target-stack
33470 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33471 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33472 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33473 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33474 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33475 address.
33476
33477 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33478 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33479
33480 @kindex maint print type
33481 @cindex type chain of a data type
33482 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33483 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33484 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33485 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33486 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33487 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33488
33489 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33490 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33491 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33492 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33493 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33494 information.
33495
33496 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33497 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33498 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33499 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33500 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33501 always see the disassembly form.
33502
33503 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33504
33505 @smallexample
33506 (gdb) info addr argc
33507 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33508 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33509 @end smallexample
33510
33511 For more information on these expressions, see
33512 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33513
33514 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33515 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33516 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33517 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33518 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33519
33520 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33521 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33522 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33523 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33524 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33525 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33526 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33527 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33528 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33529
33530 @kindex maint set profile
33531 @kindex maint show profile
33532 @cindex profiling GDB
33533 @item maint set profile
33534 @itemx maint show profile
33535 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33536
33537 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33538 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33539 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33540 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33541 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33542 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33543 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33544
33545 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33546 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33547
33548 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33549 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33550 @cindex hardware debug registers
33551 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33552 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33553 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33554 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33555 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33556 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33557 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33558
33559 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33560 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33561 @item maint set show-all-tib
33562 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33563 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33564 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33565 command.
33566
33567 @kindex maint set target-async
33568 @kindex maint show target-async
33569 @item maint set target-async
33570 @itemx maint show target-async
33571 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
33572 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
33573 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
33574 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
33575
33576 @kindex maint set per-command
33577 @kindex maint show per-command
33578 @item maint set per-command
33579 @itemx maint show per-command
33580 @cindex resources used by commands
33581
33582 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33583 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33584
33585 @table @code
33586 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33587 @itemx maint show per-command space
33588 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33589 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33590 took, following the command's own output.
33591 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33592 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33593
33594 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33595 @itemx maint show per-command time
33596 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33597 for each command.
33598 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33599 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33600 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33601 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33602 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33603 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33604 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33605 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33606 spent by the program been debugged.
33607 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33608 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33609
33610 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33611 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33612 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33613 for each command.
33614 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33615
33616 @enumerate a
33617 @item
33618 number of symbol tables
33619 @item
33620 number of primary symbol tables
33621 @item
33622 number of blocks in the blockvector
33623 @end enumerate
33624 @end table
33625
33626 @kindex maint space
33627 @cindex memory used by commands
33628 @item maint space @var{value}
33629 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33630 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33631
33632 @kindex maint time
33633 @cindex time of command execution
33634 @item maint time @var{value}
33635 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33636 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33637
33638 @kindex maint translate-address
33639 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33640 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33641 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33642 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33643 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33644 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33645 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33646
33647 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33648 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33649 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33650
33651 @end table
33652
33653 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33654 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33655
33656 @table @code
33657 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33658 @kindex set watchdog
33659 @cindex watchdog timer
33660 @cindex timeout for commands
33661 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33662 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33663 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33664
33665 @item show watchdog
33666 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33667 @end table
33668
33669 @node Remote Protocol
33670 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33671
33672 @menu
33673 * Overview::
33674 * Packets::
33675 * Stop Reply Packets::
33676 * General Query Packets::
33677 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33678 * Tracepoint Packets::
33679 * Host I/O Packets::
33680 * Interrupts::
33681 * Notification Packets::
33682 * Remote Non-Stop::
33683 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33684 * Examples::
33685 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33686 * Library List Format::
33687 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33688 * Memory Map Format::
33689 * Thread List Format::
33690 * Traceframe Info Format::
33691 * Branch Trace Format::
33692 @end menu
33693
33694 @node Overview
33695 @section Overview
33696
33697 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33698 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33699 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33700 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33701
33702 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33703 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33704
33705 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33706 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33707 @cindex remote serial protocol
33708 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33709 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33710 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33711 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33712 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33713
33714 @smallexample
33715 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33716 @end smallexample
33717 @noindent
33718
33719 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33720 @noindent
33721 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33722 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33723 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33724
33725 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33726 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33727
33728 @smallexample
33729 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33730 @end smallexample
33731
33732 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33733 @noindent
33734 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33735 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33736 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33737
33738 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33739 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33740 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33741 retransmission):
33742
33743 @smallexample
33744 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33745 <- @code{+}
33746 @end smallexample
33747 @noindent
33748
33749 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33750 once a connection is established.
33751 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33752
33753 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33754 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33755 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33756 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33757 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33758 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33759 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33760
33761 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33762 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33763 exceptions).
33764
33765 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33766 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33767 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33768 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33769
33770 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33771 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33772 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33773
33774 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33775 @anchor{Binary Data}
33776 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33777 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33778 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33779 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33780 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33781 binary data.
33782
33783 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33784 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33785 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33786 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33787 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33788 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33789 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33790 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33791 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33792 (described next).
33793
33794 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33795 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33796 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33797 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33798 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33799 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33800 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33801 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33802 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33803 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33804 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33805 3}} more times.
33806
33807 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33808 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33809 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33810 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33811 @samp{0*"00}.
33812
33813 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33814 error number. That number is not well defined.
33815
33816 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33817 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33818 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33819 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33820 on that response.
33821
33822 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33823 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33824 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33825 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33826 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33827 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33828
33829 @node Packets
33830 @section Packets
33831
33832 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33833 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33834 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33835 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33836
33837 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33838 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33839 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33840 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33841 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33842 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33843 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33844 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33845 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33846 @var{baz}.
33847
33848 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33849 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33850 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33851 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33852 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33853 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33854 pick any thread.
33855
33856 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33857 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33858 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33859 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33860 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33861 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33862 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33863 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33864 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33865 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33866 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33867 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33868 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33869
33870 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33871 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33872 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33873 more information.
33874
33875 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33876 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33877
33878 Here are the packet descriptions.
33879
33880 @table @samp
33881
33882 @item !
33883 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33884 @anchor{extended mode}
33885 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33886 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33887 debugged.
33888
33889 Reply:
33890 @table @samp
33891 @item OK
33892 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33893 @end table
33894
33895 @item ?
33896 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33897 @anchor{? packet}
33898 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33899 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33900 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33901
33902 Reply:
33903 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33904
33905 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33906 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33907 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33908 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33909 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33910
33911 Reply:
33912 @table @samp
33913 @item OK
33914 The arguments were set.
33915 @item E @var{NN}
33916 An error occurred.
33917 @end table
33918
33919 @item b @var{baud}
33920 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33921 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33922 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33923
33924 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33925 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33926 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33927
33928 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33929 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33930 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33931 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33932 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33933
33934 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33935 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33936 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33937 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33938
33939 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33940 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33941
33942 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33943 @anchor{bc}
33944 @item bc
33945 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33946 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33947
33948 Reply:
33949 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33950
33951 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33952 @anchor{bs}
33953 @item bs
33954 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33955 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33956
33957 Reply:
33958 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33959
33960 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33961 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33962 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
33963 is omitted, resume at current address.
33964
33965 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33966 packet}.
33967
33968 Reply:
33969 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33970
33971 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33972 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33973 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33974 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33975
33976 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33977 packet}.
33978
33979 Reply:
33980 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33981
33982 @item d
33983 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33984 Toggle debug flag.
33985
33986 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33987 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33988
33989 @item D
33990 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33991 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33992 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33993 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33994 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33995
33996 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33997 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33998 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33999 big-endian hex string.
34000
34001 Reply:
34002 @table @samp
34003 @item OK
34004 for success
34005 @item E @var{NN}
34006 for an error
34007 @end table
34008
34009 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34010 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34011 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34012 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34013 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34014
34015 @item g
34016 @anchor{read registers packet}
34017 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34018 Read general registers.
34019
34020 Reply:
34021 @table @samp
34022 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34023 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34024 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34025 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34026 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34027 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34028 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34029
34030 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34031 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34032 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34033 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34034 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34035 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34036 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34037 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34038
34039 @smallexample
34040 -> @code{g}
34041 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34042 @end smallexample
34043
34044 @item E @var{NN}
34045 for an error.
34046 @end table
34047
34048 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34049 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34050 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34051 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34052
34053 Reply:
34054 @table @samp
34055 @item OK
34056 for success
34057 @item E @var{NN}
34058 for an error
34059 @end table
34060
34061 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34062 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34063 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34064 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34065 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34066 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34067 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34068 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34069 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34070
34071 Reply:
34072 @table @samp
34073 @item OK
34074 for success
34075 @item E @var{NN}
34076 for an error
34077 @end table
34078
34079 @c FIXME: JTC:
34080 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34081 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34082 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34083 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34084 @c described. For example:
34085 @c
34086 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34087 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34088 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34089 @c
34090 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34091 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34092 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34093
34094 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34095 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34096 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34097 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34098 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34099 step starting at that address.
34100
34101 @item I
34102 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34103 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34104 step packet}.
34105
34106 @item k
34107 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34108 Kill request.
34109
34110 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34111
34112 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34113 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34114
34115 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34116
34117 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34118 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34119 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34120
34121 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34122 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34123 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34124
34125 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34126 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34127 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34128 (@pxref{? packet}).
34129
34130 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34131 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34132 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34133 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34134
34135 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34136 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34137 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34138 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34139 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34140 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34141 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34142 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34143
34144 Reply:
34145 @table @samp
34146 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34147 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34148 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34149 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34150 @item E @var{NN}
34151 @var{NN} is errno
34152 @end table
34153
34154 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34155 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34156 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34157 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34158 hexadecimal number.
34159
34160 Reply:
34161 @table @samp
34162 @item OK
34163 for success
34164 @item E @var{NN}
34165 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34166 written).
34167 @end table
34168
34169 @item p @var{n}
34170 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34171 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34172 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34173 register value is encoded.
34174
34175 Reply:
34176 @table @samp
34177 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34178 the register's value
34179 @item E @var{NN}
34180 for an error
34181 @item @w{}
34182 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34183 @end table
34184
34185 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34186 @anchor{write register packet}
34187 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34188 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34189 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34190 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34191
34192 Reply:
34193 @table @samp
34194 @item OK
34195 for success
34196 @item E @var{NN}
34197 for an error
34198 @end table
34199
34200 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34201 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34202 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34203 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34204 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34205 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34206
34207 @item r
34208 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34209 Reset the entire system.
34210
34211 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34212
34213 @item R @var{XX}
34214 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34215 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34216 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34217
34218 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34219
34220 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34221 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34222 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34223 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34224
34225 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34226 packet}.
34227
34228 Reply:
34229 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34230
34231 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34232 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34233 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34234 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34235 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34236
34237 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34238 packet}.
34239
34240 Reply:
34241 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34242
34243 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34244 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34245 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34246 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34247 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34248
34249 @item T @var{thread-id}
34250 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34251 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34252
34253 Reply:
34254 @table @samp
34255 @item OK
34256 thread is still alive
34257 @item E @var{NN}
34258 thread is dead
34259 @end table
34260
34261 @item v
34262 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34263 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34264
34265 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34266 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34267 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34268 The process ID is a
34269 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34270 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34271 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34272
34273 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34274 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34275 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34276 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34277 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34278 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34279 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34280 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34281
34282 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34283
34284 Reply:
34285 @table @samp
34286 @item E @var{nn}
34287 for an error
34288 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34289 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34290 @item OK
34291 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34292 @end table
34293
34294 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34295 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34296 @anchor{vCont packet}
34297 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34298 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34299 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34300 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34301 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34302 Specifying multiple
34303 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34304 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34305
34306 Currently supported actions are:
34307
34308 @table @samp
34309 @item c
34310 Continue.
34311 @item C @var{sig}
34312 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34313 @item s
34314 Step.
34315 @item S @var{sig}
34316 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34317 @item t
34318 Stop.
34319 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34320 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34321 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34322 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34323 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34324 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34325
34326 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34327 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34328 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34329 jumps to @var{start}).
34330
34331 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34332 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34333 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34334
34335 @end table
34336
34337 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34338 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34339 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34340
34341 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34342 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34343 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34344 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34345 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34346 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34347 as an implementation detail.
34348
34349 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34350 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34351 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34352 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34353 @var{thread-id}.
34354
34355 Reply:
34356 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34357
34358 @item vCont?
34359 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34360 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34361
34362 Reply:
34363 @table @samp
34364 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34365 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34366 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34367 @item @w{}
34368 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34369 @end table
34370
34371 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34372 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34373 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34374 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34375
34376 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34377 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34378 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34379 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34380 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34381 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34382 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34383 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34384 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34385 packet is received.
34386
34387 Reply:
34388 @table @samp
34389 @item OK
34390 for success
34391 @item E @var{NN}
34392 for an error
34393 @end table
34394
34395 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34396 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34397 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34398 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34399 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34400 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34401 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34402 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34403 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34404 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34405 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34406 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34407
34408
34409 Reply:
34410 @table @samp
34411 @item OK
34412 for success
34413 @item E.memtype
34414 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34415 @item E @var{NN}
34416 for an error
34417 @end table
34418
34419 @item vFlashDone
34420 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34421 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34422 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34423 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34424 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34425 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34426 request is completed.
34427
34428 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34429 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34430 @anchor{vKill packet}
34431 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34432 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34433 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34434 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34435
34436 Reply:
34437 @table @samp
34438 @item E @var{nn}
34439 for an error
34440 @item OK
34441 for success
34442 @end table
34443
34444 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34445 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34446 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34447 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34448 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34449 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34450 state.
34451
34452 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34453
34454 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34455
34456 Reply:
34457 @table @samp
34458 @item E @var{nn}
34459 for an error
34460 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34461 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34462 @end table
34463
34464 @item vStopped
34465 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34466 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34467
34468 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34469 @anchor{X packet}
34470 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34471 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34472 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34473 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34474
34475 Reply:
34476 @table @samp
34477 @item OK
34478 for success
34479 @item E @var{NN}
34480 for an error
34481 @end table
34482
34483 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34484 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34485 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34486 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34487 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34488 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34489 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34490
34491 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34492 separately.
34493
34494 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34495 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34496 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34497 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34498 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34499 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34500
34501 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34502 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34503 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34504 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34505 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34506 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34507
34508 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34509 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34510 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34511 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34512 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34513 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34514 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34515 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34516 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34517 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34518
34519 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34520 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34521
34522 @table @samp
34523
34524 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34525 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34526 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34527
34528 @end table
34529
34530 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34531 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34532 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34533 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34534 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34535 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34536 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34537
34538 @table @samp
34539
34540 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34541 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34542 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34543
34544 @end table
34545
34546 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34547
34548 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34549 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34550 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34551 target, is not defined.}
34552
34553 Reply:
34554 @table @samp
34555 @item OK
34556 success
34557 @item @w{}
34558 not supported
34559 @item E @var{NN}
34560 for an error
34561 @end table
34562
34563 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34564 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34565 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34566 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34567 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34568 address @var{addr}.
34569
34570 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34571 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
34572 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34573
34574 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34575 movement.}
34576
34577 Reply:
34578 @table @samp
34579 @item OK
34580 success
34581 @item @w{}
34582 not supported
34583 @item E @var{NN}
34584 for an error
34585 @end table
34586
34587 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34588 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34589 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34590 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34591 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34592 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34593
34594 Reply:
34595 @table @samp
34596 @item OK
34597 success
34598 @item @w{}
34599 not supported
34600 @item E @var{NN}
34601 for an error
34602 @end table
34603
34604 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34605 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34606 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34607 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34608 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34609 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34610
34611 Reply:
34612 @table @samp
34613 @item OK
34614 success
34615 @item @w{}
34616 not supported
34617 @item E @var{NN}
34618 for an error
34619 @end table
34620
34621 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34622 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34623 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34624 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34625 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34626 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34627
34628 Reply:
34629 @table @samp
34630 @item OK
34631 success
34632 @item @w{}
34633 not supported
34634 @item E @var{NN}
34635 for an error
34636 @end table
34637
34638 @end table
34639
34640 @node Stop Reply Packets
34641 @section Stop Reply Packets
34642 @cindex stop reply packets
34643
34644 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34645 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34646 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34647 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34648 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34649 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34650 @value{GDBN} source code.
34651
34652 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34653 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34654 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34655 components.
34656
34657 @table @samp
34658
34659 @item S @var{AA}
34660 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34661 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34662 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34663
34664 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34665 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34666 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34667 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34668 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34669 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34670 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34671 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34672
34673 @itemize @bullet
34674 @item
34675 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34676 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
34677 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34678 two-digit hex number.
34679
34680 @item
34681 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34682 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34683
34684 @item
34685 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34686 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34687
34688 @item
34689 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34690 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34691 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34692 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34693
34694 @item
34695 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34696 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34697 future.
34698 @end itemize
34699
34700 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34701
34702 @table @samp
34703 @item watch
34704 @itemx rwatch
34705 @itemx awatch
34706 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34707 hex.
34708
34709 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34710 @item library
34711 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34712 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34713 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
34714
34715 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34716 @item replaylog
34717 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34718 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34719 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34720 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34721 for more information.
34722 @end table
34723
34724 @item W @var{AA}
34725 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34726 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34727 applicable to certain targets.
34728
34729 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34730 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34731 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34732 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34733
34734 @item X @var{AA}
34735 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34736 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34737
34738 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34739 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34740 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34741 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34742
34743 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34744 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34745 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34746 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34747 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34748
34749 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34750 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34751 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34752 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34753 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34754 system calls.
34755
34756 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34757 this very system call.
34758
34759 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34760 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34761 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34762 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34763 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34764 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34765
34766 @end table
34767
34768 @node General Query Packets
34769 @section General Query Packets
34770 @cindex remote query requests
34771
34772 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34773 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34774 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34775 sending information to and from the stub.
34776
34777 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34778 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34779 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34780 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34781 conventions:
34782
34783 @itemize @bullet
34784 @item
34785 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34786 @item
34787 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34788 letter.
34789 @item
34790 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34791 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34792 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34793 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34794 @end itemize
34795
34796 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34797 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34798 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34799 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34800 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34801 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34802 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34803 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34804 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34805 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34806 packet.}.
34807
34808 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34809 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34810 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34811 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34812 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34813
34814 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34815
34816 @table @samp
34817
34818 @item QAgent:1
34819 @itemx QAgent:0
34820 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34821 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34822
34823 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34824 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34825 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34826 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34827 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34828 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34829 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34830 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34831 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34832 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34833 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34834
34835 @item qC
34836 @cindex current thread, remote request
34837 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34838 Return the current thread ID.
34839
34840 Reply:
34841 @table @samp
34842 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34843 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34844 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34845 @item @r{(anything else)}
34846 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34847 @end table
34848
34849 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34850 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34851 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34852 @anchor{qCRC packet}
34853 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34854 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34855 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34856 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34857
34858 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34859 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34860 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34861 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34862 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34863 detect trailing zeros.
34864
34865 Reply:
34866 @table @samp
34867 @item E @var{NN}
34868 An error (such as memory fault)
34869 @item C @var{crc32}
34870 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34871 @end table
34872
34873 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34874 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34875 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34876 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34877 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34878 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34879 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34880 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34881 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34882 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34883 randomization.
34884
34885 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34886
34887 Reply:
34888 @table @samp
34889 @item OK
34890 The request succeeded.
34891
34892 @item E @var{nn}
34893 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34894
34895 @item @w{}
34896 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34897 by the stub.
34898 @end table
34899
34900 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34901 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34902 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34903 address space randomization.
34904
34905 @item qfThreadInfo
34906 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34907 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34908 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34909 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34910 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34911 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34912 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34913 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34914 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34915 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34916
34917 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34918
34919 Reply:
34920 @table @samp
34921 @item m @var{thread-id}
34922 A single thread ID
34923 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34924 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34925 @item l
34926 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34927 @end table
34928
34929 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34930 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34931 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34932 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34933 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34934 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34935 fields.
34936
34937 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
34938 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
34939 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
34940 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
34941 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
34942
34943 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34944 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34945 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34946 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34947 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34948
34949 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34950 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34951
34952 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34953 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34954 information associated with the variable.)
34955
34956 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34957 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34958 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34959 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34960 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34961 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34962
34963 Reply:
34964 @table @samp
34965 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34966 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34967 local storage requested.
34968
34969 @item E @var{nn}
34970 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34971
34972 @item @w{}
34973 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34974 @end table
34975
34976 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34977 @cindex get thread information block address
34978 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34979 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34980
34981 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34982
34983 Reply:
34984 @table @samp
34985 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34986 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34987 thread information block.
34988
34989 @item E @var{nn}
34990 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34991 address could not be retrieved.
34992
34993 @item @w{}
34994 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34995 @end table
34996
34997 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34998 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34999 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35000 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35001 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35002 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35003 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35004
35005 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35006
35007 Reply:
35008 @table @samp
35009 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35010 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35011 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35012 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35013 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35014 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35015 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35016 @end table
35017
35018 @item qOffsets
35019 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35020 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35021 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35022 image.
35023
35024 Reply:
35025 @table @samp
35026 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35027 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35028 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35029 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35030 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35031 segments by the supplied offsets.
35032
35033 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35034 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35035 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35036
35037 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35038 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35039 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35040 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35041 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35042 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35043 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35044 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35045 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35046 @end table
35047
35048 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35049 @cindex thread information, remote request
35050 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35051 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35052 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35053 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35054
35055 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35056 (see below).
35057
35058 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35059
35060 @item QNonStop:1
35061 @itemx QNonStop:0
35062 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35063 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35064 @anchor{QNonStop}
35065 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35066 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35067
35068 Reply:
35069 @table @samp
35070 @item OK
35071 The request succeeded.
35072
35073 @item E @var{nn}
35074 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35075
35076 @item @w{}
35077 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35078 the stub.
35079 @end table
35080
35081 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35082 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35083 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35084 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35085
35086 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35087 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35088 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35089 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35090 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35091 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35092 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35093 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35094 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35095 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35096 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35097 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35098 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35099
35100 Reply:
35101 @table @samp
35102 @item OK
35103 The request succeeded.
35104
35105 @item E @var{nn}
35106 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35107
35108 @item @w{}
35109 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35110 the stub.
35111 @end table
35112
35113 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35114 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35115 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35116 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35117
35118 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35119 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35120 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35121 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35122 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35123 Others should be silently discarded.
35124
35125 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35126 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35127 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35128 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35129 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35130 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35131 signals.
35132
35133 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35134 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35135
35136 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35137 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35138 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35139 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35140 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35141
35142 Reply:
35143 @table @samp
35144 @item OK
35145 The request succeeded.
35146
35147 @item E @var{nn}
35148 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35149
35150 @item @w{}
35151 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35152 by the stub.
35153 @end table
35154
35155 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35156 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35157 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35158 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35159
35160 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35161 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35162 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35163 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35164 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35165 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35166 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35167 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35168 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35169
35170 Reply:
35171 @table @samp
35172 @item OK
35173 A command response with no output.
35174 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35175 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35176 @item E @var{NN}
35177 Indicate a badly formed request.
35178 @item @w{}
35179 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35180 @end table
35181
35182 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35183 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35184 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35185 packets.)
35186
35187 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35188 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35189 @ifnotinfo
35190 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35191 @end ifnotinfo
35192 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35193 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35194 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35195 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35196 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35197
35198 Reply:
35199 @table @samp
35200 @item 0
35201 The pattern was not found.
35202 @item 1,address
35203 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35204 @item E @var{NN}
35205 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35206 @item @w{}
35207 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35208 @end table
35209
35210 @item QStartNoAckMode
35211 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35212 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35213 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35214 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35215
35216 Reply:
35217 @table @samp
35218 @item OK
35219 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35220 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35221 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35222 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35223 @item @w{}
35224 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35225 @end table
35226
35227 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35228 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35229 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35230 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35231 @anchor{qSupported}
35232 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35233 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35234 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35235 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35236 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35237 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35238 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35239 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35240 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35241 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35242 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35243 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35244 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35245 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35246
35247 Reply:
35248 @table @samp
35249 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35250 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35251 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35252 possible forms).
35253 @item @w{}
35254 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35255 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35256 @end table
35257
35258 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35259 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35260 are:
35261
35262 @table @samp
35263 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35264 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35265 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35266 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35267 @item @var{name}+
35268 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35269 need an associated value.
35270 @item @var{name}-
35271 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35272 @item @var{name}?
35273 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35274 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35275 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35276 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35277 @end table
35278
35279 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35280 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35281 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35282 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35283 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35284
35285 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35286 are defined:
35287
35288 @table @samp
35289 @item multiprocess
35290 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35291 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35292 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35293 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35294 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35295
35296 @item xmlRegisters
35297 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35298 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35299 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35300 description.
35301
35302 @item qRelocInsn
35303 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35304 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35305 instruction reply packet}).
35306 @end table
35307
35308 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35309 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35310 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35311 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35312 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35313 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35314 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35315 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35316 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35317 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35318 all the features it supports.
35319
35320 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35321 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35322
35323 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35324 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35325 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35326 form response.
35327
35328 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35329 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35330 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35331 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35332
35333 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35334 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35335 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35336 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35337 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35338
35339 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35340
35341 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35342 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35343 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35344 @item Feature Name
35345 @tab Value Required
35346 @tab Default
35347 @tab Probe Allowed
35348
35349 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35350 @tab Yes
35351 @tab @samp{-}
35352 @tab No
35353
35354 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35355 @tab No
35356 @tab @samp{-}
35357 @tab Yes
35358
35359 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35360 @tab No
35361 @tab @samp{-}
35362 @tab Yes
35363
35364 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35365 @tab No
35366 @tab @samp{-}
35367 @tab Yes
35368
35369 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35370 @tab No
35371 @tab @samp{-}
35372 @tab Yes
35373
35374 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35375 @tab No
35376 @tab @samp{-}
35377 @tab Yes
35378
35379 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35380 @tab No
35381 @tab @samp{-}
35382 @tab No
35383
35384 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35385 @tab No
35386 @tab @samp{-}
35387 @tab Yes
35388
35389 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35390 @tab No
35391 @tab @samp{-}
35392 @tab Yes
35393
35394 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35395 @tab No
35396 @tab @samp{-}
35397 @tab Yes
35398
35399 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35400 @tab No
35401 @tab @samp{-}
35402 @tab Yes
35403
35404 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35405 @tab No
35406 @tab @samp{-}
35407 @tab Yes
35408
35409 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35410 @tab No
35411 @tab @samp{-}
35412 @tab Yes
35413
35414 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35415 @tab No
35416 @tab @samp{-}
35417 @tab Yes
35418
35419 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35420 @tab No
35421 @tab @samp{-}
35422 @tab Yes
35423
35424 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35425 @tab No
35426 @tab @samp{-}
35427 @tab Yes
35428
35429 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35430 @tab No
35431 @tab @samp{-}
35432 @tab Yes
35433
35434 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35435 @tab Yes
35436 @tab @samp{-}
35437 @tab Yes
35438
35439 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35440 @tab Yes
35441 @tab @samp{-}
35442 @tab Yes
35443
35444 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35445 @tab No
35446 @tab @samp{-}
35447 @tab Yes
35448
35449 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35450 @tab No
35451 @tab @samp{-}
35452 @tab Yes
35453
35454 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35455 @tab No
35456 @tab @samp{-}
35457 @tab Yes
35458
35459 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35460 @tab No
35461 @tab @samp{-}
35462 @tab No
35463
35464 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35465 @tab No
35466 @tab @samp{-}
35467 @tab No
35468
35469 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35470 @tab No
35471 @tab @samp{-}
35472 @tab No
35473
35474 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35475 @tab No
35476 @tab @samp{-}
35477 @tab No
35478
35479 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35480 @tab No
35481 @tab @samp{-}
35482 @tab No
35483
35484 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35485 @tab No
35486 @tab @samp{-}
35487 @tab No
35488
35489 @item @samp{QAgent}
35490 @tab No
35491 @tab @samp{-}
35492 @tab No
35493
35494 @item @samp{QAllow}
35495 @tab No
35496 @tab @samp{-}
35497 @tab No
35498
35499 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35500 @tab No
35501 @tab @samp{-}
35502 @tab No
35503
35504 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35505 @tab No
35506 @tab @samp{-}
35507 @tab No
35508
35509 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35510 @tab No
35511 @tab @samp{-}
35512 @tab No
35513
35514 @item @samp{tracenz}
35515 @tab No
35516 @tab @samp{-}
35517 @tab No
35518
35519 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35520 @tab No
35521 @tab @samp{-}
35522 @tab No
35523
35524 @end multitable
35525
35526 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35527
35528 @table @samp
35529 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35530 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35531 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35532 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35533 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35534 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35535 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35536 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35537 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35538 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35539
35540 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35541 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35542 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35543
35544 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35545 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35546 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35547
35548 @item qXfer:features:read
35549 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35550 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35551
35552 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35553 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35554 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35555
35556 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35557 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35558 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35559
35560 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35561 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35562 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35563 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35564
35565 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35566 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35567 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35568
35569 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35570 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35571 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35572
35573 @item qXfer:spu:read
35574 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35575 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35576
35577 @item qXfer:spu:write
35578 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35579 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35580
35581 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35582 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35583 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35584
35585 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35586 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35587 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35588
35589 @item qXfer:threads:read
35590 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35591 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35592
35593 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35594 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35595 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35596
35597 @item qXfer:uib:read
35598 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35599 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35600
35601 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35602 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35603 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35604
35605 @item QNonStop
35606 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35607 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35608
35609 @item QPassSignals
35610 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35611 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35612
35613 @item QStartNoAckMode
35614 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35615 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35616
35617 @item multiprocess
35618 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35619 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35620 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35621 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35622 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35623 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35624 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35625 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35626 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35627 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35628 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35629
35630 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35631 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35632 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35633
35634 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35635 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35636 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35637 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35638
35639 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35640 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35641 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35642
35643 @item ReverseContinue
35644 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35645 (@pxref{bc}).
35646
35647 @item ReverseStep
35648 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35649 (@pxref{bs}).
35650
35651 @item TracepointSource
35652 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35653 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35654
35655 @item QAgent
35656 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35657
35658 @item QAllow
35659 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35660
35661 @item QDisableRandomization
35662 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35663
35664 @item StaticTracepoint
35665 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35666 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35667
35668 @item InstallInTrace
35669 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35670 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35671
35672 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35673 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35674 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35675 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35676
35677 @item QTBuffer:size
35678 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35679 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35680
35681 @item tracenz
35682 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35683 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35684 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35685
35686 @item BreakpointCommands
35687 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35688 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35689 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35690
35691 @item Qbtrace:off
35692 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35693
35694 @item Qbtrace:bts
35695 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35696
35697 @end table
35698
35699 @item qSymbol::
35700 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35701 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35702 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35703 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35704
35705 Reply:
35706 @table @samp
35707 @item OK
35708 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35709 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35710 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35711 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35712 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35713 below.
35714 @end table
35715
35716 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35717 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35718
35719 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35720 target has previously requested.
35721
35722 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35723 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35724 will be empty.
35725
35726 Reply:
35727 @table @samp
35728 @item OK
35729 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35730 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35731 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35732 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35733 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35734 @end table
35735
35736 @item qTBuffer
35737 @itemx QTBuffer
35738 @itemx QTDisconnected
35739 @itemx QTDP
35740 @itemx QTDPsrc
35741 @itemx QTDV
35742 @itemx qTfP
35743 @itemx qTfV
35744 @itemx QTFrame
35745 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35746
35747 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35748
35749 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35750 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35751 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35752 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
35753 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
35754 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
35755 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35756 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35757 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35758 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35759 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35760
35761 Reply:
35762 @table @samp
35763 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35764 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35765 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35766 the thread's attributes.
35767 @end table
35768
35769 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35770 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35771 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35772 packets.)
35773
35774 @item QTNotes
35775 @itemx qTP
35776 @itemx QTSave
35777 @itemx qTsP
35778 @itemx qTsV
35779 @itemx QTStart
35780 @itemx QTStop
35781 @itemx QTEnable
35782 @itemx QTDisable
35783 @itemx QTinit
35784 @itemx QTro
35785 @itemx qTStatus
35786 @itemx qTV
35787 @itemx qTfSTM
35788 @itemx qTsSTM
35789 @itemx qTSTMat
35790 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35791
35792 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35793 @cindex read special object, remote request
35794 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35795 @anchor{qXfer read}
35796 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35797 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35798 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35799 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35800 additional details about what data to access.
35801
35802 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35803 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35804 formats, listed below.
35805
35806 @table @samp
35807 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35808 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35809 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35810 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35811
35812 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35813 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35814
35815 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35816 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35817
35818 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35819 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35820 packet may have one of the following values:
35821
35822 @table @code
35823 @item all
35824 Returns all available branch trace.
35825
35826 @item new
35827 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35828 the last read request.
35829
35830 @item delta
35831 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35832 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35833 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35834 used to stitch traces together.
35835
35836 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35837 @end table
35838
35839 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35840 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35841
35842 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35843 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35844 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35845 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35846 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35847
35848 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35849 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35850
35851 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35852 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35853 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35854 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35855 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35856
35857 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35858 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35859 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35860
35861 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35862 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35863
35864 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35865 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35866 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35867 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35868 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35869 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35870 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35871 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35872
35873 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35874 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35875
35876 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35877 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35878
35879 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35880 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35881 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35882 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35883
35884 @table @code
35885 @item start=@var{address}
35886 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35887 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35888 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35889 chosen as the starting point.
35890
35891 @item prev=@var{address}
35892 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35893 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35894 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35895 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35896 exists prior to the starting point.
35897
35898 @end table
35899
35900 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35901 ignored.
35902
35903 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35904 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35905 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35906 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35907 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35908
35909 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35910 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35911
35912 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35913 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35914
35915 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35916 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35917 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35918 Action Lists}.
35919
35920 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35921 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35922 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35923
35924 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35925 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35926 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35927 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35928 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35929
35930 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35931 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35932 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35933
35934 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35935 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35936 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35937 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35938 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35939 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35940 in that context to be accessed.
35941
35942 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35943 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35944 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35945
35946 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35947 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35948 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35949 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35950 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35951
35952 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35953 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35954
35955 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35956 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35957
35958 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35959 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35960 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35961
35962 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35963 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35964
35965 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35966 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35967
35968 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35969 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35970
35971 This packet is not probed by default.
35972
35973 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35974 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35975 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35976 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35977 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35978
35979 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35980 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35981
35982 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35983 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35984 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35985 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35986
35987 @end table
35988
35989 Reply:
35990 @table @samp
35991 @item m @var{data}
35992 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35993 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35994 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35995 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35996 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35997 request.
35998
35999 @item l @var{data}
36000 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36001 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36002 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36003
36004 @item l
36005 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36006 There is no more data to be read.
36007
36008 @item E00
36009 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36010
36011 @item E @var{nn}
36012 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36013 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36014
36015 @item @w{}
36016 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36017 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36018 @end table
36019
36020 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36021 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36022 @anchor{qXfer write}
36023 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36024 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36025 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36026 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36027 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36028 to access.
36029
36030 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36031 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36032 formats, listed below.
36033
36034 @table @samp
36035 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36036 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36037 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36038 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36039 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36040
36041 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36042 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36043 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36044
36045 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36046 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36047 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36048 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36049 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36050 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36051 in that context to be accessed.
36052
36053 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36054 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36055 @end table
36056
36057 Reply:
36058 @table @samp
36059 @item @var{nn}
36060 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36061 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36062
36063 @item E00
36064 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36065
36066 @item E @var{nn}
36067 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36068 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36069
36070 @item @w{}
36071 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36072 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36073 @end table
36074
36075 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36076 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36077 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36078 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36079 must respond with an empty packet.
36080
36081 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36082 @cindex query attached, remote request
36083 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36084 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36085 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36086 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36087 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36088 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36089 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36090
36091 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36092 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36093 the @code{quit} command.
36094
36095 Reply:
36096 @table @samp
36097 @item 1
36098 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36099 @item 0
36100 The remote server created a new process.
36101 @item E @var{NN}
36102 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36103 @end table
36104
36105 @item Qbtrace:bts
36106 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36107
36108 Reply:
36109 @table @samp
36110 @item OK
36111 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36112 @item E.errtext
36113 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36114 @end table
36115
36116 @item Qbtrace:off
36117 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36118
36119 Reply:
36120 @table @samp
36121 @item OK
36122 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36123 @item E.errtext
36124 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36125 @end table
36126
36127 @end table
36128
36129 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36130 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36131
36132 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36133 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36134 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36135
36136 @menu
36137 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36138 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36139 @end menu
36140
36141 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36142 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36143
36144 @menu
36145 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36146 @end menu
36147
36148 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36149 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36150 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36151
36152 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36153
36154 @table @r
36155
36156 @item 2
36157 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36158
36159 @item 3
36160 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36161
36162 @item 4
36163 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36164
36165 @end table
36166
36167 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36168 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36169
36170 @menu
36171 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36172 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36173 @end menu
36174
36175 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36176 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36177 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36178
36179 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36180 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36181 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36182 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36183 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36184 most-significant -- least-significant.
36185
36186 @table @r
36187
36188 @item MIPS32
36189 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36190 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36191 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36192
36193 @item MIPS64
36194 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36195 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36196 as @code{MIPS32}.
36197
36198 @end table
36199
36200 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36201 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36202 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36203
36204 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36205
36206 @table @r
36207
36208 @item 2
36209 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36210
36211 @item 3
36212 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36213
36214 @item 4
36215 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36216
36217 @item 5
36218 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36219
36220 @end table
36221
36222 @node Tracepoint Packets
36223 @section Tracepoint Packets
36224 @cindex tracepoint packets
36225 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36226
36227 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36228 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36229
36230 @table @samp
36231
36232 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36233 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36234 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36235 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36236 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36237 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36238 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36239 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36240 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36241 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36242 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36243 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36244 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36245 actions.
36246
36247 Replies:
36248 @table @samp
36249 @item OK
36250 The packet was understood and carried out.
36251 @item qRelocInsn
36252 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36253 @item @w{}
36254 The packet was not recognized.
36255 @end table
36256
36257 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36258 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36259 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36260 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36261 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36262 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36263 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36264
36265 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36266 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36267 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36268 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36269 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36270 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36271 tracepoint actions.
36272
36273 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36274 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36275 following forms:
36276
36277 @table @samp
36278
36279 @item R @var{mask}
36280 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36281 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36282 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36283 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36284 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36285
36286 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36287 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36288 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36289 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36290 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36291 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36292 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36293
36294 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36295 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36296 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36297 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36298 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36299 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36300 packet).
36301
36302 @end table
36303
36304 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36305 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36306 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36307 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36308 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36309 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36310 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36311 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36312
36313 Replies:
36314 @table @samp
36315 @item OK
36316 The packet was understood and carried out.
36317 @item qRelocInsn
36318 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36319 @item @w{}
36320 The packet was not recognized.
36321 @end table
36322
36323 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36324 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36325 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36326 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36327 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36328 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36329 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36330 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36331
36332 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36333 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36334 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36335 fit in a single packet.
36336 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36337 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36338
36339 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36340 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36341 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36342 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36343
36344 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36345 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36346 query packets.
36347
36348 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36349 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36350 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36351 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36352 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36353 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36354 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36355 be found.
36356
36357 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36358 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36359 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36360 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36361 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36362 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36363 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36364 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36365 mentioned in expressions.
36366
36367 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36368 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36369 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36370 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36371 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36372
36373 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36374 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36375 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36376 one of the following forms:
36377
36378 @table @samp
36379 @item F @var{f}
36380 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36381 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36382 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36383
36384 @item T @var{t}
36385 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36386 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36387
36388 @end table
36389
36390 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36391 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36392 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36393 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36394
36395 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36396 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36397 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36398 is a hexadecimal number.
36399
36400 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36401 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36402 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36403 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36404 numbers.
36405
36406 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36407 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36408 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36409
36410 @item qTMinFTPILen
36411 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36412 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36413 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36414 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36415 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36416 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36417 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36418 arrange for that.
36419
36420 Replies:
36421
36422 @table @samp
36423 @item 0
36424 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36425 @item @var{length}
36426 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36427 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36428 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36429 regardless of size.
36430 @item E
36431 An error has occurred.
36432 @item @w{}
36433 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36434 @end table
36435
36436 @item QTStart
36437 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36438 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36439 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36440 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36441 instruction reply packet}).
36442
36443 @item QTStop
36444 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36445 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36446
36447 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36448 @anchor{QTEnable}
36449 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36450 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36451 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36452 of data from it will resume.
36453
36454 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36455 @anchor{QTDisable}
36456 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36457 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36458 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36459 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36460
36461 @item QTinit
36462 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36463 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36464
36465 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36466 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36467 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36468 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36469 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36470
36471 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36472 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36473 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36474 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36475
36476 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36477 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36478 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36479 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36480 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36481 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36482
36483 @item qTStatus
36484 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36485 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36486
36487 The reply has the form:
36488
36489 @table @samp
36490
36491 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36492 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36493 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36494 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36495
36496 @end table
36497
36498 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36499 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36500
36501 @table @samp
36502
36503 @item tnotrun:0
36504 No trace has been run yet.
36505
36506 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36507 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36508 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36509 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36510 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36511
36512 @item tfull:0
36513 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36514
36515 @item tdisconnected:0
36516 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36517
36518 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36519 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36520
36521 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36522 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36523 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36524 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
36525 is hex encoded.
36526
36527 @item tunknown:0
36528 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36529
36530 @end table
36531
36532 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36533 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36534 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36535 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36536 trace.
36537
36538 @table @samp
36539
36540 @item tframes:@var{n}
36541 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36542
36543 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36544 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36545 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36546
36547 @item tsize:@var{n}
36548 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36549
36550 @item tfree:@var{n}
36551 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36552
36553 @item circular:@var{n}
36554 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36555 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36556 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36557 and may fill up.
36558
36559 @item disconn:@var{n}
36560 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36561 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36562 that the trace run will stop.
36563
36564 @end table
36565
36566 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36567 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36568 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36569 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36570 address @var{addr}.
36571
36572 Replies:
36573 @table @samp
36574 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36575 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36576 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36577 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36578 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36579
36580 @end table
36581
36582 @item qTV:@var{var}
36583 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36584 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36585 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36586
36587 Replies:
36588 @table @samp
36589 @item V@var{value}
36590 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36591 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36592 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36593 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36594 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36595 program is running.
36596
36597 @item U
36598 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36599 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36600 was not collected.
36601 @end table
36602
36603 @item qTfP
36604 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36605 @itemx qTsP
36606 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36607 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36608 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36609 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36610 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36611 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36612
36613 @item qTfV
36614 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36615 @itemx qTsV
36616 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36617 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36618 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36619 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36620 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36621 trace state variables.
36622
36623 @item qTfSTM
36624 @itemx qTsSTM
36625 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36626 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36627 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36628 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36629 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36630 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36631 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36632 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36633
36634 Reply:
36635 @table @samp
36636 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36637 A single marker
36638 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36639 a comma-separated list of markers
36640 @item l
36641 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36642 @item E @var{nn}
36643 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36644 @item @w{}
36645 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36646 stub.
36647 @end table
36648
36649 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
36650 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36651
36652 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36653 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36654 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36655 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36656 @dfn{last}).
36657
36658 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36659 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36660 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36661 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36662 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36663 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36664 tracepoint markers.
36665
36666 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36667 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36668 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36669 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
36670 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36671 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36672
36673 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36674 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36675 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36676 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36677 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36678 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36679 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36680 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36681 available.
36682
36683 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36684 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36685 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36686
36687 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36688 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36689 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36690 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36691 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36692 use whatever size it prefers.
36693
36694 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36695 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36696 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36697 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36698 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36699
36700 @end table
36701
36702 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36703 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36704 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36705 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36706 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36707 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36708 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36709 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36710 it had executed in the original location.
36711
36712 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36713 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36714 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36715 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36716 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36717 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36718 format of the request is:
36719
36720 @table @samp
36721 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36722
36723 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36724 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36725 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36726 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36727 memory starting at @var{to}.
36728 @end table
36729
36730 Replies:
36731 @table @samp
36732 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36733 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
36734 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36735 @item E @var{NN}
36736 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36737 relocating the instruction.
36738 @end table
36739
36740 @node Host I/O Packets
36741 @section Host I/O Packets
36742 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36743 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36744
36745 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36746 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36747 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36748 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36749 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36750 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36751 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36752 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36753 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36754 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36755
36756 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36757 its arguments. They have this format:
36758
36759 @table @samp
36760
36761 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36762 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36763 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36764 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36765 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36766 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36767 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36768 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36769 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36770
36771 @end table
36772
36773 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36774
36775 @table @samp
36776
36777 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36778 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36779 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36780 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
36781 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36782 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36783 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36784 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36785 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36786 @var{attachment}.
36787
36788 @item @w{}
36789 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36790
36791 @end table
36792
36793 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36794
36795 @table @samp
36796 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36797 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36798 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
36799 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36800 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36801 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36802 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36803
36804 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36805 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36806 -1 if an error occurs.
36807
36808 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36809 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36810 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36811 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36812 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36813 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36814 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36815 @var{count} was zero.
36816
36817 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36818 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36819 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36820 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36821 some characters were escaped.
36822
36823 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36824 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36825 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36826 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36827 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36828 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36829 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36830 error occurred.
36831
36832 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
36833 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
36834 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
36835
36836 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36837 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36838 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36839
36840 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36841 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36842 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36843 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36844 some characters were escaped.
36845
36846 @end table
36847
36848 @node Interrupts
36849 @section Interrupts
36850 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36851
36852 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36853 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36854 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36855 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36856
36857 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36858 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36859 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36860 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36861 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36862
36863 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36864 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36865 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36866 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36867 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36868 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36869 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36870 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36871
36872 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36873 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36874 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36875
36876 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36877 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36878 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36879 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36880 currently-executing threads and processes.
36881 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36882 running program, it should send one of the stop
36883 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36884 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36885 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36886 Interrupts received while the
36887 program is stopped are discarded.
36888
36889 @node Notification Packets
36890 @section Notification Packets
36891 @cindex notification packets
36892 @cindex packets, notification
36893
36894 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36895 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36896 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36897 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36898 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36899 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36900 is not a problem.
36901
36902 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36903 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36904 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36905 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36906 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36907 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36908 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36909
36910 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36911 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36912
36913 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36914 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36915 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36916 not they understand it.
36917
36918 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36919 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36920 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36921 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36922 recipients.
36923
36924 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36925 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36926 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36927 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36928 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36929
36930 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36931 @table @samp
36932 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36933 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36934 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36935 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
36936 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
36937 @item @var{ack}
36938 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36939 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36940 @end table
36941
36942 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36943 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36944
36945 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36946 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36947 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36948 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36949 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36950 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36951 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36952 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36953 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36954 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36955
36956 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36957 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36958 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36959 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36960 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36961 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36962
36963 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36964 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36965 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36966 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36967 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36968
36969 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36970 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36971 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36972 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36973 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36974 normally.
36975
36976 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36977 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36978 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36979 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36980 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36981 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36982 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36983 the process shall be repeated.
36984
36985 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36986 following example:
36987 @smallexample
36988 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36989 @code{...}
36990 -> @code{vStopped}
36991 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36992 -> @code{vStopped}
36993 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36994 -> @code{vStopped}
36995 <- @code{OK}
36996 @end smallexample
36997
36998 The following notifications are defined:
36999 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37000
37001 @item Notification
37002 @tab Ack
37003 @tab Event
37004 @tab Description
37005
37006 @item Stop
37007 @tab vStopped
37008 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37009 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37010 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37011 @value{GDBN}.
37012 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37013
37014 @end multitable
37015
37016 @node Remote Non-Stop
37017 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37018
37019 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37020 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37021 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37022 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37023
37024 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37025 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37026 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37027 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37028 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37029 probe the target state after a mode change.
37030
37031 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37032 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37033 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37034 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37035 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37036 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37037 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37038 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37039 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37040 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37041 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37042
37043 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37044 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37045 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37046 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37047 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37048 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37049 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37050 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37051 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37052 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37053 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37054 @samp{OK}.
37055
37056 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37057 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37058
37059 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37060 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37061 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37062 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37063 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37064 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37065 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37066
37067 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37068 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37069 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37070 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37071 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37072
37073 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37074 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37075 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37076 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37077
37078 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37079 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37080 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37081 @pxref{qSupported}.
37082 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37083 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37084 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37085 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37086 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37087 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37088 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37089
37090 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37091 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37092 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37093 connection.
37094 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37095 new connection is established,
37096 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37097 for the current connection, once disabled.
37098
37099 @node Examples
37100 @section Examples
37101
37102 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37103 does not get any direct output:
37104
37105 @smallexample
37106 -> @code{R00}
37107 <- @code{+}
37108 @emph{target restarts}
37109 -> @code{?}
37110 <- @code{+}
37111 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37112 -> @code{+}
37113 @end smallexample
37114
37115 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37116
37117 @smallexample
37118 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37119 <- @code{+}
37120 -> @code{s}
37121 <- @code{+}
37122 @emph{time passes}
37123 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37124 -> @code{+}
37125 -> @code{g}
37126 <- @code{+}
37127 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37128 -> @code{+}
37129 @end smallexample
37130
37131 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37132 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37133 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37134
37135 @menu
37136 * File-I/O Overview::
37137 * Protocol Basics::
37138 * The F Request Packet::
37139 * The F Reply Packet::
37140 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37141 * Console I/O::
37142 * List of Supported Calls::
37143 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37144 * Constants::
37145 * File-I/O Examples::
37146 @end menu
37147
37148 @node File-I/O Overview
37149 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37150 @cindex file-i/o overview
37151
37152 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37153 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37154 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37155 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37156 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37157 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37158
37159 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37160 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37161 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37162 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37163 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37164
37165 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37166 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37167 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37168 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37169 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37170 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37171 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37172
37173 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37174 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37175 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37176 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37177 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37178
37179 @smallexample
37180 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37181 <- target requests 'system call X'
37182 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37183 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37184 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37185 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37186 @end smallexample
37187
37188 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37189 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37190 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37191 system are not supported by this protocol.
37192
37193 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37194
37195 @node Protocol Basics
37196 @subsection Protocol Basics
37197 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37198
37199 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37200 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37201 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37202 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37203 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37204 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37205 to call the appropriate host system call:
37206
37207 @itemize @bullet
37208 @item
37209 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37210
37211 @item
37212 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37213 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37214 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37215 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37216
37217 @end itemize
37218
37219 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37220
37221 @itemize @bullet
37222 @item
37223 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37224 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37225 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37226 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37227 packet.
37228
37229 @item
37230 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37231 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37232
37233 @item
37234 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37235
37236 @item
37237 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37238
37239 @item
37240 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37241 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37242 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37243 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37244 packet.
37245
37246 @end itemize
37247
37248 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37249 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37250
37251 @itemize @bullet
37252 @item
37253 Return value.
37254
37255 @item
37256 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37257
37258 @item
37259 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37260
37261 @end itemize
37262
37263 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37264 the latest continue or step action.
37265
37266 @node The F Request Packet
37267 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37268 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37269 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37270
37271 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37272
37273 @table @samp
37274 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37275
37276 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37277 This is just the name of the function.
37278
37279 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37280 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37281 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37282 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37283 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37284 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37285 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37286
37287 @end table
37288
37289
37290
37291 @node The F Reply Packet
37292 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37293 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37294 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37295
37296 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37297
37298 @table @samp
37299
37300 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37301
37302 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37303
37304 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37305 representation.
37306 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37307
37308 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37309 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37310 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37311
37312 @smallexample
37313 F0,0,C
37314 @end smallexample
37315
37316 @noindent
37317 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37318
37319 @smallexample
37320 F-1,4,C
37321 @end smallexample
37322
37323 @noindent
37324 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37325
37326 @end table
37327
37328
37329 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37330 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37331 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37332
37333 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37334 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37335 the target should behave as if it had
37336 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37337 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37338 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37339 packet.
37340
37341 It's important for the target to know in which
37342 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37343
37344 @itemize @bullet
37345 @item
37346 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37347
37348 @item
37349 The system call on the host has been finished.
37350
37351 @end itemize
37352
37353 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37354 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37355 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37356 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37357 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37358 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37359
37360 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37361 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37362 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37363 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37364 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37365 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37366 or the full action has been completed.
37367
37368 @node Console I/O
37369 @subsection Console I/O
37370 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37371
37372 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37373 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37374 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37375 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37376 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37377 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37378 conditions is met:
37379
37380 @itemize @bullet
37381 @item
37382 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37383 @code{read}
37384 system call is treated as finished.
37385
37386 @item
37387 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37388 newline.
37389
37390 @item
37391 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37392 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37393
37394 @end itemize
37395
37396 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37397 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37398 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37399 is stopped at the user's request.
37400
37401
37402 @node List of Supported Calls
37403 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37404 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37405
37406 @menu
37407 * open::
37408 * close::
37409 * read::
37410 * write::
37411 * lseek::
37412 * rename::
37413 * unlink::
37414 * stat/fstat::
37415 * gettimeofday::
37416 * isatty::
37417 * system::
37418 @end menu
37419
37420 @node open
37421 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37422 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37423
37424 @table @asis
37425 @item Synopsis:
37426 @smallexample
37427 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37428 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37429 @end smallexample
37430
37431 @item Request:
37432 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37433
37434 @noindent
37435 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37436
37437 @table @code
37438 @item O_CREAT
37439 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37440 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37441 are concerned.
37442
37443 @item O_EXCL
37444 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37445 an error and open() fails.
37446
37447 @item O_TRUNC
37448 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37449 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37450 truncated to zero length.
37451
37452 @item O_APPEND
37453 The file is opened in append mode.
37454
37455 @item O_RDONLY
37456 The file is opened for reading only.
37457
37458 @item O_WRONLY
37459 The file is opened for writing only.
37460
37461 @item O_RDWR
37462 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37463 @end table
37464
37465 @noindent
37466 Other bits are silently ignored.
37467
37468
37469 @noindent
37470 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37471
37472 @table @code
37473 @item S_IRUSR
37474 User has read permission.
37475
37476 @item S_IWUSR
37477 User has write permission.
37478
37479 @item S_IRGRP
37480 Group has read permission.
37481
37482 @item S_IWGRP
37483 Group has write permission.
37484
37485 @item S_IROTH
37486 Others have read permission.
37487
37488 @item S_IWOTH
37489 Others have write permission.
37490 @end table
37491
37492 @noindent
37493 Other bits are silently ignored.
37494
37495
37496 @item Return value:
37497 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37498 occurred.
37499
37500 @item Errors:
37501
37502 @table @code
37503 @item EEXIST
37504 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37505
37506 @item EISDIR
37507 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37508
37509 @item EACCES
37510 The requested access is not allowed.
37511
37512 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37513 @var{pathname} was too long.
37514
37515 @item ENOENT
37516 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37517
37518 @item ENODEV
37519 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37520
37521 @item EROFS
37522 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37523 write access was requested.
37524
37525 @item EFAULT
37526 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37527
37528 @item ENOSPC
37529 No space on device to create the file.
37530
37531 @item EMFILE
37532 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37533
37534 @item ENFILE
37535 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37536 has been reached.
37537
37538 @item EINTR
37539 The call was interrupted by the user.
37540 @end table
37541
37542 @end table
37543
37544 @node close
37545 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37546 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37547
37548 @table @asis
37549 @item Synopsis:
37550 @smallexample
37551 int close(int fd);
37552 @end smallexample
37553
37554 @item Request:
37555 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37556
37557 @item Return value:
37558 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37559
37560 @item Errors:
37561
37562 @table @code
37563 @item EBADF
37564 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37565
37566 @item EINTR
37567 The call was interrupted by the user.
37568 @end table
37569
37570 @end table
37571
37572 @node read
37573 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37574 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37575
37576 @table @asis
37577 @item Synopsis:
37578 @smallexample
37579 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37580 @end smallexample
37581
37582 @item Request:
37583 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37584
37585 @item Return value:
37586 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37587 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37588 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37589
37590 @item Errors:
37591
37592 @table @code
37593 @item EBADF
37594 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37595 reading.
37596
37597 @item EFAULT
37598 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37599
37600 @item EINTR
37601 The call was interrupted by the user.
37602 @end table
37603
37604 @end table
37605
37606 @node write
37607 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37608 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37609
37610 @table @asis
37611 @item Synopsis:
37612 @smallexample
37613 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37614 @end smallexample
37615
37616 @item Request:
37617 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37618
37619 @item Return value:
37620 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37621 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37622 is returned.
37623
37624 @item Errors:
37625
37626 @table @code
37627 @item EBADF
37628 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37629 writing.
37630
37631 @item EFAULT
37632 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37633
37634 @item EFBIG
37635 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37636 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37637
37638 @item ENOSPC
37639 No space on device to write the data.
37640
37641 @item EINTR
37642 The call was interrupted by the user.
37643 @end table
37644
37645 @end table
37646
37647 @node lseek
37648 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37649 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37650
37651 @table @asis
37652 @item Synopsis:
37653 @smallexample
37654 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37655 @end smallexample
37656
37657 @item Request:
37658 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37659
37660 @var{flag} is one of:
37661
37662 @table @code
37663 @item SEEK_SET
37664 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37665
37666 @item SEEK_CUR
37667 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37668 bytes.
37669
37670 @item SEEK_END
37671 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37672 bytes.
37673 @end table
37674
37675 @item Return value:
37676 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37677 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37678 value of -1 is returned.
37679
37680 @item Errors:
37681
37682 @table @code
37683 @item EBADF
37684 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37685
37686 @item ESPIPE
37687 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37688
37689 @item EINVAL
37690 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37691
37692 @item EINTR
37693 The call was interrupted by the user.
37694 @end table
37695
37696 @end table
37697
37698 @node rename
37699 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37700 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37701
37702 @table @asis
37703 @item Synopsis:
37704 @smallexample
37705 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37706 @end smallexample
37707
37708 @item Request:
37709 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37710
37711 @item Return value:
37712 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37713
37714 @item Errors:
37715
37716 @table @code
37717 @item EISDIR
37718 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37719 directory.
37720
37721 @item EEXIST
37722 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37723
37724 @item EBUSY
37725 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37726 process.
37727
37728 @item EINVAL
37729 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37730 of itself.
37731
37732 @item ENOTDIR
37733 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37734 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37735 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37736
37737 @item EFAULT
37738 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37739
37740 @item EACCES
37741 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37742
37743 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37744
37745 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37746
37747 @item ENOENT
37748 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37749
37750 @item EROFS
37751 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37752
37753 @item ENOSPC
37754 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37755 directory entry.
37756
37757 @item EINTR
37758 The call was interrupted by the user.
37759 @end table
37760
37761 @end table
37762
37763 @node unlink
37764 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37765 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37766
37767 @table @asis
37768 @item Synopsis:
37769 @smallexample
37770 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37771 @end smallexample
37772
37773 @item Request:
37774 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37775
37776 @item Return value:
37777 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37778
37779 @item Errors:
37780
37781 @table @code
37782 @item EACCES
37783 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37784
37785 @item EPERM
37786 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37787
37788 @item EBUSY
37789 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37790 being used by another process.
37791
37792 @item EFAULT
37793 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37794
37795 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37796 @var{pathname} was too long.
37797
37798 @item ENOENT
37799 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37800
37801 @item ENOTDIR
37802 A component of the path is not a directory.
37803
37804 @item EROFS
37805 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37806
37807 @item EINTR
37808 The call was interrupted by the user.
37809 @end table
37810
37811 @end table
37812
37813 @node stat/fstat
37814 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37815 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37816 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37817
37818 @table @asis
37819 @item Synopsis:
37820 @smallexample
37821 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37822 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37823 @end smallexample
37824
37825 @item Request:
37826 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37827 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37828
37829 @item Return value:
37830 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37831
37832 @item Errors:
37833
37834 @table @code
37835 @item EBADF
37836 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37837
37838 @item ENOENT
37839 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37840 path is an empty string.
37841
37842 @item ENOTDIR
37843 A component of the path is not a directory.
37844
37845 @item EFAULT
37846 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37847
37848 @item EACCES
37849 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37850
37851 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37852 @var{pathname} was too long.
37853
37854 @item EINTR
37855 The call was interrupted by the user.
37856 @end table
37857
37858 @end table
37859
37860 @node gettimeofday
37861 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37862 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37863
37864 @table @asis
37865 @item Synopsis:
37866 @smallexample
37867 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37868 @end smallexample
37869
37870 @item Request:
37871 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37872
37873 @item Return value:
37874 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37875
37876 @item Errors:
37877
37878 @table @code
37879 @item EINVAL
37880 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37881
37882 @item EFAULT
37883 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37884 @end table
37885
37886 @end table
37887
37888 @node isatty
37889 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37890 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37891
37892 @table @asis
37893 @item Synopsis:
37894 @smallexample
37895 int isatty(int fd);
37896 @end smallexample
37897
37898 @item Request:
37899 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37900
37901 @item Return value:
37902 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37903
37904 @item Errors:
37905
37906 @table @code
37907 @item EINTR
37908 The call was interrupted by the user.
37909 @end table
37910
37911 @end table
37912
37913 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37914 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37915 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37916 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37917 needed.
37918
37919
37920 @node system
37921 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37922 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37923
37924 @table @asis
37925 @item Synopsis:
37926 @smallexample
37927 int system(const char *command);
37928 @end smallexample
37929
37930 @item Request:
37931 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37932
37933 @item Return value:
37934 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37935 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37936 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37937 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37938 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37939 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37940 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37941
37942 @item Errors:
37943
37944 @table @code
37945 @item EINTR
37946 The call was interrupted by the user.
37947 @end table
37948
37949 @end table
37950
37951 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37952 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37953 the host is simplified before it's returned
37954 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37955 is discarded, and the return value consists
37956 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37957
37958 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37959 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37960 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37961
37962 @table @code
37963 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37964 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37965 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37966 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37967
37968 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37969 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37970 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37971 protocol.
37972 @end table
37973
37974 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37975 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37976 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37977
37978 @menu
37979 * Integral Datatypes::
37980 * Pointer Values::
37981 * Memory Transfer::
37982 * struct stat::
37983 * struct timeval::
37984 @end menu
37985
37986 @node Integral Datatypes
37987 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37988 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37989
37990 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37991 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37992 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37993
37994 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37995 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37996
37997 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37998
37999 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38000 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38001
38002 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38003
38004 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38005 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38006 byte order.
38007
38008 @node Pointer Values
38009 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38010 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38011
38012 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38013 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38014 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38015 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38016
38017 @smallexample
38018 @code{1aaf/12}
38019 @end smallexample
38020
38021 @noindent
38022 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38023 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38024 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38025 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38026
38027 @smallexample
38028 @code{123456/d}
38029 @end smallexample
38030
38031 @node Memory Transfer
38032 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38033 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38034
38035 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38036 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38037 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38038 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38039 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38040 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38041 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38042
38043
38044 @node struct stat
38045 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38046 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38047
38048 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38049 is defined as follows:
38050
38051 @smallexample
38052 struct stat @{
38053 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38054 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38055 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38056 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38057 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38058 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38059 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38060 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38061 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38062 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38063 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38064 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38065 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38066 @};
38067 @end smallexample
38068
38069 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38070 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38071 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38072
38073 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38074 range of values.
38075
38076 @table @code
38077
38078 @item st_dev
38079 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38080
38081 @item st_ino
38082 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38083
38084 @item st_mode
38085 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38086 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38087
38088 @item st_uid
38089 @itemx st_gid
38090 @itemx st_rdev
38091 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38092
38093 @item st_atime
38094 @itemx st_mtime
38095 @itemx st_ctime
38096 These values have a host and file system dependent
38097 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38098 support exact timing values.
38099 @end table
38100
38101 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38102 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38103 continuing.
38104
38105 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38106 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38107 get truncated on the target.
38108
38109 @node struct timeval
38110 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38111 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38112
38113 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38114 is defined as follows:
38115
38116 @smallexample
38117 struct timeval @{
38118 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38119 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38120 @};
38121 @end smallexample
38122
38123 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38124 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38125 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38126
38127 @node Constants
38128 @subsection Constants
38129 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38130
38131 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38132 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38133 values before and after the call as needed.
38134
38135 @menu
38136 * Open Flags::
38137 * mode_t Values::
38138 * Errno Values::
38139 * Lseek Flags::
38140 * Limits::
38141 @end menu
38142
38143 @node Open Flags
38144 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38145 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38146
38147 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38148
38149 @smallexample
38150 O_RDONLY 0x0
38151 O_WRONLY 0x1
38152 O_RDWR 0x2
38153 O_APPEND 0x8
38154 O_CREAT 0x200
38155 O_TRUNC 0x400
38156 O_EXCL 0x800
38157 @end smallexample
38158
38159 @node mode_t Values
38160 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38161 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38162
38163 All values are given in octal representation.
38164
38165 @smallexample
38166 S_IFREG 0100000
38167 S_IFDIR 040000
38168 S_IRUSR 0400
38169 S_IWUSR 0200
38170 S_IXUSR 0100
38171 S_IRGRP 040
38172 S_IWGRP 020
38173 S_IXGRP 010
38174 S_IROTH 04
38175 S_IWOTH 02
38176 S_IXOTH 01
38177 @end smallexample
38178
38179 @node Errno Values
38180 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38181 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38182
38183 All values are given in decimal representation.
38184
38185 @smallexample
38186 EPERM 1
38187 ENOENT 2
38188 EINTR 4
38189 EBADF 9
38190 EACCES 13
38191 EFAULT 14
38192 EBUSY 16
38193 EEXIST 17
38194 ENODEV 19
38195 ENOTDIR 20
38196 EISDIR 21
38197 EINVAL 22
38198 ENFILE 23
38199 EMFILE 24
38200 EFBIG 27
38201 ENOSPC 28
38202 ESPIPE 29
38203 EROFS 30
38204 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38205 EUNKNOWN 9999
38206 @end smallexample
38207
38208 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38209 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38210
38211 @node Lseek Flags
38212 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38213 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38214
38215 @smallexample
38216 SEEK_SET 0
38217 SEEK_CUR 1
38218 SEEK_END 2
38219 @end smallexample
38220
38221 @node Limits
38222 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38223 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38224
38225 All values are given in decimal representation.
38226
38227 @smallexample
38228 INT_MIN -2147483648
38229 INT_MAX 2147483647
38230 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38231 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38232 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38233 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38234 @end smallexample
38235
38236 @node File-I/O Examples
38237 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38238 @cindex file-i/o examples
38239
38240 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38241 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38242
38243 @smallexample
38244 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38245 @emph{request memory read from target}
38246 -> @code{m1234,6}
38247 <- XXXXXX
38248 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38249 -> @code{F6}
38250 @end smallexample
38251
38252 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38253 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38254
38255 @smallexample
38256 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38257 @emph{request memory write to target}
38258 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38259 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38260 -> @code{F6}
38261 @end smallexample
38262
38263 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38264 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38265
38266 @smallexample
38267 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38268 -> @code{F-1,9}
38269 @end smallexample
38270
38271 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38272 host is called:
38273
38274 @smallexample
38275 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38276 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38277 <- @code{T02}
38278 @end smallexample
38279
38280 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38281 host is called:
38282
38283 @smallexample
38284 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38285 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38286 <- @code{T02}
38287 @end smallexample
38288
38289 @node Library List Format
38290 @section Library List Format
38291 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38292
38293 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38294 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38295 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38296 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38297 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38298 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38299 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38300 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38301 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38302 are loaded.
38303
38304 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38305 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38306 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38307 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38308
38309 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38310 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38311 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38312 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38313 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38314 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38315
38316 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38317 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38318
38319 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38320 offset, looks like this:
38321
38322 @smallexample
38323 <library-list>
38324 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38325 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38326 </library>
38327 </library-list>
38328 @end smallexample
38329
38330 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38331 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38332
38333 @smallexample
38334 <library-list>
38335 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38336 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38337 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38338 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38339 </library>
38340 </library-list>
38341 @end smallexample
38342
38343 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38344
38345 @smallexample
38346 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38347 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38348 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38349 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38350 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38351 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38352 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38353 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38354 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38355 @end smallexample
38356
38357 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38358 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38359 section for each library.
38360
38361 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38362 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38363 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38364
38365 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38366 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38367 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38368 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38369
38370 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38371 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38372 target, the following parameters are reported:
38373
38374 @itemize @minus
38375 @item
38376 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38377 @code{struct link_map}.
38378 @item
38379 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38380 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38381 @item
38382 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38383 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38384 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38385 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38386 @item
38387 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38388 @end itemize
38389
38390 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38391 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38392 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38393
38394 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38395 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38396
38397 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38398 looks like this:
38399
38400 @smallexample
38401 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38402 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38403 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38404 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38405 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38406 </library-list-svr>
38407 @end smallexample
38408
38409 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38410
38411 @smallexample
38412 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38413 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38414 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38415 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38416 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38417 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38418 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38419 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38420 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38421 @end smallexample
38422
38423 @node Memory Map Format
38424 @section Memory Map Format
38425 @cindex memory map format
38426
38427 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38428 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38429 memory map.
38430
38431 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38432 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38433 lists memory regions.
38434
38435 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38436 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38437
38438 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38439
38440 @smallexample
38441 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38442 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38443 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38444 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38445 <memory-map>
38446 region...
38447 </memory-map>
38448 @end smallexample
38449
38450 Each region can be either:
38451
38452 @itemize
38453
38454 @item
38455 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38456 bytes from there:
38457
38458 @smallexample
38459 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38460 @end smallexample
38461
38462
38463 @item
38464 A region of read-only memory:
38465
38466 @smallexample
38467 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38468 @end smallexample
38469
38470
38471 @item
38472 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38473 bytes in length:
38474
38475 @smallexample
38476 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38477 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38478 </memory>
38479 @end smallexample
38480
38481 @end itemize
38482
38483 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38484 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38485 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38486
38487 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38488
38489 @smallexample
38490 <!-- ................................................... -->
38491 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38492 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38493 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38494 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38495 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38496 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38497 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38498 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38499 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38500 and its type, or device. -->
38501 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38502 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38503 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38504 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38505 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38506 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38507 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38508 @end smallexample
38509
38510 @node Thread List Format
38511 @section Thread List Format
38512 @cindex thread list format
38513
38514 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38515 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38516 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38517 the following structure:
38518
38519 @smallexample
38520 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38521 <threads>
38522 <thread id="id" core="0">
38523 ... description ...
38524 </thread>
38525 </threads>
38526 @end smallexample
38527
38528 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38529 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38530 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38531 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38532 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38533
38534 @node Traceframe Info Format
38535 @section Traceframe Info Format
38536 @cindex traceframe info format
38537
38538 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38539 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38540 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38541 collected in a traceframe.
38542
38543 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38544 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38545
38546 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38547 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38548
38549 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38550
38551 @smallexample
38552 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38553 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38554 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38555 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38556 <traceframe-info>
38557 block...
38558 </traceframe-info>
38559 @end smallexample
38560
38561 Each traceframe block can be either:
38562
38563 @itemize
38564
38565 @item
38566 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38567 @var{length} bytes from there:
38568
38569 @smallexample
38570 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38571 @end smallexample
38572
38573 @item
38574 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38575 collected:
38576
38577 @smallexample
38578 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38579 @end smallexample
38580
38581 @end itemize
38582
38583 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38584
38585 @smallexample
38586 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38587 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38588
38589 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38590 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38591 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38592 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38593 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38594 @end smallexample
38595
38596 @node Branch Trace Format
38597 @section Branch Trace Format
38598 @cindex branch trace format
38599
38600 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38601 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38602 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38603 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38604
38605 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38606 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38607
38608 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38609 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38610
38611 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38612
38613 @smallexample
38614 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38615 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38616 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38617 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38618 <btrace>
38619 block...
38620 </btrace>
38621 @end smallexample
38622
38623 @itemize
38624
38625 @item
38626 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38627 and ending at @var{end}:
38628
38629 @smallexample
38630 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38631 @end smallexample
38632
38633 @end itemize
38634
38635 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38636
38637 @smallexample
38638 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38639 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38640
38641 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38642 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38643 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38644 @end smallexample
38645
38646 @include agentexpr.texi
38647
38648 @node Target Descriptions
38649 @appendix Target Descriptions
38650 @cindex target descriptions
38651
38652 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38653 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38654 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38655 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38656 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38657 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38658 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38659
38660 @itemize @bullet
38661 @item
38662 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38663 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38664 @item
38665 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38666 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38667 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38668 @item
38669 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38670 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38671 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38672 @end itemize
38673
38674 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38675 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38676 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38677 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38678 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38679
38680 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38681 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38682
38683 @menu
38684 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38685 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38686 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38687 descriptions.
38688 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38689 @end menu
38690
38691 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38692 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38693
38694 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38695 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38696 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38697 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38698 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38699 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38700 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38701 Format}.
38702
38703 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38704 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38705 specify a file are:
38706
38707 @table @code
38708 @cindex set tdesc filename
38709 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38710 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38711
38712 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38713 @item unset tdesc filename
38714 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38715 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38716
38717 @cindex show tdesc filename
38718 @item show tdesc filename
38719 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38720 @end table
38721
38722
38723 @node Target Description Format
38724 @section Target Description Format
38725 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38726
38727 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38728 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38729 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38730 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38731 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38732 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38733 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38734
38735 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38736 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38737 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38738 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38739 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38740
38741 Here is a simple target description:
38742
38743 @smallexample
38744 <target version="1.0">
38745 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38746 </target>
38747 @end smallexample
38748
38749 @noindent
38750 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38751 the x86-64 architecture.
38752
38753 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38754 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38755 are explained further below.
38756
38757 @smallexample
38758 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38759 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38760 <target version="1.0">
38761 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38762 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38763 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38764 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38765 </target>
38766 @end smallexample
38767
38768 @noindent
38769 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38770 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38771 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38772 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38773 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38774 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38775 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38776 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38777 the version mismatch.
38778
38779 @subsection Inclusion
38780 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38781 @cindex XInclude
38782 @ifnotinfo
38783 @cindex <xi:include>
38784 @end ifnotinfo
38785
38786 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38787 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38788 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38789 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38790 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38791
38792 @smallexample
38793 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38794 @end smallexample
38795
38796 @noindent
38797 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38798 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38799 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38800 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38801 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38802 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38803 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38804 original description.
38805
38806 @subsection Architecture
38807 @cindex <architecture>
38808
38809 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38810
38811 @smallexample
38812 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38813 @end smallexample
38814
38815 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38816 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38817
38818 @subsection OS ABI
38819 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38820
38821 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38822 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38823
38824 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38825
38826 @smallexample
38827 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38828 @end smallexample
38829
38830 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38831 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38832
38833 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38834 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38835
38836 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38837 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38838
38839 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38840
38841 @smallexample
38842 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38843 @end smallexample
38844
38845 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38846 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38847
38848 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38849 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38850 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38851 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38852 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38853 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38854 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38855
38856 @smallexample
38857 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38858 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38859 @end smallexample
38860
38861 @subsection Features
38862 @cindex <feature>
38863
38864 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38865 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38866 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38867 has this form:
38868
38869 @smallexample
38870 <feature name="@var{name}">
38871 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38872 @var{reg}@dots{}
38873 </feature>
38874 @end smallexample
38875
38876 @noindent
38877 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38878 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38879 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38880 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38881
38882 @subsection Types
38883
38884 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38885 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38886 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38887 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38888 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38889
38890 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38891 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38892 Types must be defined before they are used.
38893
38894 @cindex <vector>
38895 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38896 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38897 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38898 @var{count}:
38899
38900 @smallexample
38901 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38902 @end smallexample
38903
38904 @cindex <union>
38905 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38906 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38907 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38908 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38909
38910 @smallexample
38911 <union id="@var{id}">
38912 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38913 @dots{}
38914 </union>
38915 @end smallexample
38916
38917 @cindex <struct>
38918 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38919 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38920 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38921 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38922 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38923 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38924 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38925 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38926
38927 @smallexample
38928 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38929 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38930 @dots{}
38931 </struct>
38932 @end smallexample
38933
38934 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38935 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38936
38937 @smallexample
38938 <struct id="@var{id}">
38939 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38940 @dots{}
38941 </struct>
38942 @end smallexample
38943
38944 @cindex <flags>
38945 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38946 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38947 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38948 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38949 are supported.
38950
38951 @smallexample
38952 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38953 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38954 @dots{}
38955 </flags>
38956 @end smallexample
38957
38958 @subsection Registers
38959 @cindex <reg>
38960
38961 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38962
38963 @smallexample
38964 <reg name="@var{name}"
38965 bitsize="@var{size}"
38966 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38967 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38968 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38969 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38970 @end smallexample
38971
38972 @noindent
38973 The components are as follows:
38974
38975 @table @var
38976
38977 @item name
38978 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38979
38980 @item bitsize
38981 The register's size, in bits.
38982
38983 @item regnum
38984 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38985 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38986 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38987 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38988 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38989 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38990 in order of increasing register number.
38991
38992 @item save-restore
38993 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38994 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38995 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38996 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38997 ABI.
38998
38999 @item type
39000 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39001 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39002 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39003 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39004 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39005 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39006
39007 @item group
39008 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39009 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39010 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39011 in @code{info registers}.
39012
39013 @end table
39014
39015 @node Predefined Target Types
39016 @section Predefined Target Types
39017 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39018
39019 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39020 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39021 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39022 types. The currently supported types are:
39023
39024 @table @code
39025
39026 @item int8
39027 @itemx int16
39028 @itemx int32
39029 @itemx int64
39030 @itemx int128
39031 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39032
39033 @item uint8
39034 @itemx uint16
39035 @itemx uint32
39036 @itemx uint64
39037 @itemx uint128
39038 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39039
39040 @item code_ptr
39041 @itemx data_ptr
39042 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39043 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39044 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39045 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39046 may be marked as data pointers.
39047
39048 @item ieee_single
39049 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39050
39051 @item ieee_double
39052 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39053
39054 @item arm_fpa_ext
39055 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39056
39057 @item i387_ext
39058 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39059
39060 @item i386_eflags
39061 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39062
39063 @item i386_mxcsr
39064 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39065
39066 @end table
39067
39068 @node Standard Target Features
39069 @section Standard Target Features
39070 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39071
39072 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39073 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39074 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39075 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39076 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39077 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39078 can recognize them.
39079
39080 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39081 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39082 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39083 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39084 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39085 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39086 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39087 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39088
39089 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39090 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39091 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39092
39093 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39094 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39095 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39096 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39097
39098 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39099 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39100 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39101
39102 @menu
39103 * AArch64 Features::
39104 * ARM Features::
39105 * i386 Features::
39106 * MIPS Features::
39107 * M68K Features::
39108 * Nios II Features::
39109 * PowerPC Features::
39110 * S/390 and System z Features::
39111 * TIC6x Features::
39112 @end menu
39113
39114
39115 @node AArch64 Features
39116 @subsection AArch64 Features
39117 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39118
39119 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39120 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39121 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39122
39123 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39124 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39125 and @samp{fpcr}.
39126
39127 @node ARM Features
39128 @subsection ARM Features
39129 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39130
39131 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39132 ARM targets.
39133 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39134 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39135
39136 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39137 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39138 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39139 and @samp{xpsr}.
39140
39141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39142 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39143
39144 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39145 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39146 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39147 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39148
39149 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39150 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39151 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39152 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39153 halves of the double-precision registers.
39154
39155 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39156 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39157 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39158 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39159 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39160 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39161
39162 @node i386 Features
39163 @subsection i386 Features
39164 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39165
39166 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39167 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39168
39169 @itemize @minus
39170 @item
39171 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39172 @item
39173 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39174 @item
39175 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39176 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39177 @item
39178 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39179 @item
39180 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39181 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39182 @end itemize
39183
39184 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39185
39186 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39187 describe registers:
39188
39189 @itemize @minus
39190 @item
39191 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39192 @item
39193 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39194 @item
39195 @samp{mxcsr}
39196 @end itemize
39197
39198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39199 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39200 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39201
39202 @itemize @minus
39203 @item
39204 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39205 @item
39206 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39207 @end itemize
39208
39209 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39210 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39211
39212 @itemize @minus
39213 @item
39214 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39215 @item
39216 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39217 @end itemize
39218
39219 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39220 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39221
39222 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39223 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39224 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39225
39226 @itemize @minus
39227 @item
39228 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39229 @end itemize
39230
39231 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39232
39233 @itemize @minus
39234 @item
39235 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39236 @end itemize
39237
39238 It should
39239 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39240
39241 @itemize @minus
39242 @item
39243 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39244 @item
39245 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39246 @end itemize
39247
39248 It should
39249 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39250
39251 @itemize @minus
39252 @item
39253 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39254 @end itemize
39255
39256 @node MIPS Features
39257 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39258 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39259
39260 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39261 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39262 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39263 on the target.
39264
39265 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39266 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39267 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39268
39269 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39270 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39271 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39272 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39273
39274 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39275 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39276 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39277 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39278
39279 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39280 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39281 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39282
39283 @node M68K Features
39284 @subsection M68K Features
39285 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39286
39287 @table @code
39288 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39289 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39290 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39291 One of those features must be always present.
39292 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39293 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39294 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39295 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39296
39297 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39298 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39299 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39300 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39301 @end table
39302
39303 @node Nios II Features
39304 @subsection Nios II Features
39305 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39306
39307 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39308 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39309 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39310 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39311 @samp{mpuacc}).
39312
39313 @node PowerPC Features
39314 @subsection PowerPC Features
39315 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39316
39317 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39318 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39319 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39320 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39321
39322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39323 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39324
39325 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39326 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39327 and @samp{vrsave}.
39328
39329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39330 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39331 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39332 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39333 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39334 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39335
39336 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39337 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39338 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39339 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39340 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39341 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39342 user.
39343
39344 @node S/390 and System z Features
39345 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39346 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39347 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39348
39349 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39350 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39351 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39352 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39353 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39354 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39355 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39356 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39357 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39358
39359 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39360 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39361 @samp{fpc}.
39362
39363 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39364 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39365
39366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39367 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39368 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39369 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39370 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39371 32-bit wide.
39372
39373 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39374 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39375 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39376
39377 @node TIC6x Features
39378 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39379 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39380 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39381 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39382 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39383 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39384
39385 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39386 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39387 through @samp{B31}.
39388
39389 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39390 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39391
39392 @node Operating System Information
39393 @appendix Operating System Information
39394 @cindex operating system information
39395
39396 @menu
39397 * Process list::
39398 @end menu
39399
39400 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39401 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39402 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39403 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39404 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39405 on a different aspect of target.
39406
39407 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39408 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39409 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39410 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39411
39412 @node Process list
39413 @appendixsection Process list
39414 @cindex operating system information, process list
39415
39416 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39417 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39418 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39419 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39420
39421 An example document is:
39422
39423 @smallexample
39424 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39425 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39426 <osdata type="processes">
39427 <item>
39428 <column name="pid">1</column>
39429 <column name="user">root</column>
39430 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39431 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39432 </item>
39433 </osdata>
39434 @end smallexample
39435
39436 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39437 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39438 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39439 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39440 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39441 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39442 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39443
39444 @node Trace File Format
39445 @appendix Trace File Format
39446 @cindex trace file format
39447
39448 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39449 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39450
39451 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39452 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39453 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39454 in the future.
39455
39456 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39457 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39458 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39459 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39460 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39461 of this section.
39462
39463 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39464
39465 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39466 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39467 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39468 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39469 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39470 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39471 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39472 endianness.
39473
39474 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39475
39476 @table @code
39477 @item R @var{bytes}
39478 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39479 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39480 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39481 hexadecimal encoding.
39482
39483 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39484 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39485 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39486 @var{length} bytes.
39487
39488 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39489 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39490 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39491
39492 @end table
39493
39494 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39495 of blocks.
39496
39497 @node Index Section Format
39498 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39499 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39500 @cindex index section format
39501
39502 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39503 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39504 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39505 description.
39506
39507 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39508 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39509 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39510 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39511 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39512 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39513
39514 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39515
39516 @enumerate
39517 @item
39518 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39519 unless otherwise noted:
39520
39521 @enumerate
39522 @item
39523 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39524 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39525 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39526 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39527 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39528 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39529 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39530
39531 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39532 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39533 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39534 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39535
39536 @item
39537 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39538
39539 @item
39540 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39541 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39542 to the next offset.
39543
39544 @item
39545 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39546
39547 @item
39548 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39549
39550 @item
39551 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39552 @end enumerate
39553
39554 @item
39555 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39556 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39557 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39558 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39559 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39560 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39561 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39562 CU indices.
39563
39564 @item
39565 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39566 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39567 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39568 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39569
39570 @item
39571 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39572 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39573
39574 @enumerate
39575 @item
39576 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39577
39578 @item
39579 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39580 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39581
39582 @item
39583 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39584 @end enumerate
39585
39586 @item
39587 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39588 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39589
39590 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39591 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39592 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39593 constant pool.
39594
39595 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39596 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39597 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39598
39599 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39600 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39601 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39602 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39603 index version:
39604
39605 @table @asis
39606 @item Version 4
39607 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39608
39609 @item Versions 5 to 7
39610 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39611 @end table
39612
39613 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39614
39615 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39616 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39617 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39618 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39619 collision.
39620
39621 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39622 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39623 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39624 the code.
39625
39626 @item
39627 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39628 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39629 strings.
39630
39631 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39632 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39633 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39634 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39635 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39636 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39637
39638 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39639 @end enumerate
39640
39641 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39642 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39643 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39644
39645 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39646 (bit 0 = LSB):
39647
39648 @table @asis
39649
39650 @item Bits 0-23
39651 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39652 @item Bits 24-27
39653 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39654 @item Bits 28-30
39655 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39656
39657 @table @asis
39658 @item 0
39659 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39660 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39661 with previous versions of the index.
39662 @item 1
39663 The symbol is a type.
39664 @item 2
39665 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39666 @item 3
39667 The symbol is a function.
39668 @item 4
39669 Any other kind of symbol.
39670 @item 5,6,7
39671 These values are reserved.
39672 @end table
39673
39674 @item Bit 31
39675 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39676
39677 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39678 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39679 @value{GDBN} sources.
39680
39681 @end table
39682
39683 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39684 global/static attributes in the index.
39685
39686 @smallexample
39687 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39688 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39689 switch (die->tag)
39690 @{
39691 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39692 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39693 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39694 kind = TYPE;
39695 is_static = 1;
39696 break;
39697 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39698 kind = VARIABLE;
39699 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39700 break;
39701 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39702 kind = FUNCTION;
39703 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39704 break;
39705 case DW_TAG_constant:
39706 kind = VARIABLE;
39707 is_static = ! is_external;
39708 break;
39709 case DW_TAG_variable:
39710 kind = VARIABLE;
39711 is_static = ! is_external;
39712 break;
39713 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39714 kind = TYPE;
39715 is_static = 0;
39716 break;
39717 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39718 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39719 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39720 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39721 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39722 kind = TYPE;
39723 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39724 break;
39725 default:
39726 assert (0);
39727 @}
39728 @end smallexample
39729
39730 @node Man Pages
39731 @appendix Manual pages
39732 @cindex Man pages
39733
39734 @menu
39735 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39736 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39737 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39738 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39739 @end menu
39740
39741 @node gdb man
39742 @heading gdb man
39743
39744 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39745
39746 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39747 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39748 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39749 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39750 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39751 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39752 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39753 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39754 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39755 @c man end
39756
39757 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39758 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39759 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39760 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39761
39762 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39763 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39764
39765 @itemize @bullet
39766 @item
39767 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39768
39769 @item
39770 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39771
39772 @item
39773 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39774
39775 @item
39776 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39777 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39778 @end itemize
39779
39780 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39781 Modula-2.
39782
39783 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39784 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39785 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39786 by using the command @code{help}.
39787
39788 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39789 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39790 executable program as the argument:
39791
39792 @smallexample
39793 gdb program
39794 @end smallexample
39795
39796 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39797
39798 @smallexample
39799 gdb program core
39800 @end smallexample
39801
39802 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39803 to debug a running process:
39804
39805 @smallexample
39806 gdb program 1234
39807 gdb -p 1234
39808 @end smallexample
39809
39810 @noindent
39811 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39812 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39813 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39814
39815 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39816
39817 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39818 @table @env
39819 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39820 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39821
39822 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39823 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39824
39825 @item bt
39826 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39827
39828 @item print @var{expr}
39829 Display the value of an expression.
39830
39831 @item c
39832 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39833
39834 @item next
39835 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39836 function calls in the line.
39837
39838 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39839 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39840
39841 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39842 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39843
39844 @item step
39845 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39846 function calls in the line.
39847
39848 @item help [@var{name}]
39849 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39850 about using @value{GDBN}.
39851
39852 @item quit
39853 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39854 @end table
39855
39856 @ifset man
39857 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39858 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39859 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39860 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39861 @end ifset
39862 @c man end
39863
39864 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39865 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39866 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39867 encountered with no
39868 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39869 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39870 Many options have
39871 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39872 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39873 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39874 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39875 more usual convention.)
39876
39877 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39878 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39879 option is used.
39880
39881 @table @env
39882 @item -help
39883 @itemx -h
39884 List all options, with brief explanations.
39885
39886 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39887 @itemx -s @var{file}
39888 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39889
39890 @item -write
39891 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39892
39893 @item -exec=@var{file}
39894 @itemx -e @var{file}
39895 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39896 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39897 dump.
39898
39899 @item -se=@var{file}
39900 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39901 file.
39902
39903 @item -core=@var{file}
39904 @itemx -c @var{file}
39905 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39906
39907 @item -command=@var{file}
39908 @itemx -x @var{file}
39909 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39910
39911 @item -ex @var{command}
39912 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39913
39914 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39915 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39916 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39917
39918 @item -nh
39919 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39920
39921 @item -nx
39922 @itemx -n
39923 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39924
39925 @item -quiet
39926 @itemx -q
39927 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39928 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39929
39930 @item -batch
39931 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39932 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39933 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39934 commands in the command files.
39935
39936 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39937 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39938 more useful, the message
39939
39940 @smallexample
39941 Program exited normally.
39942 @end smallexample
39943
39944 @noindent
39945 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39946 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39947
39948 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39949 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39950 instead of the current directory.
39951
39952 @item -fullname
39953 @itemx -f
39954 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39955 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39956 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39957 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39958 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39959 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39960 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39961 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39962
39963 @item -b @var{bps}
39964 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39965 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39966
39967 @item -tty=@var{device}
39968 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39969 @end table
39970 @c man end
39971
39972 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39973 @ifset man
39974 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39975 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39976 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39977
39978 @smallexample
39979 info gdb
39980 @end smallexample
39981
39982 @noindent
39983 should give you access to the complete manual.
39984
39985 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39986 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39987 @end ifset
39988 @c man end
39989
39990 @node gdbserver man
39991 @heading gdbserver man
39992
39993 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
39994 @format
39995 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
39996 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
39997
39998 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
39999
40000 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40001 @c man end
40002 @end format
40003
40004 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40005 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40006 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40007
40008 @ifclear man
40009 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40010 @end ifclear
40011 @ifset man
40012 Usage (server (target) side):
40013 @end ifset
40014
40015 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40016 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40017 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40018 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40019
40020 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40021 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40022 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40023
40024 @smallexample
40025 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40026 @end smallexample
40027
40028 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40029
40030 @smallexample
40031 @ifset man
40032 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40033 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40034 @end ifset
40035 @ifclear man
40036 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40037 @end ifclear
40038 @end smallexample
40039
40040 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40041 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40042 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40043
40044 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40045
40046 @smallexample
40047 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40048 @end smallexample
40049
40050 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40051 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40052 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40053 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40054 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40055 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40056 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40057 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40058 print an error message and exit.
40059
40060 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40061 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40062
40063 @smallexample
40064 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40065 @end smallexample
40066
40067 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40068 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40069
40070 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40071 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40072 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40073 the program you want to debug.
40074
40075 @smallexample
40076 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40077 @end smallexample
40078
40079 @ifclear man
40080 @subheading Usage (host side)
40081 @end ifclear
40082 @ifset man
40083 Usage (host side):
40084 @end ifset
40085
40086 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40087 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40088 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40089 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40090 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40091 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40092 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40093 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40094 descriptor. For example:
40095
40096 @smallexample
40097 @ifset man
40098 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40099 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40100 @end ifset
40101 @ifclear man
40102 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40103 @end ifclear
40104 @end smallexample
40105
40106 @noindent
40107 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40108
40109 @smallexample
40110 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40111 @end smallexample
40112
40113 @noindent
40114 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40115 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40116 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40117 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40118 `Connection refused'.
40119
40120 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40121 described in
40122 @ifset man
40123 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40124 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40125 @end ifset
40126 @ifclear man
40127 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40128 @end ifclear
40129 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40130
40131 @smallexample
40132 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40133 @end smallexample
40134
40135 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40136 case.
40137 @c man end
40138
40139 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40140 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40141
40142 @itemize @bullet
40143
40144 @item
40145 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40146
40147 @smallexample
40148 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40149 @end smallexample
40150
40151 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40152 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40153 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40154 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40155 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40156 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40157 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40158
40159 @item
40160 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40161 program:
40162
40163 @smallexample
40164 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40165 @end smallexample
40166
40167 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40168 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40169 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40170 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40171
40172 @item
40173 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40174
40175 @smallexample
40176 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40177 @end smallexample
40178
40179 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40180 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40181 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40182 debug several processes in the same session.
40183 @end itemize
40184
40185 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40186
40187 @table @env
40188
40189 @item --help
40190 List all options, with brief explanations.
40191
40192 @item --version
40193 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40194
40195 @item --attach
40196 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40197
40198 @smallexample
40199 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40200 @end smallexample
40201
40202 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40203 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40204
40205 @item --multi
40206 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40207 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40208 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40209 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40210
40211 @smallexample
40212 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40213 @end smallexample
40214
40215 @item --debug
40216 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40217 process.
40218 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40219 the developers.
40220
40221 @item --remote-debug
40222 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40223 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40224 the developers.
40225
40226 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40227 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40228 of debugging output.
40229 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40230
40231 @item --wrapper
40232 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40233 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40234 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40235 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40236
40237 @item --once
40238 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40239 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40240 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40241 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40242
40243 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40244
40245 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40246 @c QDisableRandomization.
40247
40248 @end table
40249 @c man end
40250
40251 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40252 @ifset man
40253 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40254 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40255 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40256
40257 @smallexample
40258 info gdb
40259 @end smallexample
40260
40261 should give you access to the complete manual.
40262
40263 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40264 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40265 @end ifset
40266 @c man end
40267
40268 @node gcore man
40269 @heading gcore
40270
40271 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40272
40273 @format
40274 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40275 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40276 @c man end
40277 @end format
40278
40279 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40280 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40281 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40282 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40283 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40284 running without any change.
40285 @c man end
40286
40287 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40288 @table @env
40289 @item -o @var{filename}
40290 The optional argument
40291 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40292 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40293 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40294 @end table
40295 @c man end
40296
40297 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40298 @ifset man
40299 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40300 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40301 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40302
40303 @smallexample
40304 info gdb
40305 @end smallexample
40306
40307 @noindent
40308 should give you access to the complete manual.
40309
40310 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40311 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40312 @end ifset
40313 @c man end
40314
40315 @node gdbinit man
40316 @heading gdbinit
40317
40318 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40319
40320 @format
40321 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40322 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40323 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40324 @end ifset
40325
40326 ~/.gdbinit
40327
40328 ./.gdbinit
40329 @c man end
40330 @end format
40331
40332 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40333 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40334 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40335 described in
40336 @ifset man
40337 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40338 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40339 @end ifset
40340 @ifclear man
40341 @ref{Sequences}.
40342 @end ifclear
40343
40344 Please read more in
40345 @ifset man
40346 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40347 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40348 @end ifset
40349 @ifclear man
40350 @ref{Startup}.
40351 @end ifclear
40352
40353 @table @env
40354 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40355 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40356 @end ifset
40357 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40358 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40359 @end ifclear
40360 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40361 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40362 See more in
40363 @ifset man
40364 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40365 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40366 @end ifset
40367 @ifclear man
40368 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40369 @end ifclear
40370
40371 @item ~/.gdbinit
40372 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40373 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40374
40375 @item ./.gdbinit
40376 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40377 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40378 See more in
40379 @ifset man
40380 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40381 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40382 @end ifset
40383 @ifclear man
40384 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40385 @end ifclear
40386 @end table
40387 @c man end
40388
40389 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40390 @ifset man
40391 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40392
40393 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40394 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40395 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40396
40397 @smallexample
40398 info gdb
40399 @end smallexample
40400
40401 should give you access to the complete manual.
40402
40403 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40404 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40405 @end ifset
40406 @c man end
40407
40408 @include gpl.texi
40409
40410 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40411 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40412 @include fdl.texi
40413
40414 @node Concept Index
40415 @unnumbered Concept Index
40416
40417 @printindex cp
40418
40419 @node Command and Variable Index
40420 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40421
40422 @printindex fn
40423
40424 @tex
40425 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40426 % meantime:
40427 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40428 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40429 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40430 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40431 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40432 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40433 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40434 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40435 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40436 \page\colophon
40437 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40438 @end tex
40439
40440 @bye
This page took 0.992057 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.